40913448-1C48-4E68-A548-49193BF94628 Askeland2017Values-basedleadership.Overviewofthehistoricaltrajectory IntrotoIASM-Session4-2009forStudents 12AFD439-972A-48EF-BB78-9042B7DDB9D5 Almog-Bar2014Collaborationbetweenphilantropicfoundationsandgovernment 5A124270-CE4A-4D38-A11C-E475932BF55A 8A153DF4-42CC-4BDD-91EF-A6DF695DC6E0 8048263D-FD7A-4D58-AE26-A77B397852FE A53BF6FD-3006-4B3E-9DEB-C70CAF918175 25D21726-CF76-482B-B1BC-D42187EB58E2 45EE94C5-91C2-4823-858C-8EE590F384AF F9EAF6F4-6C21-4166-83ED-9BF5378249CF 2020_Book_UnderstandingValuesWork 865754A8-C2CE-479E-A769-D03D3FF78316 36666668-AA55-46AF-A08C-1B8035B0BC07 A3090CDF-D24D-46A5-B862-5DE91951D258 426DB78D-A1BE-4B01-9AF4-E70455824425 57DF8108-A839-4690-960E-4B72296C1DD0 E101019E-56B2-4192-96EB-480AF21A6070 B0954C0E-A10E-4B1E-B4F6-23F6A08BAA6B
Organization leader ship and social innovation
1
Askeland, H. (2017). Values-based leadership: Overview of the historical trajectory
(Unpublished translation). From E. Aadland & H. Askeland (Eds.), Verdibevisst
ledelse [Values-based leadership]. Oslo: Cappelen Damm.
Values in organization and leadership
Evolving perspectives within the frame of Values-based leadership
Harald Askeland
From the late 1970’s theories of values-based leadership (VBL) evolved as a concept
accompanying the turn to leadership (Brown and Treviño 2003, Copeland 2014, Askeland
2017), which gradually replaced terms such as administration and management. Yet, few
contributions have addressed the content of and differing conceptualizations of values-
based leadership through its historical trajectory within management and leadership
literature. This article tracks the theoretical foundations and basic premises behind key
contributions of VBL into four different main theoretical perspectives. In doing so, the
article present, compare and discuss key contributions. The article identify a broader set of
theories and perspectives of the concept compared to prior contributions, and propose
further venues of development: VBL need a more distinct integration with theories of
management and/or leadership, empirical research of applications through practice-
oriented studies, a linkage to the renewed interest in institutional leadership as institutional
work and contributions of public values.
Values-based leadership, or a marked focus on values and leadership, appeared as an
important new approach in the leadership discipline from the late 1970’s (Brown and
Treviño 2003). Several contributions frame the perspective focusing on structural theories
(Quinn and Rohrbaugh 1983), but the mostly cited contributions relate to individual
perspectives such as “The New Leadership Approach” (Bryman 1993) and renewed interest
in charismatic leadership (House 1976, House 1996) and transformational leadership
(Avolio and Bass 1995). Conceiving leadership as formation of meaning can also be linked
to this turn of perspective (Smircich and Morgan 1982). As far as I can find references to
the concept, the first articles on values-based leadership were written by, respectively,
Robert House (1976), who discussed charismatic values-based leadership, and by James
Woods, who mentioned values-based leadership in a study on religious leadership (Wood
1981). Meanwhile, James McGregor Burns, through his study of political leadership,
referred to as “transforming leadership,” laid the foundation for the later development of
transformational leadership (Burns 1978). This period also saw a clear, increasing
emphasis on organizational culture, with values at the core of culture (Schein 1985).
Nevertheless, existing presentations provide a somewhat simplified picture of the
perspectives labeled values-based leadership. Not least, it seems important to explore the
traditions’ intellectual roots. Second, there are different contributions and theories
identified with values-based leadership. These approaches have distinct and differing or
2
overlapping theoretical positions. Thirdly, a distinct Scandinavian approach of values-
based leadership (Petersen and Lassen 1997, Brytting and Trollestad 2000, Aadland,
Askeland et al. 2006) is left un-noticed together with a political science based interest in
public values (Moore 1995, Jørgensen and Vrangbæk 2011), largely utilizing more
collective perspectives with a distinct focus on shared values. This generates a lack of
clarity in academic research and conceptualization of values-based leadership as a whole,
as well as for practical application and implementation. Another aspect is that different
approaches arise from different academic paradigms. Ambiguity exist on whether the
approach is part of leadership theory, and this article conclude in arguing for the application
of concepts of VBL or values in organization and leadership, by clarifying and integrating
it with general management and leadership theory.
This article address the following questions regarding understanding how values-based
leadership theories has emerged and what it has become:
1. What are the underlying paradigms of values-based leadership?
2. How do theories of values-based leadership conceive its content, practice and effect
compared across different approaches?
Fundamentals in Leadership: Basic paradigms
Different leadership theories often build on different academic paradigms and often
represent one or several basic perspectives on organization and leadership. Such basic
positions relates to various positions of philosophy of science (Hollis 2002; Jørgensen et
al. 2016; Vanebo 2001). Two key dimensions can illustrate these basic positions, with
consequences for studies on and explanations of social action and organization. One is the
theory of knowledge, or epistemology, and the other is action theory or ontology (Askeland
2016).
The first dimension involves whether different perspectives on social reality is regarded as
“objective” reality that can provide certain knowledge or whether reality first becomes
“real” through our interpretation and “construction.” The first view is referred to as
positivism, while the second is most often referred to as subjectivism. Based on this
dimension, we can see different theories that relate to the understanding of reality and to
rationality. On one hand, based on a positivist approach, many organizational and
leadership theories will underpin a type of rationality referred to as “analytical” or
“purposeful.” On the other hand, a subjectivist approach leads to a rationality of
interpretation that involves evaluation, dialogue and negotiation in decision-making
processes. Therefore, some are concerned with ensuring that the organization and its
leadership follow clear goals and perform a clear analysis of what promotes effective
achievement, while others are concerned about the different interests to safeguard; and,
therefore, they interpret, negotiate and renegotiate the goals and premises that determine
organizational practices.
The second dimension involves action theory: whether organizational and leadership
theories and explanatory models should be based on broad structures or on individual
3
assessments and the need to understand individual and collective actions. While the first
approach is referred to as structure-oriented, the second approach is referred to as actor-
oriented.
All models of organizations as coherent entities can be reduced to two basic views:
organizations as social systems, sustained by the roles allocated to their
participants, and organizations as associations of self-interested parties, sustained
by the rewards the participants derive from their association with the organization
(Aldrich et al. 1992: 27).
Table 1: Classification of perspectives in organization and leadership theory, with
implications for values (Hollis 2002; Kemmis 2011; Vanebo 2001).
Theoretical dimension of knowledge
Action theory
dimension
Positivist
Rational/analytical
Subjectivist
Interpretive
Structure
Collective
System
Systems in dependent and strategic
adaptation to the environment
Leadership understood as social
interaction, i.e. ritual, function,
system-structured
Commonly formulated values based
on dialogue and compromise among
stakeholders
Institution
Organizations characterized by culture,
rules and norms in the organizational
field
Leadership understood as socially
structured, shaped by discourse and
tradition
Organizational values adapted to
society’s values and as a framework
for the organization’s members
Actor
Individual
Instrument
The organization as a tool for
meeting goals: rational agents acting
collectively for utility
Leadership understood as
individual behavior, based on
performance, events and effect
Owners’ values /Individuals with
stable preferences and values
Association
Intentional actors with common goals
and values and with an interest in the
organization’s survival
Leadership understood as intentional
action, shaped by meaning and values.
Group of individuals with shared
values and intentions
Authors conceptualizing organizations in terms of structural factors often refer to
organizations as systems. Here, I understand an organization as an established system that
sets the conditions for individual action and where different functions are defined through
structuring and role allocation. Others will be concerned that organizations are a collection
of individuals who consider it useful to collaborate on task solving around specific goals;
in this case, organizations can be referred to as associations. Theories with this starting
point are based on the understanding of organizations and their leadership as individuals
joining because they consider it beneficial to solve problems together. These different
approaches are summarized as they appear in Table 1.
4
This way of dividing the discipline of organization and leadership theory assigns different
contributions to different key theoretical positions. These positions are important to
academic approaches, whereas existing literature has placed little emphasis on these
connections. For example, a chosen approach may seem to include both theories that
implicitly assume a systems perspective on organizations as well as free choice and action
by individuals (and individual organizations). The table shows how the application of these
two dimensions can provide the basis for dividing and categorizing four main views on the
subject of organizations and leadership, with implications for understanding values and
leadership. The division is an attempt to categorize theories used to understand and analyze
organizations and leadership and later in the article will form the framework for discussion
of different approaches to values-based leadership. Before doing so, however, I present
some classic contributions to understanding leadership and their treatment of values and
leadership.
Historical lines of thought in terms of values and
leadership: Contributions by the classics
Although the concept of values-based leadership can be traced back to the late 1970s and
early 80s, ideas of values and leadership have a significantly longer history in leadership.
Max Weber used “value rationality” as a concept (Weber and Jordheim 1999), while
leadership discipline pioneer Chester Barnard was concerned with leaders taking on the
key role of establishing values in organizations (Barnard 1938). Philip Selznick, who
emphasized that leaders «infuse organizations with values» and thereby contribute to
institutionalization (Selznick 1957), put forward similar ideas. Before presenting the
various approaches representing theories of values-based leadership, it may be useful to
recapitulate the core of the classics’ contributions.
Values and leadership – Chester Barnard and Philip Selznick
In many ways, Chester Barnard1, shaped the understanding of value focus and value
creation in the normative sense as a key task for leaders. He was an inspiration for both
aforementioned traditions: the analytical and rational perspective as well as the
interpretative and natural one (Scott 1995). Barnard referred to organizations as both
formal and informal and pointed to leaders as both rational actors and moral models. Thus,
he laid the foundation for further professional work in an economic/rationally inspired
direction, as well as in the theoretical school of institutionalism.
Organizations facilitate cooperation among actors who are conscious and purpose-oriented.
He was concerned that members joined organizations voluntarily to ensuing interactions
serving a common purpose. In this sense, leaders’ tasks were “those of control,
management, supervision, administration in formal organizations” (Barnard 1938: 6).
1Furthermore, Barnard is regarded as one of the very first to publish a book on organizational theory. He
found little help in classical texts on management (Taylor and Fayol), nor within the broader social sciences
literature – at least in terms of organizations. He is considered important for having brought experience into
the academic field.
5
Leaders had to ensure that an incentive system would help members find a reason to
participate in the organization and contribute to satisfying its purpose. At the same time,
Barnard was concerned with another matter, namely that members’ connection to
organizations rested largely on non-material, informal and almost moral bases. A key
aspect for organizations to function was therefore the formation of a collective purpose that
is almost morally binding on its members. Out of the critical space, Barnard sees this
formation of meaning in organizational life as leaders’ central task:
The distinguishing mark of the executive responsibility is that it requires not merely
conformance to a complex code of morals but also the creation of moral codes for
others. The most generally recognized aspect of this function is called securing,
creating, inspiring of “morale” in an organization. (Barnard 1938:279).
This aspect of Barnard’s scientific contributions has been less focused (O’Neill 1992: 200),
but is an important platform for understanding managers’ values-based, ethical and moral
responsibility. For him, the manager’s overall position in relation to employees and
responsibility involved ensuring that the organization’s members maintained an acceptable
ethical standard in their work, which represents a key concept of leadership. Managers’
responsibilities in this field related, on one hand, to creating value, and, on the other, to
interpreting and balancing the different values that exist side-by-side in organizations
(O’Neill 1992: 202).
It is argued that Barnard strongly emphasized leaders’ function of convincing employees
and of tying their emotions, motivation and loyalty into the organization’s purpose (Scott
1995: 41f). Thus, he established organizational unity and approach-centered consensus and
deemphasized natural and existing conflicts of interest as well as different groupings in
organizations.
Selznick followed these trails in his understanding of leadership, while others have
followed Barnard’s work later on in developing an understanding of organizational culture
and opinion formation (Deal and Kennedy 1982; Ouchi 1980; Smircich and Morgan 1982).
Selznick greatly influenced early institutional theory of organizations, not least through the
formulation of the leadership role in relation to shaping values in organizations. He begins
his book briefly formulating his main thesis:
The executive becomes a statesman as he makes the transition from administrative
management to institutional leadership (Selznick 1984 [1957]: 4).
Behind this claim lay his view on organizations; Selznick affirmed that, in the strict sense,
the term “organization” was linked to a legitimate system of consciously coordinated
activities, an instrument that was designed to do a job – and thus interchangeable. On the
other hand, institutions were a natural product of social need and impressions – a receptive
and adaptable organism. Here again, one sees a fundamentally different view of
organizations, as either rational and analytical or natural and interpretative, respectively.
Selznick emphasized that organizations comprised people and constituted a vibrant social
environment that had to be cared for.
6
Institutionalization is understood as a process that depends on the organization, over time,
developing a distinctive history, as well as the dynamics that emerge when stakeholders
interact to produce results in adaptation to their environment. That something can be seen
as an institution is that it has become
Infuse with value beyond the technical requirements the task at hands (Selznick
1984 [1957]:17).
A fundamental failure of leadership occurs when one neglects to work on clarifying an
institution’s purpose – the reason for its existence:
In this sense, the leader becomes an advocate for institutionalization, offering a
guiding hand to processes that would otherwise occur more haphazardly, more
readily subject to the accidents and circumstances of history (…) The institutional
manager is however primarily an expert in the promotion and protection of values
(Selznick 1984 [1957]:27).
The basic purpose of clarifying purpose and basic values lies in the fact that they can
influence attitudes and practices – they provide social integration that far exceeds the
capacity of formal coordination and a traditional command structure. Leaders contribute to
policy through decisive decisions, which, in contrast to administration (routine decisions),
have the potential to characterize the organization’s development. Such decisive decisions
relate to staff recruitment and training, the establishment of systems for balancing different
interests in an organization and cooperation with other organizations. Selznick articulates
basic leadership functions as:
• Formulating the institution’s mission and role, by setting goals based on internal
and external requirements that govern the organization’s commitment
• Incorporating purpose into the organization’s life, i.e. building it into the social
structure
• Defending institutional integrity by maintaining values and a clear organizational
identity
• Solving internal conflicts, by contributing to balanced interests among the various
units and groups that together form the organization (Selznick 1984 [1957]:62-64).
Both Barnard and Selznick share a clear focus: infusing organizations with certain values
is a key leadership task. While Barnard includes this dimension as a constituent element of
leadership practice, Selznick believes that it establishes the distinction between
administrator and manager. In either case, the implication is clear: The leader is the one
who contribute to shaping the organization’s values. These particular values are to be linked
to general ethical and moral standards, but also to the specific values that give the
organization a distinctive character. This important premise underlies much of today’s
literature and practice in values-based leadership.
7
Values-based leadership – Presentation and discussion of
various contributions
Initially, I argued that there are different academic perspectives in the understanding of
values-based leadership and that these are related to theoretical perspectives with different
basic assumptions. In this part of the article, the previously presented classification of
theoretical traditions will form the starting point for classification in the landscape of
different contributions to values-based leadership.
In the literature dealing with values-based leadership, I believe there is a distinction among
values being understood, values taking root and values relating to leadership that can be
linked to the previously mentioned dimensions. Earlier in the article, these two dimensions
formed the basis for the development of four dominant approaches within the profession
of organizations and leadership. Although different approaches to values-based leadership
can relate to these main approaches, they will often also operate at or above the boundary
between them. In this context, the dimensions mentioned above, which have formed the
basis for the division, must be seen as a continuum between idealized positions rather than
as mutually exclusive categories.
Instrument: An economically rational perspective and ideas about charisma
and transformation
In the international, and particularly the Anglo-American, contributions, much literature
on values-based leadership seems to be rooted in a rational and individual approach. The
various contributions presented here are in debt to a positivist view of science with a
rational theory-of-action basis. At the same time, these contributions share a perspective
that is rooted in the individual and that emphasizes managers’ ability to connect others to
organizational goals and ideals.
One of the clearest advocates of such an approach is Patrick Lencioni, who applies a narrow
and instrumental concept of values. He emphasizes that values must be authentic for
application in a company’s operational practice, with clear implications for action. This
function is safeguarded by what Lencioni calls core values: “deeply ingrained principles
that guide all of a company’s actions; they serve as its cultural cornerstones” (Lencioni
2002: 6). Thus, he emphasizes the instrumental function of values in an organization. To
ensure that values possess the elements required for this purpose, he argues that they should
not be based on consensus among employees but rather be developed by senior leadership
in cooperation with founders and owners (2002:7f). It is leadership’s responsibility to
ensure that employees understand, adhere to and live out core values in practice. This
should be done by weighing the values into all of the organization’s processes, from
recruitment to production and evaluation.
More common in this approach, and clearly from the mid-1970s, is the formulation of
different theories with clear common features: Charismatic leadership, visionary leadership
8
and transformational leadership (Bryman 1993). These theories have important common
features linked to how leaders achieve exceptional results and how they achieve high
employee motivation and identification with the manager and organization’s goals and
values. What links these versions of values-based leadership to this main approach is the
focus on the individual as an actor in combination with focus on shared values. At the same
time, the content very much maintain a rationality building on a positivist and analytical
basis.
Robert J. House is credited for introducing a new focus in charismatic leadership theory
(House 1976), also referred to as “values-based leadership,” (Brown and Treviño 2003;
Busch 2012). In several works, he has presented and developed leadership theories that
have values and values-based leadership behavior as a key element. His early contributions
were particularly oriented towards charismatic leadership that moves and motivates
employees and towards leaders’ ability to influence others by promoting ideas and values
that challenge the established order (House 1976:7). It is believed that charismatic leaders
are effective because they, among other things, articulate or model ideological values that
employees hold or identify with. Eventually leaders are able to frame the organization’s
goals and tasks in a context of meaning that indirectly relates to such values. This context
is formulated as follows: “A necessary condition for a leader to have charismatic effect is
that the role of followers be defined in ideological terms that appeal to the follower” (House
1976:28). Characteristics of leaders perceived as charismatic are as follows: Dominance,
self-esteem, the need to influence others and a belief in one’s own values.
A later revision of the theory (House 1996) included values-based leadership behavior as
one of eight leadership behavior categories2. Values-based leadership behavior is
expressed in this way:
Theoretically such effects are accomplished by appealing to subordinates’
cherished values and nonconscious motives and by engaging their self-perceived
identities, enhancing their self-efficacy and sense of consistency, and making their
self-worth contingent on their contribution to the leaders’ mission and the
collective. (…) Value based leader behaviors include:
• Articulation of a vision of a better future for followers, to which the followers
are claimed to have a moral right
• Display of passion for the vision, and significant self-sacrifice in the interest of
the
vision and the collective
• Demonstration of self-confidence, confidence in the attainment of the vision,
and determination and persistence in the interest of the vision
• Selectively arousal of the nonconscious motives of followers that are of special
relevance to the attainment of the vision
• Taking extraordinary personal and organizational risks in the interest of the
vision and the collective
2 Other leadership behavior categories include: Goal clarification, goal-orientation, work organization,
supportive leadership behavior, organization of interaction, group-oriented decision-making, representation
and networking.
9
• Communication of high performance expectations of followers and confidence
in their ability to contribute to the collective effort
• The use of symbolic behaviors that emphasize the values inherent in the
collective vision
• Frequent positive evaluations of followers and the collective (House 1996:343).
House also emphasizes that values-based leadership must be based on leaders’
contributions to articulating moral or ideological goals for the organization or on help
interpreting work done in a wider context of ideological implications. Thus, it is also
assumed that values-based leadership must agree with employees’ internalized values. As
a form of leadership, values-based leadership is also closely linked to employees’ internal
motivation, when leaders mobilize around intangible values.
Many who could be categorized as theorists of transformational leadership clearly draw
from Burns’ study of political leadership (Burns 1978). Burns based his theory on material
and insights from political and religious leadership, arguing for a view of leadership that
involves leaders and co-workers lifting each other up to a higher level of morale and
motivation. His contribution were later applied to various types of business activity (Avolio
and Bass 1995; Bass 1990; Conger and Kanungo 1987; Posner 1987), an application that
cannot be regarded as unproblematic (Brown and Treviño 2003:155).
A key element of this tradition is the definition of leadership largely by the manager and
the manager’s ability to generate results, mobilize employee preparedness and increase
employees’ motivation to work (Aditya 1997: 439). Some argue that transformational
leadership is characterized by four key aspects, where a leader:
• Has charisma and act as a model
• Motivates others by inspiring them
• Asks questions about the state of things and encourages new thinking
• Shows concern for the individual’s particular needs (Hetland 2004:96).
What makes transformational leadership especially interesting in this context is the
connection made to values. A basic premise in the theoretical contribution is that
individuals are not only rational actors, but they also seek motives for expressing
themselves. The special role of leaders is assumed to consist of:
Charismatic leaders link organizational goals and missions to their followers´ self-
concepts. An important aspect of followers´ sense of self is based on a sense of
virtue and moral worth. Charismatic leaders infuse work with values and purpose,
giving it meaning that instrumental or transactional leaders do not. Charismatic
leaders emphasize a collective identity and make inspirational ideological appeals
that tap into followers´ values (Brown & Trevino 2003:159f).
Brown and Treviño raise critical questions about whether it is possible to establish such a
foundation of moral values in business and claims that there is no documented transfer of
these kinds of values from manager to employee in businesses. Others also point out this
lack of documentation:
10
For example, the neo-charismatic theories offer inadequate or untested
explanations of the process, by which the theoretical leader behaviors are linked
to, and influence, the affective state of followers (Aditya et al 1997:442).
The approaches that have been mentioned in this context are based on key ideas from the
discipline’s classics regarding leadership personalities and the ability of a values-focus to
bring meaning into organizational practice. Several studies document the link between
leaders perceived to be charismatic and values-oriented and organizational efficiency and
employee motivation. At the same time, it is unclear how values and actions relate to one
another and which processes unfold in interaction between managers and employees and
contribute to consensus on values and value-oriented practices.
Association and community
The second perspective highlighted here is an approach that, in different ways, focuses on
the importance of nonmaterial values for the organization and leadership. Common to the
theories presented here is the assumption that basic values, either individual or collective,
help shape assessments and actions – and that this concerns leadership. The differences
mainly follow the dividing lines linked to the leader’s “management of meaning” (Smircich
and Morgan 1982) or how shared values and meaning are created.
The perspectives presented here are applied in different ways. After Selznick, many of the
ideas seem to remain inactive until the 80s. Some attribute this renewed interest to the
introduction of Japanism and to the focus on values and culture as a Western academic
response (Ouchi 1980; Schein 1985). At the same time, other contributions can be traced,
not least in connection with research on religious and non-profit organizations in civil
society. The contributions highlighted here build on traditions that can be linked to Weber,
Barnard and Selznick.
The group of works presented are divided into two even though they have a common focus
on culture, values and leadership. One of the first to use the term “values-based leadership”
was James Wood in a study of leadership in American religious congregations (Wood
1981). The context was challenges associated with whether religious assemblies should be
ethnically mixed. He demonstrates how pastors and religious leaders contributed to change
individual attitudes of opposition to ethnically mixed churches by focusing on fundamental
values in the Christian tradition. With values-based leadership, he argues for the possibility
of generating support around “” and thereby helping the organization’s members to place
less emphasis on their own the common good self-interest. The requirement for leaders in
such a context will naturally be that they actually articulate the organization’s core values
with which the members also agree. Leadership is thus about articulating and showing how
common values can shed new light on a situation and lead to alternative courses of action.
Weber also discussed the importance of religious values in his study of how the Protestant
ethic laid the foundation for a set of actions that laid the foundation for the emergence of
capitalism. An example from Norway are Hans Nielsen Hauge’s combination of preaching
11
and business ventures (Fløistad 2007). In addition, within other religious traditions, there
is an indication of the possibility that religious values can form the basis of leadership. This
has happened in both an Islamic tradition (Ryan 2000) and a Hindu tradition (Krishnan
2002).
Over a decade, contributions on values and values-based leadership has appeared in a
Scandinavian context. One of those most often credited with introducing the concept in a
Scandinavian context is Verner C. Petersen (1997)3. Approaches linked to this tradition
stand out by not basing themselves on the leader as a charismatic person, as in the literature
by Burns, House and Bass. On the contrary, it was deemed crucial for values to be shared
in the organization and become part of it and for managers’ contributions to involve
contributing to a common articulation and understanding of the values’ content and
consequences. A major concern has been how values can be made into leadership tools for
organizational practices based on self-management, partly to supplement and partly to
substitute regulations and objectives-based leadership (Petersen and Lassen 1997; Thyssen
2007):
Leadership involves more. It involves the ability to have a limited group of people
working together, consistently and over time towards common goals, without
pressure or the ecstasy of power. It is also about values-based
management/leadership. In this context, leadership comprises the common values
for the entire organization. This basis of values highlights attitudes and values that
the business has chosen to represent (Petersen and Lassen 1997)4.
Petersen’s contribution to understanding values-based leadership is summarized in a few
simple points that emphasize judgment and understanding over clear goals and governance.
Leading requires the following:
• One should lead guided by a purpose that is often difficult to explain.
• One must trust that employees can both organize and commit themselves to work
towards common goals and values.
• One must lead ambiguously, leaving room for independence and creativity.
• One must lead with consistency and direction.
• As a leader, one must be willing to lead.
Swedish researchers Tomas Brytting and Claes Trollestad also advocate an approach in
which communicative rationality and leaders should first and foremost be seen as observers
and interpreters of values that are prevalent in the organizational culture (Brytting and
Trollestad 2000: 74). In this way, they seek to counter empirical findings, where leaders
perceive that the environment constitutes an economic rationality they cannot avoid, where
the organization and individual must adapt to this value and where leaders should primarily
formulate values with which the employees can identify.
3 Among other things, several Danish papers that have recently summed up the status of values-based
management have done this.
4 The authors translation
12
In a Norwegian context, several studies conducted emphasize the importance of values in
business management and leadership, especially in the public and non-profit sectors. In
2006, a study of values-based leadership in eight different not-for-profit organizations was
published, describing VBL in the following way:
This understanding of leadership is based on the fact that clarification and
awareness of values in an organization is a key asset for business leadership.
Whereas VBL was previously guided by rules and instructions and later by the
clarification and pursuit of objectives, it now looks to a broader business
foundation – one embodied in vision and values. (…) Values describe the basic
focus one wants a business to have, and this focus serves as a guideline for
individual employees in choices made and priorities set on a daily basis. (…) VBL
is not just a leadership philosophy but also an organizational development model
that accompanies a business’s basic intention (value platform). Through various
measures and processes, one ensures that a high degree of awareness of core
values is maintained throughout the organization (Aadland et al. 2006: 27).
Values-based leadership is viewed as an approach to leadership, where one does not
operate on the basis of a standardized understanding of what this implies or how it should
be practiced. Meanwhile, within this approach, different proposals have been made about
how to work on clarifying and implementing values in businesses (Aadland 2004).
However, also within this approach, leaders become key players in the value process.
Among other things, through the fact that they hold a position that allows them to take
initiative and prioritize value consciousness. A leader’s personality and practices also seem
to be crucial to the credibility and scope of values work (Aadland et al. 2006: 70). The
HSH study also found that a values orientation from a company’s founding, usually by one
of the founders, often plays an important role in how the organization understands itself
and its purpose. For many organizations, especially within civil society, this purpose could
be associated with purposes based on religious ideals or humanistic ideology. The study
found that an ideological basis were activated in all cases, but significantly more clearly
formulated as the basis for leadership in organizations with a generally humanistic
ideological basis (Aadland et al. 2006: 86).
The approaches to values-based leadership outlined here stand out as they are less
connected to general management and leadership theories. For example, while House
(1996) builds a comprehensive management theory that puts values-based leadership
behavior at the core, this perspective is absent in Scandinavian contributions. An exception
in this regard is a recent contribution (Busch 2012) linking values-based leadership to an
already established process theory of leadership (Johnsen 1992). On the other hand,
Scandinavian contributions are considerably more concerned with process and
implementation work, especially employee participation.
Institution: Values, organization and leadership
Values and leadership have a central place in contributions linked to institutional theory.
This basic task is associated with theories that focus institutional leadership (Selznick
1957), and can be linked to the following basic features: 1) clarifying the organization’s
13
mission and goals; 2) realizing this purpose in the organization’s life and endeavors; and 3)
helping the organization and its members formulate and maintain basic values in the
context.
Again, this perspective is often used in relation to nonprofit, religious and political
institutions (Carroll 2011; Jørgensen 2006; Talleraas and Haga 2012). According to this
perspective, the leader becomes an agent for institutionalization, who helps set goals and
permeate the organization with values. Thus, the leader plays an important role in
institutionalizing values and shaping the organization’s character, so that members identify
themselves with the organization and remain faithful to its tasks and goals (Eriksen 1999:
137). The leader’s role is seen as proactive, in part because of its contribution to shaping
specific values and in part because of the leader’s articulation and interpretation of basic
value positions in given situations – whether they are known or new (O’Neill 1992). This
function becomes particularly critical when the organization faces new or unknown
challenges. The importance of institutionalization lies in the way which it forms the
framework in relation to which the organization, environments and courses of action are
assessed. Eriksen has focused on leaders who motivate subordinates to pursue goals for
purely material reasons, i.e. mobilization through language tools.
A clearer focus on values in the public sector has also emerged in recent years, often under
the name “public values”” (Moore 1995). Moore linked public values to the provision of
relevant services, to the realization of social goals and to the preservation of trust and
legitimacy in the public sector. A field in which this approach differs somewhat from the
one mentioned above is that it more strongly emphasizes that value-consciousness also
deals with conflict among values and the management of values dilemmas. Key values in
the public sector, often referred to as “public ethos,” link to societal accountability, public
disclosure and transparency, good and proper case management and independent
professional standards (Jørgensen and Vrangbæk 2011). Studies have investigated which
value orientations public sector leaders have, with potential implications for their
assessments and decisions. There seems to be agreement among government leaders across
countries and political cultures that leadership should ensure integrity through independent,
professional public administration (Jørgensen and Vrangbæk 2013: 120). A recent
Norwegian study showed that values such as professional standards, the adaptation of
services to residents, good case management and loyalty to policy decisions were seen as
the most important (Wennes and Busch 2012). At the same time, this study shows that
public values are reported to be changing, since values such as user orientation, innovation,
professional standards and loyalty to policy decisions have gained ground. Values losing
ground are reported to be equal treatment, employee career prospects, continuity and
accountability to society.
The “institutional work framework” is an approach that contributes to a renewed
relationship between values and leadership in the framework of an institutional perspective
(Lawrence et al. 2009). This approach is be seen as a reaction to the new institutional
perspective having theorized about organizational change and equal treatment without
sufficiently incorporating actors and intentional action. Institutional work is defined as “the
purposive action of individuals and organizations aimed at creating, maintaining and
14
disrupting institutions”” (Lawrence and Suddaby 2006: 215). An important factor is also
the connection to practice theory, emphasizing intentional action by individuals and
organizations seeking to handle the premises and demands of daily work. In this context, I
would like to emphasize in particular how they describe the core elements of efforts to
maintain institutions:
Table 2: Different types of institutional maintenance work (Lawrence & Suddaby 2006)
Type of institutional work Definition
Facilitating work Creating rules that promote, complement
and support the institution: Authorization
of actors and allocation of resources
Monitoring Ensuring compliance through the
management, evaluation and monitoring of
results
Creating/preventing Establishing barriers to institutional
change
Valourizing Ensuring that actors can participate in
positive and negative examples that
illustrate the normative basis
Mythologization Maintaining the normative assumptions by
creating and maintaining myths about
institutional history
Inventing and routinizing Actively infusing the normative basis in
actors’ daily work, routines and practices
Valourizing-work can be classified as the type of institutional work that is referred to as
appreciative, “valourizing.” Various contributions can be categorized as belonging to this
new approach in the field of institutional theory; contributions that focus on the value of
work and analyze how values manifest themselves and evolve within organizations
(Gehman et al. 2013), as well as contributions that illustrate how leaders, together with
relevant actors, contribute to value creation in organizations (Askeland 2014). Both of
these examples can be classified under institutional work and share a practice perspective
on leadership and values work. An analysis of several contributions points to the fact that
values work is done both in different phases and by measures (activities) at different levels.
Central phases could be the initiation and articulation of value issues, participation by
actors and groups, the concretization and manifestation of values practices, and the
maintenance of values bases and practices. At the same time, different activities and
initiatives could be related to different levels, such as: Frames and events (“set-ups”), an
information plan that indirectly controls organizational activities through interaction and
relationships among actors and on a more concrete action plan.
Askeland seeks to integrate leaders’ contribution to values work with the function of
leadership, through an integrated model (Askeland 2015). The model first synthesizes
contributions by Mintzberg and Quinn and then describes four basic functions and role
profiles that leaders fulfill: Director, Service Developer, Integrator and Intermediary. This
15
division appears when two core dimensions are applied: task versus relationship orientation
and internal versus external focus. Second, Selznick’s contribution to institutional
leadership is integrated, using the institutional leader as a force for integration, focusing on
the whole and on outcomes, as well as on values and meaning formation.
System and diversity of stakeholders
A basic idea in systems theory is to provide a holistic view of the organization. At the same
time, it is emphasized that organizations as systems are part of a strategic and dependent
adaptation to external environments; while internally there can be different subsystems
with different degrees of coordination. Robert Quinn (1984), who early on developed the
idea of competing values, has provided a system-oriented contribution: Competing Values
Framework (Quinn 1984; Quinn and Rohrbaugh 1983) in four value orientations. These
are, respectively, an Employee Orientation, Structure and System Orientation, Change and
Future Orientation and Market Orientation. In a Norwegian context, this approach has been
utilized in a large study of values in large companies (Falkenberg 2006), and partly in case
studies of Norwegian municipalities (Bjølverud 2014; Engesveen 2014; Wennes and Busch
2012).
Based on the model of Quinn and colleagus, it is argued that organizations and leaders have
a tool for mapping internal culture and clarifying key values, as well as guidance for
choosing a leadership strategy and approach:
The Competing Values Framework helps guide leaders in identifying which
elements within the organization (…) can be emphasized, and to what degree they
should be emphasized as value creation strategies are formulated and
implemented. It is also important to keep in mind that not only must internal
dynamics in each quadrant be considered, but the congruence between
organizational factors and desired outcomes must also be aligned (Cameron et al.
2006: 16).
An alternative approach to values-based leadership, ethical accounting, also assumes that
priorities must be set in a context where different norms and interests are represented in
organizations. Ethics and leadership have many intellectual roots, and there is not enough
room here to go into the field in depth. Therefore, I only address the roots of ethical
accounting, which is an important Danish contribution to values-based leadership. Ethical
accounting was developed as an approach in the late 80s (Pruzan and Thyssen 1990). When
this contribution is included in the review of understanding the system approach, it involves
how Pruzan and Thyssen justify their commitment to ethical accounting with a different
purpose than business ethics:
Our aim is different. We intend to consider the use of ethics in the context of an
organization as a shared value horizon and planning tool (Pruzan and Thyssen
1990: 141).
16
Their starting point is that, in a pluralist society, it no longer seems possible to establish a
common understanding of what is right and wrong, i.e. a common moral and ethical theory.
Different groupings in societies and organizations will be able to assert different value
positions according to the same principle. Their solution lies in developing ethical thinking
with two characteristics: 1) rational in the sense that one may argue a position in dialogue,
and 2) formalistic in that it requires a certain interaction among groupings. The interaction
must be based on equal rights, where one group can claim rights that are equal to rights
that can be assigned to other groups (Pruzan and Thyssen 1990: 136).
In a study of Swedish business leaders, Brytting and Trollestad indicate that leaders’
relationship to values and leadership is ambivalent (Brytting and Trollestad 2000). They
identify a widespread view where the demands of the environment (including economic
ones) are considered to be inevitable and where leadership must therefore apply a rational
and top-down approach in formulating and implementing values.
A recent Norwegian contribution by Rudi Kirkhaug, assigned in this category because it
represent as a collective, comprehensive and top-down leadership concept (Kirkhaug
2013). He sums up his view of values-based leadership like this:
We can therefore define values-based leadership as a collective and top-down tool
for influencing employee attitudes, behaviors and aspirations to reach the
organization’s goals and purposes by enhancing, changing or teaching existing
values, designing new values, disseminating values throughout the organization
and maintaining values, through conscious behavior by leadership (Kirkhaug
2013: 104).
The collective dimension is emphasized, among other things, because the concept levels
leaders and employees socially. According to Kirkhaug, values-based leadership assumes
the expectation of shared values and commitment to realizing the organization’s core values
in terms of what is right and wrong. Furthermore, there is a mutual trust between managers
and employees. Kirkhaug’s values-based leadership is positioned quite close to
instrumental theories, with regard to values being understood as tools for realizing intended
conditions and goals. His contribution, therefore, links values to critical functions in
organizations, such as task solving and the existence of a power base to make the values
applicable in practical organizational action. At the same time, with his emphasis on
community and relationships of trust between managers and employees, he will position
himself near associations and a shared basis of values as mutually binding.
Current perspectives and the development of an integral
model
Internationally recognized theories of values-based leadership are integrated into overall
leadership theories, while Scandinavian contributions have not equally prioritized the links
17
between general managerial and/or leadership functions, leadership behavior and values-
based leadership.
International contributions demonstrate concrete relationships among charismatic values-
based leaders and efficiency, employee satisfaction, etc. However, they have not helped to
illuminate the process where values are made effective by managers and organizations’
practices. The Scandinavian approach has been much more concerned with the actual
implementation part of VBL and has contributed to studies and evaluations of this kind of
process. Similarly, recent contributions in institutional work, including values work, have
offered a deeper understanding of values work as organizational processes and practices.
Several of the contributions mentioned above, especially those of Barnard, Selznick,
Smircich and Morgan, underscore that values creation or meaning formation is a as a
process. Whether this is referred to as “morale,” values or meaning, it seems to involve
deliberate and long-term work by leaders. In understanding values, it will also be a key
insight that it is difficult to establish a direct connection between values and action. Instead,
they are effective through articulation and conversation, in a reflective process related to
specific situations where values are activated and at stake. Values, in my view, cannot be
fully controlled, but both managers and employees can interpret and exercise discretion in
matters affecting values.
In conclusion, I will present an attempt to summarize key dimensions in different
approaches to values-based leadership. This distribution of contributions will not be wholly
precise, but it presents an assessment of how they are fundamentally rooted in basic
dimensions that construct the model (see Table 1). Even with this academic foundation,
many of the contributions try to “cross” boundaries between dimensions. For example, this
is the case with several international contributions that are assigned to an instrumental
tradition and then perhaps especially with charismatic values-based leadership (House
1996) and transformational leadership (Avolio and Bass 1995). Rooted in leadership’s
contribution to values creation, through a clear rationalist approach in terms of both theory
and methodology, this primary anchoring seems clear. At the same time, the theoretical
seeks to point out that leaders must associate themselves with employees’ values in their
approach. Thus, they seek to “cross” the boundaries of the association and social
community that exists in any organization. Aadland and colleagues (2006), who use a
theoretical and analytical basis in system theory, can apply similar reasoning to
contributions. These contributions also draw on the association perspective, not least
through the emphasis on employee contributions and participation in the development and
concretization of the organization’s values.
18
Table 3: Central dimensions in different approaches to values-based leadership and values
work
Core traditions
Dimensions Instruments Association System Institution
Values Stable
individual
values
Individuals
with shared
values
Values arise
through dialog
among different
stakeholders
Organizational
values adapted
to social values
and to
frameworks for
the individual
Anchoring Individually Individually Collectively Collectively
Leader’s
role
The leader
defines values
and convinces
Common
values are the
framework for
leaders’
articulation and
interpretation
Leaders
facilitate dialog
and negotiation
on common
values
Leaders
contribute to
creating values
Work form Control and
persuasion
Process and
interpretation
Dialog and
negotiation
Communication
and values work
Contributors House (1978,
1996)
Lencioni
(2002)
Bass & Avolio
Wood (1981,
1984)
Petersen &
Lassen (1997)
Quinn &
Rohrbaugh
(1983)
Pruzan &
Thyssen 1990
Aadland et al.
(2006)
Selznick (1997)
Jørgensen
(2006)
Lawrence &
Suddaby (2006)
Gehman et al.
(2013)
Askeland
(2015)
A key challenge for the further development of the Scandinavian approach, is to make a
clearer contribution to analyses and models of how this relates to leadership or to the
integration of leadership into management and managerial work, as well as to how
managers contribute to balancing different values and managing conflicts among them.
One model attempts this kind of integration, where management and institutional
leadership is analytically distinct but held together (Askeland 2015, 2016).
The institutional side of leadership emphasizes the overriding responsibility for
performance and results in the organization and understands leadership as creating meaning
and articulating goals, where one will be able to promote values in general as well as the
institution’s particular values tradition. Leaders thus contribute to conscious attempts to
create meaningful contexts and a justification for the business’s purpose and represent an
example of values-conscious leadership.
19
Figure 1: Integrated model for management and institutional leadership in practice
The director combines classic management tasks, such as initiating structure, developing
procedures and safeguarding them, as well as coordinating and planning the work process.
The aim of this is to help the business achieve its goals in an efficient and qualitatively
good way. The service developer emphasizes an external orientation. This role involves
focusing on how tasks are performed, as well as on strategic development or the
customization of goals and services through monitoring and adaptation to the environment.
The integrator’s function is internal and relational in its orientation, focusing on aspects of
the management work that help unite the organization as a functioning social system. The
mediator is externally oriented with a focus on building, maintaining and further
developing external relations. Here, instrumental and efficiency-oriented elements are de-
emphasized in favor of the business’s pursuit of legitimacy and needs in its environment.
This role involves effort to establish alliances, but also to act as a “buffer” in relation to
external pressures on the organization5.
Finally, I would like to argue that it would be of academic interest developing value-work
as a perspective, by this approach contributing to the topic and to research on micro-
processes that underlie the development and practice of values. Thus, the perspective
contributes to the understanding of how institutional values and practices that are taken for
granted are established, maintained and changed. Understanding values work as processes
emphasizes that phasing in action can be decisive for the outcome. That is, the course of
events, detailed in the initiative, agenda setting, participation and organization, can have a
major impact on the results. In this regard, time and order will be key factors. It has been
argued that values work must be seen as a process in which the whole organization
5 For a detailed presentation of the model and its empirical basis, refer to previous work (Askeland 2016,
Askeland 2015).
Task
Director
Mediator Integrator
Service developer
External Internal
Relationship
Institutional leader
Comprehensive
response to operations
and results
Managing meaning
and promoting values
20
participates and where leaders play a critical role as a process managers (Aadland 2004:
162). At the same time, it has been demonstrated that these processes can arise out of
different groups that unite around an issue or concern (Gehman et al. 2013).
References:
Aadland, Einar 2004. Den truverdige leiaren: Det Norske Samlaget.
Aadland, Einar et al. 2006. Verdibasert ledelse i praksis : en studie av 8
medlemsvirksomheter i HSH. Oslo: Handels- og servicenæringens
hovedorganisasjon.
Aditya, Robert J House and Ram N. 1997. The Social Scientific Study of Leadership: Quo
Vadis?, Journal of Management, 23(3):409-473.
Aldrich, Howard et al. 1992. Incommensurable paradigms? Vital signs from three
perspectives, Rethinking organization: New directions in organization theory and
analysis:17-45.
Askeland, Harald 2014. Leaders Should Be the Carriers of Institutional Values: An account
of how leaders contribute to the value-base of diaconal institutions, Diaconia,
5(2):149-177.
Askeland, Harald 2015. Managerial practice in faith-based welfare organizations, Nordic
Journal of Religion and Society, 28(1):37-58.
Askeland, Harald 2016. Hverdagsledelse: Diakoni, verdier og ledelse i praksis. In. Oslo:
MF/Norwegian School of Theology.
Avolio, Bruce J and Bernard M Bass 1995. Individual consideration viewed at multiple
levels of analysis: A multi-level framework for examining the diffusion of
transformational leadership, The Leadership Quarterly, 6(2):199-218.
Barnard, Chester 1938. The Functions of the Executive. Cambridge (MA): Harvard
University Press.
Bass, Bernard M. 1990. Concepts of leadership. In Bass & Stogdill’s handbook of
leadership: theory, research, and managerial applications, Bernard M. Bass (ed.),
3-20. New York: Free Press.
Bjartveit, Steinar and Trond Kjærstad 1996. Kaos og kosmos: byggesteiner for individer
og organisasjoner. Oslo: Kolle forlag.
Bjølverud, Øyvind 2014. I hvilken grad eksisterer det gap mellom ønsket og faktisk
lederrolleutøvelse, og hva kan forklare forskjellene? En studie av kommunale
lederes ønskede og faktiske rolleutøvelse, samt deres forståelse av egen
organisasjon.
Brown, Michael E. and Linda K. Treviño 2003. Is values-based leadership ethical
leadership? . In Emerging Perspectives on Values in Organizations, Stephen W.
Gilliand et al. (eds.). Greenwich: Information Age Publishing.
Bryman, Alan 1993. Charismatic leadership in business organizations: Some neglected
issues, The Leadership Quarterly, 4(3):289-304.
Brytting, Tomas and Claes Trollestad 2000. Managerial thinking on values-based
management, International Journal of Values-based Management, 13(1):55-77.
Burns, James MacGregor 1978. Leadership. New York: Harper & Row.
Busch, Tor 2012. Verdibasert ledelse i offentlige profesjoner. Bergen: Fagbokforlaget.
21
Cameron, Kim S. et al. 2006. Competing Values Leadership. Creating Values in
Organizations. Cheltenham, UK
Northhampton, MA: Edgard Elgar Publishing.
Carroll, Jackson W 2011. As one with authority: Reflective leadership in ministry: Wipf
and Stock Publishers.
Conger, Jay A and Rabindra N Kanungo 1987. Toward a behavioral theory of charismatic
leadership in organizational settings, Academy of management review, 12(4):637-
647.
Deal, Terrence E and Allan A Kennedy 1982. Corporate cultures: The rites and rituals of
organizational life, Reading/Т. Deal, A. Kennedy.–Mass: Addison-Wesley, 2:98-
103.
Engesveen, Bent Olav 2014. Lederroller og kontrollspenn. Hvilken betydning har
enhetsstørrelsen for utøvelse av lederrollen?
Eriksen, Erik Oddvar 1999. Kommunikativ ledelse: om verdier og styring i offentlig sektor.
Bergen-Sandviken: Fagbokforlaget.
Falkenberg, Geir 2006. Verdier og sosiale normer i store norske virksomheter. Viktige
kulturbærere eller fordekt PR? In. Oslo: Fafo.
Fløistad, Guttorm 2007. Kunsten å omgås hverandre. Oslo: Ad Notam Gyldendal.
Gehman, Joel et al. 2013. Values work: A process study of the emergence and performance
of organizational values practices, Academy of Management Journal, 56(1):84-112.
Hetland, Hilde 2004. Transformasjonsledelse i en norsk kontekst, Magma, (1).
Hollis, Martin 2002. The philosophy of social science: an introduction. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press.
House, Robert J. 1976. A 1976 Theory of Charismatic Leadership. In Southern Illinois
University Fourth Biennal Leadership Symposium. Carbondale, Illinois: Faculty of
Management Studies, University of Toronto.
House, Robert J. 1996. Path-Goal Theory of Leadership: Lessons, Legacy and a
Reformulated Theory, Leadership Quarterly, 7(3):323-352.
Johnsen, Erik 1992. Ledelse af ledelsesprocessen: Dafolo Forlag.
Jørgensen, Thorkild Boelsmann et al. 2016. Modstillinger i organisations-og ledelsesteori.
Jørgensen, Torben Beck and Karsten Vrangbæk 2011. Value dynamics: Towards a
framework for analyzing public value changes, International Journal of Public
Administration, 34(8):486-496.
Jørgensen, Torben Beck and Karsten Vrangsbæk 2013. Den gode forvaltning–på basis af
hvilke værdier?, Nordisk Administrativt Tidsskrift.
Kemmis, Spephen 2011. What is professional practice? Recognising and respecting
diversity in understandings of practice. In Elaborating professionalism. Studies in
practice and theory, Clive Kanes (ed.). Dordrecht, London, Boston: Springer
Science.
Kirkhaug, R 2013. Verdibasert ledelse. Betingelser for utøvelse av moderne lederskap. In:
Oslo: Universitetsforlaget.
Krishnan, Venkat R 2002. Transformational leadership and value system congruence,
International Journal of Values-based Management, 15(1):19-33.
Lawrence, Thomas B. et al. (eds.) (2009) Institutional work: actors and agency in
institutional studies of organizations. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
22
Lawrence, Thomas and Roy Suddaby 2006. Institutions and institutional work. In The
SAGE handbook of organization studies, Stewart R. Clegg et al. (eds.), 215-254.
London: SAGE.
Lemmergaard, Jeanette 2005. Betydningen af det manglende” s”: Value (s)-Based
Management er ikke værdibaseret ledelse, Ledelse & Erhvervsøkonomi, 68(3):183-
192.
Lencioni, Patrick M 2002. Make your values mean something, Harvard Business Review,
80(7):113-117.
Moore, Mark Harrison 1995. Creating public value: strategic management in government.
Cambridge, Mass.: Harvard University Press.
O’Neill, Michael 1992. Ethical Dimensions of Nonprofit Administration, Nonprofit
Management & Leadership, 3(2):199-213.
Ouchi, William G 1980. Markets, bureaucracies, and clans, Administrative science
quarterly:129-141.
Petersen, Verner C and Mette Stuhr Lassen 1997. Værdibaseret ledelse-et alternativ til
styring, regulering og kontrol?: Dansk Industri.
Posner, Banny Z 1987. The leadership chalenge: how to get extraordinary things done in
organizations.
Pruzan, Peter and Ole Thyssen 1990. Conflict and consensus: Ethics as a shared value
horizon for strategic planning, Human Systems Management, 9(3):135-151.
Quinn, Robert E 1984. Applying the competing values approach to leadership: Toward an
integrative framework, Leaders and managers: International perspectives on
managerial behavior and leadership:10-27.
Quinn, Robert E and John Rohrbaugh 1983. A spatial model of effectiveness criteria:
towards a competing values approach to organizational analysis, Management
science, 29(3):363-377.
Ryan, Leo V 2000. Moral aspects of executive leadership, International Journal of Values-
based Management, 13(2):109-122.
Schein, Edgar H. 1985. Organizational culture and leadership. San Francisco: Jossey-
Bass.
Scott, Richard W. 1995. On the organizational ecology of Chester I. Barnard. In
Organization Theory: From Chester Barnard to the Present and Beyond, Oliver E
Williamson (ed.). Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Scott, W. Richard 2003. Organizations: rational, natural, and open systems. Upper Saddle
River, N.J.: Prentice Hall: Pearson Education International.
Selznick, Philip 1957. Leadership in administration: a sociological interpretation.
Evanston, Ill.: Row Peterson.
Selznick, Philip 1997 [1957]. Lederskap. Oslo: Tano Aschehoug.
Smircich, Linda and Gareth Morgan 1982. Leadership: the management of meaning,
Journal of Applied Behavioural Studies, 18:257-273.
Talleraas, Gro and Gjermund Haga 2012. Verdiutvikling i kommunene Namdalseid,
Namsos, Overhalla; kvalitativ intervjuundersøkelse juni 2011.
Thyssen, Ole 2007. Værdiledelse: Gyldendal A/S.
Vanebo, Jan Ole 2001. Kampen om den autoriserte organisasjonsteorien – i går, i dag og i
morgen. In Organisasjonsfaget. Innhold og formidling, Jan Ole Vanebo and Børre
Nylehn (eds.). Oslo: Universitetsforlaget.
23
Weber, Max and Helge Jordheim 1999. Verdi og handling: Pax.
Wennes, Grete and Tor Busch 2012. Changing values in public professions-a need of
values-based leadership?
Wood, James R. 1981. Leadership in voluntary organizations: the controversy over social
action in Protestant churches. New Brunswick, New Jersey: Rutgers
See discussions, stats, and author profiles for this publication at: https://www.researchgate.net/publication/46948367
Organizations: Rational, Natural and Open Systems
Article in Canadian Journal of Sociology / Cahiers canadiens de sociologie · January 1998
DOI: 10.2307/2393090 · Source: OAI
CITATIONS
2,762
READS
46,148
1 author:
Some of the authors of this publication are also working on these related projects:
Higher Education in Silicon Valley View project
W. RICHARD
Scott
Stanford University
169 PUBLICATIONS 36,971 CITATIONS
SEE PROFILE
All content following this page was uploaded by W. RICHARD Scott on 16 July 2014.
The user has requested enhancement of the downloaded file.
https://www.researchgate.net/publication/46948367_Organizations_Rational_Natural_and_Open_Systems?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_2&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/publication/46948367_Organizations_Rational_Natural_and_Open_Systems?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_3&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/project/Higher-Education-in-Silicon-Valley?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_9&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_1&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/profile/W-Scott?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_4&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/profile/W-Scott?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_5&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/institution/Stanford-University?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_6&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/profile/W-Scott?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_7&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
https://www.researchgate.net/profile/W-Scott?enrichId=rgreq-50536ea787dbfab85d956b522442bbd9-XXX&enrichSource=Y292ZXJQYWdlOzQ2OTQ4MzY3O0FTOjExOTYzNjQyMzA5MDE3NkAxNDA1NTM0OTU0NDkz&el=1_x_10&_esc=publicationCoverPdf
Session 4
(Lectures 7 and 8)
INTRODUCTION TO
INSTITUTIONS AND SOCIAL MECHANISMS
Antti Ainamo
IASM Master’s Degree Programme, Faculty of Social Sciences, University of Turku
Autumn 2009
W. Richard Scott
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Three kinds of systems, according to Scott
”Natural systems”
”Rational systems”
”Open [vs. closed] systems”
Below, a schematic to illustrate Scott’s ideas:
Open
Closeed
Natural Rational
W. Richard Scott
Organizations: Rational, Natural and Open Systems
Finland until the
1990s (e.g.
Hämäläinen, 2003)
U.S. in the 19th century,
according to Douglas C.
North
Finland from the 1990s
(e.g. Hämäläinen, 2003)
Pre-Modern Finland,
Until about 1000 A.C.
The Third World,
according to Douglas C.
North
The totalitarian regimes
of e.g. Stalin, Hitler,
Pinochet, Kim Jong-Il
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Rational systems:
Historical background of organization theory 1
Max Weber (1968, trans.), one of the founders of modern sociology, noted
in the early 2oth century that rationalized, legal and administrative systems
were replacing traditional and charismatic modes of administration, and the
rise of public- and private-sector bureaucracies were an important indicator
and carrier of these new beliefs and values.
To a surprising extent. Frederick W. Taylor (1911) was observing and
writing about the same great transformation. Taylor was deeply engaged in
engaging with approaches to production within factories, rather than being
content with describing and understanding such approaches, as was
Weber.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Human Relations:
Historical background of organization theory 2
A little bit later than Weber of Taylor, Chester Barnard (1936) and Philip
Selznick (1948, 1957) advanced the view of organizations as adaptive
systems attempting to survive in their environment.
Their functionalist approach emphasized that organizations are not simply
technical systems, but political and social systems embodying norms and
values of importance to their participants to a wider circle of constituents.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
”Hawthorne effect”
Between 1924 and 1932, at a factory called the Hawthorne Works, (a Western Electric
manufacturing facility outside Chicago IL, U.S.A.), a series of experiments on factory
workers were carried out.
Hawthorne Works had commissioned a study to see if its workers would become more
productive in higher or lower levels of light. I t was found that the workers’ productivity
seemed to improve when changes were made and slumped when the study was
concluded. It was suggested that the productivity gain was due to the motivational effect
of the interest being shown in them.
However, it was then found that subjects improved their performance in response NOT
to changes in experimental manipulation in illumination of their task area BUT simply in
response to the fact that they are being studied. In 1955, the term was coined by Henry
A. Landsberger[3] when analyzing the experiments from 1924-1932.
In a 2009 reassessment of the original data, University of Chicago economists John List
and Steven Levitt found that productivity varied due to other factors such as the weekly
cycle of work or the seasonal temperature and so the initial conclusions were
overstated and the effect was weak or illusory.[4]
Although illumination research of workplace lighting formed the basis of the Hawthorne
effect, other changes such as maintaining clean work stations, clearing floors of
obstacles, and even relocating workstations resulted in increased productivity for short
periods of time.
In appropriate sense, the Hawthorne effect is a term used to identify any type of short-
lived increase in productivity.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Organization theory: Emergence
It is only by hindsight that the above (and others) came to be known as
organization theorists.
Weber’s theories were long known as ”grand theory” or theory of an
economic sociologist.
Taylor was known as a zealous engineer obsessed with time and and
motion studies of efficiency.
It was Barnard and Selzcnick who helped to point the way toward
viewing organizations not simply as indicators settings for work, but as
distinctive social systems – as collective actors – deserving scholarly
attention.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
”Rational” vs. ”Natural” systems
In a seminal essay from 1949, Alvin Gouldner surveyed the fledgling field
of organization studies and took an important step toward identifying major
underlying fault-lines. Looking back at Weber, Taylor, and the human
relations scholars, he discerned two underlying models – a ”rational” model
and a ”natural” system perspective – that went far to account for much of
the confusion and conflict among students of organizations.
Rational systems analysts considered organizations as instruments that
could be consciously shaped and molded to accomplish given ends.
Emphasis was placed on rational design and planning under the
assumption that participants can control developments.
Natural system analysts, by contrast, viewed organizations as organic
sysems , as collectivities that evolve via spontaneous, indeterminate
proceesses. System survival was seen as the overriding goal, and
adaptation as the master process.
Making explicit these underlying assumptions and constrasting models,
somewhat paradoxically, allowed scholars to see more coherence in the
field thna had previously been visible. The recognition of a central debate
with clearly defined protagonists spurred unity.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Modern organization theory
Rational and Natural
Mechanistic and Organic
Integration and Differentiation
Compare economists, who until recently believed in tradeoffs::
”Cost leadership vs. Differentation”
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Open systems
During the 1950s, ”general systems theories”
Kenneth Boulding (1956) was among the first to emphasize that
organizations are open systems.
The most complete early application of open system’s theory is Katz and
Kahn’s (1966) The Social Psychology of
Organizations
The distinction between a closed system conception in comparison to an
open systems is that the former assumes elements are internal while the
latter assumes they are affected by environmental influences.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
A.A. Social mechanisms carry, buffer, amplify or in other ways
intermediate how institutions are produced and maintained…
B. Institutional rules and norms are produced and maintained
through social mechanisms.
Intermediation between everyday practices and institutions
Compliance and Opposition Norms
Collective Action
Institutional framework
Formal norms
Organizations
Small Group
Informal Norms
Individuals
Shift Parameters: Selection and Adaptation
Rules
Incentives and
endogenous
preferences
Source: Nee and Ingram, p. 31
Individual beliefs
&action
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Continuing the agenda
Sociological view (Nee and Ingram)
Evolutionary models and economics (in North)
Rational, Natural and Open systems
Power, grand strategy, and decision-making (in Scott)
Technical core and peripheral components (in Scott)
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
The technical core and ”Peripheral components”
Two dimensions
”Technical” or material-resource environments
”Institutional” or regulative, normative, and cultural-cognitive environments/foundations
Technical and institutional controls
1. Strong technical controls, only:
Generic manufacturing
2. Strong technical and institutional controls:
Banks
Utilities
General hospitals
3.Weak technical and institutional controls
In the U.S.: Restaurants
Health clubs
In the U.S.: Child care
4. Strong institutional controls,
weak technical:
Schools
Legal agencies
Churches
Strong TECHNICAL CONTROL
Weak
Weak
INSTI
TUTIO-
ONAL
CON-
TROL
Strong
1. 3.
2. 4.
2.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
How to apply Scott’s theory?
— a ”corporate” or business-organization illustration
Routines
Social structures
Cultures
Scott:
Three carriers:
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
The technical core and ”Peripheral components”
Two dimensions
”Technical” or material-resource environments
”Institutional” or regulative, normative, and cultural-cognitive environments/foundations
Technical and institutional controls
1. Strong technical controls, only:
Generic manufacturing
2. Strong technical and institutional controls:
Banks
Utilities
General hospitals
3.Weak technical and institutional controls
in the U.S. Restaurants
Health clubs
In the U.S.: Child care
4. Strong institutional controls,
weak technical:
Schools
Legal agencies
Churches
Strong TECHNICAL CONTROL Weak
Weak
INSTI
TUTIO-
ONAL
CON-
TROL
Strong
1. 3.
2. 4.2.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Scott
Creating organizations in
”unsettled times” vs. ”settled” times
”Recent developments in… temporary, part-time and ’flexible’
workers and arrangements… emerging forms such as networks and
alliances” (Scott, Fifth edition:x).
”Few organizations create their own technologies; rather, they
import them” (Scott, 4th:22)
”Charismatic forms arise in periods of instability and crisis” (Scott,
4th:44)
”… lawyers who represent collective actors rather than natural
persons are the more powerful, prosperous, and prestiguous
segment” (Scott, 4th:7)
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Creating organizations
”Agency”
Creating any of kind of an organization
”A stock of alternative forms has value for a society whenever
the future is uncertain…
The rights of individuals (Coleman)
[A policy making perspective: ]
A society that relies on a few organizational forms may thrive for
a while… ” (Hannan and Freeman 1989)… [Scott]
”agency theory” (Jensen and Meckling)… [”agents” / ”principals”]
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Technical core, ”peripheral components”, and power
Power in informal groups vs. power in formal organizations
Authority: no organization ”voluntarily limits itself to the appeal to material
or affectual motives as a basis for guaranteeing its continuance. In
addition, every such system attenpts to establish and to cultivate the belief
in its ”legitimacy” (Weber, 1947, trans.: 325 [Scott 2003: 313]
Two types of authority:
Endorsed [”to approve openly
express support or approval”, www.m-w.com] and
Authorized [by ”persons in command”, www.m-w.com]
Structural control [i.e. Social structure] and Culture
Strong TECHNICAL CONTROL Weak
Weak
INSTI
TUTIO-
ONAL
CON-
TROL
Strong
1. 3.
2. 4.
http://www.m-w.com/
http://www.m-w.com/
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Culture and Dominant coalition…
Though certainly not the last word on the subject of
who sets organizational goals, power avoids many
problems that have plagued earlier explanations…
[ p. 301-302]
Factors affecting the size and composition of the
dominant coalition
Owners and managers
Boundary roles
External actors
Modes of capital… human… social… cultural
[Scott, 2003, p. 301-302]
Uses of power
[p. 297-302]
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Goal-setting in organizations
Rational system analysts emphasize the cognitive functions of goals… Simon,
1964, 1997)…
Natural system analysis, such as Barnard (1938).. and Whetten and Godfrey
(1998), emphasize the cathedtic (motivational) properties of goals. Goals
serve as a source of identification and motivation for participants… Selznick
(1949)
Institutional analysts stress the symbolic functions of goals… significance for
organizational audiences… legitimacy, allies, resources, and personnel…
Some analysts… Weick… justification… Festinger… a postdecision…
… goals serve as a basis for evaluating… [p. 292]
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Decisions and structures
PREFERENCES ABOUT OUTCOMES
Agreement Disagreement
Agreement Computation Compromise
BELIEFS [bureaucracy] [the legislative process]
ABOUT
OUTCOMES Judgement Inspiration
Disagreement [collegium] [charisma]
[Scott, p. 304]
Strong technical / Weak institutional Weak technical / Strong institutional
Weak technical / Weak institutionalStrong technical / Strong institutional
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
The grand strategy: internalization
Thinking strategically
Internalization may be usefully subdivided into
(1) absorption processes
Absorption… workers were brought into the factory… organizations
developed their own distribution and marketing facilities… as Chandler
describes in wonderful detail (1977, chap. 7)… to internalize capital
requirements… ”cash cows” to fund new ventures in rapidly growing
markets (Henderson, 1980) [p. 279]
(2) mapping processes
Mapping… ”mirrors”… ”investment relations”… (Useem, 1996)…
environmental engineers… (Hoffman, 1997)
Divesting and downsizing…
[p. 279]
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
[Scott: 1998: 200]
Organizational identity as basis
for boundary spanning
Organizational identity focuses attention on the shared beliefs and self-
conceptions held by organizational participants. Defined by Albert and
Whetten (1985:265) as the ”central, enduring, and distinctive” elements set
of beliefs and values ”that distinguish the organization from the others with
which it might be compared….
Influence behavior…
relation to ”outsiders” (Dutton and Dukerich, 1991; Whetten and
Godfrey, 1998)… field boundaries…
groups, and particularly organizations, carefully differentiate members from
nonmembers… the inmate and the… world
”collective cognition”…
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Douglass C. North
Adam Smith vs. transaction costs
For 200 years the gains from trade made possible by increasing
specialization and division of labor have been the cornerstone of economic
theory.
Specialization could be realized by increasing the size of markets…
economies expanded…
As the size and scope of exchange have increased, the parties have
attempted to clientize or personalize exchange. But the greater variety
[has] made [it] more difficult… to do [so].
[A]n exchange process involving transaction costs suggests significant
modifications in economic theory and very different implications for
economic practice.
impersonal exchange
impersonal exchange with third-party enforcement
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Organizational action as myth & ceremony
To achieve legitimacy with their constituents, organizations are prone to
construct stories about their actions that correspond to socially prescribed
dictates about what an organization should do. These stories need not
have any connection to what the organization actually does, but rather,
used as forms of symbolic reassurance (Meyer and Rowan 1977)
Resource dependency (Pfeffer and Salancik 1978)
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Organizational isomorphism (D&P 1983)
Organizations appear to become increasingly similar
Coercive: pressures from other organizations, pressure within organization
Mimetic: a response to uncertaintly
Normative: professions, associations
Two or more mechanisms can cooperate simultaneously
DiMaggio and Powel discuss norms 2 x more than they do the other
institutional mechanisms of coercion and mimesis
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Critical theory
critical theorists view organizations as systems of domination in which one
class of actors exploits others
differences in interests, far from being negotiated and reconciled, are
resolved by the more powerful suppressing the weaker
Marx emphasized the ways in managerial ideologies developed to justify
and ”naturalize” arrangements that were arbitrary and inequitable
[Scott, p. 320]
no longer… choices but… natural and self-evident… (Alvesson and Deetz,
1996: 199) [Scott, p. 321]
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Postmodernism
Foucault (1977) and Lyotard (1984); Nietzsche was the early guiding
spirit. [p. 321]
Postmodernists stress the importance of the symbolic, cultural elements
of the social world. Our social world is socially constructed and what we
”see” or believe depends of the social situation and our location in it…
[p. 321-322]
The more open one’s conception of organization, the more vague and
permeated its boundaries… Rationales become multiple… interests and
purposes are differentiated and contextualized… If uniformity exists, it is
because diversity has been suppresssed… analysis… to ”deconstruct”
[p. 322]
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
”Interests”
Each correct language and classificatory scheme must be correct
or consistent relative to some set of interests
• Advanced course on institutions and social mechanisms:
”interests” (Richard Swedberg, Introduction to Economic Sociology
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Kitscher’s view of science, truth, and democracy
(Longino, Sep 19, 2007)
[Science, truth and democracy advance] via media between constructivist
debunkers of social science, on the one hand, and the uncritical scientific
faithful, on the other, [involves] no priviledge system of natural kinds
Multiple correct ways of presenting reality
Multiple language and classificatory schemes
Each correct language and classificatory scheme must be correct or
consistent relative to some set of interests
Question: How ”social”? – the Answer: ”contingently social”
Question: Can collective research be organized in a way to promote our
collective values in the most encompassing sense?”
Yes, with ”well-ordered science”
Enlightened democratic decision-making would ideally determine
choice of research projects to be pursued in a society
The research agenda, not the research agenda, is subject to
demogratic oversight
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Reconfigure justification (Longino 1990)
Not just a matter of relations between sentences, statements, or the beliefs
and perceptions of an individual…
… but also a matter of relationships wihtin and between communities of
inquirers
Not just the testing of hypotheses against data…
… but also the subject of hypotheses against particular social conventions
Cognitive and epistemic practices have social dimensions
1. normative rules or conditions for scientific inquiry must include
conditions that apply to social and discursive interactions
Venues
Upate of criticism
Public standards: aims, goals, ethical guidelines, etc.
Tempered equality of intellectual authority so that they themselves are
subject to the same standards
2. assumptions that are shared by all members of a community will be
shielded from criticism, and because they persist in the face of
effective structures, may even reinforced
Diversity
Interaction
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Funding of research
Since the Cold War, funding has shifted from the Government to private
companies
Researchers maintain their sense of independence by forming their own
corporations
If the research process is blackoboxed, it is not accessible to the user of
knowledge
Recipient of knowledge
Bearer of knowledge’s benefits and burdens
The way privatization works… if it meant only that there were some additional
players, and this would mean that there is more diversity
In Congress, individual Congressmen can channel funding in particular
directions… There is a kind of peer review… and a lot of irrationalities…
which bears little resemblance to Kitchener’s idealized (or minimal) view…
the 17th century of independently wealthy science hobbyists… a system not
unlike that of the Cold War
On the other hand, pharmaceutical companies will… control the publication
of the research. Research that shows negative results will be kept inside the
confines of the corporate while positive results will be published… So that is
the kind of research I have in mind when I speak of the negative side of
privatization.. In this era when the market mechanism is so strong
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Case by case
In many cases, a plurality of meanings but plurality is not a necessary
characteristic of a system
We need to look at a number of cases, not just we philosophers but all who
have an interest… Not just the logical structure but also the epistemic and
the practical features, the metaphysical aspects that various
representations may have…
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Douglas C. North
Entrepreneurs and U.S. economic history
”Incremental change comes from the perceptions of the entrepreneurs in
political and economic organizations that they could do better by altering the
existing institutional framework at the some margin.”
The entrepreneurs ”frequently must act on incomplete information…
persistently inefficient paths… Transaction costs in political and economic
markets make for inefficient property rights, but the imperfect subjective
models of the players as they attempt to understand the complexities of the
problems they confront can lead to the persistence of such property rights.”
”U.S. economic history… in the nineteenth century… increased
productivity… demand for educational invesments… As economic
organizations evolved to take advantage of… opportunities, they not only
became more efficient (see Chandler, 1977), but also gradually altered the
institutional framework.”
”choices… certainly not always optimal or unidirectional… indeed,
frequently, policies had unintended consequences… a mixed bag of those
[policies] that induce productivity and those that reduce productivity… But on
balance the ninetheenth-century U.S. economic history is a story of
economic growth.”
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Douglass C. North
Institutional change (introduction)
”Institutions, together with the standard contraints of economic theory, determine the
opportunities in a society. Organizations are created to take advantage of those
opportunites, and, as the organizations evolve, they alter the institutions.”
”The resultant path of institutional change is shaped by
(1) the lock-in that comes from the symbiotic relationship between institutions and the
organizations that have evolved as a consequence of the incentive structure provided by those
institutions and
(2) the feedback process by which human being perceive and reach to changes in the
opportunity set.”
”The increasing returns characteristics of an institutional matrix that produces lock-in
comes from the dependence of the resultant organizations on that institutional
framework and the consequent network exterternalities that arise.”
”Both the formal and the informal institutional constraints result in particular exchange
organizations that have come into existence because of the incentives embodied in
the framework and [these organization] therefore depend on it [that is, the institutional
framework] for the profitability of the activities that they undertake.”
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Douglas C. North
Entrepreneurs in the Third World
Also ”in many Third World countires… opportunities for political and
economic entrepreneurs are still a mixed bag, but [in contrast to the 19th
century U.S.A.] they overwhelmingly favor redistributive rather than
productive activity, that create monopolies rather than competitive
conditions, and that restrict opportunities rather than expand them.”
”They seldom induce investment in education that increases productivity”
”The organizations… become more efficient… at making the society even
more unproductive… because costs… together with the subjective
models… do not lead them to move incrementally toward more efficient
outcomes.”
”Three dimensions of institutions:
[1] formal rules and
[2] informal constraints, and
[3] the effectiveness of their enforcement.”
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Finland’s modernization after the Second World War
New industries
Urbanization
Immigration
Internationalization
People
Firms
The country’s system of governance
Informal institutions remain important
Top floor of Sitra has a sauna Global businessmen taste wines
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Working paper (30 p. / 100 p.)
Topic, goal, and title: Pick freely from the four themes ”B” thru ”E” in the course
(one theme, a combination of several, etc. ). Scott can be brought into each
and every theme. If you so choose, you can also bring in ”A.” and/or ”F.”. The
reader will assume that the choice of your topic is crystallized in the title of your
working paper.
The process of writing the paper: Your building blocks are the goal, the
structure and the literature that you want to include, the way you combine
these literatures, as well as how you position your paper. Be conscientious in
writing: include exact references, including page numbers, have references in
end of paper.
21.9.2009 A Ainamo
Other
While you are expected to have precise citations, the paper is not
intended to be an abbreviation of a set of articles. What is key is: (a)
why and how you structure your paper and (b) why and how you are
able to present clearly ideas that are interesting. The review and the way
you structure the course literature must in terms of number of pages be
dominant in your paper. However, you can include your insight(s), for
example, in an introduction or conclusion that is unique to you and(or
your research topic. Short mentions, etc., related to your own
experiences and/or research are acceptable but do not affect grading. In
your review, remember ideas expressed in ASQ research forum.
View publication statsView publication stats
https://www.researchgate.net/publication/46948367
Understanding
Values Work
Institutional
Perspectives in
Organizations
and Leadership
Edited by
Harald Askeland ∙ Gry Espedal ∙
Beate Jelstad Løvaas ∙ Stephen Sirris
Understanding Values Work
Harald Askeland · Gry Espedal ·
Beate Jelstad Løvaas · Stephen Sirris
Editors
Understanding
Values Work
Institutional Perspectives
in Organizations and Leadership
Editors
Harald Askeland
VID Specialized University
Oslo, Norway
Beate Jelstad Løvaas
VID Specialized University
Oslo, Norway
Gry Espedal
VID Specialized University
Oslo, Norway
Stephen Sirris
VID Specialized University
Oslo, Norway
ISBN 978-3-030-37747-2 ISBN 978-3-030-37748-9 (eBook)
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9
© The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s) 2020. This book is an open access publication.
Open Access This book is licensed under the terms of the Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 Inter-
national License (http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adapta-
tion, distribution and reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Commons license and indicate
if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this book are included in the book’s Creative Commons
license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit line to the material. If material is not included in the
book’s Creative Commons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation or
exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from the copyright holder.
The use of general descriptive names, registered names, trademarks, service marks, etc. in this
publication does not imply, even in the absence of a specific statement, that such names are exempt
from the relevant protective laws and regulations and therefore free for general use.
The publisher, the authors and the editors are safe to assume that the advice and information in this
book are believed to be true and accurate at the date of publication. Neither the publisher nor the
authors or the editors give a warranty, expressed or implied, with respect to the material contained
herein or for any errors or omissions that may have been made. The publisher remains neutral with
regard to jurisdictional claims in published maps and institutional affiliations.
This Palgrave Macmillan imprint is published by the registered company Springer Nature
Switzerland AG
The registered company address is: Gewerbestrasse 11, 6330 Cham, Switzerland
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
Acknowledgements
The editors want to express our gratitude to those who gave their help
in the process of writing and production of this volume. Professor Arild
Wæraas, professor Annette Leis-Peters and Ph.D. fellow Bjørg Aambø
Østby have all given invaluable comments to early drafts of the individual
chapters. We are also thankful to Liz Barlow at Palgrave for believing
in and accepting this book, along with generous support from our own
institution, VID, by rector Ingunn Moser and vice-rector Bård Mæland
to fund the open-access publication.
v
Contents
1 Understanding Values Work in Organisations
and Leadership 1
Harald Askeland, Gry Espedal, Beate Jelstad Løvaas
and Stephen Sirris
Part I Understanding Values, Values Work and Complex
Institutional Contexts
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing
Implications for Values Work in Organisation
and Leadership 15
Harald Askeland
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work
in Organisations 35
Gry Espedal
vii
viii Contents
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values and
Identities in Scandinavian Welfare Organisations 57
Stephen Sirris
Part II Who Performs Values Work?
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical Case Study
of a Religious Organisation 81
Jose Bento da Silva
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’: Implicit Leadership
Theory at the Multicultural Workplace 97
Tone Lindheim
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional Leaders Keep
Organisational Integrity and Introduce Change 117
Marta Struminska-Kutra and Harald Askeland
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing
the ‘Good’ Organisation 139
Harald Askeland
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values Work
in a Context of Conflict and Violence 159
Ellen Vea Rosnes, Terese Bue Kessel
and Jolly Namwesi Kanywenge
Part III How Is Values Work Performed?
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective
on Researching Values in Organisations 181
Gry Espedal
Contents ix
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid: Negotiating the Elasticity
of Core Values 201
Stephen Sirris
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions:
“What’s Trust Got to Do with It?”—Experiences
from Scandinavia 223
Benedicte Tveter Kivle
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 245
Johan von Essen
14 The Value of Group Reflection 265
Beate Jelstad Løvaas and Gry Bruland Vråle
Index 285
Notes on Contributors
Harald Askeland holds a Dr.Philos. and a Ph.D. degree in organisation
and leadership theory, and is Professor at the VID Specialized University,
Oslo. He is also academic head of the centre for values-based leadership
and innovation at VID Specialized University. His main field of research
is in the fields of reforms and institutional change, and the role and prac-
tice of managerial leadership. In particular, his academic interest is related
to religious organisations and faith-based health organisations, concern-
ing how they are lead, operate in and are effected by public policies and
in collaborating with public agencies.
Jose Bento da Silva holds a Ph.D. from Warwick Business School,
together with an M.B.A. and a master’s in management from the
Catholic University of Portugal. Jose also completed two degrees: Elec-
tronics and Telecommunications Engineering (University of Aveiro) and
Philosophy (University of Porto).’ His research is centred on the histor-
ical development of organisations, with a special interest in how gover-
nance mechanisms and organisational social structures evolve historically.
Jose’s research speaks to how nowadays multinational organisations struc-
ture their activities and manage their operations across nations.
xi
xii Notes on Contributors
Gry Espedal is Associate Professor of the master’s program on values-
based leadership at VID Specialized University. Espedal holds a
Cand.theol. degree from Norwegian School of Theology and master of
management degree from BI Norwegian Business School and has cur-
rently completing a Ph.D. thesis in institutionalising of values work in
organisations. Espedal’s research falls within organisation theory, institu-
tional work and institutional logic and has a special emphasis on micro-
processes in organisations. The preferred method is qualitative.
Espedal has published articles and books within fields such as values-
based leadership, authentic leadership, appreciative leadership, coaching
and solution-focused approach, in addition to two biographies of female
leaders in the Evangelical Lutheran Church.
Beate Jelstad Løvaas is Associate Professor at the VID Specialized Uni-
versity in Oslo at the master’s program on values-based leadership. She
holds a Ph.D. degree in management. She has a master of science from
the Norwegian University of Life Sciences and a European master from
University of Kiel, Germany. Her research interest includes leadership,
motivation, meaningful work, supervision, relations, values and volun-
teering.
Jolly Namwesi Kanywenge is a Junior Lecturer at the Université Offi-
cielle de Bukavu. Her research focuses on entrepreneurship and develop-
ment, with a special attention given to women entrepreneurship in South
Kivu. Kanywenge was a junior researcher at the time of data collection
and the initial drafting of this chapter.
Terese Bue Kessel holds a Ph.D. in Theology. Her research focuses on
practical theology and international diakonia. Her thesis analysed a quest
for diaconal empowerment and transformation in the women church
movement, Femmes Pour Christ in Cameroon. She is an Associate Pro-
fessor of Practical Theology and is the head of the program of theology
at VID Specialized University, Stavanger.
Benedicte Tveter Kivle holds a Ph.D. in Sociology. She is an Associate
Professor at VID Specialized University, Oslo. Her research interests are
in public values, trust, learning organisations and integration studies.
Notes on Contributors xiii
Tone Lindheim holds master’s degrees in management, theology and
intercultural religious studies. She is Assistant Professor and Ph.D. stu-
dent at VID Specialized University. Her research focuses on cultural
diversity and inclusion in the workplace.
Ellen Vea Rosnes holds a Ph.D. in Literacy Studies. She is an Associate
Professor of Intercultural Communication and Global Studies at VID
Specialized University, Stavanger. Her research interests are mission edu-
cation during the twentieth century in Madagascar and South Africa and
intercultural competence in a Norwegian educational setting. She con-
ducted the fieldwork and wrote the first draft of this chapter when she
was a researcher at the Center for Intercultural Communication.
Stephen Sirris is head of the master’s program on values-based leader-
ship and serves as the director of the centre for values-based leadership
and innovation at VID Specialized University in Oslo. He holds master’s
degrees in theology, music and values-based leadership and is currently
completing a Ph.D. thesis on how hybrid professional managers nego-
tiate identities. His research interest includes civic organisations, profes-
sionalism and volunteering.
Marta Struminska-Kutra holds a Ph.D. in sociology. She is an Asso-
ciate Professor at VID Specialized University. Her research interest
includes governance, public administration, social innovation and the
methodology of critical and participatory research.
Johan von Essen is Professor at the Centre for Civil Society Research at
Ersta Sköndal Bräcke University College, Stockholm, Sweden, and affil-
iated with the Department of Theology at Uppsala University. His main
field of empirical research is the perceived meaning of volunteering and
the intersection of religion and volunteering. Besides empirical research,
he has done philosophical work on the moral plurality in civil society.
Gry Bruland Vråle is an Associate Professor at VID Specialized Uni-
versity in Oslo. She works at the centre for values-based leadership and
innovation, for the master program of values-based leadership as well at
advanced program in mental health care at VID. Her research interest
centres on supervision and suicidal prevention.
List of Figures
Fig. 6.1 Sources of implicit ideas of good and bad leadership 108
Fig. 11.1 Elasticity in managerial values work 218
Fig. 12.1 Norway: Number of articles on trust devided in published
year and type of article 231
Fig. 12.2 Sweden: Number of articles on trust devided in published
year and type of article 232
Fig. 12.3 Denmark: Number of articles on trust devided in published
year and type of article 232
Fig. 14.1 The process, mechanism and significance of group
reflection 277
xv
List of Tables
Table 3.1 Empirical articles relevant to the literature review 38
Table 4.1 Characteristics of ideal type sectors 69
Table 6.1 List of interviewees 102
Table 6.2 Descriptions of good and bad leadership 104
Table 7.1 Institutional work around logic shifts 126
Table 11.1 Hospital value discourse 207
Table 11.2 Managerial values work 214
Table 14.1 Outline of the group meetings 270
xvii
1
Understanding Values Work
in Organisations and Leadership
Harald Askeland, Gry Espedal, Beate Jelstad Løvaas
and Stephen Sirris
Values are fundamental to organisations. Considered key determinants
of attitudes, work behaviour and decision-making, values in organisa-
tions have emerged as a topic of growing interest among organisational
scholars and practitioners. By signifying what is desirable or appropriate,
values guide the choice of action. However, they do not offer precise or
standardised prescriptions of actions. Organisations focusing on values
work are in a better position to improve their practices and quality of
services. We believe that values work serves to bridge everyday practices
with the organisational purpose.
H. Askeland (B) · G. Espedal · B. Jelstad Løvaas · S. Sirris
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: harald.askeland@vid.no
G. Espedal
e-mail: gry.espedal@vid.no
B. Jelstad Løvaas
e-mail: beate.jelstad.lovaas@vid.no
S. Sirris
e-mail: Stephen.Sirris@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_1
1
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_1&domain=pdf
mailto:harald.askeland@vid.no
mailto:gry.espedal@vid.no
mailto:beate.jelstad.lovaas@vid.no
mailto:Stephen.Sirris@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_1
2 H. Askeland et al.
Work on values in organisations also assumes significance in the light
of the contexts in which organisations operate. Organisations are part
of a broad and heterogeneous institutional environment. Market, regu-
lations and laws establish a context of challenges and difficulties, often
forcing organisations to juggle between disparate demands, which result
in persistent and deep-rooted tensions. How do, for instance, organi-
sations pursue productivity while keeping their soul intact and deliv-
ering services true to their original purpose? Values come into play in
such situations of institutional pluralism (Kraatz & Block, 2008) or
institutional complexity (Greenwood, Raynard, Kodeih, Micelotta, &
Lounsbury, 2011), and they may have different roles. Essentially, work-
ing with values in workplaces involves probing why people work and
behave the way they do. We, therefore, address the following question:
In a complex and plural institutional context, how do leaders and members
perform values work?
By placing values work at the heart of what the actors do, the chapters
in this book manifest a performative and processual practice.
Purpose and Focus of the Book
The purpose of this book is to provide new insights into how work on
values is performed in organisations. The book is an edited collection of
theoretical and empirical chapters that report cases from various organi-
sations and institutional contexts in Scandinavia, Europe and Africa. We
give special attention to values-salient organisations, particularly public
and civic welfare organisations, as much of their interactions are char-
acterised by competing demands and divergent value orientations, and
their practices are conceived as moral work (Hasenfeld, 1983). We have
focused on studying values-salient organisations because they represent
an ‘extreme’ scenario in our study area.
Whereas previous literature on values has focused on cultural and cog-
nitive perspectives, the starting point of this book is a practice perspective
that analyses what is being done by whom and how, in relation to val-
ues. We especially identify and emphasise micro-processes in complex
and challenging organisational situations—an area where the literature
1 Understanding Values Work … 3
on institutions and institutional theories is relatively silent. By adopt-
ing a practice perspective and focusing on micro-processes, we
fill a gap and call for research on institutional theories (Hampel,
Lawrence, Tracey,Greenwood, & Oliver, 2017; Micelotta, Lounsbury,
& Greenwood, 2017). Using in-depth studies on institutional leadership
and practices of values work in organisations, this book applies different
theoretical lenses within the umbrella of institutional theories combined
with micro-level perspectives and practice-based approaches.
Introducing Values and Values Work
Values are intractably connected to norms and morals: they signify
worth, preferences and priorities and separate the desirable from the
undesirable. The question of realising the ‘good’ is an existential theme
that may align with the telos and overall goals inherent to practices. For
several case organisations discussed in this volume, realising the good
is a fundamental theme because they identify as faith-based (Askeland,
Espedal, & Sirris, 2019) or because of the public ethos. We recognise
these organisations as values-salient performing some kind of moral work
(Billis, 2010; Hasenfeld, 2010).
Our working definition of values is as follows: Values are individual
and collective trans-situational conceptions of desirable behaviours, objectives
and ideals that serve to guide or valuate practice.
Our interest in values work stems from a longstanding call for bring-
ing work back into organisations (Barley & Kunda, 2001). Acknowl-
edging the role of values in several institutional perspectives, we relate
values to the work and agency of leaders as well as to various groups of
organisational actors. Work refers to activities involving mental or phys-
ical effort performed to accomplish the results of any description. Since
values are inherently connected to actions in a threefold manner—by
intention, direction and interpretation—the work practices of leaders are
fertile areas for studying values. We follow a recent stream of organisa-
tional research: theorising values work in organisations as ongoing per-
formances situated in everyday practice (Gehman, Trevino, & Garud,
2013; Vaccaro & Palazzo, 2015).
4 H. Askeland et al.
Values work reflects normative assumptions and goals—it concerns
what is of value and what are the important behaviours to the organi-
sation. The process of producing value-related actions is central. Values
work can take place in the implementation of institutionalised practice,
but it is more prominent in phases where organisations maintain, for
example, their normative or value-based roots (Lawrence & Suddaby,
2006, pp. 222–230). In this book, we define values work as including
any set of acts in everyday work as being value-driven, and values work
to be a particular set of actions that enhance the ongoing knowledge and
reflection-creating processes that infuse an organization with value-related
actions (Espedal, 2019).
Values in Organisations and Leadership
We note a resurgence of interest in values, both in public policy dis-
courses and in research on organisational institutionalism and leader-
ship. However, in the context of organisations, values are often taken
for granted. The term or concept itself is rarely examined or discussed,
despite its relevance to the purpose and direction of organisational and
leadership practice. As such, this book presents studies in which values
are externalised in work and become part of the social practice of leaders
and organisations.
Many leadership theories have been developed to help leaders cope
with challenging organisational situations. Performance management
has proposed an approach to increase the effectiveness of companies
by improving the performance of its employees (Armstrong & Baron,
1998). A functionalistic guide to improving the culture through values-
based processes (McSween, 2003) has been proposed, which identifies
values as drivers of co-operation. Such ‘value management’ approaches
have been presented to facilitate the building of values-driven organisa-
tions. Thus, work often performed by consultants has fuelled assump-
tions that values somehow exist in organisations independent of action
and primarily constructed by leaders (Barrett, 2006). Thus, though
many organisations have established core values to influence prac-
tice (Falkenberg, 2006), they are treated as ‘mantras’ in organisations
1 Understanding Values Work … 5
(Lencioni, 2002), and organisations tend to focus more on defining them
than implementing them (Gehman et al., 2013).
The last decade has seen a renewed emphasis on the importance of val-
ues ethics and morality among leaders (Copeland, 2014). Values are also
related to social corporate responsibility and business ethics (Stackman,
Pinder, & Connor, 2000). Theories such as transformational leader-
ship, authentic leadership and ethical leadership have incorporated an
ethical and moral component into leader behaviour. However, in this
book, we lean towards a values-based tradition that highlights values
as central to understanding social processes in organisations and lead-
ership (Selznick, 2008). Alternatively, we consider values as embedded
in national cultures, shaping the charismatic idea of values-based leader-
ship (House, 1996; House, Quigley, & de Luque, 2010). During the last
decades, contributions from a Scandinavian context have shed light on
‘values-based leadership’, underscoring how leaders reflect and promote
processes to enhance values-consciousness in organisational practices
(Aadland & Askeland, 2017; Petersen & Stuhr Lassen, 1997; Pruzan,
2004). What values are, what they do and what threatens them offer
insights into the development of humanist concerns and viewpoints. Fol-
lowing Selznick (2008), values are understood as expressions of what
matters in social life, what leads to social flourishing and conditions that
allow for humans to thrive.
Overview of Chapters in the Book
To introduce the content of the book, we have grouped the chapters
under the headings of the what, who and how of understanding values
work in organisations and leadership. The what section presents a theo-
retical framework for understanding values, the emerging field of values
work and values work in plural institutional environments. The who of
values work focuses on actors, leaders and various aspects of institutional
leadership. We present studies investigating institutional leadership as it
creates, change and maintain institutions by practice.
The third section introduces studies elaborating how values work can
be found in the processes of organisations and in situations where actors
6 H. Askeland et al.
influence values work. What work promotes the standards, ideals and
identity of organisations?
The What of Understanding Values
Work—A Theoretical Framework
This section of the book takes a closer look at the values construct evi-
dent in everyday language, public debate and policy. Providing a frame
for examining values work, the chapters clarify how we conceptualise
and apply the term values. Askeland outlines the trajectory of values,
particularly within streams of organisational institutionalism. Conveying
a frame for discussing values work, it clarifies how to conceptualise the
term values. Discussing classic and recent contributions, the chapter pro-
poses a working definition of values. We review studies on values work in
organisations. Espedal reviews the existing empirical studies and emerg-
ing literature on values work in organisations, aiming to disambiguate
the phenomenon. Understanding values work as ongoing value perfor-
mances, it is identified as social and institutional processes of construct-
ing agency, actions and practice. Values work is part of both a performa-
tive tradition of process studies and an institutional work tradition that
strives to change, disrupt and maintain institutions. The final chapter in
this section, by Sirris, introduces readers to the unique complexity of the
Scandinavian welfare mix by investigating how institutional complexity
relates to values work in organisations. Seen complexity as a contextual
condition that triggers work on values and identities, it discusses how the
intersection of a welfare logic and a market logic affects organisational
values and identities.
Exploring Who Is Doing Values Work—The
Actors
We witness a resurgence of interest in institutional leadership, originally
conceptualised by Selznick over sixty years ago (Selznick, 1957/1983).
Central to the concept of institutional leadership is its distinction from
1 Understanding Values Work … 7
terms such as ‘management’ or ‘administration’ (Raffaelli & Glynn,
2015; Selznick, 1957/1983). According to Selznick, institutional lead-
ership involves ‘infusing’ the organisation with values, and it distin-
guishes a leader from an administrator. Institutional leadership con-
cerns establishing and protecting institutional values and character. It
is oriented towards self-maintenance retrospective. While some con-
tributions seek to identify the central aspects of institutional leader-
ship, others show how leaders contribute to either institutional creation
(Struminska-Kutra, 2018), maintenance through adaption (Askeland,
2014) or change (Kraatz & Moore, 2002). This section foregrounds lead-
ership in understanding how organisational values work contributes to
renewal in practice. The chapters in this section address how managers
work intentionally with values through different forms of institutional
work.
To understand institutional leadership, we also identify how, for
instance, poverty became a fundamental value of the Jesuit organisation
revisiting the relevance of values. Bento da Silva discusses a less known
part of Selznick’s work in which the ambiguous character of values is
highlighted. He analyses how poverty has been conceptualised within a
Catholic religious organisation, showing that, in the Jesuit case, poverty
is not strictly defined. Instead, poverty results from the constant dialogue
between the individual Jesuit and their leader. Being the result of such
a constant dialogue between the leader and their followers, institutional
leadership can be revisited and freed from the heroic view that has long
characterised it.
Askeland addresses how managers through values work enact critical
functions of institutional leadership, by ongoing efforts and the recur-
ring facilitation of processes relating the mission, values and character of
the organisation. The chapter analyses how leaders maintain and develop
the ‘good organisation’ through three thematic frames: Conceiving of the
‘good home’, enhancing ‘the common good’ and establishing a shared,
embodied understanding of ‘good practice’. Struminska-Kutra and Aske-
land illustrate how leaders respond to external pressures for change and
actively transform organisational practices and identities. They argue that
leader’s action displays either through projective, future-oriented agency
or by habitual agency. The chapter develops a typology of strategies used
8 H. Askeland et al.
by leaders in response to plural isomorphic pressures. Lindheim explores
how employees and managers negotiate leadership across cultures when
interacting with one another’s implicit ideas of leadership. The chapter
explains how contextual factors at the institutional, field and organisa-
tional levels along with individual experiences from the native country
and the Norwegian work context present a dynamic cultural configura-
tion that shapes the implicit ideas of good and bad leadership. Vea, Kessel
and Kanywenge explore how the leadership journey is experienced dif-
ferently by women around the world. Analysing stories of women leaders
from South Kivu, the Democratic Republic of Congo, the chapter con-
tributes to the knowledge on how women compete and negotiate paths
to leadership through values work in a context of conflict and violence.
Understanding How to Do Values Work
Our ideals are tied to our experience, choices, projects and customs. Our
realisation of them is supported by sound knowledge and enhanced by
how we think and our judgements of what to do. Everything worth
knowing has an eidos—a form of an idea—that gives it a unique con-
ception (Selznick, 2008). The ideas of values such as justice, piety, love
and trust are normative as well as cognitive. How these values manifest in
actions is an aspect that needs further investigation. A process-based per-
spective might aid in catching values in flight. Espedal focuses on the use
of process studies in relation to the investigation of values work in organ-
isations. The chapter explains how values work can be studied through a
strong-process perspective linked to practices that develop, grow or ter-
minate values over time. Process studies identify various mechanisms and
issues related to the performative, situated and agentic nature of values
work. In this work, different methodology approaches are suggested for
process studies investigating values work and institutionalising processes.
Von Essen analyses how values related to the volunteer experience are
used to construct identities of engaged citizens in contemporary Swedish
society. By evaluating a normative significant situation, a human agent
discloses the kind of person she wants to be, so that identity is defined by
the agent’s evaluations. Kivle elaborates on mechanisms of values work,
1 Understanding Values Work … 9
based on textual analysis concerning trust and trust-based management
in three Scandinavian popular scientific journals. Findings indicate that
trust is ‘worked upon’ simultaneously within competing frameworks,
which are also interpreted to be manifestations of differences between
institutional logics.
Løvaas and Vråle investigate how values work are performed through
group reflections of middle managers. Findings indicate that spaces of
group reflection enable individual actors to move inward representing
identity processes, and move forward, getting the courage and strength
from the managerial group reflection. Sirris explores how managers nego-
tiate organisational core values to perform values work. The chapter con-
ceptualises the dynamics of values being simultaneously fixed—at an
organisational discursive level—and fluid—at an individual managerial
level—as value elasticity.
We believe these studies allow a more nuanced understanding of values
work in organisations and divergent configurations of practice. We argue
this promotes better consciousness and reflection on standards and ide-
als in difficult organisational situations. The editors and authors of this
book sincerely hope that this work will stimulate further discussions and
dialogue on how to perform values work in organisations. We also hope
that it serves as a useful resource for scholars working in the domains of
organisation and leadership studies.
The editors want to express our gratitude to those who gave their help
in the process of writing and production of this volume. Professor Arild
Wæraas, professor Annette Leis-Peters and Ph.D. fellow Bjørg Aambø
Østby have all given invaluable comments to early drafts of the individ-
ual chapters. We are also thankful to Liz Barlow at Palgrave for believing
in and accepting this book, along with generous support from our own
institution, VID, by rector Ingunn Moser and vice-rector Bård Mæland
to fund the open-access publication.
10 H. Askeland et al.
References
Aadland, E., & Askeland, H. (2017). Verdibevisst ledelse [Valueconscious lead-
ership]. Oslo, Norway: Cappelen Damm.
Armstrong, M., & Baron, A. (1998). Performance management: The new reali-
ties. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University.
Askeland, H. (2014). Leaders should be the carriers of institutional values: An
account of how leaders contribute to the value-base of diaconal institutions.
Diaconia: Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 5(2), 147–175.
Askeland, H., Espedal, G., & Sirris, S. (2019). Values as vessels of religion? Role
of values in everyday work at faith-based organisations. Diaconia: Journal of
the Study of Christian Social Practice, 10(1), 27–49.
Barley, S. R., & Kunda, G. (2001). Bringing work back in. Organization Sci-
ence, 12(1), 76–95.
Barrett, R. (2006). Building a values-driven organization: A whole system
approach to cultural transformation. London, UK: Routledge.
Billis, D. (2010). Hybrid organizations and the third sector: Challenges for prac-
tice, theory and policy. New York, NY: Palgrave Macmillan.
Copeland, M. K. (2014). The emerging significance of values based leadership:
A literature review. International Journal of Leadership Studies, 8(2), 105–
135.
Espedal, G. (2019). Being compassionate. Institutionalizing through values work
in a faith-based organization (PhD). VID Specialized University, Oslo.
Falkenberg, G. (2006). Verdier og sosiale normer i store norske virksomheter. Vik-
tige kulturbærere eller fordekt PR? [Values and social norms in large Norwe-
gian companies: Important cultural carrieres or hidden PR]. Retrieved from
https://www.fafo.no/media/com_netsukii/10028 .
Gehman, J., Trevino, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Greenwood, R., Raynard, M., Kodeih, F., Micelotta, E. R., & Lounsbury, M.
(2011). Institutional complexity and organizational responses. The Academy
of Management Annals, 5(1), 317–371.
Hampel, C. E., Lawrence, T. B., Tracey, P., Greenwood, R., & Oliver, C.
(2017). Institutional work: Taking stock and making it matter. In R.
Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B. Lawrence, & R. Meyer (Eds.), The Sage hand-
book of organizational institutionalism (pp. 558–590). London, UK: Sage.
https://www.fafo.no/media/com_netsukii/10028
1 Understanding Values Work … 11
Hasenfeld, Y. (1983). Human service organizations. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Pren-
tice Hall.
Hasenfeld, Y. (2010). The attributes of human service organizations. In Y.
Hasenfeld (Ed.), Human services as complex organizations (2nd ed., pp. 9–
32). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
House, R. J. (1996). Path-goal theory of leadership: Lessons, legacy and a refor-
mulated theory. Leadership Quarterly, 7 (3), 323–352.
House, R. J., Quigley, N. R., & de Luque, M. S. (2010). Insights from Project
GLOBE: Extending global advertising research through a contemporary
framework. International Journal of Advertising, 29(1), 111–139.
Kraatz, M. S., & Block, E. S. (2008). Organizational implications of institu-
tional pluralism. In R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, K. Sahlin, & R. Suddaby
(Eds.), The Sage handbook of organizational institutionalism (pp. 243–276).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Kraatz, M. S., & Moore, J. H. (2002). Executive migration and institutional
change. Academy of Management Journal, 45(1), 120–143.
Lawrence, T. B., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work.
In S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. B. Lawrence, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), The Sage
handbook of organization studies (2nd ed., pp. 215–254). London, UK: Sage.
Lencioni, P. M. (2002). Make your values mean something. Harvard Business
Review, 80(7), 113–117.
McSween, T. E. (2003). Values-based safety process: Improving your safety culture
with behavior-based safety. Hoboken, NJ: Wiley.
Micelotta, E., Lounsbury, M., & Greenwood, R. (2017). Pathways of institu-
tional change: An integrative review and research agenda. Journal of Man-
agement, 43(6), 1885–1910.
Petersen, V. C., & Stuhr Lassen, M. (1997). Værdibaseret ledelse: et alternativ til
styring, regulering og kontrol? [Valuebased leadership: An alternative to gov-
ernance, regulation and control?]. København, Denmark: Dansk Industri.
Pruzan, M Ma P. (2004). Values-based leadership. In L. Zsolnai (Ed.), Ethics
in the economy: Handbook of business ethics. Oxford, UK: Peter Lang.
Raffaelli, R., & Glynn, A. (2015). What’s so institutional about leadership?
Leadership mechanisms of value infusion. In M. S. Kraatz (Ed.), Institutions
and ideals: Philip Selznick’s legacy for organizational studies (Vol. 44). Bingley,
UK: Emerald.
Selznick, P. (1957/1983). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpreta-
tion. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Selznick, P. (2008). A humanist science: Values and ideals in social inquiry. Stan-
ford, CA: Stanford University Press.
12 H. Askeland et al.
Stackman, R. W., Pinder, C. C., & Connor, P. E. (2000). Values lost: Redi-
recting research on values in the workplace. In N. M. Ashkanasy, C. P. M.
Wilderom, & M. F. Peterson (Eds.), Handbook of organizational culture and
climate (pp. 37–54). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Struminska-Kutra, M. (2018). Democratizing public management: Towards
practice-based theory. Cham, Switzerland: Palgrave Macmillan.
Vaccaro, A., & Palazzo, G. (2015). Values against violence: Institutional change
in societies dominated by organized crime. Academy of Management Journal,
58(4), 1075–1101.
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
Part I
Understanding Values, Values Work
and Complex Institutional Contexts
2
Values—Reviewing the Construct
and Drawing Implications for Values Work
in Organisation and Leadership
Harald Askeland
Introduction
Values are an inseparable part of organisational institutionalism and are
at the core of the definition in many sub-streams of institutional theory.
As ideas of the desirable or appropriate, values have bearing on meaning,
what ought to be and choice of appropriate action. Values link to the
very essence of institutions, their distinct character or identity, the logics
influencing them and work done to create, maintain and change them.
Values work in organisations shapes the purpose of organisations and the
direction of efforts and composes criteria for the valuation of organisa-
tional practices. Increasingly embedded in multiple institutional environ-
ments or operating at institutional intersections, organisations experience
pressures regarding core values, structures and processes. In this context,
we argue that understanding values and abilities to perform values work
H. Askeland (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: harald.askeland@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_2
15
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_2&domain=pdf
mailto:harald.askeland@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_2
16 H. Askeland
is of importance for institutional development and institutional leader-
ship. Supporting the aim of exploring values work, this chapter takes a
closer look at the values construct itself.
While considered a dormant concept or under-developed issue for
some time (Chen, Lune, & Queen, 2013; Hitlin & Piliavin, 2004),
this book argues there is a resurgence of interest in the construct of val-
ues. This holds true in public policy discourses and in research within
organisational institutionalism and leadership. Inherent in institutional
arrangement, values are core constructs of normative structures and thus
taken for granted. At the same time, precise prescriptions of action are
not necessarily given. Being both individual and shared by collectives,
values might form the base for either consensus or competing orienta-
tions among actors and interest groups.
The values construct has an enduring trajectory in academic writ-
ing on organisations and leadership (Bednarek-Gilland, 2016; Deth &
Scarbrough, 1995; Meglino & Ravlin, 1998; Spates, 1983) but has
also a natural part of everyday language, public debate and policy. The
term captures increasing interest within central perspectives of institu-
tional theory, such as institutional logics (Friedland & Alford, 1991;
Krücken, Meyer, & Walgenbach, 2017), institutional work (Lawrence,
Leca, & Zilber, 2013), values work (Aadland et al., 2006; Askeland,
2014; Gehman, Trevino, & Garud, 2013; Vaccaro & Palazzo, 2014)
and identity work (Albert & Whetten, 1985; Schmid, 2013; Watson,
2008). Also within the field of research on managers or leaders, we see
a resurgence of an interest in values. Values is an important concept in
perspectives such as managing and institutional leadership (Cameron,
Quinn, DeGraff, & Thakor, 2006; Kraatz & Flores, 2015; Mintzberg,
2009; Raffaelli & Glynn, 2015), public administration (de Vries & Kim,
2011; Jørgensen, Vrangbæk, & Sørensen, 2013; Moore, 1995) and non-
profit management (Aadland & Skjørshammer, 2012; Askeland, 2011,
2015; Jeavons, 1992; Knutsen, 2012). Yet, in spite of this renewed inter-
est, the term itself remains somewhat ambiguous and taken for granted.
This ambiguity is argued to be inherent in values, allowing for differing
interpretations by actors while at the same time creating a sense of unity
(Askeland, Espedal, & Sirris, 2019).
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 17
This chapter outlines the trajectory of values, particularly within
streams of organisational institutionalism, in order to analyse its applica-
tion to values work in organisation and leadership. Conveying a frame
for discussing values work in this book requires clarification of how
we conceptualise the concept values. While economists relate value to
objects, which differs in value due to the strength of preference of actors
or consumers, I will position it in line with contributions that underscore
values’ relation to valuation emanating from meaning, concern, norma-
tive agreements and what is considered desirable (Askeland & Aadland,
2017; Bednarek-Gilland, 2016; Kluckhohn, 1951; Spates, 1983). The
latter makes the connection of individuals and collectives a crucial issue.
Basic Distinctions and Trajectory
of the Values’ Concept
Basic distinctions of the term values stem from differing paradigms and
often represent single perspectives. Such basic positions relate to various
positions of philosophy of science in the social sciences (Hollis, 2002;
Kemmis, 2011), and I argue it can be applied to separate contributions
linking values to organisation and leadership. Two key dimensions, each
one claiming opposing views, have consequences for the study and expla-
nation of values. The first dimension regards the distinction between
objective and subjective, while the other regards structure versus agency.
The first distinction affects viewing values either in a factual or inter-
pretive way, while the other affects viewing values as either individual
properties or collectively articulated and shared.
It is possible to identify two different basic understandings of values
(Aadland, 2010; Bednarek-Gilland, 2016), often referred to as the dis-
tinction between ‘facts and ideals’. This distinction draws on Simon, who
distinguishes between factual and ethical (ideational) aspects of decisions
in organisations (Simon, 1957, pp. 55–57). Research on values conse-
quently often uses differing strategies and methodologies.
The major tradition conceptualises values as inherent qualities iden-
tified and explored as objectively existing phenomena of social life
(Meglino & Ravlin, 1998). Even if values are conceptualised partly as
18 H. Askeland
beliefs (Rokeach, 1973; Schwartz, 1994), research has concentrated on
establishing measurement instruments to map existing patterns of val-
ues among individual actors and between national cultures. Major inter-
national surveys on values, which find different cultural and social pat-
terns in different countries’ values, apply this perception of values and
ascribe them structural properties that influence behaviour (Inglehart,
1990; Schwartz, 2006). One of the most influential contributions to
values research, and much cited in the scholarly literature, defines val-
ues as ‘an enduring belief that a specific mode of conduct or end-state
of existence is personally or socially preferable to an opposite or converse
mode of conduct or end-state of existence’ (Rokeach, 1973, p. 5). The
values described in surveys are short forms of people’s action flexibilities.
Such a perception, applied to values work, argues leaders should identify
desirable organisational values and launch measures to ensure the imple-
mentation of those values (Lencioni, 2002). This perception is indebted
to a somewhat positivist view of science and characterised as objectivist
values (Bednarek-Gilland, 2016, p. 2), concerning studying values for
practice. Consequently much research in this tradition, as represented by
Rokeach and Schwartz, implicitly addresses values in an individualistic
manner (Chanut, Chomienne, & Desmarais, 2015, p. 221). Question-
naires address individual respondents, and the collective or shared aspect
of values is portrayed as an aggregated accumulation of individuals to the
group level.
Another approach regards values as phenomena constructed and
added to common sense in the social space, catching attention and
affecting practice for a time and later replaced by new issues (Aadland,
2010; Bednarek-Gilland, 2016; Deth & Scarbrough, 1995). An impor-
tant idea put forth by Van Deth and Scarbrough contributes particularly
to a collective grounding of values: ‘Values could be seen as conceptions
of the desirable, which are not directly observable, but are evident in
moral discourse and patterns of attitudes forming value orientations with
relevance to action’ (Deth & Scarbrough, 1995). Values are, in other
words, linguistic constructions that express assigned importance. They
inherently rely on arguments such as ‘ought’, ‘preferable’ and ‘good’,
having moral or ethical implications not reducible to factual terms
(Simon, 1957, p. 56). Values, therefore, cannot be studied directly; they
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 19
function more like projections and interpretations by a person of what
is a good or wrong act or thing (Askeland & Aadland, 2017, p. 27;
Gehman et al., 2013). Values develop through dialogue and interpre-
tation in specific contexts. Bednarek-Gilland (2016) underscores this,
arguing values can change due to experiential learning through fac-
ing issues or situations related to what concerns actors. Such concern
represents states of being that are ‘trans-situative’ and ‘trans-subjective’
(Bednarek-Gilland, 2016, p. 4). Various actors bring their own expe-
riences, assessments and interests into the opinion formation process.
Organisational practice is ambiguous, and the relationship between val-
ues and action cannot be proven in a closed chain of logical cause and
effect (Aadland, 2010). This points at experience as central in both the
inculcation and eventual transformation of values. Consequently, values
tied to social collectives and/or organisations through articulation are
part of common sense or a shared meaning- or norm-structure. Such
an understanding, focusing on social construction, implies more use of
qualitative data.
In both understandings, the concept of values closely relates to ethics
and morality. Values indicate good and wrong and function both as
descriptive and normative concepts. In their descriptive function, val-
ues describe actual valuation practices that characterise people in a given
group or how values develop as meaningful in given contexts. In a nor-
mative function, values inform ideals and overall objectives—whether
understood as timeless and universal or as relative and contextual in
nature.
Furthermore, Brown and Treviño argue there exists little correlation
between different theories and measures within the research on values
and values in organisation and leadership (Brown & Treviño, 2003,
p. 154). A major exception, reviewed briefly later in this chapter, is the
different sub-streams of institutional theory. Although used, authors sel-
dom define values. And their effects are briefly spelled out and taken
for granted. This may indicate there has been little focus on which or
what kind of values authors convey or that the question of values’ sig-
nificance for action and interaction is a topic that garners little atten-
tion (Maierhofer, Rafferty, & Kabanoff, 2003). Within management and
leadership research, there are nevertheless some important exceptions.
20 H. Askeland
Two major streams, dating back to the late 1970s and stemming from
the turn to leadership, are charismatic value-based leadership (House,
1976) and transformational leadership (Avolio & Bass, 1995; Burns,
1978). A Scandinavian tradition conceptualises values in leadership more
as a leadership philosophy, aimed at creating and sustaining a consen-
sual base of values to guide organisational practices but with weak ties
to management or leadership theory (Aadland et al., 2006; Brytting &
Trollestad, 2000; Petersen & Lassen, 1997). These Scandinavian con-
tributions, focusing on the collective articulation and implementation
of values, come close to what is termed values work. Recent research
displays renewed interest in the relationship between ‘public values’ and
the value orientation of leaders’ in public services (Chanut et al., 2015;
Jørgensen, 2006; Tholen, 2011). Other contributions build on Selznick’s
notion of institutional leadership (Kraatz & Flores, 2015; Raffaelli &
Glynn, 2015; Washington, Boal, & Davis, 2008) and finally research on
how values shape important processes of institutional work framed as
values work (Askeland, 2014; Gehman et al., 2013; Vaccaro & Palazzo,
2014).
Values in Streams of Institutional Theory
The concept of values, historically applied in several academic disciplines,
permeates institutional theory of organisation and leadership. The term
is used in such a variety of ways that a precise and unambiguous defi-
nition may seem unattainable. In the field of social science in general,
central concepts have been close to the notion of values. The field’s clas-
sics were already keen on rationality and cognitive or cultural patterns as
explanatory factors of social life. This is especially true of Max Weber,
describing comprehensive cultural changes of rationality as the basis for
the development of social forms, using the term value-oriented rational-
ity for action based on the self-conscious conviction that the action has
a value inherent to itself, independent of any consequences it might or
might not have (Weber, 1978). Value-rationality is contrasted by pur-
poseful rational action, aiming at realising certain goals, while value-
oriented rational action stems from compliance with policies or standards
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 21
that are binding in themselves. However, the one who put values on the
agenda for comprehensive research interest was Talcott Parsons (1951).
The idea of common normative thought patterns from the classics con-
tinued in the concept of value. ‘[T]he most important of these norma-
tive agreements were what Parsons called values – those moral beliefs
to which people appealed for the ultimate rationales for action’ (Spates,
1983, p. 28). Social anthropologist Clyde Kluckhohn formulated the fol-
lowing use and understanding of the concept of value:
A value is a conception, implicit or explicit, distinctive of an individual
or characteristic of a group, of the desirable, which influences the selec-
tion from available modes, means and ends of action. (Kluckhohn, 1951,
p. 395)
This definition focuses on some important elements. First, it points to
the notion that something is desirable. This implies conceiving values
as normative ideals; they are mental constructs, not unbiased artefacts.
Second, the definition implies that values affect the choice of available
goals and options for action. Third, it distinguishes between implicit and
explicit values. While the articulation and attribution of content distin-
guish an explicit value, implicit values lack a common conceptualisa-
tion. One last important point is Kluckhohn’s emphasis on the desirable
rather than desired, which positions the value concept of closer to ethics’
‘should’ than to psychology’s ‘need’. In this understanding of values, there
are important elements that only affect the relationship between values
and action (Deth & Scarbrough, 1995, pp. 31–36). As ideas of the desir-
able, values can mobilise the notion of what should happen, acted upon
or be used as a basis for valuation.
Institutional theories have risen to become a dominant sociological
and organisational theory of collectives and collective action. Moreover,
the concept of values constitutes an inseparable part of institutional the-
ories. Most obviously, values are key in Selznick’s conceptualisation of
institutions and institutional leadership. In contrast to organisations,
understood as administrative and technical systems, he emphasises the
institution as being a kind of informal ‘social constitution’ shaped by
‘natural social processes’ and ‘adaptive changes’, leading to a process of
22 H. Askeland
institutionalisation in which it is ‘infused with value beyond the techni-
cal requirements of the task at hand’ (Selznick, 1957/1984, p. 17). Dis-
tinguishing administration from leadership, Selznick portrays the insti-
tutional leader as ‘primarily an expert in the promotion and protection
of values’ (Selznick, 1957/1984, p. 17).
Later contributions also continue to include values when defining the
term institution: ‘We see institutions as cultural rules giving collective
meaning and value to particular entities and activities, integrating them
into the larger schemes’ (Meyer & Boli, 1987, p. 13). In most definitions,
values is implicitly embedded in terminology such as ‘normative systems’,
‘beliefs’ and ‘cognitive understandings’: ‘(…) we understand the term to
refer to more-or-less taken-for-granted repetitive social behavior that is
underpinned by normative systems and cognitive understandings that
give meaning to social exchange and thus enable self-reproducing social
order’ (Greenwood, Oliver, Sahlin, & Suddaby, 2008, p. 5).
According to Scott, this is particularly true for one cluster of theories,
the normative theories, attending to the ways in which values, norms
and commitments generated in interaction shape, undermine and aug-
ment formal and official regimes (Scott, 2004, p. 410). Their importance
lies in introducing prescriptive, evaluative and obligatory dimensions
into social life. As a response, individual or collective actors determine
the nature of the situation, reflect on the nature of their own identity
and act accordingly. Values might also be important from the cultural-
cognitive perspective, as such view rests on more ‘deeply set beliefs and
assumptions’ (Scott, 2005, p. 16). Therefore, an early key contribu-
tion of institutional theory has been accounts of the processes by which
behaviour is governed by institutions or by institutionalised, taken-for-
granted assumptions (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006, p. 215). Across the
contributions, authors have accepted the notion that values affect organ-
isations and that organisations adopt structures and practices in order to
gain legitimacy (Greenwood et al., 2008, p. 7).
The further development of institutional theory nuanced the over-
all notion of adaption, thus challenging this assumed causal argument
(Scott, 2005). A first nuance was recognising the varied and conflict-
ing nature of institutional environments, which consisted of fields with
differing and plural value orientations inherent in institutional logics
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 23
(Friedland & Alford, 1991).1 In the subsequent development of the insti-
tutional logics perspective, values were originally maintained as part of
defining logics (Thornton & Ocasio, 2008).
Secondly, actors and their capacity to exercise agency and make a dif-
ference paved the way for processual approaches to examine how actors
handle differing pressures or work to maintain or change institutions.
Particularly in explaining change, institutional theory needed to incor-
porate ‘the reality of purposive, interest-driven, and conflictual behavior’
(DiMaggio, 1988, p. 5). Institutional work which is ‘the purposive action
of individuals and organisations aimed at creating, maintaining and dis-
rupting institutions’ (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006, p. 215) underscores
an actor’s perspective. Institutional work presupposes that individuals’
and organisations’ behaviour is framed by larger patterns of ideas and
opinions about what is ‘good or less good’ in organisational and manage-
ment practice. Values are critical in the establishment or implementation
of institutionalised practice but have particular emphasis in phases where
organisations maintain, for example, their normative or value-based basis
(Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006, pp. 222–230).
Of special interest, I find contributions of values work that iden-
tify and integrate the agentic efforts in temporal processes mobilising
action based on or in support of values (Gehman et al., 2013; Vaccaro &
Palazzo, 2014).2 In addition, contributions addressing the particular role
of leaders in infusing or promoting values in organisations are of interest
(Askeland, 2014; Golant, Sillince, Harvey, & Maclean, 2015; Kraatz &
Flores, 2015; Raffaelli & Glynn, 2015; Washington et al., 2008).
In these contributions, values are usually not explicitly defined but
instead taken for granted. One exception is the work of Gehman and
colleagues (2013), which explicates a values definition but does not elab-
orate on it. While functionalist theory, and the Parsonian legacy, had lost
strength, theoretical inspiration for institutional theories came from clas-
sical theorists such as Durkheim and Weber (Durkheim, 2001; Weber,
1978) as well as Berger and Luckman, applying the notion of institution-
alisation in their sociology of knowledge (Berger & Luckmann, 1967).
1For a further elaboration on the logics perspective, see Sirris’s chapter in this book.
2For a review on the values work literature, see Espedals contribution in this volume.
24 H. Askeland
Scott contends that the normative perspective in institutional theory bor-
rows from earlier, normatively oriented sociologists such as Parsons and
Selznick (Parsons, 1935, 1960; Scott, 2005; Selznick, 1949, 1957/1984).
Following Spates, it seems reasonable that this taken-for-granted use
of the concept of values relies heavily on a Parsonian understanding
of values. Spates argues that the basic idea that values were a control-
ling factor in social life, which permeated American sociology, is an
enduring Parsonian legacy (Spates, 1983, p. 30). As argued in an ear-
lier section, Kluchhohn’s definition of values is one of the most widely
used, implying that values become the instigator of behaviour ‘within’
the individual through socialisation. As such, they convey legitimacy
when observed; they order social life by shaping behavioural orientation
by being institutionalised and taking on rule-likeness. All these com-
ponents, emanating from within the Parsonian values theory (Parsons,
1951; Spates, 1983, p. 31), are traceable in major contributions of insti-
tutional theory although supplemented by refinement and the incorpo-
ration of re-constructed theoretical considerations. Important ideas con-
tradicting these basic assumptions relate to issues of institutional plural-
ism and conflicting logics, agency and the processes accompanying the
creation, maintenance and change of institutions and institutionalised
practices.
Values are part of the core construction of or definition in the follow-
ing four important contemporary streams of institutional theory of par-
ticular interest in this book: institutional leadership, institutional iden-
tity, institutional logics and institutional (values) work.
Rounding Out the Concept of Values
The concept of values, as it originated in sociology, permeates the insti-
tutional theory of organisation and leadership. Caused by variety of def-
initions, a rounding out of the term seems preferable over a precise
and unambiguous definition. In the social sciences, the term has been
used in social economics, sociology, social psychology, political science
and social anthropology but with only some connection or similarity in
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 25
how it has been used in the various academic fields (Graeber, 2001;
Hitlin & Piliavin, 2004). While values theory has enjoyed some develop-
ment regarding its explication and measurement through value surveys
(House, Quigley, & de Luque, 2010; Meglino & Ravlin, 1998; Rokeach,
1973; Schwartz, 2006), it seems to be an under-specified yet frequently
used and taken-for-granted term in streams of institutional theory (Fried-
land, 2017). Based on earlier contributions, I suggest a ‘rounding out’
of the values term combining prior (Kluckhohn, 1951; Rokeach, 1973;
Schwartz, 1994) and more recent developments (Askeland & Aadland,
2017; Bednarek-Gilland, 2016; Gehman et al., 2013).
For such a ‘rounding out’ regarding values, there are important
elements affecting the relationship between values and action (Deth &
Scarbrough, 1995, pp. 31–36). As ideas of the desirable, values can
mobilise the notion of what ought to happen or be the basis for val-
uation. At the same time, values do not directly prescribe any specific
action choices but rather form principles upon which to assess or valuate
action. Van Deth and Scarbrough assume that patterns of attitudes con-
stitute value orientations, which in turn indirectly manifest themselves in
actions. While held by individuals, values become social through articu-
lation and form a part of common sense or serve as underlying normative
structures.3 As such, they can be shared by [members of] an organised
collective. Values also relate to the interests of actors or groups and are
also situated in differing contexts, which implies they are not necessarily
organised hierarchically but rather related in ‘clusters’ of neighbouring
values (Stackman, Pinder, & Connor, 2000). These clusters may form
orientations, even within the same organisation, where different groups
place more or less importance on professional, administrative and eco-
nomic values. Thus, it becomes likely that there might be tension and
conflict among the various clusters of values constituting competition or
dilemmas needing to be resolved (Quinn & Rohrbaugh, 1983; Selznick,
1957).
As a working definition for studying values work in organisations and
leadership, I propose to conceive of values as:
3For a more thorough discussion on differing forms of values at the collective or organizational
level, see Bourne and Jenkins’s elaborate categorisation (Bourne & Jenkins, 2013).
26 H. Askeland
Values are individual and collective conceptions of desirable trans-
situational behaviours, objectives and ideals, serving to guide or valuate
practice.
Implicit in this definition is that values (1) are either explicitly or implic-
itly contextual (spatial and temporally situated); (2) serve to mobilise for
and direct action; (3) are not observable but manifested in or as the valu-
ation of practice; (4) are acquired through socialisation into group values
yet changeable through experiential learning; (5) are constituted, main-
tained and changed in dialectical interaction between the individual and
his or her social collective and (6) even when shared they are ambiguous
and open for interpretation.
Leaders contribute by focusing on values and ethical considerations
to ‘frame’ value standards for the organisation and its behaviour as well
as drawing boundaries for types of behaviour deemed unacceptable. This
has implications internally in the organisation as well as for its legitimacy
in relation to the external environment. Increasingly organisations and
leaders find themselves in plural institutional contexts, representing con-
flicting or co-existing institutional logics. While institutional theory has
traditionally emphasised external pressure leading to organisational adap-
tion or differing adaptive or coping strategies, the last two decades have
produced contributions arguing for bringing both society (Friedland &
Alford, 1991), the agentic actor (Battilana, 2004; Kraatz, 2009) and
work back in (Barley & Kunda, 2001). These streams of research and the-
orising developed into differentiated perspectives, and few studies con-
nect these perspectives. While not aiming at resolving this differentia-
tion, I argue that values entail a concept central to all of these strands
of research interest and constitute a venue for examining commonalities
and points of departure for bridging efforts.
Implications for Values Work in Organisation
and Leadership
Although sub-streams of institutional theory often employ the term val-
ues in core definitions, hardly ever is the term elaborated or clarified.
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 27
At the same time, many basic assumptions of Parsonian theory under-
pin the functions attributed to values, either taking values for granted
or omitting the values term, substituting it with terms like ‘normative
expectations’, ‘beliefs’ and ‘cognitive structures’ (Friedland, 2017). Insti-
tutional logics, which is of interest for contributions of the book, rarely
define the values term in recent work although it was a central concept
in the originating works (Friedland, 2017; Friedland & Alford, 1991).
Important exceptions are the resurgence of interest in institutional lead-
ership (Kraatz & Flores, 2015; Washington et al., 2008) and values work
(Gehman et al., 2013).
Such exploration should more generally attend to issues such as span-
ning the micro-macro divide, the importance of context, temporal or
processual aspects, organisational identity and finally the intentionality
or agentic aspect of values work.
Finally, the chapter elaborates on how a renewed conceptualisation
of values (Askeland & Aadland, 2017; Bednarek-Gilland, 2016) might
inform further research on values work in organisation and leadership
studies. In explicating the role of values, their situatedness in contexts
marked by pluralistic institutional environments (Kraatz & Block, 2017)
become critical. Studying organisations at intersections of differing fields
necessitates a conscious explication of how values relate to both individ-
ual organisations and their embeddedness in particular fields. In partic-
ular, values are key to exploring how organisations come to hold spe-
cific values, either aligning with plural external and internal demands or
developing distinct values, giving character to the organisation. While
institutional leadership traditionally is closely related to maintenance
processes, closer attention must be paid to the ongoing adaption and
re-articulation of values as institutional contexts either change or evolve
into institutional pluralism. I suggest special attention should be given to
how change or re-alignment occurs through experiential learning as lead-
ing actors facilitate organisational processes and dialectical interaction
to promote new, shared understandings of values in organisations. The
seemingly ambiguous nature of values might enable intentional efforts of
such articulation or framing. In allowing sharing yet individually inter-
preting values, values work might promote unified diversity, encouraging
28 H. Askeland
ongoing and recurring exploration of meaning and practices and link
continuity with contextually situated adaptive change.
Several of the remaining chapters of this book undertake such efforts,
expanding our understanding of ‘who’ performs values work and ‘how’
processes evolve temporally. This might shed light on the ongoing re-
explication of institutional leadership but also contribute to bridging
the inter-relatedness of the institutional logics and institutional work
perspectives.
References
Aadland, E. (2010). Values in professional practice: Towards a critical reflective
methodology. Journal of Business Ethics, 97 (3), 461–472.
Aadland, E., Askeland, H., Flatebø, E., Haugen, H., Kaasa, A., & Stapnes, L.
M. (2006). Verdibasert ledelse i praksis [Values-based leadership in practice].
Oslo: HSH.
Aadland, E., & Skjørshammer, M. (2012). From God to good? Faith-based
institutions in the secular society. Journal of Management, Spirituality &
Religion, 9(1), 1–19.
Albert, S., & Whetten, D. A. (1985). Organizational identity. Research in
Organizational Behavior, 7, 263–295.
Askeland, H. (2011). What do diaconal hospital managers really do? Man-
agement at Diakonhjemmet Hospital: Context, intention and practice.
Diaconia: Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 2(2), 145–169.
Askeland, H. (2014). Leaders should be the carriers of institutional values: An
account of how leaders contribute to the value-base of diaconal institutions.
Diaconia, 5(2), 149–177.
Askeland, H. (2015). Managerial practice in faith-based welfare organizations.
Nordic Journal of Religion and Society, 28(1), 37–58.
Askeland, H., & Aadland, E. (2017). Hva er verdier, og hva tjener de til?
[What are values and their purpose?]. In E. Aadland & H. Askeland (Eds.),
Verdibevisst ledelse [Values-conscious leadership]. Oslo: Cappelen Damm
Akademisk.
Askeland, H., Espedal, G., & Sirris, S. (2019). Values as vessels of religion?
Role of values in everyday work at faith-based organizations. Diaconia.
Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 10(1), 27–49.
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 29
Avolio, B. J., & Bass, B. M. (1995). Individual consideration viewed at mul-
tiple levels of analysis: A multi-level framework for examining the diffusion
of transformational leadership. The Leadership Quarterly, 6 (2), 199–218.
Barley, S. R., & Kunda, G. (2001). Bringing work back in. Organization
Science, 12(1), 76–95.
Battilana, J. (2004). Foundations for a theory of institutional entrepreneurship:
Solving the paradox of embedded agency. Paper presented at the Academy of
Management Annual Meeting, New Orleans, LA.
Bednarek-Gilland, A. (2016). Researching values with qualitative methods:
Empathy, moral boundaries and the politics of research: New York: Routhledge.
Berger, P. L., & Luckmann, T. (1967). The social construction of reality: A
treatise in the sociology of knowledge (Anchor Books ed.). Garden City, NY:
Doubleday.
Bourne, H., & Jenkins, M. (2013). Organizational values: A dynamic
perspective. Organization Studies, 34(4), 495–514.
Brown, M. E., & Treviño, L. K. (2003). Is value-based leadership ethical lead-
ership? In S. W. Gilliand, D. Steiner, & D. Skarlicki (Eds.), Emerging per-
spectives on values in organizations. Greenwich: Information Age Publishing.
Brytting, T., & Trollestad, C. (2000). Managerial thinking on value-based man-
agement. International Journal of Value-Based Management, 13(1), 55–77.
Burns, J. (1978). Leadership. New York: Harper & Row.
Cameron, K. S., Quinn, R. E., DeGraff, J., & Thakor, A. V. (2006). Competing
values leadership: Creating values in organizations. Cheltenham: Edward
Elgar.
Chanut, V., Chomienne, H., & Desmarais, C. (2015). Value practices and
public management. International Review of Administrative Sciences, 81(2),
219–226.
Chen, K. K., Lune, H., & Queen, E. L. (2013). How values shape and are
shaped by nonprofit and voluntary organizations: The current state of the
field. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 42(5), 856–885.
Deth, J. W. V., & Scarbrough, E. (1995). The concept of values. In J. W. V.
Deth & E. Scarbrough (Eds.), The impact of values (pp. 21–47). Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
de Vries, M., & Kim, P. S. (2011). Value and virtue in public administration.
London: Palgrave Macmillan.
DiMaggio, P. J. (1988). Interest and agency in institutional theory. Institutional
Patterns and Organizations: Culture and Environment, 1, 3–22.
Durkheim, É. (2001). The elementary forms of religious life. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
30 H. Askeland
Friedland, R. (2017). The value of institutional logics. In G. Krücken, C.
Mazza, R. Meyer, & P. Walgenbach (Eds.), New themes in institutional
analysis: Topics and issues from European research (p. 12). Cheltenham:
Edward Elgar.
Friedland, R., & Alford, R. R. (1991). Bringing society back in: Symbols,
practices, and institutional contradictions. In W. W. Powell & P. J. DiMag-
gio (Eds.), The new institutionalism in organizational analysis (p. 478).
Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Gehman, J., Trevino, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Golant, B. D., Sillince, J. A., Harvey, C., & Maclean, M. (2015). Rhetoric
of stability and change: The organizational identity work of institutional
leadership. Human Relations, 68(4), 607–631.
Graeber, D. (2001). Toward an anthropological theory of value: The false coin of
our own dreams. New York: Palgrave.
Greenwood, R., Oliver, C., Sahlin, K., & Suddaby, R. (2008). Introduction.
In R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, R. Suddaby, & K. Sahlin (Eds.), The SAGE
handbook of organizational institutionalism. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Hitlin, S., & Piliavin, J. A. (2004). Values: Reviving a dormant concept.
Annual Review of Sociology, 30, 359–393.
Hollis, M. (2002). The philosophy of social science: An introduction (Rev. and
updated ed.). Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
House, R. J. (1976). A 1976 Theory of charismatic leadership. Paper presented
at the Southern Illinois University Fourth Biennial Leadership Symposium,
Carbondale, IL.
House, R. J., Quigley, N. R., & de Luque, M. S. (2010). Insights from Project
GLOBE: Extending global advertising research through a contemporary
framework. International Journal of Advertising, 29(1), 111–139.
Inglehart, R. (1990). Culture shift in advanced industrial society. Princeton, NJ:
Princeton University Press.
Jeavons, T. M. (1992). When the management is the message: Relating values
to management practice in nonprofit organizations. Nonprofit Management
& Leadership, 2(4), 403–417.
Jørgensen, T. B. (2006). Public values, their nature, stability and change: The
case of Denmark. Public Administration Quarterly, 30(3), 365–398.
Jørgensen, T. B., Vrangbæk, K., & Sørensen, D.-L. (2013). The historical
development of values in Danish administrative reform. Paper presented at
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 31
the 11th Public Management Research Association Conference, La Follette
School Public Affairs, University of Wisconsin.
Kemmis, S. (2011). What is professional practice? Recognising and respecting
diversity in understandings of practice. In C. Kanes (Ed.), Elaborating
professionalism: Studies in practice and theory. Dordrecht, London, and
Boston: Springer Science.
Kluckhohn, C. (1951). Values and value-orientations in the theory of
action: An exploration in definition and classification. In T. Parsons & E.
Shils (Eds.), Toward a general theory of action. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
Knutsen, V. L. (2012). Value as self-sustaining mechanism: Why some
nonprofit organizations are different from and similar to private and public
organizations. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 42(5), 985–1005.
Kraatz, M. S. (2009). Leadership as institutional work: A bridge to the
other side. In T. B. Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca (Eds.), Institutional
work: Actors and agency in institutional studies of organizations (pp. 59–91).
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Kraatz, M. S., & Block, E. S. (2017). Institutional pluralism revisited. In R.
Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B. Lawrence, & R. E. Meyer (Eds.), The SAGE
handbook of organizational institutionalism (pp. 532–557). Los Angeles:
Sage.
Kraatz, M. S., & Flores, R. (2015). Reinfusing values. Institutions and ideals:
Philip Selznick’s legacy for organizational studies, 44, 353À381.
Krücken, G., Meyer, R., & Walgenbach, P. (2017). New themes in institu-
tional analysis: Topics and issues from European research. In G. Krücken,
C. Mazza, R. Meyer, & P. Walgenbach (Eds.), New themes in institutional
analysis: Topics and issues from European research (pp. 1–11). Cheltenham,
UK: Edward Elgar.
Lawrence, T., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work. In S.
R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. Lawrence, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), The SAGE handbook
of organization studies (2nd ed., pp. 215–254). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Lawrence, T. B., Leca, B., & Zilber, T. B. (2013). Institutional work: Current
research, new directions and overlooked issues. Organization Studies, 34(8),
1023–1033.
Lencioni, P. M. (2002). Make your values mean something. Harvard Business
Review, 80(7), 113–117.
Maierhofer, N. I., Rafferty, A. E., & Kabanoff, B. (2003). When and why
are values important in organizations. In S. W. Gilliland, D. D. Steiner,
32 H. Askeland
& D. P. Skarlicki (Eds.), Emerging perspectives on values in organizations
(pp. 3–32). Greenwich, CT: Information Age Publishing.
Meglino, B. M., & Ravlin, E. C. (1998). Individual values in organizations:
Concepts, controversies, and research. Journal of Management, 24(3),
351–389.
Meyer, J. W., & Boli, J. (1987). Ontology and rationalization in the Western
cultural account. In George M. Thomas et al., Institutional Structure:
Constituting State, Society and the Individual, 12–37.
Mintzberg, H. (2009). Managing. San Fransisco, CA: Berrett-Koehler.
Moore, M. H. (1995). Creating public value: Strategic management in
government. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Parsons, T. (1935). The place of ultimate values in sociological theory.
International Journal of Ethics, 45(3), 282–316.
Parsons, T. (1951). The social system (1st ed.). New York: The Free Press of
Glencoe.
Parsons, T. (1960). Structure and process in modern society. Glencoe, IL: Free
Press.
Petersen, V. C., & Lassen, M. S. (1997). Værdibaseret ledelse-et alternativ
til styring, regulering og kontrol? [Values-based leadership—Alternative to
governing, regulation and control?]. København: Dansk Industri.
Quinn, R. E., & Rohrbaugh, J. (1983). A spatial model of effectiveness
criteria: Towards a competing values approach to organizational analysis.
Management Science, 29(3), 363–377.
Raffaelli, R., & Glynn, A. (2015). What’s so institutional about leadership?
Leadership mechanisms of value infusion. In M. S. Kraatz (Ed.), Institutions
and ideals: Philip Selznick’s legacy for organizational studies (Vol. 44). Bingley,
UK: Emerald.
Rokeach, M. (1973). The nature of human values. New York: Free Press.
Schmid, H. (2013). Nonprofit human services: Between identity blurring and
adaptation to changing environments. Administration in Social Work, 37 (3),
242–256.
Schwartz, S. H. (1994). Are there universal aspects in the structure and
contents of human values? Journal of Social Issues, 50(4), 19–45.
Schwartz, S. H. (2006). A theory of cultural value orientations: Explication
and applications. Comparative Sociology, 5(2/3), 137–182.
Scott, W. R. (2004). Institutional theory. Encyclopedia of Social Theory, 11,
408–414.
Scott, W. R. (2005). Institutional theory: Contributing to a theoretical research
program. Great Minds in Management: The Process of Theory Development,
37, 460–485.
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing … 33
Selznick, P. (1949). TVA and the grass roots: A study in the sociology of formal
organization. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Selznick, P. (1957/1984). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpre-
tation. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Simon, H. A. (1957). Administrative behavior: A study of decision-making
processes in administrative organization (2nd ed.). New York: Simon &
Schuster and Free Press.
Spates, J. L. (1983). The sociology of values. Annual Review of Sociology, 9(1),
27–49.
Stackman, R. W., Pinder, C. C., & Connor, P. E. (2000). Values lost:
Redirecting research on values in the workplace. Handbook of organizational
culture and climate (pp. 37–54). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Tholen, B. (2011). Public virtue approaches. In Value and virtue in public
administration (pp. 33–46). London: Palgrave Macmillan and Springer.
Thornton, P. H., & Ocasio, W. (2008). Institutional logics. In R. Greenwood,
C. Oliver, R. Suddaby, & K. Sahlin (Eds.), The SAGE handbook of
organizational institutionalism (Vol. 840, pp. 99–128). London: Sage.
Vaccaro, A., & Palazzo, G. (2014). Values against violence: Institutional
change in societies dominated by organized crime. Academy of Management
Journal, 58(4), 1075–1101.
Washington, M., Boal, K. B., & Davis, J. N. (2008). Institutional leadership:
Past, present, and future. In R. Greenwood, R. Suddaby, C. Oliver, & K.
Sahlin (Eds.), Handbook of organization institutionalism (pp. 721–736).
London: Sage.
Watson, T. J. (2008). Managing identity: Identity work, personal predicaments
and structural circumstances. Organization, 15(1), 121–143.
Weber, M. (1978). Economy and society: An outline of interpretive sociology.
Berkeley, CA.: University of California Press.
34 H. Askeland
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
3
What Is Values Work? A Review of Values
Work in Organisations
Gry Espedal
Research on Values Work: An Introduction
Research on values work can be seen as a new trajectory within the
domain of research on values in organisations. There is a growing body
of knowledge that has identified relationships between shared values
and organisational performance on the one hand and societal values
and organisational behaviour on the other (Agle & Caldwell, 1999).
However, it is argued that we need to go beyond studies of organisa-
tional behaviour and decision-making to understand values as modes
of behaviour, or as values-in-use, in organisational practice (Meglino &
Ravlin, 1998).
Responding to the call, Gehman, Trevino, and Garud (2013) proposed
a practice perspective to values in organisations, which focuses on the pro-
cesses whereby values emerge in work performances. The practice per-
spective is different from a cognitive and a cultural approach to studying
G. Espedal (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: gry.espedal@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_3
35
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_3&domain=pdf
mailto:gry.espedal@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_3
36 G. Espedal
values. The cognitive perspective on values studies offers nuanced vocab-
ularies for describing values in abstract terms—a repertoire of discrete
values and typologies of workplace values (Quinn & Rohrbaugh, 1983;
Rohan, 2000; Schwartz, 1992). A cultural perspective on values focuses
on the manifestation of values in various artefacts, rituals and symbols
through the roles of entrepreneurs and executives and the organising of
values through the use of language (Harrison & Beyer, 1984; Martin,
1992; Schein, 2010). The practice perspective draws attention to the
practices in which the values are performed (Gehman et al., 2013, p. 86).
It is broadly consistent with the ‘practice turn’ (Schatzki, 2001) in organ-
isations. Values are to be found in practice (Dewey, 1939) and pursued
as ends in themselves. As such, Gehman et al. (2013, p. 84) define val-
ues practices in organisations as ‘sayings and doings in organizations that
articulate and accomplish what is normatively right and wrong, good or
bad, for its own sake’.
A Literature Review of Values Work
in Organisations
To identify studies that broaden the emerging concepts of values work
in organisations, I reviewed the available studies on the subject and
their contributions. A computer-based literature search was conducted in
international research databases such as ABI/Inform and Business Source
Complete (BSC). The databases covered a broad range of recent arti-
cles published in the disciplines of economy, organisations and leader-
ship. Keywords such as ‘values work’ and ‘organization’ were searched
for in titles, abstracts and article keywords in papers published during
the last ten years—from 2008 to 2018. I chose a time frame of 10 years
to include articles published before Gehman et al.’s (2013) notions of
values work.
An initial search produced a relatively large number of articles: 30
published articles in ABI/Inform and 83 in BSC. To narrow down the
number, a few inclusion criteria were imposed. Studies were chosen only
if (1) they were empirical works that researched values work as a phe-
nomenon within organisations, (2) they identified structures, processes
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 37
or mechanisms of values work in organisations, and (3) they were pub-
lished in either a Scandinavian language or English. Articles on ‘work
values’ that emphasised the development of individual values on join-
ing an organisation or on entering an occupation (Connor & Becker,
1994) were excluded from the study. Other excluded works were empir-
ical studies that focused on economic and strategic approaches, such as
sustainability strategy and value congruence as well as those based on
psychological research and management, such as work-life balance and
workplace commitment. A manual search was also performed on all the
selected articles to identify additional references.
Of the published articles selected from the literature review (Hart,
2018), six empirical articles were considered relevant to this review, and
all the six were empirical studies that focused primarily on values work as
performed in organisations. Three articles used the term ‘values work’ or
referred to Gehman et al.’s study of values work in organisations (Perk-
mann & Spicer, 2014; Vaccaro & Palazzo, 2015; Wright, Zammuto, &
Liesch, 2017). One article did not mention the term ‘values work’, but it
was cited in one of the review articles and was a distinct study on values
in a crisis situation within an organisation (Gutierrez, Howard-Grenville,
& Scully, 2010). One article was included because it was based on empir-
ical studies of values work in extant literature and discussed values as part
of the dynamic nature of organisations (Bourne & Jenkins, 2013). Table
3.1 presents the titles, research questions, methods and findings of the
six selected studies.
The six empirical studies were analysed for the following: definition
of values and values work, the institutional context of values work, the
institutional processes and outcome of values work. Additionally, they
were compared to two Norwegian studies on values in faith-based insti-
tutions (Aadland & Skjørshammer, 2012; Askeland, 2014). The Norwe-
gian papers did not appear in the online literature search. However, they
constitute unique empirical studies on values in organisations, especially
in the context of faith-based institutions. Through an action research
process, Aadland and Skjørshammer (2012) identified values reflections
as enhancing values practices and change. The process of critical value
reflection was considered a viable strategy to promote ethical reflection,
increase moral sensitivity and raise awareness of values-in-use among staff
38 G. Espedal
Ta
b
le
3
.1
E
m
p
ir
ic
a
l
a
rt
ic
le
s
re
le
va
n
t
to
th
e
li
te
ra
tu
re
re
vi
e
w
A
u
th
o
rs
’
la
st
n
a
m
e
s
a
n
d
a
rt
ic
le
ti
tl
e
R
e
se
a
rc
h
q
u
e
st
io
n
M
e
th
o
d
s
Fi
n
d
in
g
s
a
n
d
co
n
tr
ib
u
ti
o
n
s
G
e
h
m
a
n
,
J.
Tr
e
vi
ñ
o
,
L.
K
.
G
a
ru
d
,
R
.
2
0
1
3
V
a
lu
e
s
w
o
rk
:
A
p
ro
ce
ss
o
f
th
e
e
m
e
rg
e
n
ce
a
n
d
p
e
rf
o
rm
a
n
ce
o
f
o
rg
a
n
iz
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
p
ra
ct
ic
e
s
U
SA
H
o
w
d
o
va
lu
e
s
p
ra
ct
ic
e
s
e
m
e
rg
e
a
n
d
h
o
w
a
re
th
e
y
p
e
rf
o
rm
e
d
?
A
te
n
-y
e
a
r
st
u
d
y
o
f
th
e
d
e
ve
lo
p
m
e
n
t
o
f
a
n
h
o
n
o
u
r
co
d
e
in
a
b
u
si
n
e
ss
sc
h
o
o
l
A
rc
h
iv
a
l
so
u
rc
e
s;
e
th
n
o
g
ra
p
h
ic
o
b
se
rv
a
ti
o
n
;
st
a
k
e
h
o
ld
e
r
in
te
rv
ie
w
s
C
o
m
b
in
in
g
p
ra
ct
ic
e
p
e
rs
p
e
ct
iv
e
a
n
d
a
ct
o
r-
n
e
tw
o
rk
th
e
o
ry
D
e
fi
n
in
g
va
lu
e
s
p
ra
ct
ic
e
s
a
s
sa
yi
n
g
s
a
n
d
d
o
in
g
s
in
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
s
th
a
t
a
rt
ic
u
la
te
a
n
d
a
cc
o
m
p
li
sh
w
h
a
t
is
n
o
rm
a
ti
ve
ly
ri
g
h
t
a
n
d
w
ro
n
g
,
g
o
o
d
o
r
b
a
d
,
fo
r
it
s
o
w
n
sa
k
e
V
a
lu
e
s
w
o
rk
d
e
a
ls
w
it
h
a
se
t
o
f
co
n
ce
rn
s,
ty
in
g
lo
ca
l
co
n
ce
rn
s
to
a
ct
io
n
n
e
tw
o
rk
s,
p
e
rf
o
rm
in
g
va
lu
e
s
p
ra
ct
ic
e
s,
le
a
d
in
g
to
ci
rc
u
la
ti
n
g
va
lu
e
s
d
is
co
u
rs
e
s
V
a
cc
a
ro
,
A
.
P
a
la
zz
o
,
G
.
2
0
1
5
V
a
lu
e
s
a
g
a
in
st
vi
o
le
n
ce
:
In
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
ch
a
n
g
e
in
so
ci
e
ti
e
s
d
o
m
in
a
te
d
b
y
o
rg
a
n
iz
e
d
cr
im
e
It
a
ly
H
o
w
ca
n
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
ch
a
n
g
e
su
cc
e
e
d
in
a
so
ci
a
l
co
n
te
xt
th
a
t
is
d
o
m
in
a
te
d
b
y
o
rg
a
n
is
e
d
cr
im
e
?
E
ig
h
t-
ye
a
r
st
u
d
y
o
f
a
Si
ci
li
a
n
a
n
ti
-m
a
fi
a
in
it
ia
ti
ve
a
n
d
a
g
ra
ss
-r
o
o
ts
m
o
ve
m
e
n
t:
A
d
d
io
p
iz
zo
(2
0
0
4
–2
0
1
2
)
U
ti
li
si
n
g
p
u
b
li
cl
y
a
va
il
a
b
le
so
u
rc
e
s
su
ch
a
s
n
e
w
s
a
rt
ic
le
s;
in
te
rn
a
l
d
o
cu
m
e
n
ts
;
in
te
rv
ie
w
s
w
it
h
in
A
d
d
io
p
iz
zo
’s
n
e
tw
o
rk
a
n
d
w
it
h
o
ff
ic
ia
ls
a
n
d
e
xp
e
rt
s;
d
ir
e
ct
o
b
se
rv
a
ti
o
n
C
o
m
b
in
in
g
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
th
e
o
ry
,
st
a
b
il
it
y
a
n
d
ch
a
n
g
e
li
te
ra
tu
re
G
o
in
g
b
e
yo
n
d
th
e
o
b
se
rv
a
ti
o
n
o
f
va
lu
e
s
p
ra
ct
ic
e
to
sh
o
w
h
o
w
ch
a
n
g
e
a
g
e
n
ts
a
re
u
si
n
g
va
lu
e
s
st
ra
te
g
ic
a
ll
y
to
tr
a
n
sf
o
rm
th
e
h
ig
h
ly
re
si
st
a
n
t
se
tt
in
g
o
f
p
a
yi
n
g
p
iz
zo
Id
e
n
ti
fy
in
g
fi
ve
m
ic
ro
-p
ro
ce
ss
e
s
th
a
t
le
ve
ra
g
e
va
lu
e
s
in
in
te
ra
ct
io
n
w
it
h
st
a
k
e
h
o
ld
e
rs
:
h
o
o
k
in
g
,
a
n
ch
o
ri
n
g
,
a
ct
iv
a
ti
n
g
,
se
cu
ri
n
g
a
n
d
u
n
it
in
g
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 39
A
u
th
o
rs
’
la
st
n
a
m
e
s
a
n
d
a
rt
ic
le
ti
tl
e
R
e
se
a
rc
h
q
u
e
st
io
n
M
e
th
o
d
s
Fi
n
d
in
g
s
a
n
d
co
n
tr
ib
u
ti
o
n
s
B
o
u
rn
e
,
H
.
Je
n
k
in
s,
M
.
2
0
1
3
O
rg
a
n
iz
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s:
A
d
yn
a
m
ic
p
e
rs
p
e
ct
iv
e
U
K
W
h
a
t
d
is
ti
n
ct
fo
rm
s
o
f
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
co
u
ld
th
e
re
b
e
a
n
d
w
h
a
t
a
re
th
e
re
la
ti
o
n
s
b
e
tw
e
e
n
th
e
m
?
E
m
p
ir
ic
a
l
st
u
d
ie
s
in
e
xt
a
n
t
li
te
ra
tu
re
P
ro
p
o
si
ti
o
n
s
se
t
o
u
t
fr
o
m
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l,
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
a
n
d
m
a
n
a
g
e
ri
a
l
so
u
rc
e
s
C
o
n
tr
ib
u
ti
n
g
to
th
e
fi
e
ld
o
f
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
D
e
ve
lo
p
in
g
a
fr
a
m
e
w
o
rk
th
a
t
sh
o
w
s
th
e
in
te
rr
e
la
ti
o
n
sh
ip
s
b
e
tw
e
e
n
fo
rm
s
o
f
va
lu
e
s,
h
ig
h
li
g
h
ti
n
g
th
e
d
yn
a
m
ic
n
a
tu
re
o
f
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
D
e
fi
n
in
g
fo
u
r
d
is
ti
n
ct
fo
rm
s
o
f
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s:
e
sp
o
u
se
d
,
a
tt
ri
b
u
te
s,
sh
a
re
d
,
a
n
d
a
sp
ir
a
ti
o
n
a
l
a
n
d
sh
o
w
in
g
h
o
w
th
e
y
re
ve
a
l
th
e
d
yn
a
m
ic
n
a
tu
re
o
f
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
P
e
rk
m
a
n
,
M
.
Sp
ic
e
r,
A
.
2
0
1
5
H
o
w
e
m
e
rg
in
g
o
rg
a
n
iz
a
ti
o
n
s
ta
k
e
fo
rm
:
T
h
e
ro
le
o
f
im
p
ri
n
ti
n
g
a
n
d
va
lu
e
s
in
o
rg
a
n
iz
a
ti
o
n
a
l
b
ri
co
la
g
e
U
K
H
o
w
e
m
e
rg
in
g
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
s
a
re
se
le
ct
in
g
fo
rm
s
in
a
co
n
te
xt
w
h
e
re
m
u
lt
ip
le
fo
rm
s
a
re
a
va
il
a
b
le
a
n
d
h
o
w
th
e
y
a
re
sh
a
p
in
g
th
e
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
A
si
x-
ye
a
r
in
d
u
ct
iv
e
a
n
d
e
m
p
ir
ic
a
l
st
u
d
y
o
f
th
e
co
n
st
ru
ct
io
n
o
f
a
w
e
b
–
b
a
se
d
co
m
p
a
n
y
o
ff
e
ri
n
g
o
p
e
n
p
u
b
li
sh
in
g
G
a
th
e
ri
n
g
a
n
d
re
a
d
in
g
o
f
h
is
to
ri
ca
l
m
a
te
ri
a
l
a
n
d
e
xc
h
a
n
g
e
s
fr
o
m
tw
o
m
e
d
ia
o
n
li
n
e
m
e
ss
a
g
e
b
o
a
rd
s
Id
e
n
ti
fy
in
g
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
a
s
a
id
s
to
se
le
ct
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
fo
rm
s
in
re
so
n
a
n
ce
w
it
h
th
e
g
e
n
e
ra
l
p
u
rp
o
se
o
f
th
e
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
,
p
ro
vi
d
in
g
a
ya
rd
st
ic
k
a
n
d
a
n
e
n
g
in
e
fo
r
ju
d
g
in
g
th
e
co
m
p
a
ti
b
il
it
y
o
f
a
lt
e
rn
a
ti
ve
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
fo
rm
s
(c
o
n
ti
n
u
e
d
)
40 G. Espedal
Ta
b
le
3
.1
(c
o
n
ti
n
u
e
d
)
A
u
th
o
rs
’
la
st
n
a
m
e
s
a
n
d
a
rt
ic
le
ti
tl
e
R
e
se
a
rc
h
q
u
e
st
io
n
M
e
th
o
d
s
Fi
n
d
in
g
s
a
n
d
co
n
tr
ib
u
ti
o
n
s
C
o
n
tr
ib
u
ti
n
g
to
th
e
fi
e
ld
o
f
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
co
m
p
le
xi
ty
,
p
ro
ce
ss
st
u
d
ie
s,
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
O
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
b
ri
co
la
g
e
is
su
g
g
e
st
e
d
a
s
sh
a
p
in
g
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
fo
rm
s
in
th
e
e
n
vi
ro
n
m
e
n
t
o
f
m
u
lt
ip
le
ch
o
ic
e
s.
Fo
rm
s
a
re
a
li
g
n
e
d
w
it
h
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s,
a
n
d
va
lu
e
s
a
ct
a
s
a
fo
cu
si
n
g
d
e
vi
ce
sh
a
p
in
g
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
st
ru
ct
u
re
W
ri
g
h
t,
A
.
L.
Z
a
m
m
u
to
,
R
.
F.
Li
e
sc
h
,
P.
W
.
2
0
1
7
M
a
in
ta
in
in
g
th
e
va
lu
e
s
o
f
a
p
ro
fe
ss
io
n
:
In
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
w
o
rk
a
n
d
m
o
ra
l
e
m
o
ti
o
n
s
in
th
e
e
m
e
rg
e
n
cy
d
e
p
a
rt
m
e
n
t
A
u
st
ra
li
a
H
o
w
sp
e
ci
a
li
st
a
ct
o
rs
e
n
g
a
g
e
in
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
w
o
rk
a
n
d
m
a
in
ta
in
th
e
ir
p
ro
fe
ss
io
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s
w
h
e
n
th
e
y
in
te
ra
ct
w
it
h
e
a
ch
o
th
e
r
a
n
d
b
a
la
n
ce
d
e
m
a
n
d
s
fr
o
m
th
e
p
u
b
li
c
h
e
a
lt
h
ca
re
sy
st
e
m
A
th
re
e
-y
e
a
r
st
u
d
y
o
f
sp
e
ci
a
li
st
s
in
e
m
e
rg
e
n
cy
m
e
d
ic
in
e
in
a
p
u
b
li
c
h
o
sp
it
a
l
O
b
se
rv
a
ti
o
n
;
in
te
rv
ie
w
s;
a
rc
h
iv
a
l
d
a
ta
C
o
n
tr
ib
u
ti
n
g
to
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
w
o
rk
,
va
lu
e
s
a
n
d
m
o
ra
l
e
m
o
ti
o
n
s
V
a
lu
e
s
id
e
n
ti
fi
e
d
a
s
a
so
u
rc
e
o
f
co
n
fl
ic
t
a
n
d
a
m
o
ti
ve
fo
r
p
ro
fe
ss
io
n
a
l
a
ct
io
n
in
si
d
e
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
s
Tw
o
m
ic
ro
-p
ro
ce
ss
e
s
m
a
in
ta
in
p
ro
fe
ss
io
n
a
l
va
lu
e
s:
(1
)
w
h
e
n
va
lu
e
in
te
rp
re
ta
ti
o
n
s
a
re
m
is
a
li
g
n
e
d
b
e
tw
e
e
n
d
if
fe
re
n
t
sp
e
ci
a
li
st
s,
tr
a
n
si
to
ry
m
o
ra
l
e
m
o
ti
o
n
s
m
o
ti
va
te
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
a
l
m
a
in
te
n
a
n
ce
,
a
n
d
(2
)
w
h
e
n
p
ra
ct
ic
e
is
m
is
a
li
g
n
e
d
w
it
h
va
lu
e
s,
m
o
ra
l
e
m
o
ti
o
n
s
a
re
e
n
d
u
ri
n
g
a
n
d
sh
a
re
d
a
n
d
m
o
b
il
is
e
co
ll
e
ct
iv
e
m
a
in
te
n
a
n
ce
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 41
A
u
th
o
rs
’
la
st
n
a
m
e
s
a
n
d
a
rt
ic
le
ti
tl
e
R
e
se
a
rc
h
q
u
e
st
io
n
M
e
th
o
d
s
Fi
n
d
in
g
s
a
n
d
co
n
tr
ib
u
ti
o
n
s
O
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
p
ra
ct
ic
e
s
a
re
a
d
a
p
te
d
o
r
ch
a
n
g
e
d
G
u
ti
e
rr
e
z,
B
.
H
o
w
a
rd
-G
re
n
vi
ll
e
,
J.
Sc
u
ll
y,
M
.
A
.
2
0
1
0
T
h
e
fa
it
h
fu
l
ri
se
u
p
:
Sp
li
t
id
e
n
ti
fi
ca
ti
o
n
a
n
d
a
n
u
n
li
k
e
ly
ch
a
n
g
e
e
ff
o
rt
U
SA
H
o
w
ca
n
id
e
n
ti
fi
ca
ti
o
n
tr
ig
g
e
r
a
n
d
sh
a
p
e
ch
a
n
g
e
e
ff
o
rt
?
A
th
re
e
-y
e
a
r
st
u
d
y
o
f
th
e
e
m
e
rg
e
n
ce
o
f
u
n
li
k
e
ly
a
ct
iv
is
m
fr
o
m
co
m
m
it
te
d
m
e
m
b
e
rs
o
f
th
e
C
a
th
o
li
c
C
h
u
rc
h
In
te
rv
ie
w
s;
re
a
d
in
g
s
o
f
n
e
w
sp
a
p
e
r
a
rt
ic
le
s;
a
rc
h
iv
a
l
so
u
rc
e
s
C
o
n
tr
ib
u
ti
n
g
to
id
e
n
ti
fi
ca
ti
o
n
th
e
o
ry
a
n
d
o
rg
a
n
is
a
ti
o
n
a
l
ch
a
n
g
e
T
h
e
cr
a
ft
in
g
o
f
‘s
p
li
t
id
e
n
ti
fi
ca
ti
o
n
’
is
id
e
n
ti
fi
e
d
a
s
a
ll
o
w
in
g
m
e
m
b
e
rs
to
id
e
n
ti
fy
w
it
h
th
e
n
o
rm
a
ti
ve
a
sp
e
ct
s
o
f
a
n
in
st
it
u
ti
o
n
.
D
e
sp
it
e
va
lu
e
s
su
ch
a
s
lo
ya
lt
y
b
e
in
g
ch
a
ll
e
n
g
e
d
,
vo
ic
e
s
a
re
e
xp
re
ss
e
d
in
a
cr
is
is
to
b
ri
n
g
a
b
o
u
t
ch
a
n
g
e
‘S
p
li
t
id
e
n
ti
fi
ca
ti
o
n
’
a
tt
e
m
p
ts
to
re
p
a
ir
th
e
sp
li
t
b
y
se
e
k
in
g
ch
a
n
g
e
a
n
d
b
y
re
sp
o
n
d
in
g
to
re
a
li
g
n
w
it
h
va
lu
e
d
n
o
rm
s
42 G. Espedal
and leaders. By shadowing leaders, Askeland (2014) noted that leaders
initiate values processes in faith-based organisations and thus become
agents for the institutionalisation of organisational values. Leaders con-
tribute to identity and values formation through information and rela-
tional work.
Several other studies could have been included in this literature review.
For instance, the study on eight Norwegian organisations that exam-
ined the relative influence of values on core organisational functions
came close to investigating values work as institutional work in organ-
isations (Aadland, 2010). However, the study did not identify values
work and the practice of values, per se. Zilber (2009) adopted a narra-
tive approach to exploring how forms of institutional work can translate
meta-narratives into organisations and the lives of individuals. Identify-
ing process as symbolic institutional maintenance, Zilber (2009) high-
lighted how stories represent values and meaning. The study used a rape
crisis centre in Israel as a case organisation and examined institutional
maintenance as narrative acts but did not specifically identify values
work.
Another work that could have been included is by Kraatz (2009),
which revisits Selznick’s (1957/1983) perspectives. Kraatz portrayed a
leader as both the ‘agent of institutionalism’ and the defender and stew-
ard of the organisation, which is a living social entity. Values work exe-
cuted by a leader can have implications for organisational legitimacy,
governance and change. However, in this chapter, I am investigating how
values work becomes a distributed activity within the whole organisation
rather than who is doing values work and how it becomes the responsi-
bility of leaders.
A recent article discusses how values practices are performed collec-
tively through the practice of grass-roots exchange networks in crisis-
stricken Greece (Daskalaki, Fotaki, & Sotiropoulou, 2018). The study
builds on Gehman et al.’s concept of value practices and explores the
value systems of different networks and how they reconfigure economic
values. However, the study describes economic actions and solidarity at a
macro-level instead of identifying structures of values work within organ-
isations. Hence, it was not included in the review.
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 43
Defining Values Work
How do the six studies identify the concept of values work? Gehman
et al. (2013) were the first to introduce the concept of values work as
ongoing performances situated in everyday practice and manifested it in
emerging and performed value practices. Vaccaro and Palazzo (2015) go
beyond this description of values work and highlight how the performa-
tive power of values could contribute to the construction of the described
reality. Building on Schwartz (1996, p. 2), they defined values as ‘desir-
able, trans-situational goals’ and interpreted them as motivational fac-
tors and guiding principles in people’s lives, which could challenge and
change highly resistant institutions. Hence, the values work studies hold
a performative view of values in organisations (Gehman et al., 2013) stat-
ing that values are found in evolving practices (Dewey, 1939).
Gehman et al.’s (2013) perceptions of values work and practices are
building on practice theory, which suggest that people’s practices direct
their right or wrong behaviour. Their definition of values practices—‘say-
ings and doings in organizations that articulate and accomplish what is
normatively right or wrong, good or bad, for its own sake’—is influenced
by Schatzki’s definition (2012, p. 14) of practice as an ‘open-ended,
spatially-temporally dispersed nexus of doings and sayings’. The stud-
ies leaning on practice theory seems to lack an important dimension of
values as ideals or as ‘desirable modes’. The word ‘desirable’ (which is dif-
ferent from ‘desired’ [Parsons, 1968]) mentioned in classic definitions of
values by for instance Kluckhohn (1951) and Van Deth and Scarbrough
(1998) draws attention to what is wanted or sought as an attractive, use-
ful or necessary course of action, as standards for actions. It also lends
values a normative direction (Scott, 2014), indicating a close relationship
between morality and work of the ‘common good’ (Lawrence, Leca, &
Zilber, 2013). To orient values practices towards standards for behaviour
and the capacity to imagine alternative possibilities for future actions, I
therefore expand Gehman et al.’s definition of values to the sayings and
doings in organisations that articulate and accomplish the desirables in
relevance to right and wrong action and behaviour.
44 G. Espedal
The Institutional Context of Studies on Values
Work
Regarding the institutional context of values work studies, values
work has been either studied in highly institutionalised organisations,
recognised as social systems (Aldrich, 1992) or in groups described
as associations or grass-roots organisations, characterised by ‘partici-
pation in collective political activities open to everyone’ (Togeby,
1993). Associated organisations are established with a clear agenda:
micro-processes of values work help promote a political mission and
encourage the common good. For example, the grass-roots move-
ment of Addiopizzo promoted values in a context where insti-
tutions were highly resistant to change, by working against the
pizzo or protection money, in a mafia setting (Vaccaro & Palazzo,
2015). Another grass-roots organisation encouraged uniting against
child sexual abuse in the Catholic Church (Gutierrez et al., 2010).
A third study investigated an innovation that allowed anyone
to author news on a newly established web-based platform (Perkmann
& Spicer, 2014).
Organisations that function as open social systems frequently develop
strong normative and cognitive belief systems as part of the rules, norms
and ideologies of the wider society. The formal structures of these organ-
isations can reflect rationalised myths (Meyer & Rowan, 1977) and may
contain weakly connected elements that make them loosely coupled sys-
tems (Meyer & Scott, 1992). Researchers of institutionalism in Scan-
dinavia have, through case studies, investigated the dynamic aspect of
ideas circulating within institutions. ‘Translation’ tends to occur where
ideas are co-constructed in ways that change the meaning and content of
the ideas circulating in a field (Sahlin & Wedlin, 2008).
Studies on values in open systems have investigated how integrity
is reinforced through the practice of an honour code (Gehman et al.,
2013). Professionals maintain their values despite changing their organ-
isational practice (Wright et al., 2017), and this awareness of moral val-
ues shapes the organisation’s identity (Aadland & Skjørshammer, 2012).
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 45
Studies have identified not-for-profit organisations as being highly sen-
sitive to institutional influence (Greenwood, Oliver, Sahlin, & Suddaby,
2008). However, more studies should investigate how circulating ideas,
when translated, can be reframed in terms of the ideology of the recipient
organisation.
Values Work in Investigating Institutional
Processes
While the concepts of values work are highly influenced by practice the-
ory, the studies in this review are also informed by a strong-process orien-
tation (Langley, Smallman, Tsoukas, & Ven, 2013; Langley & Tsoukas,
2010). In process studies, attention is focused on how and why things
emerge, develop, grow or terminate over time in organisations (Lang-
ley et al., 2013). Process studies aim to unpack events to help under-
stand complex activities and transactions that take place in organisations
and contribute to their constitution (Langley & Tsoukas, 2010). Pro-
cesses not only point inwards to activities within the organisation but
also reflect the responses and pressures from the outside.
Process studies offer a relevant perspective to investigate values in an
organisation, especially to examine how values emerge and are performed
at different times. The process perspective investigates values as changing
or as maintained along with the mechanisms influencing these processes.
When investigating values work, Gehman et al. (2013) identified a pro-
cess: values emerge out of ‘pockets of concern’, tying local concerns into
an action network. People at different organisational levels were perform-
ing actual values practice, circulating values dialogues to foster develop-
ment and institutionalisation (VanderPal & Ko, 2014). This process was
also reported in a study by Vaccaro and Palazzo (2015) where the actor,
Addiopizzo, organised resistance to the payment of pizzo by putting up
posters all over Palermo, containing a short message: ‘A society that pays
the pizzo is a society without dignity’. Addiopizzo’s process work reinter-
preted institutions that paid pizzo and meaning of dignity in the fight
against institutions highly resistant to change.
46 G. Espedal
Reviews mostly describe strong processes in organisations (Langley &
Tsoukas, 2017); however, a question worth asking is whether reviews
provide an understanding of values work as part of the institutionalis-
ing processes at organisations. The role of values, as included in ongoing
institutionalisation processes, and how values influence actions, agency
and institutions have not been thoroughly described in any of the review
articles.
Values Work Enhancing Normative
Dimensions of Work
The analysis of the review studies shows that even though values work
rests upon a normative pillar that introduces prescriptions and valua-
tion dimensions into social life (Scott, 2014), this seems to be an under-
examined theme. Gehman et al.’s (2013) notion of values practices as
‘right and wrong practice’ suggests that a close relationship with moral-
ity is desired in working for the ‘common good’, though this is not elab-
orated in the text. Phillips and Lawrence (2012) identified 15 different
forms of institutional work, none of which are described as involving
moral or ethical work. Wright et al. (2017) noted that moral emotions
arise from situations of value conflicts in interactions between organi-
sational members, but they only considered emotions as mobilised by
problems and not as part of moral reflection. Aadland and Skjørshammer
(2012) are rather alone in highlighting that work on values can introduce
an ethical sensitivity but do not mention the mechanisms directing this
work.
Outcomes of Studies on Values Work
The outcome of studies on values work can be separated into two. First,
these studies contribute to the identification of the values process itself:
How it emerges, changes and shapes activities. Second, values work
in several studies is connected to the formation of an organisational iden-
tity.
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 47
In the studies by Gehman et al. (2013), Vaccaro and Pallazzo (2015),
and Perkman and Spicer (2014), values facilitate a process of search-
ing for hidden meanings and mechanisms that constitute value practices
(Gehman et al., 2013). Vaccaro and Palazzo (2015) identified how val-
ues can be used strategically to highlight normative tension and drive
change. Change agents in institutional change processes use the perfor-
mative power of values work to change institutions that are highly resis-
tant to change. Perkmann and Spicer (2014) showed how values work
is part of an organisational bricolage. The symbolic material (values) is
vital to structuring particular organisations. Additionally, values practices
are identified to mobilise organisational practices, re-articulate social rela-
tions and promote sustainable living (Daskalaki et al., 2018).
The contributions of values work towards identity formation are espe-
cially evident in the studies conducted in churches or faith-based organi-
sations. Values are invoked politically to restore values in a crisis (Gutier-
rez et al., 2010). For instance, crafting a ‘split identification’ was a values
work mechanism for repairing the identity of the church dealing with
the accusations of child sexual abuse by Catholic priests. Awareness of
organisational values and mutual work and self-reflection influence the
identity formation of a faith-based institution (Aadland & Skjørsham-
mer, 2012). Leaders play a special role in cementing the ideological pro-
file of faith-based institutions (Askeland, 2014).
As a spin-off of the mentioned values work studies, is a growing body
of research investigating the effects of value practices and how they are
encouraged in organisations (Daskalaki et al., 2018). Although these
studies explore different directions, two broad themes can be identified.
Some have started to use the term ‘values practices’, by extending the
performative understanding to different arrangements for social change
and maintenance. For instance, values practices are interpreted as restor-
ing human values in times of crisis, leading to sustainable living condi-
tions (Daskalaki et al., 2018). They are also highlighted in understanding
the tensions between public organisations and the management (Chanut,
Chomienne, & Desmarais, 2015) and in the protection of an organisa-
tional identity (Desai, 2017).
The second theme involves investigating how human and individual
values are relevant to organisational practice. For instance, studies have
48 G. Espedal
examined the influence of counter-ideal values (Van Quaquebeke, Graf,
Kerschreiter, Schuh, & van Dick, 2014), the relationship between organ-
isational humanity values and commitment (Husted, 2018), and how
social entrepreneurship can mitigate value concessions (Mitzinneck &
Besharov, 2018).
Based on the analysis of the review studies, a notable aspect in the
studies is the notion that no study to date has investigated how val-
ues animate the ‘value-spheres’ of institutional logics and the practice of
social order. Drawing on Weber (1946/2012), Friedland explains that
institutional logics are composed of a multiplicity of ‘value spheres’.
Confirming the ‘validity of such values’ is a ‘matter of faith’, which indi-
viduals seek and for which they claim to be instruments. Each value
sphere is teleologically consistent in exercising ‘power over man’ (Fried-
land, 2013a, p. 28). According to Friedland, Weber sees all value ratio-
nalities as religious: on the one hand, one seeks to possess the divine
in the moment, and on the other, one is an instrument of the divine,
acknowledging God’s creation and participating in the perfection (Fried-
land, 2013b, pp. 18–19).
Within each order, there are sets of expectations for both the individ-
ual and the organisation (Friedland & Alford, 1991). When expressed,
these distinct practices manifest the material substance of the logics,
organising them in time and space and giving them meaning. For exam-
ple, the material practice of the value sphere of compassion can be
expressed through rites of care that alleviate people’s suffering, which
gives the logic instrumental and ritual content. Integral to the produc-
tion of institutional logics is a valuation of a judgement on what to
do. Thus, institutional logics have a normative dimension in that they
are organised around actionable goods that are of value to the world
(Friedland, 2017, p. 12).
Over the last decade, the literature on institutional logics has broad-
ened the understanding of the institutional processes of organisations
(Thornton & Ocasio, 2008; Thornton, Ocasio, & Lounsbury, 2012).
Studies have emphasised the coexistence and mingling of logics (Purdy
& Gray, 2009; Reay & Hinings, 2009) and the effect of shifts in the
dominant logics (Lounsbury & Boxenbaum, 2013). Mainly identified at
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 49
the societal level, institutional logics can also be found within organi-
sations where they are used to legitimise the institutions’ language and
practice (Alvesson & Sköldberg, 2009; Zilber, 2017). Recently, there has
been a call to investigate institutional logics from the bottom-up, in order
to add micro-aspects to the study of institutional logics (Zilber, 2017).
However, to understand how institutional logics construct, shape and
modify activities over time, more research is needed on how values work
is a part of the internal practice of logic.
Future Research on Values Work
The six articles on values work and the more recent stream of values
practice studies indicate a renewed interest in values and values work
in organisational research. All the studies in this literature review are
informed by a process perspective. They are focused on matters within
organisations and consider values as distributed activities, embedded in
practice and constantly evolving. In the context of institutional work,
scholars note that values play a role in the interaction between actions
and institutions and in the social order that influences activities. How-
ever, what remains unclear is whether the current studies on values work
are trying to integrate perspectives on how values contribute to con-
structing people’s understanding of reality. A central question is how
institutional complexity triggers values work.
More research is needed on the role of values in institutionalisation
processes. How do values influence actions, agency and institutions? For
instance, scholars should analyse the link between institutional work and
institutional leadership in order to understand how fundamental values
become institutionalised through work. More information is needed on
which rules to follow, which authorities to obey and which strategies
leaders should adopt to reconcile conflicting tendencies in organisations
and to negotiate leadership in for instance multicultural workplaces. It
would also be interesting to explore how managers go beyond core values
and value codes to facilitate processes that tie in purpose, values and the
character of the organisation.
50 G. Espedal
Future research should also investigate values work in organisations
and how it shapes individual behaviour in everyday life, especially in
volunteering activities, in establishing different values in public gover-
nance and in developing reflexivity and values consciousness. Addition-
ally, studies should explore core values and how managers negotiate them
within the context of a thriving and distinct organisational values dis-
course. Finally, researchers should attempt to understand how institu-
tional logics construct, shape and modify activities over time by examin-
ing how values work may be part of the internal practice of logic.
References
Aadland, E. (2010). In search of values-reporting from eight norwegian
organizations. EJBO: Electronic Journal of Business Ethics and Organizational
Studies, 15(2), 22–30.
Aadland, E., & Skjørshammer, M. (2012). From God to good? Faith-based
institutions in the secular society. Journal of Management, Spirituality &
Religion, 9(1), 83–101.
Agle, B. R., & Caldwell, C. B. (1999). Understanding research on values in
business: A level of analysis framework. Business and Society, 38(3), 326–387.
Aldrich, H. E. (1992). Incommensurable paradigms? Vital signs from three
perspectives. In M. Reed & M. Huges (Eds.), Rethinking organization: New
directions in organization theory and analysis (pp. 17–45). Thousand Oaks,
CA: Sage.
Alvesson, M., & Sköldberg, K. (2009). Reflexive methodology: New vistas for
qualitative research. London, UK: Sage.
Askeland, H. (2014). Leaders should be the carriers of institutional values: An
account of how leaders contribute to the value-base of diaconal institutions.
Diaconia: Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 5(2), 147–175.
Bourne, H., & Jenkins, M. (2013). Organizational values: A dynamic
perspective. Organization Studies, 34(4), 495–514.
Chanut, V., Chomienne, H., & Desmarais, C. (2015). Value practices and
public management. International Review of Administrative Science, 81(2),
219–226.
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 51
Connor, P. E., & Becker, B. W. (1994). Personal values and management:
What do we know and why don’t we know more? Journal of Management
Inquiry, 3(1), 67–73.
Daskalaki, M., Fotaki, M., & Sotiropoulou, I. (2018). Performing values prac-
tices and grassroots organizing: The case of solidarity economy initiatives
in Greece. Organization Studies, 40, 1–25.
Desai, P. B. (2017). Values practices and identity sustenance in dual-identity
organizations. Journal of Human Values, 23(1), 1–12.
Dewey, J. (1939). Theory of valuation (Vol. II). Chicago, IL: University of
Chicago Press.
Friedland, R. (2013a). God, love, and other good reasons for practice: Think-
ing through institutional logics. In M. Lounsbury & E. Boxenbaum (Eds.),
Institutional logics in action, part A (pp. 25–50). Bingley, UK: Emerald.
Friedland, R. (2013b). The gods of institutional life: Weber’s value spheres
and the practice of polytheism. Critical Research on Religion, 1(1), 15–24.
Friedland, R. (2017). The value of institutional logics. In G. Krücken, C.
Mazza, R. E. Meyer, & Walgenbauch (Eds.), New themes of institutional
analysis: Topic and issues from European research (pp. 12–50). Cheltenham,
UK: Edward Elgar.
Friedland, R., & Alford, R. R. (1991). Bringing society back in: Symbols,
practices and institutional contradictions. In W. W. Powell & P. J. DiMaggio
(Eds.), The new institutionalism in organizational analysis (pp. 232–267).
Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.
Gehman, J., Trevino, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Greenwood, R., Oliver, C., Sahlin, K., & Suddaby, R. (2008). Introduction. In
R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, K. Sahlin, & R. Suddaby (Eds.), The SAGE hand-
book of organizational institutionalism (pp. 1–47). Los Angeles, CA: Sage.
Gutierrez, B., Howard-Grenville, J., & Scully, M. A. (2010). The faithful
rise up: Split identification and an unlikely change effort. Academy of
Management Journal, 53(4), 673–699.
Harrison, M. T., & Beyer, J. M. (1984). Studying organizational cultures
through rites and ceremonials. Academy of Management Review, 9(4),
653–669.
Hart, C. (2018). Doing a literature review: Releasing the research imagination
(2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
52 G. Espedal
Husted, E. (2018). ‘Some have ideologies, we have values’: The relationship
between organizational values and commitment in a political party. Culture
and Organization, 1–21. https://doi.org/10.1080/14759551.2018.1518325.
Kluckhohn, C. (1951). Values and value-orientations in the theory of action:
An exploration in definition and classification. In T. Parsons & E. A. Shils
(Eds.), Toward a general theory of action: Theoretical foundations for the social
sciences (pp. 388–433). Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Kraatz, M. S. (2009). Leadership as institutional work: A bridge to the other
side. In T. B. Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca (Eds.), Institutional work:
Actors and agency in institutional studies of organizations. Cambridge, MA:
Cambridge University Press.
Langley, A., Smallman, C., Tsoukas, H., & Ven, A. V. D. (2013). Process
studies of change in organization and management: Unveiling temporality,
activity and flow. Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 1–13.
Langley, A., & Tsoukas, H. (2010). Introducing perspectives on process
organization studies. Process, Sensemaking and Organizing, 1(9), 1–27.
Langley, A., & Tsoukas, H. (2017). Introduction: Process thinking, pro-
cess theorizing and process researching. In SAGE handbook of process
organizational studies (pp. 1–25). Thousand Oaks, CA and London: Sage.
Lawrence, T. B., Leca, B., & Zilber, T. B. (2013). Institutional work: Current
research, new directions and overlooked issues. Organization Studies, 34(8),
1023–1033.
Lounsbury, M., & Boxenbaum, E. (2013). Institutional logics in action. In
M. Lounsbury & E. Boxenbaum (Eds.), Institutional logics in action, part A
(pp. 3–22). Bingley, UK: Emerald.
Martin, J. (1992). Cultures in organizations: Three perspectives. Oxford, UK:
Oxford University Press.
Meglino, B. M., & Ravlin, E. C. (1998). Individual values in organizations:
Concepts, controversies, and research. Journal of Management, 24(3),
351–389.
Meyer, J. W., & Rowan, B. (1977). Institutionalized organizations: Formal
structure as myth and ceremony. American Journal of Sociology, 83(2),
340–363.
Meyer, J. W., & Scott, W. R. (1992). Organizational environments: Ritual and
rationality. Beverly Hills, CA: Sage.
Mitzinneck, B. C., & Besharov, M. L. (2018). Managing value tensions in
collective social entrepreneurship: The role of temporal, structural, and
collaborative compromise. Journal of Business Ethics, 1–20. doi:https://doi.
org/10.1007/s10551-018-4048-2.
https://doi.org/10.1080/14759551.2018.1518325
https://doi.org/10.1007/s10551-018-4048-2
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 53
Parsons, T. (1968). On the concept of value-commitments. Sociological Inquiry,
38(2), 135–160.
Perkmann, M., & Spicer, A. (2014). How emerging organizations take form:
The role of imprinting and values in organizational bricolage. Organization
Science, 25(6), 1785–1806.
Phillips, N., & Lawrence, T. B. (2012). The turn to work in organization and
management theory: Some implications for strategic organization. Strategic
Organization, 10(3), 223–230.
Purdy, J. M., & Gray, B. (2009). Conflicting logics, mechanisms of diffusion,
and multilevel dynamics in emerging institutional fields. Academy of
Management Journal, 52(2), 355–380.
Quinn, R. E., & Rohrbaugh, J. (1983). A spatial model of effectiveness
criteria: Towards a competing values approach to organizational analysis.
Management Science, 29(3), 363–377.
Reay, T., & Hinings, C. R. (2009). Managing the rivalry of competing
institutional logics. Organization Studies, 30(6), 629–652.
Rohan, M. J. (2000). A rose by any name? The values construct. Personality
and Social Psychology Review, 4(3), 255–277.
Sahlin, K., & Wedlin, L. (2008). Circulating ideas: Imitation, translation and
editing. In R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, K. Sahlin, & R. Suddaby (Eds.),
The SAGE handbook of organizational institutionalism (pp. 218–242). Los
Angeles, CA: Sage.
Schatzki, T. R. (2001). Introduction: Practice theory. In T. R. Schatzki, K. K.
Cetina, & E. Von Savigny (Eds.), The practice turn in contemporary theory
(pp. 1–15). New York, NY: Routledge.
Schatzki, T. R. (2012). A primer on practices. In Practice-based education
(pp. 13–26). New York, NY: Springer.
Schein, E. H. (2010). Organizational culture and leadership (Vol. 2). Hoboken,
NJ: Wiley.
Schwartz, S. H. (1992). Universals in the content and structure of values:
Theoretical advances and empirical tests in 20 countries. In M. Zanna
(Ed.), Advances in experimental social psychology (Vol. 25, pp. 1–65).
Orlando, FL: Academic.
Schwartz, S. H. (1996). Value priorities and behavior: Applying a theory of
integrated value system. In C. Seligman, J. M. Olson, & M. P. Zanna (Eds.),
The psychology of values: The Ontario symposium (Vol. 8, pp. 119–144).
Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Scott, W. R. (2014). Institutions and organizations: Ideas, interests, and identities.
Los Angeles, CA: Sage.
54 G. Espedal
Selznick, P. (1957/1983). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpre-
tation. Berkeley, CA: University of California Press.
Thornton, P. H., & Ocasio, W. (2008). Institutional logics. In C. Greenwood,
C. Oliver, K. Sahlin, & R. Suddaby (Eds.), The SAGE handbook of
organizational institutionalism (pp. 99–129). Greenwood: Sage.
Thornton, P. H., Ocasio, W., & Lounsbury, M. (2012). The institutional logics
perspective: A new approach to culture, structure and process. Oxford, UK:
Oxford University Press.
Togeby, L. (1993). Grass roots participation in the Nordic countries. European
Journal of Political Research, 24(2), 159–175.
Vaccaro, A., & Palazzo, G. (2015). Values against violence: Institutional
change in societies dominated by organized crime. Academy of Management
Journal, 58(4), 1075–1101.
Van Deth, J. W., & Scarbrough, E. (1998). The impact of values: Beliefs in
government. Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.
Van Quaquebeke, N., Graf, M. M., Kerschreiter, R., Schuh, S. C., & van
Dick, R. (2014). Ideal values and counter-ideal values as two distinct forces:
Exploring a gap in organizational value research. International Journal of
Management Reviews, 16 (2), 211–225.
VanderPal, G., & Ko, V. (2014). An overview of global leadership: Ethics,
values, cultural diversity and conflicts. Journal of Leadership, Accountability
and Ethics, 11(3), 166–175.
Weber, M. (1946/2012). Religious rejections of the world and their directions.
In G. H. & C. W. Mills (Eds.), From Max Weber: Essays in sociology (Vol.
2, pp. 323–362). Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.
Wright, A. L., Zammuto, R. F., & Liesch, P. W. (2017). Maintaining the
values of a profession: Institutional work and moral emotions in the
emergency department. Academy of Management Journal, 60(1), 200–237.
Zilber, T. B. (2009). Institutional maintenance as narrative acts. In T. B.
Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca (Eds.), Institutional work: Actors and
agency in institutional studies of organizations (pp. 205–236). Cambridge,
MA: Cambridge University Press.
Zilber, T. B. (2017). How institutional logics matter: A bottom-up exploration.
In J. Gehman, M. Lounsbury, & R. Greenwood (Eds.), How institutions
matter! (pp. 137–155). Bingley, UK: Emerald.
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations 55
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
4
Institutional Complexity Challenging
Values and Identities in Scandinavian
Welfare Organisations
Stephen Sirris
Introduction
Performative and processual practices are embedded. This insight is fun-
damental in this book. In turn, embeddedness implies a renewed atten-
tion to the notion of context, which is often taken for granted and sel-
dom specified. The present volume explores how organisational actors
perform values work in institutional contexts that are characterised as
complex and plural. This chapter contributes to this aim by investigating
how such institutional complexity relates to values work in organisations.
Organisations often experience complexity that challenges their basic
values and identities. This is particularly the case with welfare organ-
isations as the conditions framing them are changing, and traditional
boundaries between public, private and civic organisations have blurred
(Barr, 2012; Billis, 2010). Such development can be positive when it
enables the emergence of new styles of organising as well as innovative
S. Sirris (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: stephen.sirris@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_4
57
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_4&domain=pdf
mailto:stephen.sirris@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_4
58 S. Sirris
managerial and professional practices (Greenwood, Raynard, Kodeih,
Micelotta, & Lounsbury, 2011). However, it becomes challenging for
welfare organisations when they are compelled to simultaneously adhere
to different prescriptions. Potentially contradictory sets of ‘rules of the
game’ stemming from various sectors are conceptualised as institutional
logics that affect welfare organisations (Thornton, Ocasio, & Lounsbury,
2012). Different logics generate complexity that challenges established
patterns of values and identities (Reay & Hinings, 2009). Such com-
plexity in turn may trigger values work. This chapter exemplifies this
phenomenon by studying the interface of a welfare logic and a market
logic in the context of Scandinavian welfare organisations.
Institutional logics are defined as ‘the socially constructed, histori-
cal patterns of material practices, assumptions, values, beliefs, and rules
by which individuals produce and reproduce their material subsistence,
organize time and space, and provide meaning to their social reality’
(Thornton & Ocasio, 1999, p. 804). Scholarly works on the topic
have focused on organisations relating to multiple logics. This approach
attends to shifts in institutional logics and how organisations react to
institutional complexity, ‘the incompatible prescriptions from multiple
institutional logics’ (Greenwood et al., 2011, p. 317). This chapter cap-
tures the complexity associated with the notion of coexisting logics, offer-
ing insights into contradictions in commitments and practices in Scan-
dinavian welfare organisations.
The present chapter serves two purposes. First, it maps the institu-
tional terrain of the majority of the case organisations discussed in this
volume. To do so, I provide an overview of the institutional logics per-
spective and apply it to the context of the Scandinavian welfare mix.
Most of the case organisations are public or civic; otherwise, they are
organisational hybrids situated at sectorial intersections. Hybrids inte-
grate ‘fundamental and distinctly different governance and operational
principles in each sector’ (Billis, 2010, p. 3). Such organisations expe-
rience hybridisation of central organisational arrangements in terms of
both structure and culture, and not least in terms of values. The second
purpose of this chapter is to investigate from a theoretical perspective the
relation between institutional complexity and values work. The organi-
sations in this volume are relevant cases because they identify as values
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 59
salient in ideological, political, religious and humanitarian aspects. Thus,
this particular organisational landscape constitutes a fertile ground for
exploring intra-organisational values work.
The research question guiding this chapter is How does institutional
complexity affect work on values and identities in Scandinavian welfare
organisations? The following section offers some insights into the insti-
tutional theory perspective. I study institutional complexity as coexist-
ing logics, and I particularly address reconfigurations of sectors that in
turn provide actors with the institutional building blocks for their values
work. I then outline aspects of the Scandinavian institutional context
and welfare mix by highlighting the overarching changes and trends that
frame the organisations and precondition values work. My main argu-
ment is that institutional complexity is itself a mechanism that necessi-
tates and triggers values work.
Institutional Complexity
Complexity has always been considered a key element of institutional-
ism. Various sub-streams within institutional theory address connections
between organisations and the contexts in which they operate. This inter-
est is evident in the classical old institutionalism represented in Selznick’s
(1957) work that studied organisations in relation to their environment.
For Selznick, institutionalising was a process of value infusion by which
the organisation developed a character or an identity that distinguished
an institution from a mere technical or instrumental organisation. In the
1970s, classical new institutionalism emphasised complexity in terms of
cultural heterogeneity affecting organisations and considered the ratio-
nal actor a myth. This trajectory prompted interest in the role of the
environments and the field that organisations occupied rather than the
organisations per se. Meyer and Rowan (1977) emphasised culture and
cognition and described isomorphism—organisational similarity, despite
complexity, as an expression of conformism and legitimacy-seeking
processes. The notion of isomorphism was extended by DiMaggio and
Powell (1983) who provided theoretical explanations about the field level
of organisations by proposing coercive, normative and mimetic sources.
60 S. Sirris
Since the 1990s, scholars have sought to integrate classical old and new
institutionalism. This trajectory is called ‘change and complexity’ insti-
tutionalism (Johansen & Waldorff, 2017). It seeks to understand how
pluralism is handled within organisations. In their seminal work, Fried-
land and Alford (1991) explained society as a complex inter-institutional
system. They enriched institutionalism by suggesting a meta-theory that
pointed to the multiplicity of institutional orders in society: family, reli-
gion, capitalism, bureaucracy and democracy. Each of these orders is
guided by a specific logic that manifests in actors’ language and identity
and may denote contradictory practices and beliefs (Friedland & Alford,
1991). In most studies, the concepts of order and logic are used inter-
changeably. Logics at a meta-level with values, norms and symbols are
more abstract social structures than institutions as patterns of behaviour
(Johansen & Waldorff, 2017, p. 54).
A wealth of literature depicts logics as contradictory. However, inside
organisations, logics may peacefully complement each other or compete.
Researchers have used concepts like coexistence, hybridisation, compat-
ibility, heterogeneity, ambidexterity and centrality (Jarzabkowski, Smets,
Bednarek, Burke, & Spee, 2013) to address the coexistence of institu-
tional logics within an organisation and examine organisational responses
to various demands. Experts have noted that friction between coex-
isting logics inhibits the potential for agency and change (Micelotta,
Lounsbury, & Greenwood, 2017). This insight is crucial, since it links
institutional complexity conceptualised as coexisting logics to values
work.
In this chapter, institutional theory provides the tools to analyse how
values and identities are embedded in wider systems that both enable and
constrain them (Thornton & Ocasio, 2008, p. 103). However, individu-
als not only respond to logics as recipients, they also participate in enact-
ing and shaping logics as actors. Actors are the carriers of logics; they
represent and voice logics (Greenwood et al., 2011). The logics perspec-
tive is related to values and identities primarily through identification by
institutions with collective identities such as organisations or professions
(Thornton & Ocasio, 2008, p. 111). When such identities are institu-
tionalised, distinctive logics are developed. Values are inherently con-
nected to identity—the enduring, unique and central characteristics of
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 61
organisations (Albert & Whetten, 1985). Values express identity, and the
two have the following properties in common. First, they are not easily
replaced. Second, they are related to the organisation’s distinctive history
(Selznick, 1957). Third, values are the hallmark of centrality and indicate
what is important; hence, they are orienting devices. This sets the scene
for the institutional complexity that characterises welfare organisations.
To conclude, logics are a framework for analysis of interrelationships
between institutions, individuals and organisations (Thornton et al.,
2012). Overall, they provide schemata of interpretations and are inher-
ently connected to practice, providing guidelines for action and enabling
actors to create meaning. In turn, the institutional logics perspective is
a useful tool to analyse institutional complexity and actors’ values work
within organisational contexts.
The Context of the Scandinavian Welfare
State
This section describes an evolving and changing welfare logic within the
Scandinavian welfare state. Salamon, Sokolowski, and Haddock (2017)
show that large welfare states and vibrant civil societies and voluntary
sectors are not mutually exclusive. Rather, they are in symbiosis. A rel-
atively stable combination of strong welfare states, market economies
and civic engagement is common to Denmark, Norway and Sweden.
The universal welfare model is the dominant institutional environment
and an important backdrop for organisations in Scandinavia (Henriksen,
Strømsnes, & Svedberg, 2018). Greve (2007) argues that universalism
is the hallmark of a welfare state, which guarantees a certain minimum
standard for the welfare for all its citizens. The welfare state pursues goals
of full employment, strong commitment to equality, high level of taxa-
tion and public spending on services (Barr, 2012).
Denmark, Norway and Sweden cover a distinct geographic region.
These countries also share a historical and institutional heritage. For
centuries, common kingdoms have connected them. After the refor-
mation, the church and state power came together in the form of the
62 S. Sirris
Lutheran state church. Together, they provided the basis for a unified
public responsibility long before the modern welfare state. The nine-
teenth century marked the beginning of popular mass movements such
as peasant, labour, mission and teetotalism. These movements gave rise
to large numbers of local organisations, ranging from sports and leisure
clubs, religious associations and welfare institutions catering to educa-
tion, health and social services. In their review of such organisations,
Henriksen et al. (2018) claim that the welfare state has been a success
of solidarity. The Scandinavian countries are non-authoritarian democ-
racies with powers extensively decentralised to the local level. They are
characterised by strong egalitarianism, gender equality and cooperation
between the sectors. This explains why Scandinavia ranks high on values
like trust, participation and equality and low on poverty and deprivation.
The rates of volunteering in Scandinavia are the highest across Europe,
yet the public is heavily involved. Today Scandinavia is technologically
and economically advanced with a mobile and well-educated population.
Denmark, Norway and Sweden have a culture of homogeneity, yet see
changing demographics because of increasing immigration.
On examining the notion of welfare state, the Danish sociolo-
gist Esping-Andersen (1990) observed three predominant and differ-
ent welfare regimes, based on enduring constellations of institutions
and alliances of classes. First, social democracies are home to a sys-
tem that encompasses all inhabitants in terms of fundamental needs
related to education, health and social services. These are largely shel-
tered from the market. This is contrary to the second, more liberal,
regime where the market attends to these needs through insurances
and services paid directly by users. The third, conservative, regime is
characterised by the state and workers’ insurances covering the basic
needs. In some areas, these services are partly differentiated by payments.
Esping-Andersen (1990) finds Scandinavian countries to be the clos-
est examples of a social democratic regime. Historically, the countries
developed in alliance with the working class and farmers and eventually
based in the wider middle class, supporting the welfare state. Further,
Esping-Andersen (1990) describes decommodification processes, which
refers to individuals becoming less dependent on the family and market
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 63
because the state is ubiquitous in most aspects of society. In Scandinavia,
individualism is somewhat paradoxically combined with a state-friendly
sentiment.
Introducing a Market Logic
Although Scandinavian countries are characterised by a welfare logic,
this logic has also been contested in Scandinavia. Towards the 1980s,
the welfare state crisis was heavily debated. The crisis was related to
financing, new technology, globalisation, the changed context of policy-
making introduced by the EU and the new demand for welfare because
of changes in demography and the labour market (Lægreid & Chris-
tensen, 2011). The challenges of the welfare state were met by several
reforms, which aimed at making the public sector more effective and
efficient by introducing a market logic as the solution to severe prob-
lems.
The basic idea of the reforms based on a distinct market logic, term
New Public Management (NPM), was to transfer business-inspired ideas
into the public sector (Røvik, 2007). These reforms were developed
for several reasons and particularly to have more efficient organisations,
accountability and economic measures. NPM originated in the 1970s in
an Anglo-American context. At the core of the ideology is an emphasis
on management, the separation of firms into independent result units,
increased competition and contracting. NPM is based on two pillars
(Lægreid & Christensen, 2011). The first pillar is economic efficiency
and a criticism of the bureaucratic welfare state. This stemmed from the
idea that choices of citizens should be enhanced as customers. Manage-
rialism is the other pillar, sharpening the divide between politicians and
administration. Management through objectives became common, and
organisational units and managers were to report on goal achievement.
The Scandinavian countries sought to maintain their welfare state and
simultaneously make it more efficient. This called for a new coexistence
of the traditional welfare logic and the market logic of NPM. The liber-
alistic turn was not as strong as that experienced in other Western coun-
tries because of Scandinavia’s unique historical and institutional context,
64 S. Sirris
described above. For example, long-standing cooperation and partner-
ship between the public and civic sectors are dominant features in Den-
mark, Norway and Sweden. Further, the Scandinavian work-life model
refers to the tripartite relations of state, work unions and employers.
Given these traditions, the state of Norway has been called a ‘reluctant
and hesitant reformer’ with regard to NPM (Lægreid & Christensen,
2011). This statement succinctly encapsulates the complexity experi-
enced by the Scandinavian states. On the one hand, the NPM reforms
were lauded for the efficiency they introduced to combat bureaucracy
and in favour of marketisation, network solutions and measuring results.
On the other hand, NPM was criticised for its liberalistic ideas and
market logic, which presupposed that individuals maximise their own
benefits, diverging from the traditional public ethos. Sceptics did not
deem the market logic appropriate for the public sector, since political-
democratic systems have a normative base.
Importantly, when the welfare logic was confronted with a market
logic, public organisations found that their basic values were at stake.
Even identities were re-articulated since public agencies were now con-
ceptualised as organisations (Røvik, 2007). Consequently, the develop-
ment outlined above had an impact on the central values in the public
ethos—the core values of responsibility, transparency, justice and equal-
ity. It also affected the ethical dimension represented in the values of
the professional culture in public service production (Busch & Wennes,
2012). The logic shift in Scandinavian welfare organisations is rooted
in these tensions and dilemmas that indicate a changed and hybridised
welfare logic.
Changes Affecting Public Values
The public sector in Scandinavia is called a moral community because it
is committed to fundamental values like democracy, community and jus-
tice (Christensen, Lægreid, Roness, & Røvik, 2014). Public organisations
are responsible to citizens and the elective rather than the shareholders.
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 65
Public values are complex as they encompass democracy, loyalty, open-
ness, predictability, professionalism and equality. Such values are chal-
lenged by market values such as effectivity and rationality. While these
values are not a novelty in the public sector, they tend to be emphasised
differently than in for-profit organisations. Efficiency is promoted often
by criticising excessive expenditure and providing more welfare for less
money.
The market logic, as displayed in NPM, downplays the typical char-
acteristics of different sectors, as private models and governance are
transferred to public organisations. Thus, NPM reforms have con-
tributed to reducing differences between public, private and civic sector
organisations (Greve, 2007). The boundaries between the three sectors
have changed through interventions—primarily legislations that regulate
sectors—and in the Scandinavian context limited marketisation. Barr
(2012) describes various types of resource allocation and their relation
to production, regulation and financing. By changing structures in pub-
lic organisations, the market has an impact on institutional conditions.
The regulative interventions through which this logic was introduced
may in turn have influenced normative and cognitive institutions. This
is reflected in isomorphism and institutionalised organisational scripts
(Røvik, 2007). This development is evident in the recurrent debates
about the welfare state among the state, market and civic sector in terms
of providing services (Barr, 2012; Henriksen et al., 2018).
In sum, welfare organisations have experienced increased complexity
that might be conceptualised as clashes of institutional logics, each with
its own sets of values. The government is now focused on results: deci-
sions are decentralised and objectives are defined for financing. A mar-
ket logic has made its impact, yet it may be concluded that traditional
patterns of bureaucratic administration have not been replaced (Lægreid
& Christensen, 2011). Importantly, post-NPM reforms emphasise cross-
sectoral coordination and integration, unlike NPM reforms, which cre-
ated disintegration and fragmentation. Post-NPM reforms pursue seam-
less services to citizens, which is challenged by the freedom of choice
and fragmentation associated with NPM. Evaluations of NPM show
that Scandinavian countries have not adopted the market logic easily.
Rather, elements from this logic have been translated and incorporated
66 S. Sirris
into a new welfare logic on the grounds of modernising the public sector
(Christensen & Lægreid, 2010). This development testifies to how logics
coexist and constitute institutional complexity.
The Welfare Mix
The institutional changes framing welfare have led to a shift from govern-
ment to governance in several European countries (Barr, 2012). Essen-
tially, older bureaucratic manners of welfare provision were insufficient,
and it paved the way for other welfare providers to enter the field, such as
commercial and voluntary agencies. This phenomenon is known as the
welfare mix. According to Bode (2006), versions of the welfare mix man-
ifest in contract culture and marketisation, and Anglo-Saxon countries
are at the forefront of this trend. It essentially denotes the distribution of
public financed welfare, health care, social service and education between
public, private and civic sector providers. Institutional complexity and
heterogeneity mark this phenomenon since it is located at the interplay
between sectors.
Sivesind (2016) claims that the Scandinavian countries are a lab-
oratory for testing the regimes proposed by Esping-Andersen (1990)
rather than exhibiting a unified welfare model. There are clear differences
between the three countries in terms of the welfare mix. Denmark has
traditionally had the highest proportion of civic sector welfare services
(Sivesind, 2016). This situates Denmark between Norway and Sweden
on the one side and the conservative European model on the other side.
Statistics from 2013 show that in Norway, the civic sector accounts for
7.8% of welfare services, in Denmark 13.8% and in Sweden 3.2%. The
private sector has a 13.4% share in Norway, 19.2% share in Sweden and
7.1% share in Denmark. Norway is dominated by public services, yet
commercial versions are common in primary health services. Sweden has
strongly prioritised public services; however, a turn towards privatisation
has occurred in recent decades.
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 67
Coexisting Logics in Welfare Organisations
The complex changes described above in the welfare mix organisations
essentially depict the blurring of boundaries between the public, pri-
vate and civic sectors. Hybrids are organisations that embed conflict-
ing demands in a complex institutional environment (Greenwood et al.,
2011). Hybridity is a concept that denotes crossovers between species.
It refers to the combining components that are not normally found
together. In social studies, it has been applied differently. It is used, for
example, for civic organisations that have entered the market. In such
cases, logics from other sectors are heavily influenced by civic organisa-
tions. Thus, hybridity may be considered a hallmark of the civic sector
(Evers, 2013; Jäger & Schröer, 2014).
The taxonomy of organisations within each sector is detailed. This fact
challenges the notion of a sector as a fixed gathering of organisations with
common structural features. Dominating logics or principles are central
to categorising sectors (Billis, 2010, p. 47). The private sector is marked
by an economic rationality, where organisations adapt to the market in
order to ensure long-term survival. Aiming at profit, private organisations
engage in the production of goods or delivery of services in the mar-
ket to respond to consumption demands. In contrast, the public sector
has a democratically elected leadership and is marked by accountability
towards many, often contradictory, concerns, goals and values. It pro-
tects and promotes the welfare of the citizens and distributes resources.
Lastly, Anheier (2014) claims that multiplicity is the signature of the civic
sector. Characteristics such as private, non-profit, self-governed and vol-
untary are typical of these organisations. Their purpose and mission are
particular focal points as civic organisations contribute to attachment,
reciprocity and community. In summary, the task of the market is to
create values, that of the public is to distribute values and that of the
civic sector is to promote certain values.
68 S. Sirris
The Sectors as Ideal Types
In order to specify hybridisation, some ideal types are presupposed. This
is the starting point, though in reality these are better placed on a con-
tinuum. Table 4.1, based on Jäger and Schröer (2014, p. 1293) and Billis
(2010, p. 55), shows the three sectors as ideal types.
Hybrid Civic Organisations and Values
While the first part of this chapter adopted a public sector perspective, in
this section, I elaborate the position of the civic sector. The civic logic or
identity has been articulated by Jäger and Schröer (2014). After NPM,
civic organisations have begun to increasingly operate in the market, yet
they have served, for long, as welfare providers on contract with pub-
lic authorities. The logic or main principle underlying the civic sector is
the use of identity as a means to a higher end. Identity is collectively
rather than individually framed. Consequently, civic organisations are
intractably normative and public because of their identity as a moral
community. Studies on motivations of volunteers point at a congruence
between individual values and those of the organisation (Henriksen et al.,
2018). This provides an opportunity for individuals to express their val-
ues through actions. Civic collectives are characterised by solidarity and
trust as they are embedded in social networks and take action in solidar-
ity. These practices are particularly value-salient as they aim to serve the
greater good.
Civic organisations are observed to have a pioneer and entrepreneurial
function, and they seek to fill the gaps in private or public service pro-
vision (Henriksen et al., 2018). A fundamental question facing these
organisations is how to balance and integrate marketisation into their
specific identity and civic mission. The market is driven by rational
organisations pursuing their goals and self-interest. Hybrid organisations
between the market and the civic sector may find themselves in the para-
doxical situation of trading solidarity for resources. The development
of civic organisations implies market-oriented transactions, regulated
by contracts as well as legislation. Risk is being commercialised
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 69
Ta
b
le
4
.1
C
h
a
ra
ct
e
ri
st
ic
s
o
f
id
e
a
l
ty
p
e
se
ct
o
rs
C
o
re
e
le
m
e
n
t
P
ri
va
te
se
ct
o
r
p
ri
n
ci
p
le
s
P
u
b
li
c
se
ct
o
r
p
ri
n
ci
p
le
s
C
iv
ic
se
ct
o
r
p
ri
n
ci
p
le
s
O
w
n
e
rs
h
ip
Sh
a
re
h
o
ld
e
rs
C
it
iz
e
n
s
M
e
m
b
e
rs
G
o
ve
rn
a
n
ce
Sh
a
re
o
w
n
e
rs
h
ip
si
ze
P
u
b
li
c
e
le
ct
io
n
s
P
ri
va
te
e
le
ct
io
n
s
O
p
e
ra
ti
o
n
a
l
p
ri
o
ri
ti
e
s
M
a
rk
e
t
fo
rc
e
s
a
n
d
in
d
iv
id
u
a
l
ch
o
ic
e
P
u
b
li
c
se
rv
ic
e
a
n
d
co
ll
e
ct
iv
e
ch
o
ic
e
C
o
m
m
it
m
e
n
t
to
u
n
iq
u
e
m
is
si
o
n
D
is
ti
n
ct
iv
e
h
u
m
a
n
re
so
u
rc
e
s
P
a
id
e
m
p
lo
ye
e
s
in
m
a
n
a
g
e
ri
a
ll
y
co
n
tr
o
ll
e
d
Fi
rm
P
a
id
p
u
b
li
c
se
rv
a
n
ts
in
le
g
a
ll
y
b
a
ck
e
d
B
u
re
a
u
M
e
m
b
e
rs
a
n
d
vo
lu
n
te
e
rs
in
A
ss
o
ci
a
ti
o
n
D
is
ti
n
ct
iv
e
o
th
e
r
re
so
u
rc
e
s
Sa
le
s,
fe
e
s
Ta
xe
s
D
u
e
s,
d
o
n
a
ti
o
n
s
a
n
d
le
g
a
ci
e
s
V
a
lu
e
s
C
re
a
te
a
n
d
p
ro
ce
ss
m
a
te
ri
a
l
va
lu
e
s
D
is
tr
ib
u
te
va
lu
e
s
C
re
a
te
,
m
a
in
ta
in
a
n
d
p
ro
ce
ss
im
m
a
te
ri
a
l
va
lu
e
s
Id
e
n
ti
fi
ca
ti
o
n
Fu
lf
il
so
ci
e
ta
l
n
e
e
d
b
y
a
ct
in
g
in
se
lf
-i
n
te
re
st
C
o
ll
e
ct
iv
e
n
o
ti
o
n
s
a
n
d
co
m
m
o
n
g
o
o
d
Se
lf
-u
n
d
e
rs
ta
n
d
in
g
a
s
a
m
e
a
n
s
to
a
ch
ie
ve
h
ig
h
e
r
co
ll
e
ct
iv
e
g
o
a
l
Id
e
n
ti
ty
U
ti
li
ty
U
ti
li
ty
a
n
d
n
o
rm
a
ti
ve
N
o
rm
a
ti
ve
70 S. Sirris
by the exchange of resources and receipt of funding. Hybrids integrate
dual logics or identities in their central dimensions. The starting point
for the market logic is that individuals freely enter such network as a
means to their own purposes.
Among the cases presented in this volume, some of the organisations
are faith-based or diaconal, which originated to express the social, moral
or religious values of their founders. Some emerged within religious com-
munities and associations in Europe or America that established insti-
tutions to provide social and health services to disadvantaged groups.
These represent non-governmental organisations (NGOs) ‘whose iden-
tity and mission are self-consciously derived from a religious tradition,
and which operate on a voluntary, non-profit and independent basis to
promote articulated ideas about the common good’ (Askeland, 2015,
p. 37). Although modern Scandinavian mentality relegates religion to the
realm of private life, religious non-governmental organisations (RNGOs)
represent a unique hybrid of religious beliefs and sociopolitical activism
at all levels of society.
Lacking the authority of the public sector and motivated by values-
based rather than profit-based objectives, civic sector organisations are
characterised by networks of citizens seeking to change the status quo in
the interest of the public good. From the time of their founding, NGOs
have identified as moral entities, seeking to alter inequitable distributions
of power and resources in favour of the disenfranchised. The ‘becoming
business-like of non-profit organizations’ is confirmed in a review of 599
studies (Maier, Meyer, & Steinbereithner, 2016, p. 64). The institutional
logic perspective is an established perspective to study this phenomenon.
Traditional non-profits are characterised by the co-presence of different
logics because there is mostly a degree of hybridity to be found in all of
them. Civil society is thus conceptualized as an intermediate area between
the market and public sector. Similarly, (…) researchers describe the ten-
sions between different logics within organizations as normal tensions or
dilemma. (Jäger & Schröer, 2014, p. 1237)
For civic organisations, marketisation represents challenges in terms of
values and identities. It denotes a ‘Faustian pact’ in which an organisation
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 71
may lose its identity in exchange for resources, influence and delivering
more services. The cost is ‘those fundamental attributes which made it an
attractive proposition in the first place, its mission, values and voluntary
contribution’ (Billis, 2010, p. 10). Value-salient organisations are bound
to have non-negotiable values. For them, ‘confusion over identity might
be a chronic fact of life’ (Billis, 2010, p. 246) that triggers values work.
Overall Discussion
This chapter discusses how institutional complexity affects values work
and identities of Scandinavian welfare organisations. Public and civic
organisations are by nature complex (Anheier, 2014) and characterised by
coexisting logics. With welfare organisations becoming more heteroge-
nous, generalisations and strict categorisations are difficult. Hybrids are
organisations that mix or integrate elements, action logics and value sys-
tems from differing sectors in important dimensions of organisational
form or practice (Jäger & Schröer, 2014). They may thus be called multi-
identity organisations (Pratt & Ravasi, 2016). Against this backdrop,
a specific challenge facing organisations is value convergence with for-
profit organisations and mission drift.
Central to my argument is how institutional change triggers values
work and hence organisational identity. An organisation pursues its nat-
ural purpose and organises this pursuit. Processes of institutionalisation
imply infusing the organisation with values which, in turn, shape its
character or identity (Selznick, 1957). There is an intractable relation-
ship between values and identity as values mediate organisational self-
understanding (Pratt & Ravasi, 2016)—in the same way as personal
traits express aspects of a person. When a market logic challenges, sup-
plements or rejects traditional public values, the very identity of public
or civic organisations is destabilised. Profound reforms thus have con-
siderable impact on identities (Røvik, 2007). The challenging of public
values, norms and organisational identity by a market logic can result
in loss of identity, problems associated with multiple identities, dissolu-
tions of old identities, exchange of identities or an identity crisis (Busch
& Wennes, 2012).
72 S. Sirris
Incorporating a market logic has allowed commercial, civic and pub-
lic organisations to provide welfare services in novel ways (Bode, 2006).
Both commercial and civic organisations collaborate with the public sec-
tor and are denoted as welfare hybrids (Wollebæk, Selle, & Lorentzen,
2000). This development is particularly related to increased gover-
nance or managerial structures and professionalism. By accepting public
funding and supplementing services, civic organisation must meet the
demands of equality in services and professional competencies. However,
they are also accountable to the demands of the private sector, which
include environmental sustainability and the triple bottom line concept.
Welfare organisations are as such situated in a unique institutional
environment, characterised as pluralistic and complex. Current institu-
tional change, as discussed above, manifests in a questioning of pub-
lic values as well as challenged identities. This phenomenon is evident
in recent decades in the increased attention paid to the identity and
character of organisations, in terms of values and self-presentations.
Core values are a medium for conveying such identity externally and
internally. Legitimacy is also considered a chronic problem of organi-
sations (Billis, 2010), which have to cater to their constituencies and
stakeholders. Organisations are supported by their environments inas-
much as there exists a perceived congruence in values. This argument
may suggest a singular and fixed identity and set of values—which may
be articulated in core value statements—yet organisations are pluralistic,
multi-functional and complex (Pratt & Ravasi, 2016).
An illuminating study by Wæraas (2010) found that public organ-
isations adhere to less bureaucratic and more relational values such as
respect, tolerance and honesty. This reflects a major trend within organ-
isations towards de-bureaucratisation and towards structures that are
changing and flexible. Another development is that organisational set-
ups have become more temporal and ad hoc, based on projects, teams
and matrixes or networks. The focus on values reflects expressive aspects
where reputation management becomes an ongoing challenge and is
taken for granted (Røvik, 2010).
The above-mentioned trends in complexity emphasise that organisa-
tions are expected to articulate their identity through values. It is no
longer possible to assume what an organisation is, what tasks it should
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 73
perform and how. A solution to these challenges is to develop and con-
struct an attractive and unique identity that differentiates the organi-
sation from others. According to Wæraas (2007), such processes may
occur in two ways. First, a unique identity can be developed over time
through the natural perspective described in classical old institutional-
ism (Selznick, 1957). The identity is collectively and internally devel-
oped and emphasises the organisation’s distinct mission and values. This
presents an institutional or normative perspective, in which managers
have limited abilities to change the identity in an instrumental way. The
evolution of such identity occurs in a specific context, wherein the act of
comparison with others is crucial. Over the last decades, welfare organ-
isations compare themselves increasingly with private organisations, by
incorporating a market logic. This situates welfare organisations at the
boundaries of different logics, which in turn increases hybridisation and
the search for identity. The second approach to crafting a unique identity
may be considered more strategic and thus an instrument for the man-
agement (Wæraas, 2007). This identity stems from utility and supports
the governing of organisations by visions, values and missions that are
clearly defined. It is based on a prospective view of how the organisa-
tion should exist at a point in the future and thus highlights the distance
between the actual and desired identity. While this may imply a risk of
losing the soul of the organisation, it can also be an impetus for strategic
development and managerial agency that aims to re-articulate the organ-
isation’s values and identity.
Moreover, a third approach is described by Askeland, Espedal, and
Sirris (2019) who compared work on values and identities in three faith-
based organisations. In these case organisations, religious traditions had
permeated the identity of the organisations that now found themselves
embedded in a secular society. In other words, they experienced institu-
tional complexity. Through strategic efforts, values to some degree medi-
ated aspects of religion yet also served to bridge the Christian tradi-
tion with expectations from the secular society. Thus, a renewed identity
was forged through values work that simultaneously both integrated and
adjusted. The combination of safeguarding and developing buffered the
organisations from entering the above-mentioned ‘Faustian pact’. These
74 S. Sirris
organisations hybridised the welfare and the market logic guided by a
commitment to values and without losing their identity.
Concluding Remarks
This chapter offers insights into how institutional complexity relates to
values work in Scandinavian welfare organisations. First, I have argued
that the institutional logics perspective offers an analytical framework
for institutional complexity. I have illustrated this by introducing readers
to the Scandinavian context and exemplified how the logics framework
is applicable in this particular context. The chapter draws attention to
organisations operating at the cusp of sectors. Such organisations face
institutional complexity though coexisting logics, as explained with the
help of the Scandinavian welfare state and the evolving welfare mix. Sec-
ond, on a theoretical level, I have shown how institutional complexity
relates to values work. Values are part of the institutional logics perspec-
tive and resources that managers may draw from in their work. Various
sets of values emerge from logics as reality is endlessly rich and pluralistic.
Values work represents an embedded agentic response to both institu-
tional policy changes and the challenges of institutional complexity. The
chapters in this book provide examples of how institutional complexity
triggers values work.
References
Albert, S., & Whetten, D. A. (1985). Organizational identity. In L. L.
Cummings & B. M. Staw (Eds.), Research in organizational behavior
(pp. 263–295). Greenwich: JAI Press.
Anheier, H. K. (2014). Nonprofit organizations: Theory, management, policy.
New York: Routledge.
Askeland, H. (2015). Managerial practice in faith-based welfare organizations.
Nordic Journal of Religion and Society, 28(1), 37–58.
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 75
Askeland, H., Espedal, G., & Sirris, S. (2019). Values as vessels of religion?
The role of values in everyday work at faith-based organizations. Diaconia:
Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 10(1), 27–49.
Barr, N. (2012). Economics of the welfare state. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Billis, D. (2010). Hybrid organizations and the third sector: Challenges for prac-
tice, theory and policy. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Bode, I. (2006). Disorganized welfare mixes: Voluntary agencies and new gov-
ernance regimes in Western Europe. Journal of European Social Policy, 16 (4),
346–359.
Busch, T., & Wennes, G. (2012). Holdning til markedsløsninger: organisasjon-
sidentitet og verdiorientering. Beta, 26 (1), 20–39.
Christensen, T., & Lægreid, P. (2010). Increased complexity in public organi-
zations—The challenges of combining NPM and post-NPM. In P. Lægreid
& K. Verhoest (Eds.), Governance of public sector organizations: Proliferation,
autonomy and performance (pp. 255–275). Houndsmill: Palgrave Macmillan.
Christensen, T., Lægreid, P., Roness, P. G., & Røvik, K. A. (2014). Organi-
zation theory and the public sector: Instrument, culture and myth. New York:
Routledge.
DiMaggio, P., & Powell, W. W. (1983). The iron cage revisited: Collective
rationality and institutional isomorphism in organizational fields. American
Sociological Review, 48(2), 147–160.
Esping-Andersen, G. (1990). The three worlds of welfare capitalism. Princeton:
Princeton University Press.
Evers, A. (2013). Hybridisation in German public services—A contested field of
innovations. Paper presented at the Civil Societies Compared, Germany and
The Netherlands.
Friedland, R., & Alford, R. R. (1991). Bringing society back in: Symbols, prac-
tices and institutional contradictions. In W. W. Powell & P. J. DiMaggio
(Eds.), The new institutionalism in organizational analysis (pp. 232–263).
Chicago: Chicago University Press.
Greenwood, R., Raynard, M., Kodeih, F., Micelotta, E. R., & Lounsbury, M.
(2011). Institutional complexity and organizational responses. The Academy
of Management Annals, 5(1), 317–371.
Greve, B. (2007). What characterise the Nordic welfare state model. Journal of
Social Sciences, 3(2), 43–51.
Henriksen, L. S., Strømsnes, K., & Svedberg, L. (2018). Civic engagement in
Scandinavia. Cambridge: Springer.
76 S. Sirris
Jäger, U. P., & Schröer, A. (2014). Integrated organizational identity: A defi-
nition of hybrid organizations and a research agenda. VOLUNTAS: Interna-
tional Journal of Voluntary and Nonprofit Organizations, 25(5), 1281–1306.
Jarzabkowski, P., Smets, M., Bednarek, R., Burke, G., & Spee, P. (2013).
Institutional ambidexterity: Leveraging institutional complexity in practice.
Research in the Sociology of Organizations, 39, 37–61.
Johansen, C. B., & Waldorff, S. B. (2017). What are institutional logics—And
where is the perspective taking us? In G. Krücken, C. Mazza, R. E. Meyer,
& P. Walgenbach (Eds.), New themes in institutional analysis (pp. 51–76).
London: Edward Elgar.
Lægreid, P., & Christensen, T. (2011). The Ashgate research companion to new
public management. Farnham: Ashgate.
Maier, F., Meyer, M., & Steinbereithner, M. (2016). Nonprofit organizations
becoming business-like: A systematic review. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector
Quarterly, 45(1), 64–86.
Meyer, J. W., & Rowan, B. (1977). Institutionalized organizations: Formal
structure as myth and ceremony. American Journal of Sociology, 83(2), 340–
363.
Micelotta, E., Lounsbury, M., & Greenwood, R. (2017). Pathways of institu-
tional change: An integrative review and research agenda. Journal of Man-
agement, 43(6), 1885–1910.
Pratt, M. G., & Ravasi, D. (2016). The Oxford handbook of organizational
identity. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Reay, T., & Hinings, C. R. (2009). Managing the rivalry of competing insti-
tutional logics. Organization Studies, 30(6), 629–652.
Røvik, K. A. (2007). Trender og translasjoner: Ideer som former det 21. århundrets
organisasjon. Oslo: Universitetsforlaget.
Røvik, K. A. (2010). Managementtrender. Praktisk økonomi & finans, 26 (3),
61–72.
Salamon, L. M., Sokolowski, S. W., & Haddock, M. A. (2017). Explaining
civil society development: A social origins approach. Boston: John Hopkins
University Press.
Selznick, P. (1957). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpretation.
Evanston, IL: Row Peterson.
Sivesind, K. H. (Ed.). (2016). Mot en ny skandinavisk velferdsmodell? Kon-
sekvenser av ideell, kommersiell og offentlig tjenesteyting for aktivt medborg-
erskap (Vol. 2016:01). Oslo: Institutt for samfunnsforskning.
Thornton, P. H., & Ocasio, W. (1999). Institutional logics and the historical
contingency of power in organizations: Executive succession in the higher
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values … 77
education publishing industry, 1958–1990. American Journal of Sociology,
105(3), 801–843.
Thornton, P. H., & Ocasio, W. (2008). Institutional logics. In W. W. Powell,
J. A. Colyvas, R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, K. Sahlin, & R. Suddaby (Eds.),
The SAGE handbook of organizational institutionalism (pp. 99–128). Lon-
don: Sage.
Thornton, P. H., Ocasio, W., & Lounsbury, M. (2012). The institutional logics
perspective: A new approach to culture, structure, and process. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Wæraas, A. (2007). Fra forvaltningsinstruks til visjon: NSBs identitetsutvikling
ved tusenårsskiftet. Norsk statsvitenskapelig tidsskrift, 23(2), 149–172.
Wæraas, A. (2010). Communicating identity: The use of core value statements
in regulative institutions. Administration & Society, 42(5), 526–549.
Wollebæk, D., Selle, P., & Lorentzen, H. (2000). Frivillig innsats: Sosial inte-
grasjon, demokrati og økonomi. Bergen: Fagbokforlaget.
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
Part II
Who Performs Values Work?
5
Institutional Leadership—The Historical
Case Study of a Religious Organisation
Jose Bento da Silva
Institutional Leadership as Institutional Work
Notwithstanding institutionalism’s relevance within organisation studies,
the leadership of institutions is a topic that we can classify as largely
overlooked. As an example, the 2008 edition of the SAGE Handbook
of Organizational Institutionalism had a chapter on ‘Institutional Lead-
ership’ (Washington, Boal, & Davis, 2008); however, the 2017 edition
of the same volume has less than one page devoted to the leadership of
institutions (see Kraatz & Block, 2017, p. 552).
Two reasons might contribute to the lack of studies on institutional
leadership. First, institutionalism ‘is creaking under the weight of its
own theoretical apparatus’ (Haveman & David, 2008, p. 588). This
means that something as ‘simple’ as defining what an institution remains
unclear. This limitation of institutionalism affects a plethora of concepts
within the field: ‘As these concepts become more general and cover a
J. B. da Silva (B)
Warwick Business School, University of Warwick, Coventry, UK
e-mail: Jose.Bento-Da-Silva@wbs.ac.uk
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_5
81
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_5&domain=pdf
mailto:Jose.Bento-Da-Silva@wbs.ac.uk
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_5
82 J. B. da Silva
greater territory, their explanatory power weakens’ (Alvesson & Spicer,
2018, p. 8). Second, leadership, although arguably the most studied topic
in organisation studies, also remains a contested field. More specifically,
‘the field of leadership studies has traditionally been leader-centered’
(Crevani, Lindgren, & Packendorff, 2010, p. 77). Such characteristic
of leadership studies hinders its integration into institutionalism with
its emphasis on what is beyond the individual. Not surprisingly, then,
there is ‘a lack of institutional leadership ideas in the leadership litera-
ture’ (Washington et al., 2008, p. 11).
That said, the leadership of institutions haunts some strands of the
literature on institutionalism and neo-institutionalism. Two examples
are ‘institutional entrepreneurship’ and ‘institutional work’. On the one
hand, the type of leadership needed to create or change an institution
remains largely overlooked; on the other hand, even though institutional
work ‘link[s] quite well’ (Kraatz, 2009, p. 59) with institutional leader-
ship, the possible linkages have not been further explored.
Institutional work was initially defined as the ‘purposive action of
individuals and organizations aimed at creating, maintaining and dis-
rupting institutions’ (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006, p. 215). That said,
institutional leadership can be understood as part of ‘institutional work’.
As Kraatz puts it, leadership is part of ‘the work involved in govern-
ing, adapting, and reforming organizational institutions’ (Kraatz, 2009,
p. 60, emphasis in the original). This leaves aside the work done by
entrepreneurs to create an institution. However, it does include the work
done to reform and adapt, id est, change, which is part of the work done
by institutional entrepreneurs. Such overlap does attest to the fact that
some of the concepts within institutionalism end up meaning ‘every-
thing and nothing’ (Alvesson & Spicer, 2018, pp. 7–8). Therefore, in
this chapter I will attempt a clarification of what institutional leader-
ship is, of how it might be distinguished from institutional work more
broadly and of how it can enlighten our own understanding of what
stands for an institution. The latter is particularly important because it
will help us to better delineate what separates the leadership of an insti-
tution from the leadership of an organisation. This has more potential
to enlighten our understanding of institutional leadership if we analyse
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 83
an organisation which is itself an institution or part of a highly insti-
tutionalised field. Such organisation is the Society of Jesus, commonly
known as the ‘Jesuits’, a Catholic Religious Order. This way of defin-
ing the Jesuits already points towards several distinct levels of analysis.
First, the Jesuits are a religious organisation, and, in this sense, they
could be simply classified as an ‘organisation’; second, the Jesuits are a
Catholic Religious Order, which refers to an institutionalised ‘form-of-
life’ (Agamben, 2013) within Catholicism; third, Jesuits are part of the
Catholic Church which is one way of ordering life within the institu-
tional order of religion.
In this chapter, I will analyse the Jesuits vis-a-vis the value of poverty.
The reason for this choice is that poverty is a value that is shared by the
various institutional levels I described above: poverty is the pillar of all
Jesuit values (Jesuit institution); poverty is one of the three vows that any
member of a Catholic Religious Order should do (the institutionalised
‘form-of-life’ (Agamben, 2013) that characterises any Religious Order
member); and finally, poverty as an evangelical value should be pursued
by any Catholic (the institution of the Catholic Church).
Methodologically, I will analyse historical primary sources that span
almost five centuries. I will start by analysing how poverty became the
fundamental value of the Jesuit organisation. This discussion will posi-
tion the Jesuits in the poverty debates that go back to the twelfth century
(see Agamben, 2013); then I will analyse government documents of the
Jesuits relating to poverty, namely their General Congregation decrees
and instructions on the management of their property.
The analysis of how poverty was conceptualised and governed over
almost five centuries will allow us to revisit the relevance of values for
understanding institutional leadership. Selznick famously said that insti-
tutions are ‘organizations infused with value’. (1957, p. 17) and that, as
a consequence, institutional leadership is about ‘the promotion and pro-
tection of values’ (Selznick, 1957, p. 28). However, this definition raises
the question of ‘how leaders can guard against the tendency to lose sight
of institutional values’ (Besharov & Khurana, 2015, p. 60)? This chapter
will contribute to this discussion by showing, through the Jesuit case,
how the institutional leader’s role might be not about the preservation
84 J. B. da Silva
of values, but about the constant search for specific values. This insight
furthers our understanding of ‘procedural logics’ (Quattrone, 2015) and
its critique of our obsession with the substantiation of values.
The Jesuits
The Jesuits are a Catholic Religious Order. Within Catholicism, there are
two main forms of life. First, secular life, ‘Secular’ means ‘living in the
world’, and therefore outside the ‘walls of a monastery’. Second, religious
life. Those who live a religious life, traditionally inside the walls of a
monastery, do it in seclusion and take the three vows of poverty, chastity
and obedience. Religious Orders are organisations whose members adopt
a religious ‘form-of-life’ (Agamben, 2013).
The Jesuits, as a Religious Order, are not secular insofar as they take
the three religious vows of poverty, chastity and obedience. However,
unlike traditional monastic religious orders, the Jesuits were founded so
that their members would live immersed in the world. Therefore, the
Jesuits did not adopt the most emblematic of monastic orders’ traditions,
like the choir, the communal prayers and the monastic habit (O’Malley,
1993).
The fact that the Jesuits were not like other monks, living secluded
within the walls of a monastery, led their founder, Ignatius of Loyola, to
revisit many of the institutionalised ways of ordering religious life. Put
differently: How can you live a chaste, obedient and poor life outside the
walls of a monastery? Or, put yet in a different way: What are the effects
of living outside a monastery on the understanding of the institution-
alised values of chastity, obedience and poverty?
The three values of chastity, obedience and poverty are equally impor-
tant in religious forms of life. Notwithstanding, for the purposes of this
chapter we will focus on the value of poverty for two main reasons. First,
poverty was part of important debates within the Catholic Church that
go back to the thirteenth century (Agamben, 2013). This means that
from an institutional point of view, the value of poverty within Catholi-
cism has a century-old history. Second, and most importantly, poverty
was considered by Ignatius the ‘wall that protects the life of a Jesuit’:
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 85
‘Poverty, as the strong wall of the religious institute, should be loved and pre-
served in its integrity as far as this is possible with God’s grace. The enemy of
the human race generally tries to weaken this defense and rampart which God
our Lord inspired religious institutes to raise against him and the other adver-
saries of their perfection. Into what was well ordered by their first founders
he induces alterations by means of interpretations and innovations not in
conformity with those founders’ first spirit ’ (Jesuit Constitutions, §553).
Poverty thus emerges as a fundamental value of (a) religious forms of
life and (b) the Jesuit order in particular. Furthermore, as I will discuss
in the following sections, the value of poverty is critical to understand
the institutional leadership of the Jesuit organisation.
Ordering Individual Values
As Agamben (2013) highlights, what underpinned the mediaeval debates
around poverty was the possibility, strongly denied by the Catholic
Church of the thirteenth century, that an individual could renounce
their natural right to property. Such a possibility is made visible in the
sixteenth-century text of the Spiritual Exercises (SE), as follows: ‘it is nec-
essary to make ourselves indifferent to all created things, in regard to every-
thing which is left to our free will and is not forbidden. Consequently, on our
own part we ought not to seek health rather than sickness, wealth rather
than poverty, honor rather than dishonor, a long life rather than a short
one, and so on in all other matters. Rather, we ought to desire and choose
only that which is more conducive to the end for which we are created ’ (SE,
§21, emphasis added). All this so as ‘to overcome oneself and order one’s
life, without reaching a decision through some disordered affection’ (SE,
§21, emphasis added).
The absence of any form of desire towards material goods/wealth
thus becomes one of the values underpinning the Jesuit organisation.
Poverty at the individual level is therefore translated as indifference
towards wealth and poverty. That said, what becomes the target of order-
ing at the individual level are the affects: the important aspect is not
materiality, but how the individual relates to it, how they feel and
which affections are brought to the surface in regard to material objects.
86 J. B. da Silva
‘Disordered affections’ (SE, §21) are affects that make the individual desire
one thing more than the other. Indifference is therefore not a specific way
of behaving, but a guiding desire (Certeau, 1973) of individual action:
the individual only desires to become totally indifferent to outcomes that
are equally good (Geger, 2012). This raises the question: if one is sup-
posed to be indifferent to wealth and poverty, what is the role of poverty?
The indifferent individual and the absence of desire (Certeau, 2000)
need to be constantly self-monitored, insofar as they are never fully
attained: actions, thoughts and desires are permanently monitored and
accounted for (see Quattrone [2004] for a discussion of this issue vis-à-
vis accounting). In the SE, indifference is neither the target of any spe-
cific form of speech, nor is it framed as a form of ‘counter-conduct’ (see
Munro [2014] for a discussion of counter-conduct). Indifference is sim-
ply defined as we have outlined above. However, even though the SE are
a process whose logics are procedural and non-substantiated (Quattrone,
2015), they are performed under the guidance of what is called a Spir-
itual Exercises director. This means that the individual never performs
the SE alone, but always under the guidance of someone whose func-
tion is to help assess the order or disorder of the individual’s affections.
It is through the constant and regular dialogue with the SE director that
the individual orders their life and assesses their indifference. The SE’s
logics are therefore not only procedural (Quattrone, 2015), but also dia-
logical and relational. This is akin to Anteby’s (2013) emphasis, when
discussing the case of Harvard Business School (HBS), on those mem-
bers of the faculty who are the guardians of the shared understanding
about what constitutes HBS’s moral pursuit. Anteby (2013) highlights
the relevance of recruitment, socialisation and leadership for large-scale
organisations which pursue moral projects, even though they do not sub-
stantiate what morality consists of, as in the case of HBS. The Jesuit
organisation also emphasises, in its Constitutions, the vital importance
of recruitment, socialisation and leadership. However, unlike the case of
HBS as described by Anteby (2013), silence is replaced by processes that
foster dialogue with an SE director or Superior/manager so as to reach a
shared understanding of what constitutes indifference, eventually leading
to individual and organisational order. We expand on this below through
an analysis of the Jesuit Constitutions.
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 87
Ordering the Corpus’ Values
Arguably, the most important aspect to consider when approaching the
Jesuit Constitutions is their structure. In accordance with the modern
way of charting thought (Ong, 2004), the Constitutions follow a deter-
mined order in the presentation of subject matters (Coupeau, 2010).
That order is based on practical considerations, which means that the aim
of the Constitutions, which is the proper governance of the Jesuit corpus,
is only stated in the final chapters. The Constitutions can and should
be analysed according to this, simultaneously taking into consideration
that the aim of this legislative text is to fully regulate the governance of
its members aligned with their characteristic ‘way of proceeding ’. How-
ever, unlike monastic Rules, the Jesuit Constitutions do not substantiate
every detail of the monk’s life (Aldama, 1989; Coupeau, 2010). Instead,
the Jesuit Constitutions outline a ‘way of proceeding ’ which is akin to
what Agamben (2013) calls a ‘form-of-life’.
The Jesuits Constitutions are divided into 10 chapters which trace the
development of the indifferent Jesuit and the governance of the Jesuit
‘corpus’. The first 5 chapters deal with the socialisation and training of
a Jesuit; Chapters 6 and 7 deal with the specificities of religious life,
including poverty, and Chapters 8 through 10 deal with the governance
of the entity. However, the outlining of a uniform ‘form-of-life’ (Agam-
ben, 2013) does not occur via a detailing of everyday life, as in monastic
rules (Agamben, 2013), but is achieved through the replication of a set
of experiences. These experiences, part of the training of any Jesuit, are
replicated over and over again. Among those experiences is the practice
of the Spiritual Exercises (Constitutions, §65), to work for one month
in a hospital (Constitutions, §66), to go on a pilgrimage (Constitutions,
§67), to teach (Constitutions, §69) and to experience poverty (Consti-
tutions, §254, §285, §287). In accordance with the rhetorical under-
pinnings of the Jesuit Constitutions (Coupeau, 2010), Chapters 6 and
7 represent the outcome of what is experienced after the ‘training’ the
Jesuit underwent, and which is described as the Jesuit way of living a
religious life. Part of this religious life is a life of poverty.
88 J. B. da Silva
However, before we explore what it means to live in poverty, it is
important to describe how indifference is framed within the Jesuit Con-
stitutions: ‘The members of this Society ought to be ready at any hour to
go to any part of the world where they may be sent by the sovereign pon-
tiff or their own superiors’ (Constitutions, §588). Put simply, indifference
means to be fully available to go to any part in the world and perform any
activity. This availability was, at the time, quite unusual, because life in
the monasteries was characterised precisely by what Weber (1968/1978)
termed ‘stabilitas loci’: after joining a monastery, a monk would spend
his entire life in that same monastery, and have his day entirely regulated
with great minutiae (Agamben, 2013).
It is intriguing how the Jesuits devised a ‘way of proceeding ’ that repre-
sented an extraordinary shift in comparison with other religious forms-
of-life, which were focused mainly on ordinances (Aldama, 1989). The
reason for such an option is well known: the need for flexibility and
adaptability to different geographical locations (O’Malley, 1993). The
Jesuit geographical dispersion, and the emphasis on the flexibility of the
individual and the ‘corpus’, rendered it impossible to construct life ‘as a
total and unceasing liturgy or Divine Office’ (Agamben, 2013, p. xii), to
share the monastic Rule’s tension between the private and the commu-
nal, to put at the centre the habitus, to order life via the ‘horologium’ or
to enclose life in a disciplinary apparatus (Agamben, 2013). Even so, the
Jesuit Constitutions shared with other forms of religious life an emphasis
on poverty as a key tenet of such a life.
Agamben (2013) discusses how Franciscan monastic Rules pointed
towards a ‘form-of-life’ in which a theory of use (use of a property that is
not individual, but communal) translated itself into an ethos, a form of
life: ‘What was in question (…) was not the rule, but the life, not the ability
to profess this or that article of faith, but the ability to live in a certain way’
(Agamben, 2013, p. 93). This means that the ‘way’ that was appropri-
ate for monastic orders was poverty (Agamben, 2013). The Franciscans’
rule and the identification of life with its form (a rule as a form-of-life)
represented, in the thirteenth century, a major shift in the pastorate, one
that Foucault (2009) does not acknowledge, but which Agamben (2013)
explores. Although the first 5 chapters of the Jesuit Constitutions point
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 89
towards a coincidence between the form (the Constitutions and the expe-
riences they devise) and life, they do represent a shift in the understand-
ing of what a religious form of life meant.
Ordering a Poor Way of Life
Poverty is fundamental to understanding how order is achieved in the
Jesuits. Poverty is about a ‘way of life’, not a substantiated ‘rule of life’.
We expand below via an analysis of the ‘Statutes on Religious Poverty in
the Society of Jesus’ (SRPSJ).
Poverty has three dimensions: individual poverty, expressed through a
formal poverty vow that each individual undertakes; communal poverty,
which relates to how the local community of Jesuits experiences poverty
and finally a ‘common way of living in external matters’ (SRPSJ, arti-
cle 3). First, individual poverty, which is about renouncing the natural
right to property, points towards a ‘theory of use’ (Agamben, 2013): ‘No
one should have the use of anything or dispose of it as his own’ (SRPSJ,
article 1, 21, §1). This means that the individual has no property, but
the community may have. This leads us to the second dimension, that
of communal poverty. Communal poverty is made visible by a common
‘standard of living’ (SRPSJ, article 2, 28, §1) in which ‘superfluities are
always to be avoided’ (SRPSJ, article 2, 28, §2). However, what is super-
fluous is not substantiated. The third and final dimension of poverty
refers to a ‘common way’ of living in poverty and deals with ‘external
matters’ (SRPSJ, article 3). The objective of this third dimension is to
foster a ‘common way’ of being poor, without, again, ever substantiating
what ‘being poor’ means. ‘Being poor’ is always referred to as an imita-
tion of those who are poor. However, what characterises poverty or an
individual as being poor is never defined. Poverty is a ‘manner of life’,
something which is ‘entirely authentic’, ‘not becoming illusory’ (SRPSJ,
Part 1, §G) and to ‘be adapted’ in ‘creative fidelity’ and ‘active indiffer-
ence’ (SRPSJ, Part 1, §F, §R).
There is one element in the Jesuit Constitutions and in how poverty
is conceived that may pass unnoticed: the role of the Superior/manager.
The Jesuit Superior, just as in the case of the SE director, is the guardian
90 J. B. da Silva
of poverty. However, unlike the Abbot of the monastery, his role is not
to guarantee that the minutiae outlined in the Rules are observed, but
to allow for a ‘way of proceeding ’ to be developed. The Jesuit ‘way of pro-
ceeding ’ unfolds (Quattrone, 2015) through a constant dialogue between
the Superior and the individual, and between the Superior and the com-
munity he manages. It is not that the Superior commands poverty, but
rather that what constitutes a poor ‘manner of life’ emerges out of con-
stant dialogue. It is precisely in this sense that the logics underpinning
Jesuit rationality are not only procedural (Quattrone, 2015), but also
dialogical and relational.
Leading a ‘Poor’ Corpus
Unlike monastic orders’ ‘forms-of-life’ (Agamben, 2013), the Jesuit ‘cor-
pus’ was an expanding global corpus in which the remote controlling
of a geographically widely dispersed ‘population’ of individuals appar-
ently underpinned the development of a unique constitutional frame-
work (Knowles, 1966). However, the Jesuit constitutional framework
revolves around ‘indifference’ and is not guided by any specific organising
objectives, established purposes or objectified moral pursuits or values.
Jesuit indifference can be made visible through the treatment accorded
to poverty and to what Agamben (2013) defines as a ‘theory of use’. In
the case of the Jesuits, we see that use is more than the refusal of the
individual’s right to property. Jesuit poverty, and its underpinning the-
ory of use, is about active indifference to material goods; in addition, it
is about the ordering of a poor life via the manufacturing of a poor indi-
vidual, a poor community and as a consequence a poor ‘corpus’. It is not
the Jesuit ‘corpus’ which imposes a particular conception of poverty on
its members; poverty emerges out of individual indifference to material
goods and is constructed relationally and in ambiguous terms. The only
driver of poverty is indifference, which in this context means the absence
of desire for any specific material goods.
The ‘way of proceeding ’ is the only rule the Jesuit organisation has.
Ordering the globally dispersed population of individual Jesuits is the
result of the construction of a ‘form-of-life’ (Agamben, 2013) (or ‘way of
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 91
proceeding ’) in which the form (the rule) is coincident with the individ-
ual’s life (Agamben, 2013). However, whereas in traditional monasticism
this was done within the confines of the monastery, as Agamben (2013)
highlights, the Jesuits were not bound by any space that could ‘in-form’
their life. Indifference was what ‘in-formed’ life: ‘each one ought to be
ready to undertake whatever may be assigned to him’ (Constitutions,
§302).
Conclusion
Selznick describes the process of institutionalisation as one in which flex-
ibility is lost: ‘the enterprise gains the stability that comes with a secure
sense of support’ (1957, p. 7). The Jesuit order is interesting precisely
because of how it balances stability with constant accommodation to
local circumstances: be it at the individual level, or at the community
level. In this sense, poverty is not a stable value. Instead, poverty is a
value to be constantly interrogated. And it is the process of interrogation
what poverty means that is stable (institutionalised), and not the under-
standing of what poverty is. Poverty is therefore not the result of ‘con-
scious design’, but of ‘unplanned adaptations to new situations’ (Selznick,
1957, p. 12). This allows the Jesuit order to evolve, change and adapt
without ‘significantly changing the role and character of the organiza-
tion’ (Selznick, 1957, p. 12).
However, if the changing understandings of poverty are not con-
sciously designed, what is left for institutional leadership? Selznick
(1957) provides us with an answer: ‘the more precise an organization’s
goals, and the more specialized and technical its operations, the less oppor-
tunity will there be for social forces to affect its development ’ (p. 16). And
it is precisely in those situations in which ‘goals are less clearly defined ’
(Selznick, 1957, p. 16) that institutional leadership is most needed. This
contradicts our heroic view of leadership, according to which the leader
is responsible for leading towards clearly defined goals, preferably defined
by the leaders themselves. Institutional leadership thus emerges as ‘a kind
of work done to meet the needs of a social situation’ (Selznick, 1957,
92 J. B. da Silva
p. 22) in which the goals of the organisation are problematic instead of
stable.
Selznick’s (1957) insights are corroborated by the Jesuit case. More
specifically, the idea that the ‘less clearly defined’ (Selznick, 1957, p. 16)
the goals are, the more we need leadership is concomitant with the rela-
tional nature of leadership manifested in the Jesuit case. However, the
Jesuit case furthers Selznick’s intuition insofar as it frees it from the heroic
view it seems to imply. Institutional leaders are not the only ones who
protect and promote the institution’s values. Instead, such protection and
promotion emerge out of the relational nature of leadership that charac-
terises Jesuit leadership. The constitution of poverty is the result of the
dialogue between the Jesuit leader and their followers, which allows the
Jesuit organisation to constantly adapt according to different times and
places. Jesuits can operate in extreme contexts of poverty as well as in
privileged contexts; individual Jesuits, unlike members of other Catholic
Religious Orders, have no rules regarding the way they dress (the monk’s
habit is traditionally an exterior sign of poverty). These are examples of
how the value of poverty is open and ambiguous, which is precisely what
allows the Jesuits to adapt so easily to multiple contexts.
Such openness raises interesting questions regarding institutionalisa-
tion processes. The intuition that leadership is most needed when the
organisation faces ambiguity is rather easy to grasp. However, institu-
tionalisation processes always imply some form of stability which is at
odds with openness and ambiguity. Moreover, the Jesuit case shows that
leadership is not needed only in situations of ambiguity understood as
extraordinary situations. Instead, ambiguity is understood as constitu-
tive of the values guiding the institution: it is not that poverty needs to
be redefined when the context asks for it; the point is that poverty is
ambiguous by its own nature. Put differently, values and meanings do
not need to be substantiated so as to generate action and maintain an
institution (Quattrone, 2015). Institutional leadership and institutional
work thus emerge as relational in their own nature: they are not about the
maintenance, protection and promotion of specific institutional values,
but about the constant interrogation of what such values mean according
to different times and places.
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 93
Published Sources
1. Statutes on Religious Poverty in the Society of Jesus, published by the
‘Curia General of the Society of Jesus’, in Rome, 2005. Consulted in
the British Archives of the Society of Jesus—Archivum Britannicum
Societatis Iesu.
2. Loyola, I. (1992). The spiritual exercises. Saint Louis: The Institute of
Jesuit Sources.
3. Loyola, I. (1996). The constitutions of the society of Jesus and their com-
plementary norms. Saint Louis: The Institute of Jesuit Sources.
4. Documents of the Jesuit General Congregations. Published as:
a. For matters of greater moment—The first thirty Jesuit general con-
gregations. Edited and Translated by Padberg, J. W., O’Keefe, M.
D., & McCarthy, J. L. (1994). Saint Louis: The Institute of Jesuit
Sources.
b. Jesuit life and mission today—The decrees & accompanying docu-
ments of the 31st–35th general congregations of the society of Jesus’.
Edited by Padberg, J. W. (2009). Saint Louis: The Institute of
Jesuit Sources.
5. On giving the spiritual exercises: The early Jesuit manuscript directories
and the official directory of 1599. Edited and translated by Palmer, M.
E. (2009). Saint Louis: The Institute of Jesuit Sources.
References
Agamben, G. (2013). The highest poverty: Monastic rules and form-of-life. Stan-
ford, CA: Stanford University Press.
Aldama, A. M. (1989). The constitutions of the society of Jesus: An introductory
commentary on the constitutions. Saint Louis: The Institute of Jesuit Sources.
Alvesson, M., & Spicer, A. (2018). Neo-institutional theory and organization
studies: A mid-life crisis? Organization Studies, First Published Online on
July 6, 2018. https://doi.org/10.1177/0170840618772610.
https://doi.org/10.1177/0170840618772610
94 J. B. da Silva
Anteby, M. (2013). Manufacturing morals: The values of silence in business school
education. Chicago and London: The University of Chicago Press.
Besharov, M. L., & Khurana, R. (2015). Leading amidst competing techni-
cal and institutional demands: Revisiting Selznick’s conception of leader-
ship. In M. S. Kraatz (Ed.), Institutions and ideals: Philip Selznick’s legacy for
organizational Studies. Research in the Sociology of Organizations (Vol. 44,
pp. 53–88).
Certeau, M. (1973). L’espace du désir. Christus, 20, 118–128.
Certeau, M. (2000). Mystic speech. In G. Ward (Ed.), The Certeau Reader
(pp. 188–206). Oxford and Malden, MA: Blackwell Publishers.
Coupeau, J. C. (2010). From inspiration to invention: Rhetoric in the constitu-
tions of the society of Jesus. Saint Louis: The Institute of Jesuit Sources.
Crevani, L., Lindgren, M., & Packendorff, J. (2010). Leadership, not leaders:
On the study of leadership as practices and interactions. Scandinavian Jour-
nal of Management, 26, 77–86.
Foucault, M. (2009). Security, territory, population: Lectures at the Collège de
France (1977–1978). Hampshire and New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Geger, B. T. (2012). What magis really means and why it matters. Jesuit Higher
Education, 1(2), 16–31.
Haveman, H. A., & David, R. J. (2008). Ecologists and institutionalists:
Friends or foes? In R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, R. Suddaby, & K. Sahlin
(Eds.), The SAGE handbook of organizational institutionalism (pp. 573–595).
London: Sage.
Knowles, D. (1966). From Pachomius to Ignatius: A study in the constitutional
history of the religious orders. Oxford: Clarendon Press.
Kraatz, M. S. (2009). Leadership as institutional work: A bridge to the other
side. In T. B. Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca (Eds.), Institutional work
actors and agency in institutional studies of organizations (pp. 59–91). Cam-
bridge: Cambridge University Press.
Kraatz, M. S., & Block, E. S. (2017). Institutional pluralism revisited. In R.
Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B. Lawrence, & R. E. Meyer (Eds.), The SAGE
handbook of organizational institutionalism (pp. 532–557). London: Sage.
Lawrence, T. B., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work.
In S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. B. Lawrence, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), The Sage
handbook of organization studies (2nd ed., pp. 215–254). London, UK: Sage.
Munro, I. (2014). Organizational ethics and Foucault’s ‘art of living’: Lessons
from social movement organizations. Organization Studies, 35(8), 1–22.
O’Malley, J. W. (1993). The first Jesuits. Cambridge: Harvard University Press.
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical … 95
Ong, W. J. (2004). Ramus, method and the decay of dialogue. Chicago: The
University of Chicago Press.
Quattrone, P. (2004). Accounting for god: Accounting and accountability prac-
tices in the society of Jesus (Italy, XVI–XVII centuries). Accounting, Organi-
zations and Society, 29(7), 647–683.
Quattrone, P. (2015). Governing social orders, unfolding rationality, and Jesuit
accounting practices: A procedural approach to institutional logics. Admin-
istrative Science Quarterly, 60(3), 411–445.
Selznick, P. (1957/1984). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpreta-
tion. New York: Harper & Row.
Washington, M., Boal, K. B., & Davis, J. N. (2008). Institutional leader-
ship: Past, present, and future. In R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, R. Suddaby,
& K. Sahlin (Eds.), The SAGE handbook of organizational institutionalism
(pp. 721–736). London: Sage.
Weber, M. (1968/1978). Economy and society. Berkeley: University of California
Press.
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
6
‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’: Implicit
Leadership Theory at the Multicultural
Workplace
Tone Lindheim
Introduction
Today, workplaces are increasingly culturally diverse, and managers and
employees interact across various societal cultures. Facilitating commu-
nication and cooperation among individuals to accomplish shared goals
is central to leadership, and multicultural workplaces represent new chal-
lenges and opportunities in this regard. This chapter proposes values
work as a strategy, inquiring into the implicit ideas of good and bad
leadership at the multicultural workplace with loosely held cultural cate-
gories. The aim of the chapter is to examine the factors that shape man-
agers’ and employees’ implicit ideas of leadership and to analyse how
leadership is negotiated in everyday interaction across cultures. Three
nursing homes in Oslo, Norway, are the empirical context of the case
study.
T. Lindheim (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: tone.lindheim@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_6
97
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_6&domain=pdf
mailto:tone.lindheim@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_6
98 T. Lindheim
A Critical Review of the Comparative
Paradigm of Cultural Universals
The relevance of culture to leadership is well established, especially
through large-scale studies that have developed cultural universals or
dimensions for comparing cultures at the societal level (Hofstede, 2001;
House, 2004). In much of cross-cultural management research, these cul-
tural dimensions are strongly linked to values (Hofstede, 2001; House,
2004; Mustafa & Lines, 2016). In the GLOBE project (House, 2004),
the dimensions developed to measure and compare societal culture are
referred to as values orientations. In the same vein, Mustafa and Lines
(2016) reviewed the literature on culture and leadership and analysed
the interaction between societal level values and individual values. How-
ever, this approach in cross-cultural management—identifying culture
with values—has been criticised for ignoring other aspects of culture that
frame leadership practice, such as societal structures and legal frameworks
(Alvesson, 1989; Nathan, 2015).
A theoretical concept that describes the relationship between societal
culture and leadership in the comparative tradition, and in the GLOBE
project in particular (House, 2004), is ‘culturally endorsed implicit lead-
ership theories’ (CLTs). The central tenant of implicit leadership the-
ory is that managers and employees bring to their daily interactions
implicit, taken-for-granted ideas of good and bad leadership (Eden &
Leviatan, 1975). Building on implicit leadership theory, the GLOBE
project aimed at extending the theory from an individual level to a soci-
etal level, arguing that implicit ideas of leadership are culturally con-
tingent and culturally endorsed (CLT). To gain acceptance and support
from employees, managers must therefore take culture into account and
behave in a manner that matches the culturally contingent expectations
of the specific society. CLT can then be identified and measured at the
societal level and compared with those of other societies. This theory of
culturally congruent leadership has gained broad support within cross-
cultural management research (Green, 2017; Mustafa & Lines, 2016);
however, it has also been criticised for promoting a static and essential-
ist understanding of culture (Fang, 2005; Mahadevan, 2017; Nathan,
2015).
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 99
Phenomena like globalisation and migration make cultural configu-
rations more complex and blur the lines that mark the societal level.
Macro-level comparative approaches in cross-cultural management have
been criticised for offering a perspective on culture that does not align
with the reality of today’s multicultural workplaces. Further, the use of
cultural universals to sensitise individuals to cultural differences has been
criticised for reinforcing stereotypes and essentialising aspects of people’s
social identities (Nathan, 2015; Witte, 2012). This is why researchers
have called for alternative, in-depth qualitative approaches that analyse
the complexity of leadership and culture in multicultural environments
(Fang, 2005; Mahadevan, 2017).
In line with this criticism, this study argues that the macro-level com-
parative approach to culture and leadership offers a flawed perspective on
the interplay of culture and leadership at the workplace. The approach is
too narrow in that culture is reduced to values, and it is too broad when
culture is identified at the societal level. To understand culture and lead-
ership at the multicultural workplace, it is necessary to broaden the gaze,
beyond values, to include the larger institutional context and to narrow
the gaze to inspect more specific local organisational factors.
Exploring Implicit Ideas of Leadership
at the Multicultural Workplace
Through a case study in three nursing homes in Oslo (Norway), this
study explores implicit ideas of leadership at the multicultural workplace
and the different sources that shape these ideas. In line with practice the-
ory (Nicolini, 2012) and the ‘Leadership-as-practice’ tradition (Raelin,
2016), this study locates leadership in the practice as it unfolds at the
workplace. The study analyses how leadership is negotiated in the every-
day interactions of managers and employees. Such negotiation involves
an exchange of ideas of good and bad leadership to arrive at a common
frame of understanding (Børve, 2008, p. 17) as well as specific leadership
practices (Børve, 2010).
100 T. Lindheim
The present study seeks to analyse culture in a way that does not
confine it to societal or national boundaries. Culture is a social phe-
nomenon enacted at different levels: societal, organisational and group
(Mahadevan, 2017). Culture is tied to collectives and as such draws
boundaries between insiders and outsiders (Borofsky, 1994). But con-
trary to the comparative paradigm described above, the boundaries are
multiple, shifting, incongruent and overlapping. Thus, although culture
is a collective phenomenon, it is enacted by individuals embedded in
a variety of cultural contexts and belonging to several different cultural
collectives simultaneously.
The present study draws on elements from the GLOBE project, par-
ticularly the concept of CLTs, but seeks to use the concept differently.
Implicit leadership theory provides a useful framework for understand-
ing how managers and employees negotiate leadership at the workplace,
but the cultural configuration of organisational members at the multicul-
tural workplace is more complex than what is suggested by the GLOBE
project. Organisational actors embody unique cultural configurations
that vary for instance with their first-, second- and third-generation
country background and the time spent in their current country of resi-
dence. Other collective identities like gender and profession add to their
individual cultural configurations (Witte, 2012). In this chapter, I argue
that these dynamic cultural configurations play a central role in shaping
the implicit ideas of leadership and that to improve communication and
cooperation at the workplace, it is more fruitful to inquire into these
than look for societal level scores to measure them.
Applying an institutional perspective, this study broadens the under-
standing of culture beyond values and identifies different contextual fac-
tors that shape the implicit ideas of leadership at the multicultural work-
place. Contextual factors can be found at the institutional, field and
organisational levels (Scott, 2014). For instance, factors at the institu-
tional level include legal frameworks and regulations like the Working
Environment Act and the Basic Agreement between trade unions and
the employers’ unions (Børve & Kvande, 2018; Byrkjeflot, 2001). These
frameworks and regulations are central to the Norwegian culture; they
frame leadership practice and regulate the roles, rights and responsibili-
ties of managers and employees. At the field level, characteristics of the
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 101
healthcare sector and the professions dominating the sector are contex-
tual factors that frame leadership practice (Zilber, 2012). In addition,
the formal and informal as well as technical and ideational features spe-
cific to an organisational context (Scott & Davis, 2016) are important
for understanding leadership in a local setting.
Research Design and Methods
To explore the implicit ideas of leadership and the negotiation of lead-
ership at the multicultural workplace, a qualitative approach was cho-
sen, and three nursing homes in Oslo were selected for a case study
(Stake, 1995). In the Norwegian context, nursing homes represent highly
multicultural workplaces. In this study, the share of employees with an
immigrant background varied from 69 to 84% of employees on perma-
nent contracts in the units studied. To investigate the complex cultural
dynamics of leadership in the nursing homes, I studied one unit with a
manager from an immigrant background and one unit with a manager
from the majority background in each nursing home.
An ethnographically inspired method that combined participant
observation, semi-structured shadowing and interviews was used to study
leadership practices as they unfolded in the organisational context. A
total of 200 h was spent on observation in the nursing homes. The six
unit managers were shadowed for one day each (Askeland, 2015). The
other days of observation were less structured and allowed the researcher
to participate more freely and observe the interaction between unit man-
agers and employees. After the observation, 27 semi-structured inter-
views were conducted (see Table 6.1). Interviewees were selected to rep-
resent a diverse collection of country backgrounds, professions and gen-
ders. Combining observation and interviews helped validate the observa-
tions and interpretations by participating objectification (Fangen, 2010,
p. 224). All the interviews were recorded and transcribed verbatim by the
researcher. The informants and the nursing homes were given fictitious
names to protect their identity.
102 T. Lindheim
Table 6.1 List of interviewees
Name Regional background Position Nursing home
Anita (f) Norway Care assistant Marigold
Banu (f) Asia Unit manager Riverside
Bente (f) Norway Healthcare worker Riverside
Celeste (f) South America Care assistant Marigold
Dragan (m) Eastern Europe Unit manager Cornerstone
Edel (f) Norway Healthcare worker Cornerstone
Ellen (f) Norway CEO Cornerstone
Faiza (f) Africa Care assistant Cornerstone
Hamza (m) Africa Care assistant Cornerstone
Harald (m) Norway CEO Riverside
Hege (f) Norway CEO Marigold
Hilde (f) Norway Unit manager Marigold
Ingrid (f) Norway Nurse Marigold
Jenny (f) Asia Nurse Marigold
Jodit (f) Africa Healthcare worker Marigold
Jonathan (m) Africa Unit manager Marigold
Justyna (f) Eastern Europe Nurse Cornerstone
Kari (f) Norway Unit manager Cornerstone
Kristin (f) Norway Unit manager Riverside
Marko (m) Eastern Europe Nurse Marigold
Milan (m) Norway/South
America
Nurse Riverside
Nina (f) Norway Healthcare worker Riverside
Omar (m) Africa Healthcare worker Riverside
Shanti (f) Asia Healthcare worker Riverside
Silje (f) Norway Healthcare worker Cornerstone
Vanessa (f) Asia Nurse Cornerstone
Zahra (f) Asia Nurse Riverside
NVivo was used for thematic coding and analysis of field notes
and interview transcripts. The notes from the semi-structured shad-
owing were coded and analysed in accordance with procedures from
previous studies (Askeland, 2015). As recommended for case studies,
the different types of data were converged and analysed as a whole
(Yazan, 2015). After a preliminary analysis of the data from observa-
tion and interviews, findings were shared and validated at meetings in
the nursing homes. In terms of transferability of the results, the choice
of nursing homes has both advantages and limitations. As mentioned,
nursing homes have a high percentage of managers and employees
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 103
with an immigrant background, which provided rich opportunities to
observe negotiation of leadership across cultures. On the other hand,
choosing workplaces where employees with an immigrant background
are in minority could generate different results showing a more domi-
nant influence of the Norwegian cultural context.
Implicit Ideas of Leadership
at the Multicultural Workplace
The following sections present findings from the fieldwork and inter-
views. It starts with a presentation of the implicit ideas of leadership
in the nursing homes, followed by an analysis of the multiple sources
of these ideas: contextual factors and individual experiences. The three
managers with an immigrant background are then presented as examples
of how leadership is negotiated at the multicultural workplace.
Implicit Ideas of Good and Bad Leadership
in the Nursing Homes
Participant observation and shadowing allowed the researcher to observe
leadership practices as they played out in the natural work setting, and
during observation and interviews, informants described different leader-
ship practices as either good or bad. The ideas of good and bad leadership
are presented in Table 6.2. The ideas of good leaders can be summarised
as follows: good leaders are visible and present in the unit, they listen to
their employees, and they support and fight for their employees instead
of simply accepting the demands of their supervisors. Good leaders are
communicative, and they recognise the efforts of their employees and
speak nicely with the employees. They place themselves at the level of
the employees and are not afraid of doing the dirty work. Employees
highly value leaders who put on the uniform and share the employee
workload. Hilde, one of the unit managers at Marigold, said the follow-
ing at the validation meeting: ‘What my staff really remembers and what
I get credit for is that I cleaned the floor in one of the residents’ room
104 T. Lindheim
Table 6.2 Descriptions of good and bad leadership
Good leadership
• The leader must be available and visible in the unit
• The leader must listen to the employees
• The leader must show some flexibility
• The leader must support the staff and show that they fight for the staff
• The leader must call in substitutes when someone is sick
• A good leader puts on the uniform and isn’t afraid of working
• A good leader gives you a pat on the shoulder. It is someone who says
you have done a good job today
• A good leader is strict and kind—a good mix of both
Bad leadership
• Bad leaders lock themselves in the office and just sit there; they are
not present in the unit
• Bad leaders only think of money and budget
• Bad leaders are very rigid and closed
• Bad leaders are strict with their employees but pander to their bosses
– not that I negotiated a higher salary for them’. In the study, infor-
mants’ ideas of good leadership reflected general leadership expectations
of a flat structure, of involvement and being treated as equals as well as
context-specific factors like presence in the unit and putting on the uni-
form to share common tasks. These expectations were confirmed in the
validation meetings.
Contextual Factors and Individual Experiences
as Sources of Implicit Ideas of Leadership
Where do the ideas of good and bad leadership come from? From the
data, two sets of sources were identified: contextual factors from the
institutional, field and organisational levels and individual experiences
of leadership from the country of origin and the country of residence.
The first source of implicit ideas of leadership is related to contex-
tual factors. Contextual factors were identified at the institutional, field
and organisational levels. As described above, the Working Environment
Act is one of the regulatory factors at the institutional level that frame
leadership in Norwegian work life. Together with the Basic Agreement
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 105
accorded by employers’ and trade unions, the Working Environment
Act regulates the work environment. These frameworks were frequently
referred to in the nursing homes, and employees were conscious of their
rights:
We work under the same rules and the same obligations, you know. And
rights. (…) We have the same rights all of us, and the same obligations.
So that doesn’t worry me. (Omar, health care worker at Riverside)
Jonathan [unit manager at Marigold] follows the Norwegian rules. If he
doesn’t, we can complain. (Alvin, health care worker at Marigold)
Employees expected leaders to play by the rules and were conscious of
the mechanisms that protected them and regulated the power balance
between managers and employees.
The shadowing of the six unit managers showed that being unit man-
agers in a nursing home shaped the manager role in a significant way,
which can be attributed to nursing homes as a sector or institutional
field. The unit managers engaged in similar types of activities (e.g. super-
vising clinical work, staffing shifts, attending meetings, responding to
emails and phone calls), and they related to the same set of actors (CEOs,
other unit managers, employees, residents, relatives of the residents). One
of the factors that featured in the list of good leadership was appointing
substitutes to compensate for employees on sick leave. Again, the use of
substitutes may be attributed to the field level as the healthcare sector is
characterised by a relatively high percentage of employees on sick leave,
and the completion of tasks depends on the number of hands available.
The topic of sick leave and use of substitutes was discussed frequently
among the employees.
Organisational factors seemed to cause differences in the patterns of
leadership between the unit managers. Tasks included in the job descrip-
tion and access to office space were two examples of such organisational
factors. Among the unit managers, the access to a separate office space
was not consistent. Jonathan and Hilde at Marigold had their own offices
on one floor, while their units were located on other floors. At Riverside,
Banu and Kristin did not have a separate office space. For administra-
tive work, they used the computer at the staff room that was accessed by
106 T. Lindheim
all staff members. At Cornerstone, Dragan and Kari had private office
spaces next to the staff room in their units. The physical conditions of
the space where the unit managers spent time during the day influenced
how they interacted with the employees and thus the employees’ expec-
tations towards their managers.
The tasks included in the unit managers’ role descriptions varied
between the nursing homes. While all the unit managers were trained
as nurses, the extent to which they were expected to participate in the
daily care of residents varied. At Marigold, unit managers did not par-
ticipate in care on a regular basis, but when needed, they would put
on the uniform and share the tasks with other employees. At Riverside,
Banu and Kristin were counted as part of the staff in care on a regular
basis. Since they also had other responsibilities, they often took on the
lighter cases or dropped out to attend to other commitments. At Cor-
nerstone, the unit managers participated in care once a week. These dif-
ferences implied that Banu and Kristin at Riverside wore the uniform at
all times, whereas the unit managers at Marigold and Cornerstone wore
regular clothes and changed into the uniform only when they partici-
pated in care. The degree to which managers and employees share the
same tasks and wear the same clothes influences expectations towards
leadership practices and the implicit ideas of good and bad leadership. I
perceived that unit managers at Riverside, who participated in care on a
daily basis and wore the same uniform as other employees, were expected
to behave in a more egalitarian way than managers in the other nursing
homes.
The second source of implicit ideas of leadership was the individual
experiences of leadership from the country of origin and from Norway.
Taken together, the employee backgrounds of the informants across the
nursing homes represented more than 40 countries. Their time spent in
Norway and in the Norwegian education system varied. As such, employ-
ees with an immigrant background brought with them a mix of experi-
ences from different countries. One of the most striking patterns in the
data was the almost unanimous description of leadership in their country
of origin offered by employees with an immigrant background. Despite
their different country backgrounds, their descriptions of leadership in
their country of origin were far more similar than expected. Leadership
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 107
in their country of origin was in general described as hierarchical, and
leaders were perceived as inaccessible. The following excerpts from infor-
mants of different country backgrounds illustrate this perception:
In [my country in Eastern Europe], leaders decide everything. There is no
room for communication so … they are dictators. Employees do what the
leader says, and the leader has absolute power” (Dragan, unit manager at
Cornerstone)
[In my country in Asia] it is something about how they have this great
respect for their leaders, that when the leader says it has to be done, they
do it. For they are a bit afraid of being punished, you know. For there are
consequences. (…) It’s good in a way. Like a bit authoritarian. (Vanessa,
nurse at Cornerstone)
In [my country in Southern Europe] you only speak with your leader if
there is a problem – something that you cannot solve. You may not even
know your leader. (Magdalena, nurse at Marigold)
Although the descriptions of leaders given by employees of different
country backgrounds seemed unanimous, they should not be perceived
as specific descriptions of leadership in the respective countries. The
descriptions were relative—comparing leadership in their country with
what they experienced in their Norwegian work context. In the data,
there were fewer references to typical Norwegian leadership, but aspects
like a flat structure and the approachability of the Norwegian managers
stood out. A key factor in the conversations with employees from an
immigrant background was that they continuously related to both the
culture of their native country and that of their present work country
(Norway).
Implicit leadership theory applied to societal level tends to guide one’s
attention towards commonalities and sharedness of leadership ideas.
However, tensions and disagreements were also observed in the data of
implicit ideas of good and bad leadership in the nursing homes. In gen-
eral, the hierarchical and authoritarian leadership style prevalent in their
native country was perceived as negative but not without ambivalence,
as demonstrated in the quote from Vanessa. She saw being ‘a bit author-
itarian’ as positive and useful in the work context. Other informants
108 T. Lindheim
referred to how leaders in the Norwegian context were expected to talk
to employees in a polite and nice way, even when criticising or correcting
employees. Some of the informants described this as problematic as the
Norwegian leaders appeared evasive when employees underperformed.
Further, because of the flat structure, some employees with an immigrant
background perceived that the employees controlled the leader and not
the other way around. Vince, a nurse from Asia at Cornerstone, had a
frustrating experience as unit manager at a different nursing home:
Here, it is the employees who manage the boss. It is “my way or the
highway”. The smallest thing, and the employees write a deviation report
on their leader. “I am protected because I am an employee”. Here it is
the Working Environment Act and all that stuff.
These examples show that employees were not uncritically socialised into
the Norwegian context. They did not simply accept what was considered
typical Norwegian leadership as good leadership.
In summary, the implicit ideas of leadership in the nursing homes stem
from a variety of sources. Figure 6.1 illustrates how contextual factors at
the institutional, field and organisational levels along with experiences of
leadership from the country of origin and Norway feed into the implicit
Institutional
factors
Organisational
factors
Experiences
from Norway
Experiences
from native
country
Field level
factors
Implicit ideas of good
and bad leadership
Fig. 6.1 Sources of implicit ideas of good and bad leadership
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 109
ideas of good and bad leadership. This illustrates the dynamic cultural
configurations of managers and employees in the nursing homes. The
figure also illustrates the interplay between contextual factors and per-
sonal experiences, showing how for example the structurally given frame-
works shape implicit ideas of leadership. The dotted lines point to the
permeable and overlapping nature of each of the sources. Their weight
and importance vary from person to person.
Negotiating Leadership in the Nursing Homes
To illustrate how leadership is negotiated at the multicultural work-
place, the three managers with an immigrant background are presented
as examples.
Jonathan (Marigold). Jonathan, from a West African country, had
studied nursing in Norway. He had no formal management training
when he took over as unit manager about two years prior to the field
study. When he took over, the employees in his unit were on sick leave on
average 28% of their regular working hours. His major achievement as a
unit manager was to reduce this percentage to below 6%. Jonathan, the
staff and the CEO at Marigold, attributed this achievement to his lead-
ership style and especially to his visibility in the unit and his flexibility in
accommodating the needs of the staff. Jonathan spent little time in the
office doing administrative work. Once or twice a week, he stayed back
after normal work hours to complete his administrative tasks. Jonathan
preferred informal areas for interacting with the staff—the hallway, the
kitchen or the resident rooms where he accompanied the staff. When
employees asked for changes in their shift schedules, Jonathan tried his
best to accommodate. The employees found him understanding and easy
to talk with, and he claimed he made an effort to be so. He said that at
times, he felt like a social worker but added that the give-and-take was a
part of the game: ‘If you show them that in case of sick leave, you call
in substitutes, within reasonable limits, it works’. When the staff sensed
that he made an effort to cover shifts with substitutes, they made an extra
effort to not fail him. Overall, Jonathan responded to the core aspects of
110 T. Lindheim
the implicit ideas of good leadership in the nursing home and was appre-
ciated and respected for it.
Banu (Riverside). Banu was from an Asian country and had com-
pleted her nursing degree as well as management studies in Norway. She
took over the unit six months prior to the field work. Banu participated
in care on a regular basis, but instead of recognising her for sharing their
tasks, the staff complained that she was not doing enough and that they
could not rely on her. Further, because she did not have a separate office
space, she was expected to be in the unit, and the staff complained when
she was not there. The employees described Banu as professionally and
theoretically very competent. She was respected for her courage to stand
up and take charge in difficult situations with residents and relatives.
However, when it came to other aspects of her leadership, the employees
were more negative. Banu claimed to care for her staff, but the staff found
her harsh and felt that she cared more about budgets and favourable
reviews from the top management:
She is a bit direct. And it is not everybody who likes that. You feel that
you are treated very hard sometimes. Nobody likes to be treated badly.
Everybody does their best, and still they get “pepper”. (…) And then we
have heard she is the best to save money. So, it means that she doesn’t
spend money on calling in substitutes. (Zahra, nurse at Riverside)
When analysed in the context of the implicit ideas of leadership, Banu
failed to live up to core expectations of leaders: to be understanding, to
remain loyal to employees and to communicate in a soft and kind man-
ner. Her strengths—being performance-oriented, strategy-driven and a
visionary—did not align with the leadership characteristics highlighted
in the implicit ideas of leadership in the nursing homes; as a result, she
did not earn legitimacy or support from the staff. Banu argued that
as a leader, she could not expect to receive positive feedback from the
employees. The support from the CEO and positive comments from resi-
dents and their relatives were more important to her. In a way, it seemed
like she had resigned from negotiating leadership with her employees,
and the level of conflict with the staff in the unit was high.
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 111
Dragan (Cornerstone). Dragan was from an Eastern European coun-
try and had started working as a manager about six months prior to
the field study. Being a unit manager at Cornerstone was his first formal
management position. During the field study period, an employee survey
was conducted in the nursing home, and the staff gave Dragan impres-
sively high scores. A striking aspect that was highlighted in the fieldwork
and interviews was the autocratic style of Dragan’s leadership. He main-
tained a log of the mistakes and deviations of each employee to gather
evidence, and he insisted on being direct when correcting mistakes:
They are not used to direct feedback. They mean I should wrap it more
in and say it in a nice way. No one likes to receive criticism, even if it
is constructive. (…) My job is to correct the mistakes and supervise the
employees so that they don’t make mistakes. So, I need to have this kind
of … a bit direct leadership. (…) I need to become dictator as long as we
have serious mistakes.
The autocratic tendency was in sharp contrast to what was perceived as
good leadership in the nursing homes. So how did Dragan get away with
it and receive high scores on the employee survey? It appears that Dragan
had special ways of demonstrating affection towards his employees. The
employees used emotionally charged words when expressing how much
they liked him. Alvin, a healthcare worker from Asia, captured the ten-
sion between the affective attachment and Dragan’s directness: ‘It is kind
of like a father. We are the children and get scolded by our father. We
are like a family’. Alvin seemed very satisfied with this style. By devel-
oping an affective relationship with the staff and creating a family spirit
among the employees, Dragan created a space for himself to be direct
and, at times, autocratic. Thus, he responded to the core aspects of ideas
of good leadership in the nursing home but also renegotiated them to
create acceptance for his more authoritarian leadership practices.
How did culture influence the three managers’ negotiation of lead-
ership? Interestingly, all of them clearly distanced themselves from the
leadership practices in their country of origin and frequently cited ideas
of leadership that they had adopted in the Norwegian study or work
112 T. Lindheim
context. However, they also deliberately drew on their cultural back-
ground as a resource. Dragan specifically noted how his temperament
as an Eastern European was different from that of the typical Norwe-
gian and allowed him to connect with the more emotional and expressive
temperaments of his employees from around the world. When Jonathan
handled permission requests from employees who wanted to visit their
home country to care for their family members, he drew on his personal
experiences with a sick mother in West Africa and his family members
who expected him there. Some employees linked their managers’ leader-
ship practices to their country backgrounds even though the managers’
self-perceptions indicated otherwise. Other employees argued that it had
more to do with the manager’s personality.
The examples of the three unit managers show that it is difficult to
isolate cultural values from their country of origin or country of residence
as factors determining leadership practices. Contextual factors from the
institutional environment, the field and the organisation, as presented
above, framed their leadership practices. As such, the unit managers drew
on a repertoire of resources in their leadership practices. These resources
may be traced back to the culture of their country of origin and to the
Norwegian context, but also to professional background or leadership
discourses that transcend national boundaries.
Concluding Remarks
To enhance communication and cooperation at the multicultural work-
place, it is necessary to actively engage with culture and leadership. This
study proposes values work as a strategy—inquiring into the implicit
ideas of leadership, taking into consideration the dynamic cultural con-
figuration of the organisational members. The study has shown that con-
textual factors at the institutional, field and organisational levels frame
leadership in a significant way. The contextual factors, such as the legal
framework, office space and job descriptions, are more than technical-
ities. They come with sets of value-laden expectations that shape the
implicit ideas of leadership and needs to be discussed. The process of
values work also requires a space for sharing individual experiences of
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 113
leadership across cultures, as these experiences as well frame implicit
ideas of leadership. Through values work, managers and employees at the
multicultural workplace make their implicit ideas of leadership explicit
in a continuous dialogue around legitimate expectations of leaders and
employees. The degree to which managers and employees respond to
implicit ideas of leadership in a meaningful way impacts communication
and cooperation.
The comparative paradigm in cross-cultural management has focused
on national or societal level culture scores on values dimensions (Hof-
stede, 2001; House, 2004). The present study has shown that these
scores fall short for two reasons. First, when culture is limited to values,
the influence of contextual factors arising from the institutional envi-
ronment, the field or the organisation is omitted. Second, societal cul-
ture scores do not capture the heterogeneity of cultural influence at the
multicultural workplace. Hence, this study argues that it is necessary to
broaden the perspective—to zoom out—to include the broader institu-
tional context. At the same time, it is also necessary to zoom into include
the factors specific to the local organisation. Instead of trying to iden-
tify cultural universals, which may reinforce stereotypes and stigmatise
organisational actors, it seems more useful to examine the implicit ideas
of leadership with loosely held cultural categories.
References
Alvesson, M. (1989). The culture perspective on organizations: Instrumental
values and basic features of culture. Scandinavian Journal of Management,
5(2), 123–136. https://doi.org/10.1016/0956-5221(89)90019-5.
Askeland, H. (2015). Managerial practice in faith-based welfare organizations.
Nordic Journal of Religion and Society, 28(1), 37–58.
Borofsky, R. (1994). Introduction. In R. Borofsky (Ed.), Assessing cultural
anthropology (pp. 1–21). New York: McGraw-Hill.
Børve, H. E. (2008). Norske kunnskapsorganisasjoner i et globalt arbeidsliv
[Norwegian knowledge organisations in a global worklife] (PhD). Norges
teknisk-naturvitenskapelige universitet (NTNU), Trondheim.
https://doi.org/10.1016/0956-5221(89)90019-5
114 T. Lindheim
Børve, H. E. (2010). Ledelseskultur i en internasjonal, norskeid kunnskap-
sorganisasjon [Leadership culture in an international Norwegian owned
knowledge organisation]. Nordiske Organisasjonsstudier, 1(12), 29–50.
Børve, H. E., & Kvande, E. (2018). Den norske samarbeidsmodellen [The
Norwegian cooperation model]. Tidsskrift for Samfunnsforskning, 59(1),
26–40. https://doi.org/10.18261/issn.1504-291X-2018-01-02.
Byrkjeflot, H. (2001). The Nordic model of democracy and management.
In H. Byrkjeflot (Ed.), The democratic challenge to capitalism: Management
and democracy in the Nordic countries (pp. 19–45). Bergen, Norway:
Fagbokforlaget.
Eden, D., & Leviatan, U. (1975). Implicit leadership theory as a determinant
of the factor structure underlying supervisory behavior scales. Journal of
Applied Psychology, 60(6), 736–741. https://doi.org/10.1037/0021-9010.
60.6.736.
Fang, T. (2005). From “onion” to “ocean”: Paradox and change in national
cultures. International Studies of Management & Organization, 35(4),
71–90. http://www.jstor.org/stable/40397646.
Fangen, K. (2010). Deltagende observasjon [Participant observation] (2nd ed.).
Bergen, Norway: Fagbokforlaget.
Green, M. J. (2017). Adaptation versus authenticity: Achieving leader effec-
tiveness in intercultural encounters with followers—Towards an integrated
model. International Journal of Cross Cultural Management, 17 (2), 257–271.
https://dx.doi.org/10.1177/1470595817706986.
Hofstede, G. (2001). Culture’s consequences: Comparing values, behaviors,
institutions, and organizations across nations. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
House, R. J. (2004). Culture, leadership, and organizations: The GLOBE study
of 62 societies. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Mahadevan, J. (2017). A very short, fairly interesting and reasonably cheap book
about cross-cultural management. London, UK: Sage.
Mustafa, G., & Lines, R. (2016). The emergence and effects of culturally con-
gruent leadership: Current status and future developments. Entrepreneurial
Business & Economics Review, 4(1), 161–180. http://dx.doi.org/10.15678/
EBER.2016.040110.
Nathan, G. (2015). A non-essentialist model of culture: Implications of
identity, agency and structure within multinational/multicultural organiza-
tions. International Journal of Cross Cultural Management, 15(1), 101–124.
https://dx.doi.org/10.1177/1470595815572171.
Nicolini, D. (2012). Practice theory, work, and organization: An introduction.
Oxford, UK: Oxford University Press.
https://doi.org/10.18261/issn.1504-291X-2018-01-02
https://doi.org/10.1037/0021-9010.60.6.736
http://www.jstor.org/stable/40397646
https://dx.doi.org/10.1177/1470595817706986
http://dx.doi.org/10.15678/EBER.2016.040110
https://dx.doi.org/10.1177/1470595815572171
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’ … 115
Raelin, J. A. (2016). Leadership-as-practice: Theory and application. New York,
NY: Routledge.
Scott, W. R. (2014). Institutions and organizations: Ideas, interests and identity
(4th ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Scott, W. R., & Davis, G. F. (2016). Organizations and organizing: Rational,
natural, and open systems perspectives (International student ed.). New York:
Routledge.
Stake, R. E. (1995). The art of case study research. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Witte, A. E. (2012). Making the case for a post-national cultural analysis of
organizations. Journal of Management Inquiry, 21(2), 141–159. https://doi.
org/10.1177/1056492611415279.
Yazan, B. (2015). Three approaches to case study methods in education:
Yin, Merriam, and Stake. The Qualitative Report, 20(2), 134–152. https://
nsuworks.nova.edu/tqr/vol20/iss2/12.
Zilber, T. B. (2012). The relevance of institutional theory for the study
of organizational culture. Journal of Management Inquiry, 21(1), 88–93.
https://doi.org/10.1177/1056492611419792.
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
https://doi.org/10.1177/1056492611415279
https://nsuworks.nova.edu/tqr/vol20/iss2/12
https://doi.org/10.1177/1056492611419792
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
7
Foxes and Lions: How Institutional Leaders
Keep Organisational Integrity
and Introduce Change
Marta Struminska-Kutra and Harald Askeland
Introduction
Theoretical considerations presented in this chapter develop empirical
findings from multiple case studies of Polish public administration enti-
ties struggling to adapt to field-level changes in governance patterns
(Bevir, 2011; Gilardi & Radaelli, 2012; Strumińska-Kutra, 2018), par-
ticularly to environmental pressures for more inclusive and participa-
tory public management. With the emergence of these pressures, public
agencies in many Western and Central-Eastern European (CEE) coun-
tries have begun to function within institutional pluralism—between
the traditional, hierarchically oriented paradigm of public administra-
tion (PA), the market-oriented paradigm of New Public Management
(NPM), and the network-oriented paradigm of New Public Governance
M. Struminska-Kutra (B) · H. Askeland
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: marta.struminska@vid.no
H. Askeland
e-mail: harald.askeland@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_7
117
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_7&domain=pdf
mailto:marta.struminska@vid.no
mailto:harald.askeland@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_7
118 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
(NPG) (Kordasiewicz & Sadura, 2017). Each of these paradigms priori-
tises different logics, promotes different values and delivers a different
frame for their interpretation. Consequently, each provides a different
way of conceptualising the public administration’s identity and role in
society. Hence, in order to keep legitimacy, public agencies must learn
to perform accordingly.
We adopt the institutional leadership perspective by asking: How lead-
ers build organisational structures that embody new goals and values while
at the same time keeping organisational integrity? While changing their
own organisations, how do they gain cooperation from internal and
external constituencies and reconcile otherwise conflicting tendencies?
We review public administration leaders’ interactions with internal and
external constituencies to show how leaders choose different strategies of
adaptation. Some act as ‘foxes’, working to associate new rules and prac-
tices with old ones. Others represent ‘lions’, whose goal is to secure the
survival of innovations and prevent them from drift or co-optation. This
typology of leaders-innovators, briefly mentioned by Selznick, represents
indispensable features of institutional leadership that combine cohesive
force for change with an understanding that winning consent for new
directions depends on how secure the participants feel (Selznick, 1957,
p. 153). We explore these two types and supplement them with two oth-
ers. The strategy of an ‘ostrich’ responds to environmental pressures for
change by faking innovation, or using new rhetoric while in fact resorting
to routine. A ‘mole’ does not even notice new qualities of the situation
and reinterprets new expectations in the old, routinised frames. Norma-
tively speaking, the latter two types escape from the true functions of
leadership that are about defining (new) ends in the face of ambiguity
and pluralism, designing an enterprise adapted to these ends, and ensur-
ing that the design becomes a living reality (Selznick, 1957, p. 37).
We contribute to the literature on institutional leadership in two
ways. First, we complement a dominant focus on the backward-leaning
orientation of institutional leaders (Washington, Boal, & Davis, 2008)
by exploring their future-oriented, innovative side. Using the concept
of institutional work; purposive action aimed at creating, maintaining
and disrupting institutions (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006), we illustrate
how leaders intentionally work to change organisations and their values.
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 119
We argue that their actions manifest either through projective, future-
oriented agency or through habitual agency by selecting among a set of
established routines. Reference to projective and habitual agency con-
stitutes our second contribution, emphasising that institutional leaders
act in an arena that is never empty of institutions. In particular, the
leader herself is an institutionally embedded individual whose patterns
of thinking and acting are conditioned by field-level and organisational
institutions. In this messy environment, leaders struggle to build struc-
tures that reflect new goals and internalise different or even conflicting
values, as well as even deinstitutionalise some. Our typology explicates
ways in which leaders respond to these challenges.
Consistent with the aim of this book, we explore how values come into
play in situations of institutional pluralism.1 Our argument is developed
in two sections. First, we present Selznick’s concept of institutional lead-
ership. Then, we link neo-institutional approaches, nested in the field-
level perspective (isomorphism), with the micro-level perspective (insti-
tutional work). We present leaders as those who perform the institutional
work of translating (plural) field-level logics into organisational struc-
tures, as well as those who negotiate the shape of organisational struc-
tures with actors both inside and outside of the organisation. The sec-
ond section presents the typology of leaders/innovators responding to
environmental pressures for change by reaching to old and new institu-
tional scripts. We conclude by comparing the strategies and reflect on
their effectiveness within the context of institutional pluralism.
Institutional Leadership: Linking Field,
Organisation and Actor Levels
The idea of institutional leadership—the promotion and protection of
values (Selznick, 1957, p. 28)—does not appear often in contemporary
theoretical discussions (Kraatz, 2009; Kraatz & Block, 2017). When
it does, it tends to be perceived as conservative and backward leaning
1Such contexts are outlined in the introductory chapter (Askeland, Espedal, Løvaas and Sirris)
and elaborated on in the chapter of Sirris on institutional complexity.
120 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
(Washington et al., 2008). Yet, a forward-looking orientation was promi-
nent in the original concept. According to Selznick (1957), institutional
leaders respond to diverse external pressures by making critical decisions
that affect the basic character of an enterprise, and these critical deci-
sions go beyond the routine, day-to-day solution of problems. They are
about navigating ‘uncharted waters’, making structural changes that, on
the one hand, enable the pursuit of new goals and values and, on the
other, recognise the status quo and its limitations. Institutional leadership
is about decisions having long-running implications for organisational
identity and organisation’s role and meaning in wider societal networks.
These decisions create conditions ‘that will make possible in the future
what is excluded in the present’ (Selznick, 1957, p. 154). Selznick (1957)
argued that such adaptations to new goals ‘require a strategy of change
that looks to the attainment of new capabilities more nearly fulfilling the
truly felt needs and aspirations of the institution’ (p. 154).
Selznick located institutional leaders in a ‘liquid’ and turbulent reality,
where it is not (or no longer) clear for an organisation what it should be
or what it should do. In such circumstances, there are four functions of
institutional leadership: (1) defining values, mission and role entails an
assessment of the organisational commitments set by internal and exter-
nal demands; (2) building structures creates new organisational arrange-
ments that are sensitive to the existing ones, as well as to ways of think-
ing and responding that secure the execution and elaboration of the new
policy; (3) defending integrity means maintaining values and distinctive
identity; (4) ordering internal conflicts means winning the consent of
constituent units in order to maximise voluntary cooperation while keep-
ing the balance of power to maintain the fulfilment of key commitments
(Selznick, 1957, pp. 62–63).
Contemporary accounts of institutional leadership have developed
some aspects of this list. Washington et al. (2008) shifted emphasis
from the internal to external orientation of leaders, claiming that the
leader’s function is to develop external supporting mechanisms, thereby
enhancing the legitimacy of an organisation, and to overcome exter-
nal enemies. While viewing institutional leaders’ actions as institutional
work, Kraatz (2009) supplemented the list with an individual dimen-
sion of self-reflection. He suggested that some leaders should also work
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 121
on themselves and undergo transformations when experiencing ‘complex
and anxiety laden social situations’ (p. 81). Others have reflected on inte-
grative function while referring to the frame of institutional logics, plu-
ralism, complexity, and organisational hybridity (Besharov & Khurana,
2015; Kraatz & Block, 2017). They called for empirically grounded per-
spectives on how leaders develop both an organisational and individual
identity that integrate potentially diverse goals and moralities, as well
as how they foster productive rather than destructive tensions between
potentially conflicting views of who the organisation is and should be.
We will enhance this perspective by investigating institutional and organ-
isational changes in public administration.
Institutional Pluralism and Public Administration
Selznick’s contemporary relevance increases when we consider his refer-
ences to pluralism in an organisation and its environment. Such plural-
ism is exhibited in various expectations about organisational roles and
identity, comes from diverse organisational stakeholders and foreshad-
ows concepts of institutional pluralism and institutional logics (Gawer
& Phillips, 2013; Thornton, Ocasio, & Lounsbury, 2012). Institu-
tional pluralism is the situation faced by an organisation that oper-
ates in multiple institutional spheres. Organisations become multiply
constituted when they have more than one socially sanctioned pur-
pose (Kraatz & Block, 2017). Pluralism creates internal tensions, shifts
objectives and turns administrators into institutional leaders—political
players whose actions and choices ultimately shape the organisation’s
evolution and character. Hence, institutional leadership, when focus-
ing on organisations, becomes a concept of ‘gluing’ field-level consider-
ations with an individual-level analysis of practices, aiming at the main-
tenance, transformation and disruption of institutions. At the organi-
sational level, institutional pluralism becomes an operationalisation of
Selznickean ‘critical experience’ (Selznick, 1957, p. 38), calling for insti-
tutional leadership, where a range of alternative actions are possible and
legitimate, tasks and goals are not defined, and, therefore, routine-based
122 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
decision-making is unsuitable. We explore this issue by empirical exam-
ples of institutional pluralism and leadership in public administration.
The governance turn is observed in many Western and CEE countries
(Denters, 2011). This simultaneous co-evolution of similar patterns of
rule in public administration can be perceived as a process of institutional
isomorphism (DiMaggio & Powell, 1983; Rządca & Strumińska-Kutra,
2016).
Isomorphic pressures are vehicles through which the disjunction
between the values held by society and the behaviour of an organi-
sation is erased. Changes in patterns of rule can be interpreted as a
result of growing expectations for more responsive and inclusive pub-
lic governance. Yet, public agencies still face expectations and pressures
aligned with two other paradigms: PA privileging hierarchical logic and
NPM imposing the quasi-market logic of effectiveness. The presence
of multiple and often conflicting institutional orders, to which public
organisations must adhere, complicates the process of isomorphism and
legitimacy-building. Values pursued by public administrations, such as
social justice and democracy, are understood differently in each of the
paradigms. Within the hierarchical logic, public agencies are the final
link in a chain of democratic representation. Here, executives enact the
‘people’s will’, expressed in general elections. Network-based logic pro-
poses building up societal and democratic consent through collaborative
problem-solving (Ansell, 2011) and participatory forms of democracy.
Market-based logic would build consent around the quality and costs of
public services. Institutional pluralism poses a challenge to leadership in
public administration. Bureaucracy or NPM may be impuissant when
it comes to solving complex social problems, but this does not mean
that we do not need them anymore (Ansell, 2011; Sørensen & Torfing,
2015).
Institutional leadership is located where policy formation and
organisation-building meet (Selznick, 1957, p. 37), and its role is to facil-
itate a dynamic adaptation to the values inherent in policies. In the face
of the governance turn, public leaders are met with several challenges.
First, to maintain or (re)create values and structures characteristic of each
of the three paradigms. Second, to create and maintain meta-level, shared
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 123
values that transcend but do not eliminate paradigmatic divisions (chal-
lenge 2, Besharov & Khurana, 2015). The first requires work on integrity
at the horizontal dimension, translating external expectations into the
organisational structures and negotiating with bottom-up responses and
managing tensions between symbolic (values, ideals) and technical (tools,
procedures) (Besharov & Khurana, 2015).2 The second is placed on a
vertical axis, focusing on creating and maintaining ‘a cap’ that holds the
parts together.
What has been largely omitted, even by Selznick himself, is that
although specific types of institutions might be lacking, it does not
mean that the arena of leaders’ actions is empty of institutions. Con-
cepts of institutional pluralism and ambiguity suggest that social spaces
are never empty of institutions, rather, they can be perceived as insti-
tutional voids that result from conflict and contradiction among insti-
tutional bits and pieces from local political, community and religious
spheres (Mair, Marti, & Ventresca, 2012). Network-based coordination,
typical for NPG, is introduced into a field already governed by diverse
institutions. Even if collaborative approaches are not explicitly built into
the organisational structures of public agencies, the institutional environ-
ment may deliver a more or less productive ground for establishing such
ways of coordination. Horizontal ways of governing are not typical of the
Polish institutional environment, which is the subject of empirical inves-
tigation here (see also Strumińska-Kutra, 2018). As a result, new col-
laborative approaches to public management are more easily interpreted
according to the traditional hierarchical logic of PA, or to the relatively
new but firmly embedded quasi-market logic of NPM. There is a lack of
examples proving that horizontal coordination and partnerships not only
confine the imagination on the realm of the possible but also reduce the
resources necessary to initiate cooperation, most prominently social trust
(Putnam, Leonardi, & Nonetti, 1993). This adds a third challenge for
an institutional leader because institutionalising a new approach means
building new and changing old structures. Some values need to be rein-
terpreted or even removed in order to make a room for new structures.
2See also Askeland’s chapter “Maintaining the good organization” in this volume.
124 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
A fourth challenge is that the institutional leader herself is an institu-
tionally embedded individual (Zietsma & Lawrence, 2010) whose mind-
set and actions are influenced by institutions in a field. This sets her
in the middle of an embedded agency paradox: How do those subject
to the institutions in a field effect changes within them? Paying atten-
tion to leaders’ institutional embeddedness in a cognitive and normative
sense is an important supplementation of Selznick’s concept. His origi-
nal and current contributions portray the leader as a ‘super individual’
whose identity and perception are not affected by cognitive and norma-
tive aspects of institutions. Nevertheless, some of Selznick’s remarks do
connect to this problem of depicting leaders as individuals with the abil-
ity to transcend their own specialisation and who are conscious of their
own weaknesses and potentialities (Selznick, 1957).
The Institutional Embodiment of Purpose:
Strategies for (Not) Building Integrity While
(Not) Introducing Change
In this section, we take a closer look at these challenges by utilising
empirical illustrations3 of public administration leaders involved in pro-
cesses towards more inclusive and collaborative governing patterns. In
Poland, the beginning of these processes was marked by the decentralisa-
tion reform introduced in the late-1990s and the introduction of legisla-
tion on public participation and access to information at the beginning
of the 2000s. The process accelerated in anticipation of EU accession
in 2004. The leaders under analysis were acting upon public disputes
understood as conflicts ‘involving governmental entities and other stake-
holders, such as individual citizens, business firms or organisations, over
policy priorities, standards, or resources they hope to share’ (Susskind,
2000, p. 130). Public disputes are instances where public administration
3Empirical investigation was conducted in years 2007–2017 and includes various types of data
(interviews, archival sources, notes from observations) covering the time span between 1998
and 2017. Research was funded by the Polish Ministry of Science and Higher Education under
the grant number: 2011/01/B/HS4/04935 and by Kozminski University.
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 125
comes under direct pressure to implement ideals and regulations follow-
ing an inclusive and collaborative logic of new policies. In the follow-
ing examples, stakeholders demanded that public agencies enact partic-
ipatory modes of governance, organise dialogue where all parties could
express preferences and exchange knowledge in response to a given prob-
lem. They insisted that their values and knowledge be somehow included
in solutions devised to address given policy dilemmas. Since the regu-
lations and policies were new, organisational structures enabling their
implementation either needed to be created or were in place but had
hardly been practised. Institutional leadership was needed to create new
structures and infuse them with vales (and meanings).
Habitual and Projective Agency
The introduction of new, collaborative logic and policy, accelerated by
public disputes, questioned the goals and tools of public agencies and
disrupted their routines. Following Selznick, we see disruption of rou-
tines as a disruption of logics commonly used to solve problems in the
organisation (Selznick, 1957, p. 36). Dispute has the potential to create a
‘critical experience’ affecting the character of an organisation. This is the
situation where distinct qualities of institutional leadership can be found.
In order to create conditions ‘that will make possible in the future what is
excluded in the present’ (Selznick 1957, p. 154), leaders perform institu-
tional work (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006). They make critical decisions
about how new regulations are to be understood and implemented in
practice (Kraatz, 2009).
Selznick’s leaders use projective agency, oriented at the formation and
implementation of a new policy. Either they are foxes devising new
programmes and techniques in cooperation with conservative elements,
or lions, who secure innovations need for survival (Selznick, 1957,
p. 112). Both roles require institutional innovation and entrepreneur-
ship (DiMaggio, 1988; Maguire, Hardy, & Lawrence, 2004; Zietsma &
Lawrence, 2010). Such leaders ‘deal with current issues not for them-
selves alone but for their long run implications for the role and meaning
of the group’ (Selznick, 1957, p. 37).
126 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
Yet, in practice, a failure to set goals, or only their superficial accepta-
tion, is quite common. Below we shift attention to less explored institu-
tional sources of leadership failures. We suggest that leaders may also use
habitual agency that replicates existing patterns of thinking and acting.
Combining habitual and projective agency in analysing leaders’
responses to pressures enables us to capture both how those subject to
institutions in the field can implement changes and, more or less con-
sciously, resist them. The latter in particular opens a venue for the explo-
ration of cognitive aspects of institutional leadership since it addresses
questions of institutional inertia (Hallet & Ventresca, 2006; Kraatz &
Block, 2017; Mahoney & Thelen, 2010). Following a previous analy-
sis (Strumińska-Kutra, 2018), we combined two types of institutional
work: practice work, understood as developing and legitimising prac-
tices, and identity work, or developing and legitimising roles and iden-
tities (Gawer &Phillips, 2013; Svenningsson & Alvesson, 2003; Zietsma
& Lawrence, 2010) with habitual and projective agency. This analyti-
cal exercise enables the capturing of actions oriented to the creation of
qualitatively new solutions (following a new logic) from actions oriented
at proposing ‘the same but in a new wrapping’ (following the old logic)
(Table 7.1).
Table 7.1 Institutional work around logic shifts
Habitual agency Projective agency
Identity work Developing and legitimizing
new identities within the
framework of the old
logic
Striving to develop and
legitimize new roles and
identities within the
framework of the new
logic
Practice work Developing and legitimizing
new practices within the
framework of the old
logic
Striving to develop and
legitimize new practices
within the framework of
the new logic
Source Strumińska-Kutra, 2018
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 127
Empirical Illustrations
We analyse leaders who faced isomorphic pressures for implementing
participatory governance patterns. The pressures were accelerated by
public disputes/conflict over policy priorities and standards. The first dis-
pute concerned the closing of a school in a small rural community. The
solution was to be formulated and the decision taken at the lowest level
of public administration, which is the municipality. The mayor of the
municipality enacted new regulations within the market and hierarchical
narratives. Similar patterns of institutional inertia manifested in the case
of a dispute over the construction of a flood prevention facility. Here, the
director of an agency was responsible for organising public participation
frames according to a hierarchical logic in which experts and bureaucrats
were those who had the knowledge and made the decisions, while the
public was the one who needed to be educated.
The two remaining disputes—over the location of a marketplace and
of a wastewater treatment plant—took place in the same large city and
the responsibility for planning and decision-making was split between
the municipality and the province level. Two province-level leaders occu-
pying the vice president position played a major role in the dispute
over the marketplace. First, the vice president ‘faked’ participation to
restore legitimacy and control—he ceremonially praised it without cre-
ating organisational structures to make it realistic. The second vice presi-
dent (successor to the first) engaged in participatory practices and build-
ing narratives praising and justifying direct democracy and collaborative
decision-making.
The analysis of dispute around the wastewater treatment plant brought
the director of the Social Communication Department at the city admin-
istration to the forefront. He exploited opportunities created by external
pressures in order to build organisational structures that facilitated access
to public information, public participation and conflict mediation.4
The Mole: critical reflection on one’s own specialism involves the abil-
ity to question one’s own normative and cognitive patterns that guide
thinking and acting on a problem. This ability is necessary to create
4For an extensive exploration of the cases, see Struminska-Kutra (2018).
128 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
structures that go beyond static, routine-based adaptations. Without it,
leaders continue business as usual by reinterpreting new expectations
within routinised frames, not noticing new angles to the situation. For
two of the leaders investigated in this analysis, the major obstacle in cre-
ating and practising new rules was that the new logic contradicted their
belief system, particularly their convictions about professional identities
and practices.
The mayor responsible for the decision regarding the closed school
had no doubts about the roles of the parties involved in the dispute.
She reconstructed them according to well-established institutional log-
ics: citizens and non-public organisations are those who listen and vote
or possibly deliver feedback regarding satisfaction with government deci-
sions and services. When, at a council meeting, she was pressured for a
public discussion on possible solutions to the school problem, she stated:
…once the resolution (about what to do) is adopted, I can officially con-
sult people. I do not know what the Council’s decision will be and I do
not know what to ask the community. By reaching out to the community
(after the resolution), we will know their opinion (…) We need to take a
decision. I think this procedure is consistent with the letter of the law.
Identity work reinforces the work directed at developing and legitimis-
ing new practices, again within an old, habitual frame. Since the mayor
could not imagine citizens contributing to the development of ideas,
she advanced the solution herself, arguing for the need to vote over the
proposed solution at council meetings. Having a resolution accepted by
the council, she considered it ready for public consideration. The par-
ticular perception of the role played by citizens and officials also con-
tributed to the creation of a bulletin that was to educate citizens on how
public management processes work and why certain decisions, even if
unpopular, need to be made. The same logic is visible in the eventually
institutionalised practice of consulting citizens in quasi-surveys, asking
whether they would accept or reject solutions developed by officials and
councillors.
A similar mechanism of mutual reinforcement of practice and iden-
tity work was observed in the case of flood prevention facilities, where
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 129
the perception of identities influenced practice work. The public agency
director responsible for public consultation saw experts and officials as
the owners of a superior knowledge. Thus, for him public consulta-
tions were about providing local communities with technical knowledge,
allowing them to understand that the proposed solution was suitable:
‘We have done it as usual: calmly, argumentatively, providing technical
and professional information (…) We wanted to explain that we were
doing the right thing’ (interview, October 2013).
Importantly, each of the two leaders was motivated by a certain under-
standing of professional ethos, of doing what is right. They believed that
their interpretation of participatory approaches was valuable.
The ‘ostrich’ responds to pressures for change by creating the appear-
ance of compliance. This strategy was adopted by the city vice presi-
dent, who was involved in the dispute over closing a local market. City
authorities made the decision about the closure in order to use the area
for building blocks of flats. The decision was made without consulting
the local community, and it broke previous agreements with municipal
authorities and merchants. When faced with protests, the vice president
engaged in institutional work by developing ad hoc participatory prac-
tices. First, city authorities invited local community members to select
among the projects of blocks. Since the project was the very reason for
the protests, this did not calm the public. Then, two public meetings
were organised. During the first meeting, the vice president and officials
heard the opinions of the local community; during the second, held a
year later, they presented a project modified in accordance with some of
the requests. Protests escalated, and yet city authorities did not act on the
problem for another two years. In the meantime, the vice president offi-
cially declared the authorities were going through ‘the process of learning’
to deal with public participation. Two years later, the vice president was
approached by a group of researchers and urban activists, who proposed
a mediation of the conflict. He agreed and appointed a representative for
the city in the mediation process. Importantly, he neither equipped this
person with special prerogatives nor gave his own active support. Media-
tion failed, and in the report announcing a closure, mediators explained:
130 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
Despite detailed explanations of mediation principles and goals, Director
X [appointed by the vice president] stated that she could not act as an
actual representative of the city in the mediation process and that the
procedure described by mediators was not defined in regulations govern-
ing the work of city authorities (…) A serious obstacle in the process of
disseminating dialogue and consultation is the lack of unambiguous legal
and procedural regulations which would justify and explain to citizens
their access to civic dialogue.
The institutional work of the leader was not directed at re-defining
the role of public administration during collaborative processes. It was
instead focused on faking participatory approaches in order to restore
legitimacy and keep control over decision-making, thereby avoiding crit-
ical decisions that could change how the organisation operated. His strat-
egy was to wait out the conflict. The vice president did not risk any sig-
nificant losses in terms of legitimacy, instead deciding to abstain from
action. Merchants and local community representatives were just one of
many groups involved in the many decision-making processes he had
supervised over the years. Faking change was just enough to survive and
remain in power.
Foxes: leaders who adopt the strategy of ‘foxes’ avoid confrontation
with old structures by offering space where new practices can be imple-
mented along with old practices, as well as a narrative of how new and
old identities can be complementary and valuable at the same time. This
approach was adopted by the Director of Social Communication Depart-
ment (SCD), a unit created during a conflict over a wastewater treatment
plant. Interestingly, this leader used the opportunity not to solve the
conflict but to institutionalise the collaborative identities and practices
in city administration structures. He skilfully built up the new depart-
mental identity as being complementary to established identities. The
following narrative from an interview illustrates the tactic:
They [officials from different departments] come to us when they face
a conflict, because they are afraid and do not know how to deal with
it (…) We need to combine the knowledge of experts representing dif-
ferent parties: those who use the city, those who manage it (officials),
and experts in a given domain (for example, architects). Each of them
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 131
thinks she knows best, but they know different things. Officials have a
vast knowledge of procedures, they know what is allowed, and happens
elsewhere. The experts know what can be done from the technical point
of view. Citizens know, because they use the city every day. We facilitate
the coordination of these perspectives; we make them respect each other
to see the complementarity of their knowledge.
By building this integrative identity, he reduced internal tensions
between the original organisational identity and new practices associ-
ated with the new logic (Svenningsson & Alvesson, 2003). He effectively
used social skills (Fligstein & McAdam, 2012) to build social relation-
ships, helping the organisation to cope with uncertainty and anxiety from
the inevitable effects of institutional pluralism (Kraatz & Block, 2017).
Additionally, he combined the support of external environments, pro-
moting participation with the internal support of the city president, who
commissioned the creation of the department yet did not equipped it
with financial resources. By actively reaching out to the external environ-
ment, he attracted professionals skilled in organising participation and
financing from European Economic Area grants. He organised exper-
imental public consultation processes in all municipalities of the city.
Thus, he created opportunities for practice work, which is institutional
work focused on establishing new patterns of action. He personally nego-
tiated the financial and structural conditions of projects’ implementa-
tion, which eventually resulted in setting up positions of public consul-
tation officials in each municipality. In the following years, the director
and his employees either established or supported the creation of new
organisational structures, enabling public participatory action. Among
others, there was the Public Consultation Platform, a register of all past
and current consultation processes, and a city-level regulation defining
public consultation and making it compulsory to announce each consul-
tation process held by the city administration authorities on the Public
Consultation Platform.
Lions: the goal of ‘lions’ is to secure the survival of innovations and
to prevent them from drift or co-optation. They protect new, vulnerable
132 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
structures from being taken over by opportunistic interest or reinterpre-
tation that is inconsistent with the original ‘spirit’. Hence, their strate-
gies are more confrontational and may involve the deinstitutionalisation
of organisational structures, contradicting new mission. The second vice
president, also involved in the dispute over the marketplace, offers an
example of this confrontational type. He entered the scene when the fail-
ing experiment with mediation was still ongoing. He refused, however, to
follow in the former vice president’s footsteps, instead taking back con-
trol of the process. He constructed a new, temporary structure, a working
group, on the interface of city administration, municipality administra-
tion and external stakeholders’ organisations. He established communi-
cation channels between these stakeholders and personally coordinated
the process of designing solutions for the market. Importantly, although
the new vice president shared the ideological orientation of collabora-
tive approaches to governance, at the time, he had no experience in
governing multi-stakeholder processes. What made the new vice presi-
dent prone to learning new governance modes was a strong conviction
that involving external stakeholders was the right thing to do, as well
as social skills (Fligstein & McAdam, 2012). The latter enabled him to
create trust-based relationships with external constituents and organise
collective action, combining actors from different levels and ‘siloes’ of
public administration and external stakeholders.
Having a formal position of power, the new vice president was able to
design new practices and make his subordinates follow them, even if it
meant going against institutionalised methods and officials’ convictions
about their roles. Within new processes, the role of the members of the
administration was to discuss different solutions with the community
and merchants’ representatives and to provide information about any
procedural and material aspects of the situation. Importantly, employees
trying to work according to the new collaborative logic received substan-
tial support and could further learn and improve their practice. In this
particular case, these were street-level bureaucrats, directly responsible for
managing the market area, who were in touch with merchants on a daily
basis.
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 133
Along with introducing new practices, the new vice president per-
formed institutional work by building narratives that justified new prac-
tices and identities and built organisational integrity around them. The
most prominent example was the ‘there-is-no-alternative’ narrative about
replacing the hierarchical approach to public management with a partic-
ipatory approach. First, he claimed that such a replacement was a real-
ity and second, a historical necessity, a sign that a public management
structure was becoming ‘civilised’ (an original expression used by the
vice president). When describing the hierarchical approach, he directly
questioned the assumption of representative democracy in which citizens
delegate power to politicians who then solve public problems through
public administration. He framed this approach as obsolete and old-
fashioned.
In 2006, you would hear such opinions everywhere. They would argue in
favour of the iron rule of representative democracy and ask: if we should
have direct participation and consultation, what are the councillors for? I
hear such voices now, but no one dares say it out loud.
The major line of his argument was very different from the one used by
the director of the SCD. Both believed in participatory approaches and
promoted them, but the SCD director worked with a more inclusive,
conciliatory strategy.
Conclusions
Institutions are broadly understood as ‘the rules of the game’ that direct
and circumscribe organisational behaviour (Kraatz & Block, 2017). Pub-
lic agencies facing the three paradigms play in three games simultane-
ously. Historically speaking, they were made to play according to a hier-
archical logic. Then, in the 1980s, institutional pressures for the adop-
tion of market logic emerged. In the 1990s came the next shift, this time
towards network-based, collaborative approaches to governance. Each of
the logic sediments in organisational structures influences the way new
organisational practices and identities are perceived (van de Bovenkamp,
134 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
Stoopendaal, & Bal, 2017). Whenever projective agency is used to cre-
ate innovative solutions according to a new logic, there is a risk that old,
deeper-rooted logic prevails, and what was supposed to be qualitatively
different turns out to be an old thing in a new wrapping. Hence, the four
challenges that institutional pluralism poses for an institutional leader in
public administration are the challenges of maintaining and (re)creating
structures that are characteristic of each paradigm; creating meta-level
integrating values; deinstitutionalising some of the original structures;
and transcending their own institutional embeddedness.
Our typology illustrates the responses to these challenges by trac-
ing how leaders build organisational institutions that embody new
goals and values while keeping organisational integrity. First, ‘moles’
and ‘ostriches’, use routinised patterns of thinking and acting (habit-
ual agency) when creating new structures for collaboration. Yet, only the
second can be accused of opportunism: the pursuit of immediate, short-
term political advantages (Selznick, 1957, p. 143). The ‘ostrich’ performs
institutional work that is strategically focused on creating the appearance
of compliance. Since he/she is faking change in response to pressures,
her/his orientation is towards external not internal publics. The insti-
tutional work she performs addresses practices (visible from the outside)
not identity work. ‘Ostriches’ only address the first challenge of structure
creation, though in a selective and opportunistic way. The ‘moles’ are
not opportunistic because, despite their habitual orientation, their work
is values-based. She develops and legitimises new practices and identities
within the old logic because that is the only logic she knows and believes
in. This is also how she answers the challenge of integration, through the
act of translation from new to old. She neutralises the tensions between
logics by re-establishing old order.
‘Foxes’ and ‘lions’ use projective agency; infusing new forms and con-
tents into organisational practices and identities. ‘Foxes’ build a struc-
ture while keeping the diverse paradigms in a creative tension and build
an integrating narrative of complementarity and dialogue. For ‘foxes’,
organisational integrity means wholeness rather than consistency, build-
ing structures that transcend but do not eliminate paradigmatic divisions
(Besharov & Khurana, 2015). In contrast, ‘lions’ aim for consistency.
They use a confrontational strategy, which comes with the danger of
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 135
organisational integration manifesting through the colonisation of the
old paradigms by the new. Interestingly, this same danger is caused by
the strategy of a ‘mole’, although projective agency provides the coloni-
sation act with future-oriented not past-oriented content.
Only ‘foxes’ and ‘lions’ engage with the third challenge of deinstitu-
tionalising some of the organisational patterns of thinking and acting.
The strategy of the ‘lion’ evolves through confrontation. This poses the
risk of subordinating one logic to the other and, hence, it is less fitting
in the situation of institutional pluralism.
The fourth challenge of transcending one’s own cognitive and norma-
tive embeddedness is indirectly addressed by the ‘fox’. A ‘fox’ works at the
interface of different logics by advancing a meta-level value of dialogue.
By being exposed to various interpretations of the same values,5 she is
more prone to engage in critical reflection upon her own understand-
ings and actions. Moreover, by creating the structures for communica-
tion between perspectives, she builds a reflexive capacity into the organ-
isation. In this sense, she provides an institutional leadership model that
fits institutional pluralism best. It is also a model that best exploits con-
ditions of pluralism to create opportunities for evolutionary for public
good (Ansell, 2011).
References
Ansell, C. (2011). Pragmatist democracy: Evolutionary learning as public philoso-
phy. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Besharov, M. L., & Khurana, R. (2015). Leading amidst competing technical
and institutional demands: Revisiting Selznick’s conception of leadership. In
K. Matthew (Ed.), Institutions and ideals: Philip Selznick’s legacy for organi-
zational studies (pp. 53–88). Bingley: Emerald.
Bevir, M. (2011). Democratic governance: A genealogy. Local Government
Studies, 37 (1), 3–17. https://doi.org/10.1080/03003930.2011.539860.
Denters, B. (2011). Local governance. In M. Bevir (Ed.), The SAGE Handbook
of Governance. London: Sage.
5For reflection about ambiguity of values, see Askeland, de Silva in this volume.
https://doi.org/10.1080/03003930.2011.539860
136 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
DiMaggio, P. (1988). Interest and agency in institutional theory. In L. G.
Zucker (Ed.), Institutional patterns and organizations: Culture and environ-
ment. Cambridge, MA: Ballinger.
DiMaggio, P., & Powell, W. (1983). The iron cage revisited: Institutional iso-
morphism and collective rationality in organizational fields. American Soci-
ological Review, 48, 147–160.
Fligstein, N., & McAdam, D. (2012). A theory of fields. Oxford: Oxford Uni-
versity Press.
Gawer, A., & Phillips, N. (2013). Institutional work as logics shift: The case of
intel’s transformation to platform leader. Organization Studies, 34(8), 1035–
1071. https://doi.org/10.1177/0170840613492071.
Gilardi, F., & Radaelli, C. M. (2012). Governance and learning. In D. Levi-
Faur (Ed.), The Oxford handbook of governance (pp. 155–168). Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Hallet, T., & Ventresca, M. (2006). Inhabited institutions: Social interactions
and organizational forms in Gouldner’s “patterns of industrial bureaucracy”.
Theory and Society, 35(2), 213–236.
Kordasiewicz, A., & Sadura, P. (2017). Clash of public administration
paradigms in delegation of education and elderly care services in a post-
socialist state (Poland). Public Management Review, 19(6), 785–801. https://
doi.org/10.1080/14719037.2016.1210903.
Kraatz, M. (2009). Leadership as institutional work: A bridge to the other side.
In T. B. Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca (Eds.), Institutional work: Actors
and agency in institutional studies of organizations (pp. 59–91). New York:
Cambridge University Press.
Kraatz, M., & Block, E. (2017). Institutional pluralism revisited. In R.
Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B. Lawrence, & R. E. Meyer (Eds.), The SAGE
handbook of organizational institutionalism (Vol. 2, pp. 635–662). London:
Sage.
Lawrence, T. B., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work.
In S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. B. Lawrence, & W. Nord (Eds.), The SAGE
handbook of organization studies (pp. 215–254). London: Sage.
Maguire, S., Hardy, C., & Lawrence, T. B. (2004). Institutional entrepreneur-
ship in emerging fields: HIV/AIDS treatment advocacy in Canada. Academy
of Management Review, 47 (5), 657–679.
Mahoney, J., & Thelen, K. (2010). Explaining institutional change ambiguity,
agency, and power. New York: Cambridge University Press.
Mair, J., Marti, M., & Ventresca, M. (2012). Building inclusive markets in
rural Bangladesh: How intermediaries work institutional voids. Academy of
https://doi.org/10.1177/0170840613492071
https://doi.org/10.1080/14719037.2016.1210903
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional … 137
Management Journal, 55(4), 819–850. https://doi.org/10.5465/amj.2010.
0627.
Putnam, R., Leonardi, R., & Nonetti, R. (1993). Making democracy work.
Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Rządca, R., & Strumińska-Kutra, M. (2016). Local governance and learning:
In search of a conceptual framework. Local Government Studies, 42(6), 916–
937. https://doi.org/10.1080/03003930.2016.1223632.
Selznick, P. (1957). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpretation.
Berkeley and Los Angeles, CA: University of California Press.
Sørensen, E., & Torfing, J. (2015). Enhancing public innovation through col-
laboration, leadership and New Public Governance. In New frontiers in social
innovation research (pp. 145–169). London: Palgrave Macmillan.
Strumińska-Kutra, M. (2018). Democratizing public management: Towards
practice-based theory. New York: Palgrave Macmillan.
Susskind, L. (2000). Confessions of a public dispute mediator. Negotiation Jour-
nal, 16 (2), 129–132. https://doi.org/10.1111/nejo.2000.16.issue-2.
Svenningsson, S., & Alvesson, M. (2003). Managing managerial identities:
Organizational fragmentation, discourse and identity struggle. Human Rela-
tions, 56 (10), 1163–1193.
Thornton, P. H., Ocasio, W., & Lounsbury, M. (2012). The institutional logic
perspective: A new approach to culture, structure and process. Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
van de Bovenkamp, H. M., Stoopendaal, A., & Bal, R. (2017). Working with
layers: The governance and regulation of healthcare quality in an institution-
ally layered system. Public Policy and Administration, 32(1), 45–65. https://
doi.org/10.1177/0952076716652934.
Washington, M., Boal, K., & Davis, J. (2008). Institutional leadership: Past,
present, and future. In R. Suddaby, K. Sahlin-Andersson, C. Oliver, & R.
Greenwood (Eds.), The SAGE handbook of organizational institutionalism
(pp. 719–733). London: Sage.
Zietsma, C., & Lawrence, T. B. (2010). Institutional Work in the transforma-
tion of an organizational field: The interplay of boundary work and practice
work. Administrative Science Quarterly, 55(2), 189–221.
https://doi.org/10.5465/amj.2010.0627
https://doi.org/10.1080/03003930.2016.1223632
https://doi.org/10.1111/nejo.2000.16.issue-2
https://doi.org/10.1177/0952076716652934
138 M. Struminska-Kutra and H. Askeland
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
8
Institutional Leadership: Maintaining
and Developing the ‘Good’ Organisation
Harald Askeland
Introduction
Drawing on data from a case study in a faith-based health organisa-
tion (FBO), this chapter addresses how leaders work intentionally with
values through forms of work. Such values work sheds light on critical
functions of institutional leadership, namely the ‘infusion of values’, as
coined by Selznick. Addressing the renewed interest in institutional lead-
ership (Kraatz, 2009; Kraatz & Flores, 2015; Raffaelli & Glynn, 2015),
the chapter utilises Selznick’s identification of basic functions of institu-
tional leadership (Selznick, 1957/1984, pp. 62–63) and elaborates how
values work relates to mission, character and the embodiment of values
in organisations. The discussion explores how leaders, through ongoing
efforts and the recurring facilitation of processes, relate mission, values
and character of the organisation.
H. Askeland (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: harald.askeland@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_8
139
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_8&domain=pdf
mailto:harald.askeland@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_8
140 H. Askeland
This chapter argues that values work enacts such value infusion.
Selznick (1957/1984), unlike the more rational organisational contribu-
tions, emphasises that organisations consist of individuals and constitute
a vibrant social scene. Institutionalisation intertwines with the organisa-
tion’s development over time, shaping a distinctive history. In this pro-
cess, leaders exert agency that is underexplored in institutional and values
work research.
Institutional leadership concerns establishing and protecting institu-
tional values and character. Its orientation is argued to be more towards
self-maintenance and less leaning towards a future or change orienta-
tion (Washington, Boal, & Davis, 2008). Selznick, on the contrary, ends
his essay by underscoring how institutional leadership requires strate-
gies of change that realise the needs and aspirations of the organisation
(Selznick, 1957/1984, p. 154). Some contributions actually address how
leaders contribute to either institutional creation (Struminska-Kutra,
2018), maintenance through adaption (Askeland, 2014), change (Kraatz
& Moore, 2002) or the fundamental practices of institutional leadership
(Beaton, 2017). Leadership is important in understanding how values
work contributes to development, extending the traditional concep-
tion of institutional leadership. Golant and colleagues show how man-
agers contribute to a temporal consistency by contextualising inherited
value commitments through identity work (Golant, Sillince, Harvey,
& Maclean, 2015). Consistent with the intention of this book, and
responding to the call to supplement research in institutional work
(Hampel, Lawrence, & Tracey, 2015), this chapter addresses the who and
how by exploring the work of leaders as intentional efforts of infusing
values.
Institutional theory often represents a macro- perspective (DiMaggio
& Powell, 1991; Meyer & Rowan, 1991). Yet, there was a parallel interest
in the agentic and creative ways in which organisations and leaders incul-
cate and reflect their institutional pluralistic contexts (Suddaby, 2010).
Organisations facing pluralistic institutional contexts constitute salient
cases to study institutional leadership, responding to changing and/or
contradicting external and internal audiences.
FBOs originated primarily to give expression to the social, moral
and/or religious values of their founders and supporters (Jeavons, 1992).
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 141
They developed into voluntary or professional organisations, with self-
imposed identities and missions derived from religious traditions and act-
ing independently to promote the realisation of the common good (Aske-
land, 2011). Historically, religious organisations and FBOs played an
influential role as carriers of values associated with the common good
(Lorentzen, 1998; O’Neill, 1992), such as welfare provision, tending to
the needs of the community and caring for the sick and needy (Fokas,
2011). FBOs in Scandinavia operate autonomously in relation to both
religious communities and public agencies. Within a context of institu-
tional pluralism (Kraatz & Block, 2017), FBOs are constituted and oper-
ating on the boundaries of differing fields. This encourages continuous
work on mission, values and character (Kraatz, 2009), making leaders
positioned to influence organisational evolution and character.
Empirical research illustrates the theoretical considerations of this
chapter, by utilising publications from prior case studies at the Røysum-
tunet Foundation. Firstly, the chapter contributes to previous research
by integrating values work with the concept of institutional leadership.
Secondly, it offers an agentic process perspective, analysing how leaders
contribute to institutionalising the mission, values and character through
ongoing and recurring organisational processes.
Relating Values Work and Institutional
Leadership
Selznick was interested in how organisations evolved into institutions by
developing a distinct character and labelled the work of leaders to infuse
them with values as institutional leadership (Selznick, 1957). Claim-
ing that ideational, change and agentic aspects were lacking in research,
authors voiced the need for understanding institutional change as related
to intentional, resourceful and strategic efforts. Coined as institutional
work (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006), it pointed at the possibility to estab-
lish ‘a broader vision of agency in relationship to institutions’ (Suddaby,
2010, p. 16). This emphasis sparked interest in different kinds of such
work (Phillips & Lawrence, 2012; Suddaby & Foster, 2014). Of par-
ticular interest for this chapter is values work (Aadland et al., 2006;
142 H. Askeland
Askeland, 2014; Gehman, Trevino, & Garud, 2013; Vaccaro & Palazzo,
2015).1 Leaders perform values work as they become involved in the
reflexive and skilful articulating and promoting of values and meaning
in organisations, performing a particular set of actions to enhance ongo-
ing knowledge and processes producing value-related practices in specific
situations.
Of particular interest in this institutional context is the question of
how ‘good organisation’ and ‘good ends’ are constructed. The case organ-
isation represents an interesting example, operating within the frame of
a Norwegian public welfare and health policy regime. The issue of ful-
filling their faith-based mission within a secular society and adjusting to
dynamic changes regarding legal, political and professional logics chal-
lenges them. Documented strategies are value overlap, integrating differ-
ent logics into a new conception of values and character or seeing values
as vessels of implicit religious meaning (Askeland et al., 2019; Eurich,
2012; Repstad, 2001).
Due to their responsibilities, vested with authority to initiate and
shape direction, leaders function as key actors. The study of Gehman
et al. demonstrated that values work could occur without executive man-
agers being involved but encouraged studying top executives and their
role in such work. Askeland and Beaton argue that aspects of this are evi-
dent across managerial levels even though they are clearest in the work
and self-perception of top-level executives (Askeland, 2015; Beaton,
2017). Prior Scandinavian research demonstrates how values work is not
solely linked to organisational governance or top-down implementation,
underscoring collective and dialogical aspects of values work even while
being initiated or facilitated by managers (Aadland, 2010; Aadland et al.,
2006; Brytting & Trollestad, 2000; Petersen, 2003). Previous contribu-
tions to values work by leaders look at processes or phases in an organ-
isation’s life (Maierhofer, Rafferty, & Kabanoff, 2003), offering insight
into processes and mechanisms that contribute to value formation and
application in practice.
1See also the chapter on values work by Espedal in this book for a more thorough discussion
on values work.
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 143
A temporal and processual perspective enhances understanding on
the inner life and dynamics of processes, where actors act intention-
ally and knowledgeably, simultaneously embedded in and responding to
specific institutional contexts. Existing studies document that these pro-
cesses manifest themselves through different groups voicing and acting
on concerns or matters (Gehman et al., 2013; Vaccaro & Palazzo, 2015).
Understanding values work as temporally embedded practice, Gehman
and colleagues found the following four key processes: emerging con-
cerns, knotting into action networks, performing practice and circulat-
ing discourses (Gehman et al., 2013, p. 102). Alternatively, Askeland
identified the following four phases of values work: initiating, activating,
articulating and maintaining across different levels of practice (Askeland,
2017, p. 176).
Research Setting
The case organisation is a diaconal institution, a kind of organisation
established from the second half of the nineteenth century shaped by the
moral and faith-based convictions of religious groups within a North-
European Lutheran context (Angell, 2001), conceived as expressions
of the health and social services of the Lutheran church. Over time,
diaconal institutions developed into highly professional organisations.
They operated in close collaboration with, and mostly funded by, public
welfare agencies (Leis-Peters, 2014a, 2014b). Due to this institutional
pluralism, they are subject to differing regimes by their constitution,
embedded within multiple normative orders and possess multiple iden-
tities derived from segments of the plural environment (Kraatz & Block,
2017). Such embeddedness plays out differently related to national con-
text (Göçmen, 2013), depending on institutional changes in religion and
the role of the voluntary sector. The particular welfare and health policies
and established relations to public agencies thus raise particular issues to
consider.
Data were gathered at the Diaconal Foundation Røysum, an indepen-
dent foundation, defining itself as a diaconal institution. The institution
operates on contract with either state-owned health enterprises in the
144 H. Askeland
rehabilitation of epileptics or local municipal agencies offering long-term
care for epileptics as well as psychiatric patients.
Data from a combination of methods, such as participant observa-
tional field-notes, interview transcripts and policy documents form the
material for research utilised in this chapter. In doing so, this chapter
aligns with a need to get to the ‘institutional stories’, construction of
meaning systems and frames for action rather than counting institution-
alised forms (Suddaby, 2010, p. 16). Interviews gave important data on
assessments of actions and their relation to mission, character and values.
Policy documents of the organisation provided the same as they aim at
articulating the missions and espoused values defining the organisation
and represent data on the aspirations and efforts of the board and man-
agers. Process data come from two cycles of organisational values work.
The first process took place in 2006–2007, gathering archival data as
reflected in policy documents and interviews and a previous report from
the case study organisation (Sanna, 2008). A new cycle of values work,
in which I had an opportunity to be a participating observer, started in
the summer of 2016 and concluded in autumn of 2017, with my own
summarising of Cycle II.2
Mission, Character and the Embodiment
of Values
Analysing data, leaders’ efforts to maintain and develop the good organ-
isation evolve through three thematic frames: conceiving of the good
home, participating in the enhancement of the common good and estab-
lishing a shared, embodied understanding of good practices.
2This summary is not published but issued as a report to the Board of the Røysumtunet
Foundation in November 2017.
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 145
Conceiving of the Good Home: Continuity
and Development in Institutionalising the Mission
Temporality was important, as the leaders emphasised connecting to the
founding era (Suddaby & Foster, 2014) in order to contextualise values
work. The Norwegian Association of Deacons established Røysumtunet
in 1965 as an institution of residence and care for epileptics, giving direc-
tion for institutional development according to the basic mission and
values shaping its identity. Such conceptions require legitimation, and
following a diaconal tradition, a central part of organisational identity
formation was related to the concept of ‘a good home’ (Røysumtunet,
2015, p. 14) for groups without sufficient care. The organisational char-
acter captured an orientation towards ‘good professional practice’ in car-
ing and enhancing ‘a good life’ for vulnerable groups.
Underpinning the values driving the establishment of Røysumtunet
was the idea of doing good through the religiously inspired concep-
tion of Christian compassion (diaconia). In the original bylaws, mission
and identity closely related to the Christian faith and tradition, building
professionalism for long-term residence and care. The first CEO, Arne,
framed the mission as being ‘based on Christian values’ and cited the
original bylaws stating care to be ‘a service in the Spirit of Christ’. Erik,
the second and still acting CEO, expressed that institutional practice is
an intentional enactment of ‘Christian motivated compassion’ and the
institution to be ‘part of the diaconal ministry of the Church’. While
the early period marked a direct and articulated link to faith and moral-
ity, the last 20 years represents a broader orientation imbuing values-
expressions with both faith-based and universal formulations.
As establishing institutions requires funding, the founders worked the
ground for approval by forming networks and alliances with medical
authorities and public agencies (Røysumtunet, 2015). The founders had
a pragmatic view on this issue, collaborating with public agencies pro-
vided allies for performing the common good but also meant possibil-
ities for funding (Tønnessen, 2005). Both CEOs underscored a non-
conflictual relationship to public agencies.
146 H. Askeland
Symbolic acts conveying religious meaning marked the opening of the
institution as the prior farm buildings underwent a ritual of consecra-
tion in the presence of representatives of public agencies and local civic
organisations. Throughout its history, residents had lived their lives and
interacted closely with communal life in the local community. These
historical lines established a basic understanding of mission, character
and values maintained and adjusted through ongoing work and recurring
cycles of values work. Publishing 30- and 50-year anniversary booklets,
the CEOs edited one each, were deliberate efforts to narrate and connect
the contemporary mission and character with the founding period of the
organisation.
The first CEO stayed at his post for 30 years, contributing to basic
shaping of mission and identity. The second CEO took on the task of
renewing and broadening the organisation’s scope and services, adding
psychiatric care to the original care for epileptics. He articulated it thusly:
‘Most of our residents consider Røysumtunet as their home, and this
goes whether they stay for one or twenty years. Accordingly, we provide
services aimed at living a full life; it’s not just about care but concerns
social life, leisure and even spiritual nurturing of differing faiths’.
The strategic plans of the period display a balancing of history and
contemporary strategic opportunities, defining future mission, objectives
and profile. Characteristic of the plans is a professional strategic assess-
ment of the current reforms of health care in Norway as well as relations
to external institutions and cooperative partners. Emphasis is put on the
issue of economic growth as fundamental for a secure economy. They
also display work of developing a profile and values during the period
to be strategic. Both value process cycles of 2006–2007 and 2016–2017
contributed to developing the institution’s profile. Values were articu-
lated in a more general, humanistic way, underscoring confident, joyful
and mature residents met by professionalised care. The basic mission was
articulated implicitly but was still to ‘conform to the institution’s under-
standing of its diaconal mission, which is to help people in difficult sit-
uations, based on Christian compassion’.
Framing the mission of the organisation within the Christian faith
tradition shows agency by the board and the CEO. Although oper-
ating under premises set by public welfare and health policies, and
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 147
being involved in promoting care and health as the common good, they
labelled arguments for operating in this sector as diaconal. At the same
time, in daily operations an equally important factor for the institution
and the interviewees was to appear as a professionally strong institution
with a particular focus on bringing confidence and quality of life to weak
patient groups through holistic services (Sanna, 2008, p. 9). After the
second cycle, the annual report for 2017 summarised the process by link-
ing these dual rationalities:
Our vision of generosity and competence signals that ‘our diaconal profile
is all about fraternal love and enhancing compassion’ and at the same
time ‘it also expresses an expectation and commitment to performing
competent professional health care’.
The CEO displayed the most evident commitment to the expressed val-
ues and initiated the process but worked closely with the executive group.
The other managers were familiar with and identified with the values.
First-line leaders stated commitment to basic values, emphasising their
indirect effect on practice without articulating them as explicitly reli-
gious. Through critical decisions, both by the initiation and later expan-
sion of organisational services, intentional efforts to define the mission
and role of the organisation were evident—upholding the notion of the
‘good home’ through continuously narrating and adapting its framing
within the given faith tradition.
Leaders’ Contribution to Institutionalising
‘the Common Good’: Value Processes as Conveying
of Character and the Role of the Organisation
The institution underwent a first cycle of values work in 2006–2007 and
engaged in a new cycle in 2016–2017. Both cycles and processes, initi-
ated by the Board and the CEO, partly confirmed and partly reformu-
lated the existing mission and values statements (Askeland, 2014; Sanna,
2008). Choosing an inclusive design, all employees were invited and
148 H. Askeland
expected to participate. The CEO chose a strategy, combining a repre-
sentative project group preparing and summarising two plenary sessions
while 16 smaller groups discussed and prepared plenary input.
At the outset of cycle two of values work in 2016, questions arose
as to how open the process could be. The CEO acknowledged an open
discussion to take place, underscoring this to be a deliberate choice by
the board. He nevertheless signalled some limits regarding upholding the
faith-based identity and mission in particular and not substituting all
core values. The chair of the board together with the CEO gave intro-
ductions at plenary sessions, emphasising the importance of the services
offered and their grounding in values and institutional history.
This paved the way for differing views, highlighting professional and
humanistic aspects of organisational practice. This duality was evident in
the values work process (2016–2017), both in the main project group
and in working groups when presenting their discussions at two plenary
sessions. Expressions of values had two main focal points—they were
resident-oriented and important for performing daily professional prac-
tice. Also expressed, although less prominently, was the diaconal faith-
base of the institution that showed legitimacy and accept among the staff.
Already evident from the first cycle in 2006–2007, much of the aspi-
rations regarding the common good that the organisation enhanced were
articulated and aligned with public health policy documents and human-
istic values (Sanna, 2008). Still, leaders viewed the character and mis-
sion of the organisation in the context of religious tradition but more as
inspiration and argument for the continuing presence of the institution
(Askeland, 2014, p. 160). The second cycle (2016–2017) confirmed this
profile but combined narrating the historical character with renewed and
adjusted articulation of mission and values statements.
The new values chosen, reflected a profile that is distinct compared
to reports on values of business enterprises but also public organisations
(Falkenberg, 2006; Jørgensen, Vrangbæk, & Sørensen, 2009; Wæraas,
2018). While Falkenberg’s study of values in Norwegian enterprises dis-
covered several rationalities or logics, such as economic, moral, relational
and professional values, economic values lacked among the values of
Røysumtunet. Their values related to moral and professional practice and
focused markedly on residents.
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 149
Røysumtunet is a health institution, operating as a service provider for
public health agencies, characterised by public health and professional
values and governed by health care legislation. The legal regulation of
habilitation and rehabilitation stated general values and objectives con-
cerning rights to and quality of services received. The choice of a new
mission statement and values aligned closely with such publicly stated
norms and standards. Røysumtunet chose values that ‘correspond’ with
their own identity (Wæraas, 2010), while institutional health-sector val-
ues were incorporated, with assumed significance for legitimacy by possi-
ble components being given a situational- and institutional-specific com-
position. This way, choice was guided by those values which matter in
the context at hand (Selznick, 1996, p. 271). Given that the organisa-
tion under study already had established identities, it seems probable that
such organisational identity governed the choices of contextually avail-
able values and norms while keeping close to their own understanding
of what common good to realise.
Although the mission and values statements did not use specific faith-
based language, their formulations were framed by an understanding of
diaconia as an expression of faith. Policy texts emanating from the values
work cycles, including annual reports, strategic plans and internal proce-
dures and codes of conduct, elaborated how chosen mission and values
statements related to institutional character. This represents a continu-
ous balancing of a dually constituted character by profiling distinction
by translating common values while framing them in relation to institu-
tional history.
Conceiving of and Performing ‘Good Practice’:
Embodying Values in Organisational Structure
and Practice
In accounts of the founding of Røysumtunet, faith was more explicitly
said to embody practice. Nevertheless, professional care and the enhance-
ment of a good life seemed to be the primary aspirations of daily work
and a necessity for societal legitimacy, funding the expansion of ser-
vices. In establishing Røysumtunet, the faith-oriented founders allied
150 H. Askeland
with external stakeholders’ expertise to secure legitimacy and sanction-
ing from public agencies. This mix of logics constituted and continued
to characterise Røysumtunet.
The embodiment of values, firstly, had a symbolic and meaning-
bearing dimension. The old farm storehouse was converted into and con-
secrated as a chapel in 1980. Monthly sermons together with a weekly
devotion, held in a common living room, gave residents an opportunity
to nurture their spiritual life. Symbolically, leaders and other members of
staff throughout these 50 years voluntarily offered these devotions, com-
bining their professional and managerial roles with those of being carriers
of the faith tradition.
In preparation of the plenary sessions, all employees were invited to
discuss working experiences related to existing values. These discussions
let staff assess the experienced relevance and strengths of values, evalu-
ating whether they were portraying or aligning with the diaconal her-
itage. The content of the group discussions was presented and discussed
at the session, led by a department manager and later summarised by the
project group. The project group drafted new issues to be prepared for
the next session, inviting the groups to suggest new values and a new
mission statement of the institution. Arguing and grounding accompa-
nied the groups’ suggestions for new values, followed by a plenary dis-
cussion. The project group summarised input for mission statements and
values, discussing and negotiating suggested formulations. The CEO led
the project group, keeping a low profile in the initial phase but became
more actively involved in the concluding phase—not so much on the val-
ues statements but more active regarding mission statement and uphold-
ing the faith-based framing of interpreting the statements. Such agency
involved heading a smaller group to edit and articulate a final suggestion
of text.
When asked why the new cycle was initiated, the CEO stated: ‘We
did it very much to energize our attention to and enhance reflection on
values. Therefore, we gave much leeway for the staff to influence the
choice of values, whether we have respect or equality as core values does
not change much. What is a change was the process in itself; we now
have a more vigorous internal values discourse than ever before’.
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 151
Following each cycle of values work, as part of ongoing managerial
leadership work, the formulation of organisational values led to artic-
ulating a platform of leadership philosophy and a parallel code of con-
duct for employees. This represents a structural effort of institutionalising
practices. Developed in the executive group of leaders, it was an expli-
cation of how the values should inform practice. It covered areas such
as human resource management, administration, financial management
and professional practice. The primary focus of the leadership philoso-
phy concerned an internal orientation for leading employees. Along these
guiding principles, the implementation of values practices was combined
with ongoing reflection on professional practice. Emphasised in plenary
sessions and in conversations with staff and first-level managers, ongoing
supervision and reflection-groups put the values and ethical dilemmas on
the agenda on a continuous basis.
This mix is seen across differing sources of data. Though the institu-
tion has a self-imposed basis in the diaconal tradition informing defined
values, leaders need to maintain a broad set of goals and values. Such a
broader set of values relates to professional standards and quality, eco-
nomic sustainability and the efficient use of resources in addition to
relationships with official cooperative partners concerning reporting and
legitimacy (Askeland, 2014, p. 168). In addition, Sanna (2008) claimed
that the ongoing values work of the institution had a significant effect in
daily life. Her study showed the integration of values in the daily work of
the staff. Even though the staff did not express values as a conscious gov-
erning tool in daily life, they were reflected when it came to interaction
with residents and cooperative partners (Sanna, 2008, p. 52).
Concluding Remarks
This chapter demonstrates how leaders contribute to the interpretation of
organisational mission, shaping of character and embodiment of values
in both structural guidelines and interpreting practice. Through values
work, leaders address the issue of a ‘good’ organisation by attempting
to bridge past and present mission, maintaining a sense of institutional
152 H. Askeland
character and framing and legitimising their contribution for the res-
idents and the community. This work is performed through activities
ranging from faith-based practices, such as offering religious devotions
and sermons, publications celebrating anniversaries narrating the his-
tory of the organisation and dialogical interaction through organisational
value projects and maintaining and embedding values in procedures and
daily practices. This holds true across levels, yet contribution differs with
regard to level of the leaders. The CEO had a special role, authorised
by the board, in articulating values and mission statements. The creation
of a temporally consistent institutional narrative, through both ongoing
efforts and recurring cycles of processes, is constituting a link between
the creating- and disrupting/change-processes of institutional work.
Central to these efforts are choosing and articulating values, which
function as ‘stepping stones’ that translate between the faith tradition
and public welfare and professional values. The values, chosen among
sector-based values, aimed at enhancing explication and arguments that
integrate a faith-based profile and value-base with those sanctioned by
public policy and professionalism. These values framed the more con-
crete professional and administrative practices that were the responsibil-
ity of mid-level and first-line leaders. These did not express much conflict
between the different sets of values but rather integrated their profes-
sional leadership by loyalty to these more overarching values.
In addition, organising and facilitating a broad and inclusive process
of values work contributed to engaged consciousness of the staff. The
voicing of concerns at plenary sessions, regarding choice of core values,
was acknowledged by the main project group, the executives and by the
board. This found its way into the annual report of 2017, arguing for
the change of core values from respect to equality: ‘The value of equal-
ity substitutes respect, as the employee group considers this as a more
applicable term, while the values of safety and coping are kept as they
are prerequisite for a good life’.
I interpret these efforts as purposive acts aiming at infusing values and
creating frames for action. While earlier studies report the prior values as
ambiguous for groups among employees (Askeland, 2014; Sanna, 2008),
the second cycle seemed to ground the new values as they align with con-
cerns voiced throughout the groups and in the plenary work. Choosing
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 153
to facilitate a broad process, and yet setting some ramifications for change
and directing the internal discussion, strengthened the internal accep-
tance of a diaconal heritage while focusing attention on including spiri-
tual needs of the residents in general. This diversity was partly bridged by
choosing and framing public values within the diaconal heritage but also
by allowing involvement that fostered engagement, values consciousness
and reflective capacity.
Through facilitating and managing processual work, their efforts relate
to embedded agency. The established mission, character and values of the
organisation is a frame for managerial work but also a matter of main-
tenance and even re-shaping by the interpretations and evolving prac-
tice of leaders interacting with internal and external actors and stake-
holders. The re-shaping aspect has received little attention, although
Selznick argued that true commitments needed continuous reassessment
(Selznick, 1957/1984, p. 73). Selznick saw this as a combination of inter-
nal competencies and aspirations and external demands or pressures. This
chapter suggests institutional pluralism spurs recurring efforts to bridge
internal and external tensions, recreating a new articulation of mission,
character and values.
I interpret this contribution as efforts of institutional leadership, as
coined in previous work (Kraatz, 2009; Kraatz & Flores, 2015; Raffaelli
& Glynn, 2015; Selznick, 1957; Tengblad, 2006), confirming the impor-
tance of values in communicating institutional character and under-
standing mission (Wæraas, 2010). Such purposive efforts are related to
multiple internal and external value-sources and rationalities and work
through conceiving of the ‘good’ organisation, partaking in the public
policies for the common ‘good’ and performing ‘good’ professional prac-
tices through activities articulating shared social meaning and framing
interpretation through symbolic practices.
Institutional leadership exerts values-infusion by creating narratives
linking past, present and future, translating external values-expectations
by aligning and framing them with existing organisational identity, and
securing their embodiment by facilitating processes of explorative values
154 H. Askeland
discourse. Utilising the ambiguity of values enhances shared yet individ-
ual interpretation of values, bridging the interests of differing stakeholder
groups.
References
Aadland, E. (2010). In search of values-reporting from eight Norwegian
organizations. EJBO: Electronic Journal of Business Ethics and Organizational
Studies, 15(2), 22–30.
Aadland, E., Askeland, H., Flatebø, E., Haugen, H., Kaasa, A., & Stapnes, L.
M. (2006). Verdibasert ledelse i praksis [Values-based leadership in practice].
Oslo: HSH.
Angell, O. H. (2001). Church and welfare state in Norway: The role of religious
organisations in the provision of health care and social services (Unpublished
paper). Oslo.
Askeland, H. (2011). What do diaconal hospital managers really do? Man-
agement at Diakonhjemmet Hospital: Context, intention and practice.
Diaconia: Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 2(2), 145–169.
Askeland, H. (2014). Leaders should be the carriers of institutional values: An
account of how leaders contribute to the value-base of diaconal institutions.
Diaconia, 5(2), 149–177.
Askeland, H. (2015). Managerial practice in faith-based welfare organizations.
Nordic Journal of Religion and Society, 28(1), 37–58.
Askeland, H. (2017). Hvordan bidrar ledere til institusjonell ledelse? [How do
leaders contribute to institutional leadership?]. In E. Aadland & H. Aske-
land (Eds.), Verdibevisst ledelse [Values-conscious leadership] (pp. 156–181).
Oslo: Cappelen Damm Akademisk.
Askeland, H., Espedal, G., & Sirris, S. (2019). Values as vessels of religion?
Role of values in everyday work at faith-based organizations. Diaconia:
Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 10(1), 27–49.
Beaton, E. E. (2017). Managerialism, mission, & values: Micromechanisms of
nonprofit institutionalization (PhD thesis). University of Massachusetts,
Boston.
Brytting, T., & Trollestad, C. (2000). Managerial thinking on value-based man-
agement. International Journal of Value-Based Management, 13(1), 55–77.
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 155
DiMaggio, P. J., & Powell, W. W. (1991). The iron cage revisited: Institutional
isomorphism and collective rationality on organizational fields. In P. J.
DiMaggio & W. W. Powell (Eds.), The new institutionalism in organizational
analysis (pp. 63–82). Chicago: University of Chicago Press.
Eurich, J. (2012). Diaconia under mission drift: Problems with its theological
legitimation and its welfare state partnership. Diaconia: Journal for the Study
of Christian Social Practice, 3(1), 58–65.
Falkenberg, G. (2006). Verdier og sosiale normer i store norske virksomheter
[Values and social norms in large Norwegian enterprises] (Fafo Report).
Oslo: Fafo.
Fokas, E. (2011). State of the art report. In A. Bäckström (Ed.), Welfare and
values in Europe (Vol. 1). Uppsala: Uppsala University.
Gehman, J., Trevino, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Göçmen, I. (2013). The role of faith-based organizations in social welfare
systems: A comparison of France, Germany, Sweden, and the United
Kingdom. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 42(3), 495–516.
Golant, B. D., Sillince, J. A., Harvey, C., & Maclean, M. (2015). Rhetoric
of stability and change: The organizational identity work of institutional
leadership. Human Relations, 68(4), 607–631.
Hampel, C., Lawrence, T. B., & Tracey, P. (2015). Institutional work: Taking
stock and making it matter. In C. Hampel, T. B. Lawrence, & P. Tracey
(Eds.), The SAGE handbook of organizational institutionalism (2nd ed.).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Jeavons, T. M. (1992). When the management is the message: Relating values
to management practice in nonprofit organizations. Nonprofit Management
& Leadership, 2(4), 403–417.
Jørgensen, T. B., Vrangbæk, K., & Sørensen, D.-L. (2009). The historical
development of values in Danish administrative reform. 11th Public Manage-
ment Research Association Conference, La Follette School Public Affairs,
University of Wisconsin.
Kraatz, M. S. (2009). Leadership as institutional work: A bridge to the
other side. In T. B. Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca (Eds.), Institutional
work: Actors and agency in institutional studies of organizations (pp. 59–91).
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Kraatz, M. S., & Block, E. S. (2017). Institutional pluralism revisited. In R.
Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B. Lawrence, & R. E. Meyer (Eds.), SAGE hand-
book of organizational institutionalism (pp. 532–557). Los Angeles: Sage.
156 H. Askeland
Kraatz, M. S., & Flores, R. (2015). Reinfusing values. Institutions and Ideals
Philip Selznick’s Legacy for Organizational Studies, 44, 353–381.
Kraatz, M. S., & Moore, J. H. (2002). Executive migration and institutional
change. Academy of Management Journal, 45(1), 120–143.
Lawrence, T., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work. In
S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. Lawrence, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), The SAGE
handbook of organization studies (2nd ed., pp. 215–254). London: Sage.
Leis-Peters, A. (2014a). Diaconal work and research about Diakonia in the
face of welfare mix and religious pluralism in Sweden and Germany. In D.
Stephanie, K. Jørgensen, K. K. Korslien, & K. Nordstokke (Eds.), Diakonia
as Christian social practice: An introduction. Regnum: Oxford UK.
Leis-Peters, A. (2014b). Hidden by civil society and religion? Diaconal
institutions as welfare providers in the growing Swedish welfare state.
Journal of Church and State, 56 (1), 105–127.
Lorentzen, H. (1998). Normative forståelser av sivile sammenslutninger
[Normative understandings of civic associations]. Socialvetenskaplig tidskrift,
2(3), 244–267.
Maierhofer, N. I., Rafferty, A. E., & Kabanoff, B. (2003). When and why
are values important in organizations. In S. W. Gilliland, D. D. Steiner,
& D. P. Skarlicki (Eds.), Emerging perspectives on values in organizations
(pp. 3–32). Greenwich, CT: Information Age Publishing.
Meyer, J. W., & Rowan, B. (1991). Institutionalized organizations: Formal
structure as myth and ceremony. In P. J. DiMaggio & W. W. Powell (Eds.),
The new institutionalism in organizational analysis (pp. 41–62). Chicago:
University of Chicago Press.
O’Neill, M. (1992). Ethical dimensions of nonprofit administration. Nonprofit
Management & Leadership, 3(2), 199–213.
Petersen, V. C. (2003). Beyond rules in society and business. Cheltenham:
Edward Elgar.
Phillips, N., & Lawrence, T. B. (2012). The turn to work in organization and
management theory: Some implications for strategic organization. Strategic
Organization, 10(3), 223.
Raffaelli, R., & Glynn, A. (2015). What’s so institutional about leadership?
Leadership mechanisms of value infusion. In M. S. Kraatz (Ed.), Institutions
and ideals: Philip Selznick’s legacy for organizational studies (Vol. 44). Bingley,
UK: Emerald.
Repstad, P. (2001). Diaconia and the science of diaconia looking at the welfare
state. Tidsskrift for kirke, religion og samfunn, 14(2), 139–148.
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing … 157
Røysumtunet. (2015). Røysumtunet – Jubileumsbok 1965–2015 [Røysum-
tunet—Anniversary book 1965–2015]. Jaren: Eget forlag.
Sanna, H. K. (2008). Menneskesyn og verdier – utgangspunkt for selvbestemmelse?
[Humanity and values—A starting point for self-determination] (Master i
psykisk helsearbeid Master thesis). Høgskolen i Hedmark, Elverum.
Selznick, P. (1957/1984). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpre-
tation. Berkeley: University of California Press.
Selznick, P. (1996). Institutionalism “old” and “new”. Administrative Science
Quarterly, 41(2), 270–277.
Struminska-Kutra, M. (2018). Democratizing public management: Towards
practice-based theory. Cham, Switzerland: Palgrave Macmillan.
Suddaby, R. (2010). Challenges for institutional theory. Journal of Management
Inquiry, 19(1), 14–20.
Suddaby, R., & Foster, W. (2014). Organizational re-membering: Rhetorical
history as identity work. In M. G. Pratt, M. Schultz, & B. E. Ashforth
(Eds.), Oxford Handbook of organizational identity (p. 297). Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Tengblad, S. (2006). Is there a ‘new managerial work’? A comparison with
Henry Mintzberg’s classic study 30 years later. Journal of Management
Studies, 43(7), 1437–1461.
Tønnessen, A. V. (2005). Velferdsstat og kirkelig diakoni i Norge etter 1945.
Kritikk og fornyelse [Welfare state and church-based diaconia in Norway
since 1945: Criticism and renewal]. In J. H. Schjørring & J. T. Bak (Eds.),
Velfærdsstat og kirke [Welfare state and church] (pp. 103–123). København:
Anis.
Vaccaro, A., & Palazzo, G. (2015). Values against violence: Institutional
change in societies dominated by organized crime. Academy of Management
Journal, 58(4), 1075–1101.
Wæraas, A. (2010). Communicating identity: The use of core value statements
in regulative institutions. Administration & Society, 42(5), 526–549.
Wæraas, A. (2018). Putting on the velvet glove: The paradox of “soft” core
values in “hard” organizations. Administration & Society, 50(1), 53–77.
Washington, M., Boal, K. B., & Davis, J. N. (2008). Institutional leadership:
Past, present, and future. In R. Greenwood, R. Suddaby, C. Oliver, &
K. Sahlin (Eds.), Handbook of organization institutionalism (pp. 721–736).
London: Sage.
158 H. Askeland
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
9
Women’s Path to Leadership Through
Values Work in a Context of Conflict
and Violence
Ellen Vea Rosnes, Terese Bue Kessel
and Jolly Namwesi Kanywenge
Introduction
Women across the globe experience the path to leadership differently. In
African contexts, female leadership has a strong legacy (Skaine, 2010).
Queen mothers have held positions of power across the continent, and
ancient Egypt had women pharaohs (Skaine, 2010, p. 345). The tradi-
tion of women leaders can be seen to this day, with several freely elected
female head of states. Women also serve as leaders of traditional African
religions (Odamtten, 2012). In mainline and African-founded churches,
women occupy various leadership positions, especially at a congrega-
tional level (Ngunjiri & Christo-Baker, 2012).
E. V. Rosnes (B) · T. B. Kessel
VID Specialized University, Stavanger, Norway
e-mail: ellen.vea.rosnes@vid.no
T. B. Kessel
e-mail: terese.bue.kessel@vid.no
J. N. Kanywenge
Université Officielle de Bukavu, Bukavu, Democratic Republic of Congo
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_9
159
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_9&domain=pdf
mailto:ellen.vea.rosnes@vid.no
mailto:terese.bue.kessel@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_9
160 E. V. Rosnes et al.
However, from a broader perspective, female representation in lead-
ership positions is much lower than that of males (Ngunjiri, 2010;
Wakahiu & Salvaterra, 2012), and the situation reflects the global phe-
nomenon of a ‘glass ceiling’ (Adams, 2007). That is, women’s access to
powerful positions is limited by ‘social norms, organizational cultures,
and structures’ (Ngunjiri & Christo-Baker, 2012, p. 1). Madimbo high-
lights that the entire structure of religious organisations, including ‘the
wall, the roof’, is embedded in a patriarchal culture and prevents women
from reaching leadership positions (2012, p. 27).
Given the scarce scholarly publishing on women leaders in African
contexts (Christo-Baker, Roberts, & Rogalin, 2012; Ngunjiri, 2010), we
wish to understand what values, implicit or explicit, assist and impede
grass-roots women on their path to leadership. We ask how women com-
pete and negotiate paths to leadership through values work in a context of
conflict and violence. Our work is based on qualitative research carried out
in South Kivu, located in the Democratic Republic of Congo (DRC).
Drawing on women leaders’ narratives, we discuss how women engage
in values work on their path to leadership positions through education,
religious civil society organisations and the fight for women’s rights.
By values, we refer to ‘individual and collective conceptions of desir-
able trans-situational behaviours, objectives and ideals, serving to guide
or valuate practice’ (see introductory chapter). Espedal (see chapter on
values work) defines values work as ‘…social and institutional processes
of constructing agency, actions, and practice in organisations’. On the
one hand, women face severe challenges in reaching a leadership position
in an environment marked by patriarchal values, violence and conflict.
On the other hand, contextual shifts (see introductory chapter) brought
about by wars and conflicts sometimes offer new opportunities to engage
in the society, which, for instance, result from an increased involvement
of international development actors promoting women’s rights.
In this book on values work, we appreciate the space for a contribu-
tion from the Global South. Studies on women and leadership in Africa
over the last decades have highlighted relational skills, collaboration in
the community and feminine conducts of care (Ngunjiri, 2010; Njoroge,
2005; Skaine, 2010). These characteristics are also reflected in our data
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 161
on how values work is negotiated at the grass-roots level between individ-
ual and collective desires. This work complies with the suggestion that
more knowledge can be gained from how women, ‘the who of values
work’, describe their experiences on their way to influential positions (see
introductory chapter).
A Context of Conflict and Violence
The data for this chapter were collected as part of a broader project on
religious civil society networks in the Great Lakes region, who serve as
partners in peacebuilding processes in conflict-prone areas (Jordhus-Lier,
Rosnes, & Aasen, 2015). The project, funded by the Norwegian Min-
istry of Foreign Affairs, was carried out in collaboration between the
Center for Intercultural Communication (SIK), the Norwegian Institute
for Urban and Regional Research (NIBR), the Université Evangelique en
Afrique (UEA) and the Université Officielle de Bukavu.
DRC has witnessed much violence and conflict in the last decades
because of two devastating wars (1996–1997 and 1998–2003). The
United Nations Security Council Resolution (UNSCR) 1325 on
women, peace and security (United Nations, 2000) acknowledges the
serious effects of conflicts on women. The resolution, articulating an
internationally accepted value, reaffirms the need for women’s equal par-
ticipation in promoting peace and security. Women constitute a large
proportion of the millions of conflict victims in DRC (Jordhus-Lier et al.
2015, pp. 42–44; Kimaathi & Waruhiu, 2009; Solhjell, 2009). In fact,
one of the main reasons women is not actively engaged in peacebuilding
and formal negotiations is that they are looked upon as caregivers and
victims of war (Puechguirbal, 2004; Whitman, 2006). Ngongo (2009)
noted that women in South Kivu are not passive but active sufferers of
war. Their contributions are often seen in informal settings, such as in
the local community, in the family and in the corridors of official nego-
tiations. According to Ngongo, even though women act mostly on the
periphery of formal structures, they manage to capture a space and exert
influence as representatives of the civil society.
162 E. V. Rosnes et al.
In a war and post-war context, the role of civil society organisations
is crucial. Aembe and Jordhus-Lier (2017, p. 3) summarise it as follows:
‘With formal statehood in crisis, Congolese churches and international
development agencies are among the many civil society actors who per-
form state functions in its places, including the provision of social ser-
vices and various public governance role’. It is against this backdrop that
the women participating in this study narrated their experienced leader-
ship journeys.
Women Leadership, Values and Values Work
Leadership studies mostly focus on power and control and apply theo-
ries developed in the West. The voices of the marginalised are seldom
heard. Scholars such as Ngunjiri (2010) have argued for the inclusion of
non-Western and non-White leadership studies into the Western hege-
mony. Ngunjiri shows how leadership evolves in various social, cultural
and historical contexts by studying African women in Kenya and argues
that context matters in the practice of leadership. She sees the meaning-
making experiences of African women leaders as tempered by radicalism,
servant leadership and spirituality: ‘a context that has produced critical
servant leaders who rock the boat without falling out, convicted and
guided by their spiritual praxis’ (Ngunjiri, 2010, p. xi).
Between community entrepreneurial leadership and institutional lead-
ership and between compatible and competing values of gender, culture
and religion, there is a need to understand the interaction of the who of
values work. We will address the who of values work (see introductory
chapter) using women’s reflections of their paths to influential positions
in interaction with local communities and institutions. We agree that
values, implicit and explicit, are embedded in all kinds of practices and
behaviours of life (Kluckhohn, 1951, p. 395). While explicit values are
audible and can be articulated, implicit values are silent, embedded in
practices, taken for granted and go under the radar of common con-
ceptualisation. Similarly, trajectories of values are implicit within leader-
ship practices in religious and civic institutions, and they are the driving
force for when women who seek to influence. According to Kluckhohn
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 163
(1951), values play a role between individual understanding and collec-
tive considerations of what is desirable and what is good or bad practice.
Others situate values as interaction between two sets of agents, such as
Spates (1983) who sees the connection of individuals and collectives as
essential to understanding how values work operates in organisational
leadership. There will be either ‘consensus or competing orientations
among actors and interest groups’ (see introductory chapter). The fol-
lowing discussion is on how consensus and competing values are man-
ifested in women’s paths to leadership through education, participation
in religious civil society organisations and women’s rights.
Discovering Paths to Leadership Through
Narrative Life Stories
In 2011, a team of two co-authors (Rosnes from VID and Namwesi
from UEA) collected 13 stories of women leaders in Bukavu, South
Kivu. The UEA research team selected these participants on the basis
of their influence in society. Four of the participants were leaders within
religiously affiliated civil society organisations or churches; three within
other organisations in civil society; three within media firms; and three
within public political structures. The participants were between 30 and
60 years old and represented different social classes, education levels, reli-
gions and regions. A narrative life story approach was used to analyse how
women leaders themselves explained their journeys to becoming lead-
ers (Lieblich, Zilber, & Tuval-Mashiach, 2008). Participants spoke about
their current situation in leadership positions and the story of how they
came to occupy it, according to them. Most interviews lasted for more or
less one hour were carried out in French, recorded and later transcribed.
Excerpts included in this chapter have been translated into English by
the authors. The women consented to participating in the project and
did not want to stay anonymous in publications. Because they are used
to public exposure, they wished to have their names attached to their
experiences. They had the opportunity to read through the transcrip-
tions and the first draft of the analysis. In the 13 life stories, there are
164 E. V. Rosnes et al.
several examples of women’s values work and how women challenge col-
lective values on their path to leadership. We discuss two of these stores
in detail below.
Basombana and Kusinza’s stories have been chosen because they align
with our focus on religious organisations. Both these women were inter-
viewed when they were leaders of departments of women’s affairs in dif-
ferent churches. Their stories illustrate how values work is at play in reli-
gious civil society organisations.
Basombana’s Story
Basombana said she did not have a happy childhood. Her mother was
only 15 years old when she married her father—a man who was twice
her mother’s age. A year later, in 1948, Basombana was born. Her par-
ents divorced when she was young. She described herself as an orphan
living with family members who often treated her badly. In the end, an
uncle helped her go to school. Basombana was an engaged student: ‘I
was always elected as the leader of the group… everywhere. It was like
that—spontaneous; it didn’t depend on me’.
She developed her competencies through participation in women’s
work in church. She was inspired by older women and ‘…later they also
gave me the role of leading women during worship in church’. When she
was 25, some women asked her to be president of the women in church:
‘They told me “We will elect you as President.” I said: “As President?
Can I actually lead the mamas from all these communities?” And these
mamas said, “We know you very well. We are sure that if we give you
this responsibility, you will manage”’. Basombana accepted the challenge
and believes that God helped:
I was the preacher that day, and God helped me so much that when I had
preached, all the women were touched by what I said. Even the women
that had asked me how I could manage to lead them came to ask me
for forgiveness. They said, “Oh, you’re the servant of God, forgive us for
saying that you will not be able to lead us.”
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 165
Basombana interacted with the women in the communities, listened
to their needs and initiated small projects using international funding.
Later, she became the only female member in the executive committee
of the church. She also discussed the challenges women encounter in
religious organisations: ‘…we can elect women, but we don’t give them
the power to act as responsible women. And that really makes me feel
bad’. She explained that women need courage to be able to talk to many
people and actively participate in boards that often consist only of men:
Every time there was something that needed to be said to the papas, they
[women in church] said: “You are our leader. You have to advocate for
us!” Moreover, I considered myself as a leader, because when I started to
talk politely, in the papas’ assembly, they listened to me. Sometimes they
highlighted what I said because they often said that what this woman says
is true, we have to implement it.
Basombana needed good mediation skills to appeal to several sets of peo-
ple: the men running the church, the older women who were sceptical
of younger women leaders and the younger women who were more edu-
cated than her. She said, ‘I was a simple woman with little instruction,
but now I’m working with women with university degrees, doctors etc’.
Her strategy was to be humble and co-operate without discrimination.
According to Basombana, a leader is someone who engages herself on
behalf of others. She said women’s engagement led to a marked improve-
ment in women’s work and representation in the church. They managed
to, among other things, establish a department for women in the church.
This was realised with the help of heavy lobbying for many years. News
about what they achieved spread to other parts of the country and that
made her proud.
Basombana has also served as the president of other associations.
Twice, she was appointed as one of the women leaders of Bukavu and
actively participated in politics. In 2011, she contested elections as a
National Deputy. Protesting the violence against women was Basom-
bana’s main motivation. Her aim was to promote women’s rights:
166 E. V. Rosnes et al.
…They killed those women and they were buried in the forest like that.
I was shocked. And, no one wanted to talk about those women – not
even the Provincial Deputies, who were in the Assembly. We asked them:
“Can’t you advocate in order to make it known what happened to those
women?” They said “No, no, no, leave it, leave it, leave it”. So, I decided
to try to make it to the Assembly. And when there are incidents like that
again, I will advocate for those women.
According to Basombana, women have political ambitions, but they
often lack the means, especially financial, to run campaigns. However,
she also acknowledges a change in gender roles, with more educated
women willing to take on responsibilities.
Kusinza’s Story
Kusinza was born in 1963. At the age of 4, her parents were divorced.
As an only child, she was raised by father and grandmother. Her father
taught her to do all kinds of work, including those typically associated
with boys: ‘He talked to me. He even gave me the responsibility to organ-
ise a party. He told me: “Go and kill that goat”. I learned to slit a goat’s
throat at the age of 12’. Accustomed to working hard, Kusinza became a
strong woman. Her father believed in her, but there was one challenge:
‘He didn’t want me to study. He saw in me a girl who could help her
grandmother with the housework. But he didn’t have the perspective that
I could go to school’.
At the age of 12, Kusinza followed her cousin to school. When the
teacher asked her why she did not attend school, she decided to start
school even though she was much older. She was the best in class and
received an out-of-turn promotion to a higher grade because of her skills.
Because of her performance, the teachers let her continue even though
her father did not always pay the school fees. At school, she was very
good in political events: ‘I was in charge of Mopap, the popular student
event in school. I had to teach students songs about the movement, the
songs of action that were linked to our President. It made me an author-
ity, and I started to organise others’. Kusinza was also given the role of
Virgin Mary in religious parades: ‘I had my little Jesus, and I was dressed
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 167
in a white dress like a bride and a veil, and I had to march very slowly
like the Holy Virgin. And, there was a long chain of people in front of
me and behind me, and it was me – the Virgin Mary’. The different roles
made people respect her:
With all those roles that I played in the community, I don’t think it
passed without leaving any traces. It started to stir certain things in me.
When I presented myself in a group, in church or in village meetings, in
the service, I found gratitude. Me, I call that gratitude. I saw gratitude in
the eyes of authorities, in the eyes of colleagues.
Kusinza also became engaged in the Shirika, the Catholic parish in her
village. She was one of the people responsible for leading the Sunday
service liturgy. The authorities also nominated her to be in charge of
women and development.
Kusinza worked as a teacher at a Catholic school—a job she planned
on leaving after her marriage. However, Kusinza cancelled her marriage
to the man who had given her family the dowry after she realised that
he was not good for her: ‘I went through some difficult times because of
the separation of my parents, and if I also get married in haste, it will
lead to more difficulties in my life, and I will never be happy’. Later,
she married a man she loved and had eight children with him. She did
not know that he was a Protestant until the day they went to the pastor.
Despite pressure, she refused to change her religious affiliation and gave
the matter some thought. Eventually, she became an active member of a
Protestant church. The church recognised her abilities and requested her
to take on responsibilities:
There was a voice there, which had done political events. There was a
voice, different from the others. One day they told me: “You, over there,
when you sing there is a nice voice coming out. You have to leave the last
row, come forward”.
In 2003, Kusinza was nominated to become a nation-wide leader for
women in church and asked to contest the election:
168 E. V. Rosnes et al.
“Mama Kusinza, put your name. Put her name also on the board!”…
When you come home, you have to thank God. Why is my name among
those of the religious authorities in my congregation? There are others
that seek this post, others who have the capacity to do it, but you see
that they have given this post to you. And it’s paid, it’s not a voluntary
post, it’s a post with a salary.
As the head of the Women and Family Department, Kusinza received
many opportunities, including to travel within and outside her own
country, meet other women and receive training. Kusinza was a candi-
date in the political provincial elections of 2006.
Individual and Collective Values on Education
of Girls
In this section, we explain how women leaders performed values work in
South Kivu. How much agency did they have within the limits of their
societal structures? The stories of Basombana, Kusinza and other women
interviewed in this project reveal that education played a key role. On
their path to leadership positions, women engaged in values work in for-
mal educational spaces, hence obtained qualifications. The women lead-
ers, the who of values work, collaborated and negotiated gender-inclusive
values with parents, families and school authorities in a context of com-
peting values and traditions. Although the right to education for girls and
boys is enshrined in international conventions, many children have been
and still are deprived of education. In the communities of the women
leaders who participated in this project, education of girls was neither an
implicit nor an explicit value. The leaders started school at different ages.
Their social class and parents’ values determined whether they received
an education. Gender roles and the lack of educational structures did not
help either. Some were encouraged by their parents to go to school, but
others had to find their own way.
Basombana and Kusinza are examples of actors who negotiated val-
ues work as their practices competed with their parents’ values. Kusinza
recalled being concerned that her father did not want her to study. With
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 169
the help of other actors in society, who recognised the value of edu-
cating girls, both Basombana and Kusinza received a formal education.
Basombana lived with her uncle who let her go to school. Kusinza got
her chance when the teacher of Kusinza’s cousin learned that she did
not go to school. Because she performed well, the school let her stay
even though her father avoided paying school fees. In other words, by
studying well and by taking on different roles in school, such as being in
charge of political events, Kusinza attained a special position within the
school community, which led others to respect her. These roles left an
impression: they gave her a voice that was noticed.
Today, women’s access to secondary education has improved. Basom-
bana notes that there is a change in gender roles because more educated
women are ready to take on responsibilities. When she was young, she
would sometimes be the only educated woman in a group. What this
highlights is that the women leaders have engaged in values work by
aiming for, demanding and completing higher education. Women born
in and after the 1970s had easier access to university education. However,
through their agency, they had to convince their parents that they were
as capable as their brothers, to be sent to school. In general, the collected
narratives suggest that the girls were dependent on their parents’ values
and that they had to perform well for their parents to see the value in
educating them. In the end, managing to get educated was a result of
explicit negotiation of values on the journey to leadership.
Values Work Within the Framework
of Religious Civil Society Organisations
Ogundipe-Leslie (1994, p. 209) claims that African men view women as
subordinate, especially within a marriage, even though the women may
have many roles outside of it. One such social network where women can
acquire leadership skills is within religious civil society, as reflected in the
data above. How did the participants act to become leaders in church
contexts within the frameworks of religion, culture and gender?
While women in general encouraged Basombana to get involved in
church work, lead Sunday worship and announce her candidacy for the
170 E. V. Rosnes et al.
executive committee, such spaces call for the negotiation of compatible
and competing values with churchmen and elderly women. Women are
eligible for posts in the church management as long as the position does
not include power. To gain influence within the community and estab-
lish a platform of communication, Basombana relied on cultural and
gender-sensitive approaches. For instance, she complied with the contex-
tual expectations of feminine conduct, was humble and polite, showed
respect to both genders and strove to get along with everyone (Ngun-
jiri, 2010; Skaine, 2010). She displayed courage, credibility and values
work by acting for others, which to her was a leader characteristic. She
engaged in projects that were internationally funded to improve commu-
nity life. Her efforts showcased collective and community values in tra-
ditional Africa as well as the cultural knowledge of how survival depends
on mutual exchanges across gender and age (Kessel, 2016). Her way of
navigating practices challenged traditional boundaries.
Her story is an example of how an individual’s values of desirable
trans-situational behaviours can counter collective patriarchal values. In
this case, the who contests the implicit values of subordination through
explicit gender- and culture-sensitive entrepreneurial behaviour (Kluck-
hohn, 1951). By sharing one’s understanding of what constitutes good
practice and challenging the collective understanding of what is bad prac-
tice, the individual manages to create paths to leadership and involve-
ment in the church management. Values interact between two sets of
agents (Spates, 1983). Both genders trust and respect the agency of
Basombana after seeing how the who acts.
In Kusinza’s case, the church provided her with the path to leadership.
By leading the Sunday service liturgy—a space historically dominated by
men—she showed the courage and capacity to overcome traditional gen-
der roles. Her familiarity with church work and with leading the Sunday
service paved the way to more influential positions.
Both narrators considered human resources as important assets that
enable access to informal and formal spaces of influence. Their reflec-
tions highlighted a sense of self-consciousness, self-confidence and expe-
riences in church and community contexts that improved their self-
awareness (Freire, 2012). They named their own talents: communica-
tion skills, the ability to encourage and inspire others and the ability to
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 171
gain trust. Contexts that deny women power reflect patriarchal values
that situate women in inferior positions (Lerner, 1986); however, both
narrators acted with agency in such gender-limited spaces. By deliber-
ately challenging values that preserve patriarchal conduct, such as by tak-
ing on responsibilities in church and society, the participants influenced
their own situations. Oduyoye (2004) notes that only if women engage
in confronting cultural oppression can gender-inclusive African contexts
develop.
Basombana’s engagement in the church also had a spiritual aspect.
She explicitly believed in God’s assistance. Her spiritual experience was
neither abstract nor distant. Faith in God is a reality that encourages
women in African contexts (Kessel, 2014, pp. 92–95, pp. 159–180)
as they are ‘guided by their spiritual praxis’ (Ngunjiri, 2010, p. xi). In
many environments in Africa, the church is among the best function-
ing institutional structure within local communities. It is common to
organise women’s church work through movements, such as the Mother
Union of the Anglican Church in South Africa and the Women for
Christ in the Evangelical Lutheran Church in Cameroon (Kessel, 2014).
Several authors have argued that women leadership in Africa requires
organising women’s groups and supportive leadership to overcome struc-
tures that prevent women from reaching high positions (Fenny, 2019;
Madimbo, 2012; Wakahiu & Salvaterra, 2012).
Both Basombana and Kusinza exemplify how female leadership can
evolve through support from groups of people within the community.
They used available opportunities within the patriarchal structure of the
churches to wisely, in the words of Ngunjiri (2010, p. xi), ‘rock the
boat without falling out’. They acted with courage and negotiated larger
spaces for women’s influence, for instance, by filling traditional male roles
at a congregational and managerial level, such as leading the Sunday ser-
vice liturgy and being a part of decision-making boards.
The Fight for Women’s Rights
In Africa in general, mechanisms of domination over women prevent the
application of equal rights and gender equality. Gender role expectations
172 E. V. Rosnes et al.
of women are constantly negotiated with patriarchal values in any given
context (Oduyoye & Kanyoro, 1992). Women’s status in the patriarchal
society of South Kivu does not generally enable their path to leadership.
In fact, several of the women leaders, such as Basombana, were victims
of domestic violence as children. For women to be considered inferior to
men is part of the traditional social structure. This mindset affects how
children and the women themselves are educated. At the same time, the
leader narratives in this work also show how recognition from others are
crucial to gaining the courage to take on responsibilities. Kusinza was a
respected woman in the community, and Basombana was always elected
as the leader of the group. Changing the value constraints to women
leadership requires long-term values work in the family, in institutions
and in the society at large.
For the women leaders, their family situation is either a barrier to or
an enabler of their roles as leaders. A woman’s engagement outside of the
household can be viewed as a good or bad practice and is often depen-
dent on her husband’s values. Accordingly, some of the women leaders
explained how they had been selective in choosing a husband: he had to
be someone who understood them. For instance, Kusinza did not want
the same fate as her divorced parents.
In addition to their husbands, women also have to deal with their
families-in-law, who typically are not favour of women being active out-
side of the home. Some of the women leaders had to engage in values
work within the family in order to continue their engagements outside
of home. We strongly felt, from our interviews, that the courage and self-
belief that strengthened women leaders’ agency was often in conflict with
the collective considerations of what was desirable and good practice for
them as women. They told us, for instance, about incidents when they
had to oppose their father, a boss or a politician, which resulted in grave
consequences.
Women leadership trajectories are prevented by patriarchal contexts.
Having said this, it is also important to add that the 1995 Beijing Plat-
form for Action has led to more opportunities for women in education
and leadership positions at many levels of decision-making. In spite of
war and conflict in several countries, it is evident that some countries
have managed to mainstream women into leading positions. This is the
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 173
case in Rwanda, which in 2007 had the highest percentage of women in
the parliament in the world (48.8%). Many countries in conflict, such
as the DRC, have adopted UN Resolution 1325 to guarantee women’s
presence at peace tables. However, given the ineffectiveness of the state,
the civil society plays an important role in South Kivu. Its emergence can
be attributed to both internal and external stimuli and the international
donor community (Aembe & Jordhus-Lier, 2017). This civil society has
led to contextual shifts where institutional environments have enabled
new ways to engage in society. By leaning on the universal values of
women’s rights and challenging local values that viewed them as care-
givers and victims of war instead of actors for peace, the women in the
state carved their paths to leadership.
Ngongo (2009) argues that one of the most important contributions
of women has been to promote, in communities and in peace negotia-
tions, the issue of sexual violence. In a society where women are deprived
of their fundamental rights, many are engaged in advocating for women’s
rights. In fact, victim accounts of sexual violence, the need to provide
them with medical and practical help and making them aware of what
happened to them have motivated many women to engage in civil soci-
ety organisations and in politics. Women leaders who work as journalists
advocate through the media and have been awarded international prizes
for their work. Among our participants, Basombana listens to women’s
needs and initiates projects that are internationally funded. She had also
approached the Provincial Deputies and asked them to talk about what
was happening to the women. Silence on the part of politicians pushed
her to run for deputy elections.
In their narratives, women leaders described a woman’s status in South
Kivu as an enduring obstacle to their advocacy efforts towards women’s
rights. The participants told us that while women may know what the
right thing to do is, they do not always have the power to implement
it. For instance, Basombana identified the lack of financial resources as
a barrier to contesting elections. It is plausible that a similar lack of
finances may be an obstacle for values work and for promoting women
leaders.
174 E. V. Rosnes et al.
Concluding Remarks
This chapter marks a contribution from the Global South on women’s
access to leadership through values work. The life narratives of women
leaders in South Kivu, DRC, the who of values work, offer insights into
how women compete and negotiate traditional and gender-inclusive val-
ues in a patriarchal society ridden by war, violence and conflict. As illus-
trated in the narratives of Basombana and Kusinza, women perform val-
ues work on various levels on their paths to leadership. Contextual shifts,
due to international influence and an increased role of civil society actors,
assist their values work. They strive to acquire an education, even though
their parents do not value girls’ education. They negotiate and advocate
for space for women leaders within religious civil society organisations.
They fight for women’s rights together with other women leaders. Appar-
ent in the stories was community support for values work within fami-
lies, communities, institutions and in society at large. This illustrates how
values are articulated and re-articulated and are dynamic in different con-
texts and groups. Women gain access to leadership through negotiation
of values and connection both to the international and to the collective’s
values work. The narrators’ strategic choices are deliberate and facilitate
access to influential spaces and relationships in social and institutional
networks.
References
Adams, J. (2007). Stained glass makes the ceiling visible: Organizational oppo-
sition to women in congregational leadership. Gender & Society, 21(1), 80–
105. https://doi.org/10.1177/0891243206293773.
Aembe, B., & Jordhus-Lier, D. (2017). Within, above, and beyond: Churches
and religious civil society activism in South Kivu. Journal of Civil Society,
13(2), 149–165. https://doi.org/10.1080/17448689.2017.1309731.
Christo-Baker, E. A., Roberts, C., & Rogalin, C. L. (2012). Spirituality as
a vehicle for passing through the stained glass ceiling: Perspectives on
African American women’s leadership in US organizations. The Journal of
Pan African Studies, 5(2), 5–26.
https://doi.org/10.1177/0891243206293773
https://doi.org/10.1080/17448689.2017.1309731
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 175
Fenny, A. P. (2019). Rising African women leaders in global health. The Lancet,
392(10165), 2662–2663.
Freire, P. (2012). The pedagogy of the oppressed. New York: Bloomsbury Aca-
demic.
Jordhus-Lier, D., Rosnes, E. V., & Aasen, B. (2015). Church networks, peace-
building and women’s participation in Eastern DRC and the Great Lakes
region–A mapping study (NIBR/SIK Report).
Kessel, T. B. (2014). Between God’s sharing power and men’s controlling power: A
quest for diaconal empowerment and transformation in Femmes Pour Christ in
Cameroon (PhD dissertation). Misjonshøgskolen, Stavanger.
Kessel, T. B. (2016). The Africanisation of Diakoni care in community with
Femmes Pour Christ in Cameroon. In S. Dietrich, K. Jørgense, K. Korslien,
& K. Nordstokke (Eds.), Diakonia in a gender perspective (pp. 163–172).
Oxford: Regnum Books.
Kimaathi, R., & Waruhiu, J. (2009). DRC: Bukavu assessment report. Retrieved
from http://www.iansa-women.org/node/210.
Kluckhohn, C. (1951). Values and value-orientations in the theory of action:
An exploration in definition and classification. In T. Parsons & E. Shils
(Eds.), Toward a general theory of action. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Univer-
sity Press.
Lerner, G. (1986). The creation of patriarchy. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Lieblich, A., Zilber, T. B., & Tuval-Mashiach, R. (2008). Narrating human
actions: The subjective experience of agency, structure, communion, and
serendipity. Qualitative Inquiry, 14(4), 613–631.
Madimbo, M. (2012). Supportive leadership behavior key to breaking the glass
ceiling in religious communities in Malawi. Journal of Pan African Studies,
5(2), 27–41.
Ngongo, K. F. (2009). Femme et paix dans la ville de Bukavu de 1996 à
2006. Réflexion théologique. Kinshasa: Editions de l’Université Protestante
au Congo (EDUPC).
Ngunjiri, F. W. (2010). Women’s spiritual leadership in Africa: Tempered radicals
and critical servant leaders. Albany: State University of New York Press.
Ngunjiri, F. W., & Christo-Baker, E. A. (2012). Breaking the stained glass
ceiling: African women’s leadership in religious organizations. Journal of Pan
African Studies, 5(2), 1–4.
Njoroge, N. (2005). A new way of facilitating leadership: Lessons from African
women theologians. Missiology: An International Review, 33(1), 29–46.
Odamtten, H. N. K. (2012). They bleed but they don’t die: Towards on Ga-
Adangbe gender studies. The Journal of Pan African Studies, 5(2), 110–127.
http://www.iansa-women.org/node/210
176 E. V. Rosnes et al.
Oduyoye, M. A. (2004). Beads and strands: Reflections of an African woman on
Christianity in Africa. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis Books.
Oduyoye, M. A., & Kanyoro, M. E. (Eds.). (1992). The will to arise: Women,
tradition, and the church in Africa. Maryknoll, NY: Orbis Books.
Ogundipe-Leslie, M. (1994). Re-creating Ourselves: African women and critical
transformations. Trenton, NJ: Africa World Press.
Puechguirbal, N. (2004). Involving women in peace processes: Lessons from
four African countries (Burundi, DRC, Liberia and Sierra Leone). In K.
Karamé (Ed.), Gender and peace-building in Africa (pp. 47–66). Oslo: Norsk
Utenrikspolitisk Institutt.
Skaine, R. (2010). Women’s leadership in Africa. In K. O’Connor (Ed.), Gen-
der and women’s Leadership: A reference handbook (pp. 345–353). Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
Solhjell, R. (2009). Seksualisert vold i Kongo. Sosiologi i dag, 39(2), 5–22.
Spates, J. L. (1983). The sociology of values. Annual Review of Sociology, 9(1),
27–49.
United Nations. (2000). Resolution 1325 (2000). S/RES/1325. Retrieved from
https://undocs.org/S/RES/1325(2000).
Wakahiu, J., & Salvaterra, M. (2012). Sustainable leadership: Lessons and
implications of a leadership development program for women religious in
Africa. Journal of Pan African Studies, 5(2), 150–167.
Whitman, S. (2006). Women and peace-building in the Democratic Republic
of the Congo: An assessment of their role in the Inter-Congolese dialogue.
African Journal on Conflict Resolution, 6 (1), 29–48.
https://undocs.org/S/RES/1325(2000)
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values … 177
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
Part III
How Is Values Work Performed?
10
Catching Values in Flight: A Process
Perspective on Researching Values
in Organisations
Gry Espedal
Introduction
During the last few decades, the concept of process studies has become
increasingly visible in social studies (Langley, Smallman, Tsoukas, &
de Ven, 2013; Langley & Tsoukas, 2010, 2017), incorporating a new
stream of how to study values work (Gehman, Trevino, & Garud, 2013;
Vaccaro & Palazzo, 2015; Wright, Zammuto, & Liesch, 2017), shedding
light on how values work is shaping organisational forms, practices and
activities. Values are part of the construction of the organisational life
(Gehman et al., 2013), and we need approaches that help to identify
and investigate the performative work of values in organisations, includ-
ing temporal and relational aspects. In this chapter, I propose that stud-
ies of values work have not gone far enough in investigating how values
institutionalise practices in organisations. Therefore, this chapter aims
to investigate the question of how process studies can contribute towards
G. Espedal (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: gry.espedal@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_10
181
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_10&domain=pdf
mailto:gry.espedal@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_10
182 G. Espedal
identifying values work as strong-process studies, as how reality is brought
into being in every instant, as well as weak-process studies—as interac-
tions constituting institutionalising processes in organisations.
Throughout the decades, research on values has utilised a quantita-
tive approach treating values as positivistic facts, measuring the degree of
commitment to perceived values. For instance, the World Values Survey
has carried out national surveys on values (Inglehart, 1977), and there
have been studies on the effects on social cultures (Hofstede, 1980) and
the motivational dimensions of values (Schwartz, 2006). Values have also
been studied through using qualitative methods such as action research
to investigate a reflective process for improving values work in organisa-
tions (Aadland & Skjørshammer, 2012). Leaders are also shadowed to
investigate their actions in relation to values (Askeland, 2016).
We can ask if these methodological approaches capture the mecha-
nisms of values work in organisations, especially regarding how they are
formed and informed by practices. Quantitative surveys identifying val-
ues investigate values as facts and not as intentional social objects or
social practice. Action research pays more attention to the inquiry pro-
cesses than to studying values work per se. Shadowing the practices of
leaders in action does not capture the deeper temporal organisational
engagement of values inhabited from the past and their influence on
future standards of behaviour.
In organisations, there are many processes going on at the same time
(Hernes, 2016). Actors operate within structures, technologies and legal
systems. They are involved in history and in stories from the past, as well
as processes which impose corporate strategies, visions and goals for the
future (Hernes, 2014). These ongoing processes point inwards to occur-
rences within the organisations, but they are also based on responses and
pressures from the outside. Process studies aim to unpack events in order
to reveal an understanding of the complex activities and transactions that
occur in organisations and contribute to their constitutions (Langley &
Tsoukas, 2010). As such, studying values as an organisational process can
give insight to the underlying mechanisms, consciousness and broader
awareness of value patterns in organisations.
Current studies of values work highlight values work in organisa-
tions as processes of ongoing performances situated in everyday practices
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 183
(Gehman et al., 2013). Previous research on values is criticised for pursu-
ing values work through cognitive and cultural lenses. Instead, the new
stream of values work studies is enhancing values work performed and
provoked in organisations as various types of processes articulating and
accomplishing the desirables in relevance to right and wrong actions and
behaviours (Espedal, 2019; Gehman et al., 2013).
Gehman et al.’s (2013) study proposes the concept that values work is
comprised of key interrelated domains, such as concerns, networking and
being part of value practices and discourses. Their study is followed by
a few others, including a study on how change agents use values strate-
gically to transform the highly resistant institutional setting of paying
pizzo to the mafia at Sicily (Vaccaro & Palazzo, 2015) and a study show-
ing how the values of healthcare professionals are maintained in every-
day work (Wright et al., 2017). One recent study identifies a process of
value inquiry that is used to question the dominant value frames in sit-
uations of institutional pressure. Through a systematic analysis of three
highly value-salient issues within a faith-based organisation, the study
theorises the process of value inquiry as an open-ended process of ques-
tioning and reinterpreting the meaning of the dominant value frames.
To adapt to this situation, institutions are inquiring the dominant value
frame in order to seek out and find institutional values and practices to
form new behaviours that realign with the common good and the values
and agency of the organisations (Espedal, 2019).
In this chapter, I suggest that future developments in studying val-
ues work in organisations should include process perspectives. One may
question if the recent stream of studies of values work in organisations
has gone far enough in including the process nature of institutions and
institutionalisation in their investigation of values (Surachaikulwattana
& Phillips, 2017). Therefore, in this chapter, I will cover how values
work enhance actions and agency in influencing actors and institutions
exemplified through a recent study of values work in a faith-based health-
care organisation.
184 G. Espedal
Process Studies and Values Work
Scholars have been engaging in a rather new field of process studies. Since
the late 1990s, researchers have taken an explicitly agentic view of organ-
isations and organising, researching routines, innovation, change, iden-
tity, strategising, decision-making, learning, knowing, communication
and organised action (Langley & Tsoukas, 2017). Several articles and
books have described process thinking, process theorising and process
research (Hernes, 2014, 2016; Langley, 1999, 2009; Langley & Tsoukas,
2010, 2017). Since 2008, the interest in process studies has gathered
researchers at Process Organization Studies (PROS)—a yearly conference
focusing on studies in organisations that are grounded on process meta-
physics—seeing processes, rather than substances, as the basic forms of
the universe
Weick (1995)’s work on organising is highlighted as being revealing
for process studies (Langley & Tsoukas, 2017). The foundational notion
of directing attention towards organising rather than organisation enables
a new line of inquiry. This new emphasis invites scholars to exam-
ine how settings of interaction become organised, rather than hitherto
research viewing organisations as already constituted entities. Organisa-
tion is highlighted ‘to assemble ongoing interdependent actions into sen-
sible sequences that generate sensible outcome’ (Weick, 1979, p. 3). The
researchers’ task is to explain how organisations (the process) emerge. Key
themes of process approach can include relationality, agency, constrained
interactivity, emergence and open-endedness (Langley & Tsoukas, 2017).
Process studies can be identified as strong- or weak-process stud-
ies (Bakken & Hernes, 2006). Early studies of values and practices in
organisations have studied values through a weak-process perspective.
This perspective emphasises interactions as constituting processes. Weak-
processes assume that, for the most part, the task of process research is to
provide arrows that connect pre-existing, relatively stable boxes in order
to understand the temporal evolution of things or substances that never-
theless retain their identity over time. Through this perspective, organ-
isations are viewed as relatively stable entities, time is primarily beheld
chronologically and change is something that happens to the organisa-
tion (Langley & Tsoukas, 2017).
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 185
The examining of an introduction of core values and the investiga-
tion of how they influence activities and actions might be identified as
a weak-process study. Often, core values’ visibility is connected to being
promoted in organisational strategies and mission statements. Core val-
ues are established among other activities, and the process might be iden-
tified as how values influence or change practices. Falkenberg (2006)
has done a Norwegian study that investigates organisational core values
through a weak-process perspective; this study investigates the character-
istics of organisational core values.
Two other Norwegian studies can be characterised as being close to
weak-process studies. Askeland (2014) includes institutionalising per-
spectives in understanding leaders’ work and practices. This study argues
that leaders may have a significant contribution to the institutionalisation
process for the interpretation of the mission and the shaping of values
in faith-based welfare organisations. However, the arrows that connect
the pre-existing identity and mission point to relatively stable boxes that
allow leaders to understand how they carry values that facilitate the tem-
poral evolution of their organisations. Leaders are the subject, conveying
value orientation through policy documents, and leaders build value ori-
entation into the governing structures of their organisations. This study
investigates leaders as actors and examines how they influence faith-based
welfare organisations to maintain their value base, but it does not give
insight to how values as a verb (valuing) constitute the conditions for
this process (Bakken & Hernes, 2006).
Aadland and Skjørshammer (2012) studied a faith-based healthcare
organisation and the enhancement of humanistic and moral values
through an action research process, identifying how the organisation is
part of the societal processes of secularisation and pluralisation. The pro-
cess identified in this study is closer to a strong value study that identifies
values work and value discourses. The arrow in this study initiates a value
process pointing to value discussions as generating ethical reflection and
increasing the moral sensitivity (Eide & Eide, 2008). The study describes
how values work affects ethical work in the organisations, but we are not
given insight into how values work per se influences this process.
In strong-process studies, change is not necessarily investigated as
something that happens to things but as how reality is brought into being
186 G. Espedal
in every instant. The emphasis is on ‘arrows all the way through’ (Langley
& Tsoukas, 2017, p. 4), which means investigating how phenomena are
constituted through the work that agents do. The study conducted by
Gehman et al. (2013) is characterised as a strong-process study (Langley
& Tsoukas, 2017, p. 4), which examines organisational values as a form
of practice that is continually constituted and adapted through ongoing
work enacted by organisational members.
Using process lenses, inspired by the practice theory of Schatzki
(2002) and Dewey (1939), Gehman et al. (2013) conducted a ten-
year study of the development of an honour code in a business school,
where they looked for different processes in which the concept of values
work was interrelated with organisational activities. Based on conveying
archival sources, ethnographic observation and stakeholder interviews,
Gehman et al. (2013) generated a new theory on understanding values as
situated in practice. The process of values work was identified as emerg-
ing through dealing with pockets of concern, knotting local concerns into
action networks and performing actual value practices that are circulated
in value discourses.
Gehman et al.’s (2013) study has contributed to other studies of the
effects that value practices provoke in organisations (Daskalaki, Fotaki,
& Sotiropoulou, 2018). Rather than a top-down procedure, it is through
discussions, negotiations and ongoing community collaboration that
value ideology is performed (VanderPal & Ko, 2014). Despite the preva-
lence of the research, it is questionable whether Gehman et al.’s argument
goes far enough in relation to investigating the work as part of the insti-
tutionalising processes. The study conducted by Gehman et al. (2013)
implies a linear sequence where values (in the form of an honour code)
first emerge in response to various concerns and are then practised. We
can ask if the theory sufficiently emphasises the conditions of embedded
agency and the role of institutional agents in relation to developing the
institutions of value practices. From a strong-process theory, all values
work, whether claims to core values by leaders or the enactment of pro-
fessional values in everyday work (Wright et al., 2017), are constitutive
acts (Ashcraft, Kuhn, & Cooren, 2009) that serve a performative func-
tion in constructing people’s understanding of organisational life.
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 187
Vaccaro and Palazzo (2015, pp. 1094–1095) come closer to recognis-
ing values work as an institutionalising process, leaning on Schwartz’s
(1996, p. 2) definition of values as ‘desirable, trans-situational goals’. As
such, this study goes beyond the observation of emerging value practices
by showing how change agents can use values strategically to transform a
highly resistant institutional setting. This process involves viewing values
as a motivational factor guiding principles in people’s lives, challenging
and changing highly resistant institutions through five micro-processes
used to leverage values in interaction with stakeholders: hooking, anchor-
ing, activating, securing and uniting.
Process Studies’ Role in Enhancing
the Temporal and Relational Aspects
of Organisational Work
Time, timing and temporality are inherent in process studies, based on
the notion that ‘No motion is possible without the category of time’
(Sorokin & Merton, 1937, p. 615). The notion of time goes beyond the
chronological conception of clock time (Ancona, Okhuysen, & Perlow,
2001) and temporality can be enhanced in organisational processes by
being viewed as an ongoing relationship between past, present and future
(Schultz & Hernes, 2013). Actors’ ongoing present activities are contin-
ually enacted from past experiences by using presently available materi-
als to enhance an organisation’s future (Mead, 1932; Schultz & Hernes,
2013). This temporal aspect presents a unique opportunity to study val-
ues as part of the situated agency, and how it is informed by the capacity
to imagine alternative possibilities (Emirbayer & Mische, 1998, p. 963).
Within various aspects of temporality, it is highlighted that ‘process
studies meet practice’ (Langley et al., 2013, p. 5). Process studies draw
upon the past and make it relevant to the present. This process is not
viewed as a random exercise but as one that deepens the social practice
in which actors are embedded. This can be seen, for instance, in the
study conducted by Vaccaro and Palazzo (2015), the process of values
188 G. Espedal
work carried out by Addiopizzo is changing the practice of paying pizzo
to the mafia by focusing on the processes of dignity and legality.
The relational aspect of organisational work is clearly processual.
Experience is the deepest character of nature that bursts into existence
in each moment (Mesle & Dibben, 2017). We live in a complex world,
and we need to understand what factors establish order and stability and
how to achieve any degree of richness of experience. Investigating value
processes can grant insight into relational power and the growth of values
in our personal and communal experiences. Included in this are investi-
gations into what is required to sustain relationships and supportively
engage with others in an ongoing way. When studying the relational
aspects of processes, values become an important mechanism for iden-
tifying who we are as people caring about various things in the world
around us (Bednarek-Gilland, 2015). Whitehead (1957) highlights val-
ues as having an intrinsic nature, including a sense of immediate self-
valuing. Values nurture intentional openness in ourselves and others to
the complexities and the contrasts in the world around us (Mesle &
Dibben, 2017).
We are never neutral towards the things we care about (Bednarek-
Gilland, 2015). We try, test and make subjective justifications, which
again gives us ideas of what is good and how life might be lived. As such,
values can be defined as things that matter to us trans-situatively—in
specific situations as well as beyond the specificity of any situation—and
trans-subjectively—not only for myself, but also for others (Bednarek-
Gilland, 2015, p. 19).
Values as Part of Institutionalising Processes
Part of old institutionalism and recent streams of institutional theory can
be identified as process studies (Surachaikulwattana & Phillips, 2017).
While new institutionalism characterises institutions as stable and taken
for granted (Meyer & Rowan, 1977), the field has seen a shift from sta-
bility to institutional change and agency since the 1990s. The new tra-
jectories of institutional work (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006) and insti-
tutional logic (Friedland & Alford, 1991) have involved a growing focus
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 189
on understanding and unravelling the processes and mechanisms of insti-
tutionalising by investigating how institutions are created, maintained
and transformed as well as establishing a foundation for a social order
(Surachaikulwattana & Phillips, 2017).
Values as part of the organisational processes of institutionalism are
highlighted by Suddaby, Elsbach, Greenwood, Meyer, and Zilber (2010).
Leaning on Stinchcombe (1997, p. 8), Suddaby et al. argue that people
accept institutions, not because these institutions have the right answers,
but because they embody ‘a value that people accept’ (Suddaby et al.,
2010, p. 1235). For years, Selznick (1957, 2008) has highlighted val-
ues and ideals as part of the institutional processes of constructing the
agency, actions and practices of organisations. This includes looking at
organisational pressures and rivalries not as forms of mobilising indi-
vidual egotism but as a natural social process in which the intention is
to ask the right question on which ideals to treasure. Institutionalising
then becomes a means of infusing the organisation with values beyond
the technical requirements at hand in order to work on the institu-
tion as a natural product shaped by social needs and pressures (Selznick,
1957/1983, pp. 5, 17).
Investigating Values Informed by Process
Studies—A Strong-Process Perspective
To understand values in leadership and organisations and their tempo-
ral and relational aspects, we need strong-process studies that investigate
how values work is conditioned by organisational work and practices
and how it is institutionalised. Since few have investigated the processes
that enable the conditions for human agency and actions to maintain,
change and disrupt institutions and values work from a strong-process
study perspective, I will proceed by giving an example of such research
in one faith-based organisation (Espedal, 2019). Many of the most obvi-
ous methodologies for conducting empirical research from a process per-
spective are not new in and of themselves. Historical analysis, ethnog-
raphy and narrative approaches are well-established methods of natural
analysis of evolving temporal phenomenon, but will be presented here,
190 G. Espedal
since they present ideas of process sensitivity. The case example repre-
sents a unique case (Yin, 2014) of being rich in the phenomenon of
values work throughout 150 years of institutional history. Leaning on its
history and conveying a triangulation of methods consisting of archival
sources, ethnographic observation and semi-structured interviews, a five-
year study on values work in this faith-based organisation was conducted.
Identifying the processes of values work in the organisation was imple-
mented through studying processes from the outside and from within
(Langley & Tsoukas, 2017). Studying a phenomenon from the inside
involves an effort to capture the evolving meaningful experience; in this
case, looking at how meaning is taken care of by management and how
the identities and callings of institutions are resurrected through values
work. In the case of this organisation, the research was implemented
through ethnographic work involving semi-structured interviews asking
managers and employees at different levels open-ended questions about
the organisation’s activities, challenges and major concerns, as well as ask-
ing questions about how they saw values processes and value priorities at
work.
To establish a process-sensitive approach, two approaches were con-
ducted. First, catching the values in flight was implemented through ask-
ing questions starting with how, bringing in the temporal structures of
the organisation’s social practices and the uncertainty and urgency that
were inherently involved in them (Langley et al., 2013). The driving
assumption behind process thinking is that social reality is not steady
state. It is a dynamic process. The overriding aim of the process analyst is
therefore to catch the reality in flight, including values (Pettigrew, 1997).
Open-ended questions regarding activities, challenges and the major con-
cerns of the leaders and employees were asked, including question of how
they knew that stories made a difference to people at work. Additionally,
it was asked ‘At work, what are the most important and difficult discus-
sions you encounter?’ and how the interviewees saw values processes and
value priorities in their work.
Second, to identify the organisational aspects of reality in flight, sud-
den ruptures of change or the verb-influenced day-to-day practices that
occurred in an unexpected, non-routine manner were observed and iden-
tified. A way to identify relevant changes and unexpected events can
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 191
be shown through shadowing leaders (Czarniawska-Joerges, 2007) and
looking for how events and actions were connected to ongoing value dis-
courses. The aim was to investigate and observe values work in vivo in
social situations. The observations were especially driven by an interest
in investigating the performance of values work, but the observers were
also engaged in questions about how values work is organised through
talk and interaction.
A process-sensitive approach can also be to study a process from the
outside, capturing the process through which a phenomenon developed
over a chronology of time, with emphasis on how and why it happened
or changed or on following changes of events set off by an incident or by
accident (Van Hulst, Ybema, & Yanow, 2017). In these studies of prac-
tices, a process researcher might move from treating these phenomena
as stable entities to seeing them as entailing recurrent bricolages, break-
downs and improvisations. In the case organisation, it was when starting
the analytical work on the data that the process of value inquiry emerged.
A narrative approach (Rantakari & Vaara, 2016; Riessman, 2008) was
used to elicit the values work and value practices of the case organisa-
tion. Narratives play a key role in organisation process research due to
their temporality, providing descriptions of sequences of events (Ricoeur,
1984). Narratives can offer knowledge of human intentions and deeds
(Czarniawska, 2004, p. 650) and can play a crucial role in forming a
landscape of action (Bruner, 1986). Accordingly, narratives can provide
information on how things become organised (Boje, 1991) and on how
members make sense of things (Boje, 2008).
Stories and episodes crucial to the organisation were added to a time-
line, and tables were created for events, identifying their aims, actors,
motivations and financial platforms. The historical timeline was brack-
eted into periods to compare and identify the different elements that
facilitated the process of values work in the case organisation (Langley,
1999). In 1991, a chaotic situation was identified in the case organi-
sation, as the hospital’s existence was threatened by the municipality’s
suggestion to shut down the institution due to financial difficulties. This
chaotic situation led to the establishment of a new strategic plan (2002)
and a renewal of the organisational mission through launching two new
core values: compassion and quality. The value of compassion pointed
192 G. Espedal
backwards to the practices of the case organisation over 150 years, and
the value of quality was an answer to the demands and expectations of the
healthcare authorities who funded the hospital. Therefore, values were
studied retrospectively by looking back in time using archival sources
such as annual reports and minutes from the board, as well as prospec-
tively by observing the organisation and interviewing people at different
times to deepen the investigation. Going through the data material, the
author of the study searched for information-rich cases by using an inten-
sity sampling approach (Patton, 2002, p. 234) that located value-salient
issues. In zooming in on these stories, the author identified underlying
assumptions for each issue and named them as elements of the process of
value inquiry, including questioning the dominant value frame, refram-
ing and reinterpreting and realigning values work.
The analytical work and theorising of the value inquiry process extend
the emerging research on values work by highlighting the institutional
work of organisation members and stakeholders as moving beyond a lin-
ear view of institutional complexity to maintain and change values and
organisational agency in the face of plural demands. Unlike Gehman
et al. (2013), this study does not reserve the term value practices for
demarcated and recurrent bundles of actions that met specific time-
bound concerns, such as the performance of an honour code. Instead,
this study found values work as include any set of acts in everyday work
as being value-driven, and values work to be a particular set of actions
that enhance the ongoing knowledge and reflection-creating processes
that infuse an organisation with value-related actions (Espedal, 2019).
The process of value inquiry was identified as an open-ended process
of questioning and reinterpreting the meaning of dominant value frames
by continuously asking self-reflecting questions, such as ‘What is our
contribution now?’ and ‘Are we reaching those we are here for?’ (Espedal
et al., 2019). The process of value inquiry elaborates on the temporality
and intertextuality of values work, suggesting conditions under which
value inquiry becomes a dominant microprocess of building organisa-
tional meaning-making. The process of value inquiry occurs amidst a
need to accommodate external demands and balance internal agency and
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 193
practice. The process of self-reflection and the integration of values estab-
lish a central logic that guides and realigns organising principles and pro-
vides the organisation with a vocabulary of motive and sense of self.
The process of value inquiry is a response to a request from scholars
of the institutional work tradition to investigate the relationship between
actions and creation and between the maintenance and transformation
of institutions (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006). It has been suggested that
institutionalising processes affect institutions at a micro-level (Lawrence,
Suddaby, & Leca, 2009; Tolbert & Zucker, 1996). These institutionalis-
ing processes infuse the organisation with values beyond the immediate
technical requirements and work as a natural product in relation to social
needs and pressures (Selznick, 1957/1983, pp. 5, 17). As such, this values
work establishes a link between actions, agency and institutions.
Concluding Remarks
This chapter asks how process studies can contribute towards identifying
values work and the institutionalising processes of values work in organi-
sations. A new stream of values work studies is shedding light on how val-
ues work processes are shaping organisational forms, practices and activi-
ties. These process studies aim to unpack events to reveal an understand-
ing of the complex activities and transactions of values work in organi-
sations. However, one can ask if the recent stream of values work studies
goes far enough in including the process nature of institutions and insti-
tutionalisation for instance through strong-process studies studying how
reality is brought into being in every instant. In the illustrative study on
a highly value-salient organisation, it is highlighted how process studies
of values work can be conducted. The methodological approach being
used conveys a triangulation of methods consisting of archival sources,
ethnographic observation and semi-structured interviews. The described
research project asked how activities, challenges and the major concerns
of the leaders were enhanced through values work, bringing in tempo-
ral structures of social practice and looking for unexpected non-routines
or sudden ruptures of change. The agentic capacity that the values were
194 G. Espedal
producing in the case organisation was used to identify how the organi-
sation reorganised and reconstructed the habits and institutional agency
through a process of value inquiry. The process of value inquiry estab-
lished a profound process of institutionalisation meaning-making within
the organisation.
As future studies, the processes of values work could be investigated
in relation to several other topics. An interesting future process study
could involve investigating the values work involved in for instance the
worldwide #MeToo campaign, either with an insider or an outsider per-
spective. The #MeToo campaign started in October 2017 in the Holly-
wood film industry and has become a virtual revolution across the West.
This campaign has swept over Europe, with uprisings in different coun-
tries, including within professional groups in Norway. Many have used
the subject node and shared stories in virtual media. Under the key-
word #stilleføropptak (silent before shooting), the Norwegian newspa-
per Aftenposten published several stories together on 16 November 2017
with an appeal signed by almost 600 Norwegian actresses.
It would be interesting to investigate the #MeToo campaign and the
various associated mechanisms, issues and factors through examining
how processes have maintained and changed the desirable modes of insti-
tutional values such as respect and disrespect. How are people’s experi-
ences with disrespect and violence establishing patterns of action? How
are people re-establishing human worth through the campaign? How is
this values work related to the development of moral work and ethi-
cal attitudes? Stories presented in testimonies complemented with news
articles, blogs, columns, Facebook posts and letters to editors could be
the objects of studies. The #MeToo campaign has led to an increased
awareness of managers’ responsibility to prevent the problem and react
in an active manner. In this regard, a question of investigation could
involve identifying good practices and systems that establish people’s
safety when, for instance, making others aware of unwanted relationships
at work.
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 195
References
Aadland, E., & Skjørshammer, M. (2012). From God to good? Faith-based
institutions in the secular society. Journal of Management, Spirituality & Reli-
gion, 9(1), 83–101.
Ancona, D. G., Okhuysen, G. A., & Perlow, L. A. (2001). Taking time to
integrate temporal research. Academy of Management Review, 26 (4), 512–
529.
Ashcraft, K. L., Kuhn, T. R., & Cooren, F. (2009). Constitutional amend-
ments: ‘Materializing’ organizational communication. The Academy of Man-
agement Annals, 3(1), 1–64.
Askeland, H. (2014). Leaders should be the carriers of institutional values: An
account of how leaders contribute to the value-base of diaconal institutions.
Diaconia: Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 5(2), 147–175.
Askeland, H. (2016). Hverdagsledelse: Diakoni, Verdier og Ledelse i Praksis
[Everyday leadership: Diaconia, values and leadership in practise] (PhD the-
sis), The Faculty of Theology, Oslo, Norway.
Bakken, T., & Hernes, T. (2006). Organizing is both a verb and a noun: Weick
meets Whitehead. Organization Studies, 27 (11), 1599–1616.
Bednarek-Gilland, A. (2015). Researching values with qualitative methods: Empa-
thy, moral boundaries and the politics of research. London, UK: Ashgate Pub-
lishing Ltd.
Boje, D. M. (1991). The storytelling organization: A study of story perfor-
mance in an office-supply firm. Administrative Science Quarterly, 36 (1),
106–126.
Boje, D. M. (2008). Storytelling organizations. Los Angeles, CA: Sage.
Bruner, J. S. (1986). Actual minds, possible worlds. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
Czarniawska, B. (2004). The uses of narrative in social research. In M. A.
Hardy & A. Bryman (Eds.), Handbook of data analysis (pp. 649–666). Lon-
don: Sage.
Czarniawska-Joerges, B. (2007). Shadowing: And other techniques for doing field-
work in modern societies. Malmø, Sweden: Liber/CBS Press.
Daskalaki, M., Fotaki, M., & Sotiropoulou, I. (2018). Performing values prac-
tices and grassroots organizing: The case of solidarity economy initiatives in
Greece. Organization Studies, 1–25.
Dewey, J. (1939). Theory of valuation (Vol. II). Chicago, IL: The University of
Chicago Press.
196 G. Espedal
Eide, T., & Eide, H. (2008). Verdien av en verdi-intervensjon. En studie av
verdiarbeid i et norsk sykehus [The value of a value-intervention. A study
of value work in a Norwegian hospital]. Retrieved from Diakonhjemmet:
https://vid.brage.unit.no/vid-xmlui/bitstream/handle/11250/98571/Eide%
20og%20Eide%20-%20Verdien%20av%20en%20verdi-intervensjon%
20Rapport%202-2008 ?sequence=1&isAllowed=y.
Emirbayer, M., & Mische, A. (1998). What is agency? American Journal of
Sociology, 103(4), 962–1023.
Espedal, G. (2019). Being compassionate. Institutionalizing through values work
in a faith-based organization (PhD thesis). VID Specialized University, Oslo.
Espedal, G., Carlsen, A., & Askeland, H. (2019). How do we reach out to those
we are here for? Value inquiry in sustaining institutions. Work in process.
Falkenberg, G. (2006). Verdier og sosiale normer i store norske virksomheter. Vik-
tige kulturbærere eller fordekt PR? Retrieved from http://www.fafo.no/~fafo/
media/com_netsukii/10028 .
Friedland, R., & Alford, R. R. (1991). Bringing society back in: Symbols, prac-
tices and institutional contradictions. In W. W. Powell & P. J. DiMaggio
(Eds.), The new institutionalism in organizational analysis (pp. 232–267).
Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.
Gehman, J., Trevino, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Hernes, T. (2014). A process theory of organization. Oxford, UK: Oxford Uni-
versity Press.
Hernes, T. (2016). Organisering i en verden i bevegelse [Organizing in a moving
world]. Oslo, Norway: Cappelen Damm.
Hofstede, G. (1980). Culture’s consequences: International differences in work-
related values. Beverly Hills, CA: Sage.
Inglehart, R. (1977). The silent revolution: Changing values and political styles
among Western publics. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Langley, A. (1999). Strategies for theorizing from process data. Academy of
Management Review, 24(4), 691–710.
Langley, A. (2009). Studying processes in and around organizations. In D.
Buchanan & A. Bryman (Eds.), The Sage handbook of organizational research
methods (pp. 409–429). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Langley, A., Smallman, C., Tsoukas, H., & de Ven, A. V. (2013). Process stud-
ies of change in organization and management: Unveiling temporality, activ-
ity and flow. Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 1–13.
https://vid.brage.unit.no/vid-xmlui/bitstream/handle/11250/98571/Eide%20og%20Eide%20-%20Verdien%20av%20en%20verdi-intervensjon%20Rapport%202-2008 %3fsequence%3d1%26isAllowed%3dy
http://www.fafo.no/%7efafo/media/com_netsukii/10028
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 197
Langley, A., & Tsoukas, H. (2010). Introducing perspectives on process orga-
nization studies. Process, Sensemaking and Organizing, 1(9), 1–27.
Langley, A., & Tsoukas, H. (2017). Introduction: Process thinking, process
theorizing and process researching. In A. Langley & H. Tsoukas (Eds.), The
Sage handbook of process organization studies (pp. 1–25). Thousand Oaks,
CA: Sage.
Lawrence, T. B., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work.
In S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. B. Lawrence, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), The Sage
handbook of organization studies (2nd ed., pp. 215–254). London, UK: Sage.
Lawrence, T. B., Suddaby, R., & Leca, B. (2009). Introduction: Theorizing
and studying institutional work. In T. B. Lawrence, R. Suddaby, & B. Leca
(Eds.), Institutional work: Actors and agency in institutional studies of organi-
zations (pp. 1–29). Cambridge, MA: Cambridge University Press.
Mead, G. H. (1932). The philosophy of the present. Chicago, IL: Open Court
Publishing Company.
Mesle, C. R., & Dibben, M. R. (2017). Whitehead’s process relational phi-
losophy. In A. Langley & H. Tsoukas (Eds.), The Sage handbook of process
organization studies. London, UK: Sage.
Meyer, J. W., & Rowan, B. (1977). Institutionalized organizations: Formal
structure as myth and ceremony. American Journal of Sociology, 83(2), 340–
363.
Patton, M. Q. (2002). Purposeful sampling. In M. Q. Patton (Ed.), Qualitative
designs and data collection (pp. 230–245). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Pettigrew, A. M. (1997). What is a processual analysis? Scandinavian Journal of
Management, 13(4), 337–348.
Rantakari, A., & Vaara, E. (2016). Narratives and processuality. In A. Langley
& H. Tsoukas (Eds.), The Sage handbook of process organization studies
(pp. 271–286). London, UK: Sage.
Ricoeur, P. (1984). Time and narrative (Vol. I). Chicago, IL: University of
Chicago Press.
Riessman, C. K. (2008). Narrative methods for the human sciences. Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
Schatzki, T. (2002). The site of the social: A philosophical exploration of the consti-
tution of social life and change. University Park, PA: The Pennsylvania State
University Press.
Schultz, M., & Hernes, T. (2013). A temporal perspective on organizational
identity. Organization Science, 24(1), 1–21.
Schwartz, S. H. (1996). Value priorities and behavior: Applying a theory of
integrated value system. In C. Seligman, J. M. Olson, & M. P. Zanna (Eds.),
198 G. Espedal
The psychology of values: The Ontario symposium (Vol. 8, pp. 119–144). Mah-
wah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum.
Schwartz, S. H. (2006). A theory of cultural value orientations: Explication
and applications. Comparative Sociology, 5(2), 137–182.
Selznick, P. (1957/1983). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpreta-
tion. Berkeley, CA: University of California Press.
Selznick, P. (2008). A humanist science: Values and ideals in social inquiry. Stan-
ford, CA: Stanford University Press.
Sorokin, P. A., & Merton, R. K. (1937). Social time: A methodological and
functional analysis. American Journal of Sociology, 42(5), 615–629.
Stinchcombe, A. L. (1997). On the virtues of the old institutionalism. Annual
Review of Sociology, 23(1), 1–18.
Suddaby, R., Elsbach, K. D., Greenwood, R., Meyer, J. W., & Zilber, T.
B. (2010). Organizations and their institutional environments—Bringing
meaning, values, and culture back in: Introduction to the special research
forum. Academy of Management Journal, 53(6), 1234–1240.
Surachaikulwattana, P., & Phillips, N. (2017). Institutions as process. In A.
Langley & H. Tsoukas (Eds.), The Sage handbook of process organization stud-
ies (pp. 372–387). London, UK: Sage.
Tolbert, P. S., & Zucker, L. G. (1996). The institutionalization of institutional
theory. In S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), Handbook of orga-
nization studies (pp. 175–190). London, UK: Sage.
Vaccaro, A., & Palazzo, G. (2015). Values against violence: Institutional change
in societies dominated by organized crime. Academy of Management Journal,
58(4), 1075–1101.
Van Hulst, M., Ybema, S., & Yanow, D. (2017). Ethnography and organiza-
tional processes. In H. Tsoukas & A. Langley (Eds.), The Sage handbook of
process organization studies (pp. 223–236). London, UK: Sage.
VanderPal, G., & Ko, V. (2014). An overview of global leadership: Ethics,
values, cultural diversity and conflicts. Journal of Leadership, Accountability
& Ethics, 11(3), 166–175.
Weick, K. E. (1979). The social psychology of organizing (2nd ed.). Reading,
MA: Addison-Wesley.
Weick, K. E. (1995). Sensemaking in organizations. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Whitehead, A. N., & Sherburne, D. W. (1957). Process and reality. New York,
NY: Macmillan.
Wright, A. L., Zammuto, R. F., & Liesch, P. W. (2017). Maintaining the values
of a profession: Institutional work and moral emotions in the emergency
department. Academy of Management Journal, 60(1), 200–237.
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective … 199
Yin, R. K. (2014). Case study research: Design and methods (5th ed.). Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
11
Values as Fixed and Fluid: Negotiating
the Elasticity of Core Values
Stephen Sirris
Introduction
Values connect ideals and actions as they are ‘conceptions of the desir-
able which are not directly observable, but evident in moral discourse and
patterns of attitudes forming value orientations with relevance to action’
(Van Deth & Scarbrough, 1995, p. 46). Similarly, Chapter 1 of this book
reflects this connection by defining values as ‘individual and collective
conceptions of desirable behaviours, objectives and ideals that serve to
guide or valuate practice’. The present chapter extends our understanding
of the interaction between values and practices by utilising a critical per-
spective on how values are externalised in the work of organisations and
managers. Organisations have multiple values that provide guidelines to
potentially different courses of action. Such plurality is reflected in stud-
ies that categorise values into clusters such as professional, personal or
organisational (Cameron, Quinn, DeGraff, & Thakor, 2014). These sets
S. Sirris (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: stephen.sirris@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_11
201
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_11&domain=pdf
mailto:stephen.sirris@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_11
202 S. Sirris
of values are safeguarded by various actors. The relation between value
sets may range from conflicting to complementing.
Several scholars have shed light on tensions between organisational
values. It is well known that replacing existing core values and intro-
ducing new ones is a challenge (Rokeach, 1973). In fact, Gehman,
Trevino, and Garud (2013) claim that the act of defining core values
has received more attention than the process of implementing them.
The process of values replacing one another through institutional change
has been described by Cha and Edmondson (2006) and Wæraas (2018).
Moreover, the tensions between values are highlighted in the distinction
between espoused values and values-in-use (Argyris & Schon, 1978).
Cha and Edmondson (2006) also noted how various interpretations
of values may give rise to accusations of hypocrisy, owing to the gap
between one’s saying and doing. Further, values have also been studied
as stemming from the institutional logics that are relevant to organisa-
tional members (Cameron et al., 2014).
Instead of studying the dynamics between value sets, this chapter
examines how the same core values are pursued in different ways and for
different ends. Core values constitute a specific set of values that serve to
provide a sense of unity. Internal to organisations, core values are identity
markers, signalling stability and consistency across organisational struc-
tures. They operate at an aggregate level and may be the result of internal
consensus as well as approval from wider constituencies and stakehold-
ers (Wæraas, 2018). However, even if values are shared verbatim across
organisations, their interpretation in contexts tends to be unique because
these contexts are related to people and the organisational history, prac-
tices, culture and structure (Schein, 2010). Importantly, the stable yet
contingent nature of core values implies tensions and sets the scene for
institutional complexity. However, this paradox can easily be overlooked,
also by researchers, since values are primarily used to express identity: the
enduring, unique and central characteristics of an organisation (Albert &
Whetten, 1985).
Situating this chapter in the perspective of values work, I examine how
managers negotiate core values within a firmly established and thriving
organisational value discourse. I present a case study of a sudden inter-
ruption that triggers values work. I analyse how the discourse manifests
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 203
in local discussions when actors reconstruct the core values in particular
settings. This study of the interplay between discourse and managerial
efforts is undertaken in a faith-based hospital, which is a rich setting
for values work. The case study reports an acute infection crisis where
managers in two departments strategically activate and reinterpret the
hospital’s core values.
My theoretical interest lies in analysing the mechanisms that affect this
type of values work. More particularly, I explore the ambiguous nature
of values by examining the tension between values that seem fixed at an
organisational discursive level and fluid at an individual managerial level.
This study explores how values that are initially articulated to promote
unity and consensus are subject to the dynamics of conceptual stretch-
ing. I conceptualise this stretching as value elasticity which develops the
notion that values are ambiguous. The overall aim of this chapter is not
only to improve the understanding of how managers engage in values
work when negotiating values but also to propose a renewed conceptu-
alisation of such efforts. The research question guiding this work is how
do managers negotiate core values as fixed and fluid? In the following sec-
tions, I further clarify key concepts and ground my study. Subsequently,
I present the research context and methods, describe the case, discuss the
main findings and present my concluding remarks.
Theoretical Perspectives on Core Values
as Fixed and Fluid
Goals and means are constantly negotiated in managerial practices.
According to Selznick (1957), managers’ primary—and paradoxical—
job is to maintain organisational values while simultaneously adapting
to changes. Managers essentially safeguard what organisations tend to
consider their basic values. The fixed aspects of values are their central,
distinctive and enduring qualities. However, as organisations evolve, they
risk deviating from their original goals. This drift can occur in the mis-
sion and values because of their abstract or ‘fuzzy’ nature. Values are not
entirely fixed, even though organisations may articulate their core val-
ues clearly. Actors engage in a dynamic interplay of values and tend to
204 S. Sirris
employ new interpretations. The same values can refer to different ideas
for different people and encapsulate various meanings, signalling fluidity.
Often, employees turn to managers to provide meaning on ambiguous
events. Values are by nature ambiguous—capable of carrying historical
ideology and allowing for differing views and motivations to promote
their acceptance. According to Eisenberg (1984), ambiguity promotes
‘unified diversity’ for the organisational members and hence facilitates
organisational change. When a value allows for varied classifications, it is
deemed ambiguous:
Values are expressed in this form because their equivocal expression
allows for multiple interpretations while at the same time promoting a
sense of unity. It is therefore not the case that people are moved toward
the same views (in any objective verifiable sense) but rather that the
ambiguous statement of core values allows them to maintain individual
interpretations while at the same time believing that they are in agree-
ment. (Eisenberg, 1984, p. 232)
This citation displays a relativist view of meaning, which is contextual
and constructed. Ambiguity implies a lack in both message attributes and
receiver interpretation, typically evident in situations where equivocality
is absent. Omitting contextual cues allows for multiple interpretations. A
strategic use of ambiguity serves to accomplish goals, and inconsistency
of goals may increase flexibility. Ambiguity thus balances the organisa-
tional needs for both individuality and community, which are essentially
paradoxical. Ambiguity is well known in relation to reforms, which call
for institutional work, and lends to creativity and agency, in which indi-
viduals may exploit a reform to their own interests (Thelen & Mahoney,
2010).
I argue that although core values are fixed by definition, they are nego-
tiated and altered in ways that reveal their elasticity. Core values are sub-
ject to ongoing tensions. Gehman et al. (2013, p. 105) commented on
this fluidity in the following words:
Even when the “same” values (such as honesty and transparency) were
invoked, those involved drew from disparate personal, organizational,
professional, institutional, and societal understandings and experiences
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 205
to interpret and assign meaning. What appeared to be agreement about
the importance of specific values on the surface revealed a plurality of
understandings at a deeper level, sometimes even leading those involved
to reach opposing conclusions about the appropriate practices to pursue.
A value discourse may be contested in terms of practices that are deemed
valid manifestations of the core values. Discursive practices encompass
the more dynamic or even fluid properties of core values when nego-
tiated and lead to divergent configurations of practices. Whereas rules
are direct guidelines in articulated situations, values are indicators for
actions and offer room for discretion. For example, when core values
are interpreted in health care, they are presumably expanded to include
elements of professional values (Sirris & Byrkjeflot, 2019). When the
contents of a given value are substantially altered, actors interpret the
value to include other notions or practices than typically assumed to be
contained in the core value. Metaphorically, defining the boundaries of
a given value involves conceptual stretching by contracting or expand-
ing the contents of the value (Cha & Edmondson, 2006). I study the
dynamic tensions between core values that are fixed and fluid by terming
the conceptual stretching as value elasticity. I argue that although core
values by definition are fixed, actors negotiate and alter values in ways
that show elasticity.
Research Context and Methods
To study managers negotiating values within a distinctive organisational
discourse, I employed a method that allowed access to sayings and doings
at a micro-level. This chapter reports parts of a larger ethnographic field-
work involving a single case study conducted within a hospital, which
consisted of interviews, observations and archival material.
Research Setting and the Values Discourse
Hospitals are well known for institutional pluralism and multiple insti-
tutional logics. My case hospital is located in a larger Norwegian city and
206 S. Sirris
functions as local hospital with some specialisations. It has 1700 employ-
ees and three managerial levels and caters to a catchment area of 150,000
residents. This particular context and organisation are value laden due to
the history of the organisation and its challenges stemming from being
diaconal or faith-based. The hospital has over the last decades actively
sought to reformulate its Christian mission and identity through sev-
eral projects on core values. Values may serve as stepping stones between
the sacred and the secular, facilitating dialogue between the diaconal his-
tory and traditional Christian imagery on the one hand and the grow-
ing demands and expectations of the state to deliver welfare services in
an increasingly secularised manner on the other (Askeland, Espedal, &
Sirris, 2019). The resurgent attention towards values among faith-based
organisations is characterised by the dual context of religion and a secu-
lar society (Aadland & Skjørshammer, 2012). Both share an interest in
ethics, despite growing individualistic and anti-dogmatic spirituality.
My case hospital has a strong and long-standing value discourse that
has prompted extensive projects on the role of values within the organi-
sation, involving comprehensive processes, managers and employees. The
hospital’s chosen core values quality, justice, service and respect manifest
in many ways and constitute a value discourse inhabiting the organi-
sation and profoundly permeating it. Table 11.1 lists the central value
statements obtained from an analysis of the hospital’s documents. This
chapter explores how unexpected and acute changes triggered the man-
agers to negotiate these values. The case I will discuss was a sudden out-
break methicillin-resistant Staphylococcus aureus (MRSA) infection in the
hospital.
The value discourse was incorporated into practices like seminars for
new employees, which introduced the core values and its history. Man-
agers also had a value codex as part of their training programme. Plenary
settings were arenas for interpretation of the diaconal tradition and val-
ues. The CEO actively shared narratives across the organisation about
the hospital’s founder and the Good Samaritan. He saw it as his mis-
sion to articulate the expectations of employees in order to enhance the
core values. Narratives served as models for value practices, displaying
good examples for others to live by. Moreover, there were several posi-
tions such as deacons and chaplains at the hospital. In every department,
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 207
Ta
b
le
1
1
.1
H
o
sp
it
a
l
va
lu
e
d
is
co
u
rs
e
B
yl
a
w
st
a
te
m
e
n
ts
St
ra
te
g
ic
p
la
n
st
a
te
m
e
n
ts
C
E
O
’s
o
p
e
ra
ti
o
n
a
l
st
a
te
m
e
n
ts
V
a
lu
e
s
a
n
d
va
lu
e
e
xp
li
ca
ti
o
n
in
p
o
li
cy
d
o
cu
m
e
n
ts
T
h
e
h
o
sp
it
a
l
is
a
d
m
in
is
te
re
d
b
y
b
yl
a
w
s
se
t
b
y
th
e
o
w
n
e
r
a
n
d
N
o
rw
e
g
ia
n
h
e
a
lt
h
la
w
a
n
d
a
g
re
e
m
e
n
ts
m
a
d
e
w
it
h
re
g
io
n
a
l
h
e
a
lt
h
ca
re
a
u
th
o
ri
ti
e
s
T
h
e
h
o
sp
it
a
l
id
e
n
ti
fi
e
s
a
s
e
cc
le
si
a
l
a
n
d
d
ia
co
n
a
l
V
is
io
n
P
io
n
e
e
rs
in
ca
re
fo
r
h
u
m
a
n
b
e
in
g
s
in
d
is
tr
e
ss
.
R
e
n
e
w
e
rs
in
se
rv
ic
e
fo
r
o
u
r
n
e
ig
h
b
o
u
rs
M
o
tt
o
:
E
n
g
a
g
e
d
fo
r
h
u
m
a
n
s
a
n
d
in
th
e
b
e
li
e
f
th
a
t
e
a
ch
h
u
m
a
n
b
e
in
g
h
a
s
va
lu
e
a
s
cr
e
a
te
d
in
th
e
e
ye
s
o
f
G
o
d
,
cr
e
a
ti
n
g
a
m
u
tu
a
l
co
m
m
u
n
it
y
w
it
h
G
o
d
a
n
d
fe
ll
o
w
h
u
m
a
n
b
e
in
g
s
T
h
e
id
e
n
ti
ty
is
b
a
se
d
o
n
1
2
6
ye
a
rs
o
f
se
rv
in
g
(d
ia
co
n
ia
)
C
o
n
ti
n
u
e
in
th
e
sa
m
e
sp
ir
it
,
ch
a
ll
e
n
g
e
,
d
o
so
m
e
th
in
g
o
u
ts
id
e
th
e
m
a
in
st
re
a
m
a
n
d
e
ss
e
n
ti
a
ll
y
se
rv
e
th
e
co
m
m
o
n
g
o
o
d
T
h
e
k
e
y
o
b
je
ct
iv
e
o
f
th
e
h
o
sp
it
a
l
is
to
e
n
su
re
th
a
t
p
a
ti
e
n
ts
re
ce
iv
e
th
e
b
e
st
p
o
ss
ib
le
tr
e
a
tm
e
n
t
R
e
sp
e
ct
:
U
n
d
e
rs
ta
n
d
in
g
a
n
d
re
sp
e
ct
in
g
th
e
co
m
p
le
x
n
e
e
d
s
o
f
vu
ln
e
ra
b
le
p
a
ti
e
n
ts
a
n
d
th
e
ir
k
in
a
s
w
e
ll
th
e
ir
p
e
rs
o
n
a
l
in
te
g
ri
ty
a
n
d
ch
a
ra
ct
e
ri
st
ic
s
Q
u
a
li
ty
:
T
h
e
h
o
sp
it
a
l’
s
se
rv
ic
e
s
sh
o
u
ld
b
e
o
f
h
ig
h
q
u
a
li
ty
b
y
e
n
su
ri
n
g
co
m
m
it
m
e
n
t
to
p
ro
fe
ss
io
n
a
l
co
m
p
e
te
n
cy
a
n
d
b
e
st
p
ra
ct
ic
e
s
Se
rv
ic
e
:
A
ll
co
o
p
e
ra
ti
o
n
a
m
o
n
g
p
a
ti
e
n
ts
,
k
in
a
n
d
e
m
p
lo
ye
e
s
is
a
n
o
p
p
o
rt
u
n
it
y
to
o
ff
e
r
se
rv
ic
e
s,
b
e
a
va
il
a
b
le
a
n
d
e
xp
re
ss
co
m
p
a
ss
io
n
a
n
d
ca
re
Ju
st
ic
e
:
T
h
e
h
o
sp
it
a
l
w
il
l
sa
fe
g
u
a
rd
p
a
ti
e
n
ts
a
n
d
th
e
ir
k
in
’s
ri
g
h
ts
,
re
p
re
se
n
t
vu
ln
e
ra
b
le
g
ro
u
p
s
a
n
d
st
ri
ve
fo
r
th
e
ri
g
h
t
a
n
d
e
ff
e
ct
iv
e
u
se
o
f
re
so
u
rc
e
s
208 S. Sirris
there was a part-time diaconal nurse. Another channel was the provisions
of gifts with diaconal spirit as well as books and magazines emphasising
the organisation’s values and identity.
Data Collection and Analysis
Data collection for this study was completed between January and June
2016. Data were collected by 10 days of shadowing two nurse middle
managers. This process gave access to both actions and interpretations
(Denzin & Lincoln, 2005). By following managers around as they were
doing their work, I was able to capture all the activities of the man-
agers for a workweek. Moreover, I interviewed them before and after the
shadowing session on managerial roles, co-operation, tasks, challenges
and issues they found relevant. Additionally, I interviewed the CEO, two
of the managers’ superiors and ten subordinates. In total, 15 interviews
were performed in Norwegian, recorded and transcribed verbatim. Rele-
vant hospital documents and webpages were analysed. The chapter offers
empirical evidence by focusing on how a dramatic situation triggered
specific measures that interfered with the daily routines of the units, and
how the two managers adopted different strategies for coping with the
situation.
Importantly, I chose two hospital units to study how the exact same
values were negotiated differently. The first part of my analytical strat-
egy involved thematic coding (Denzin & Lincoln, 2005). The material
related to the infection crisis was easily identified and subjected to open
coding. Then, I wrote summaries as narratives of the event from the per-
spectives of each manager, which are presented below as case descrip-
tions. From this analysis and in-depth descriptions of actions, interac-
tions and intentions, emerging from both the interviews and the obser-
vations, I developed categories and themes from the data as exemplary
quotes and codes. I analysed the notions that core values encompassed
and tabulated the articulation of the values. The key insights from the
analysis pertain to how managers align practices with core values.
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 209
Case Description and Findings
Departing from the notion of values as both fixed and fluid within the
hospital’s value discourse, I describe the interrupting event that triggered
the values work. The data highlight certain mechanisms in the values
work, which represent the main themes of the analysis: framing, target-
ing, negotiating, and a new practice as the outcome.
Framing
The disruption reported in this case occurred rather suddenly—an out-
break of MRSA infection. During the outbreak, I was engaged in
fieldwork within the hospital. When the outbreak was announced, all
employees and managers in the surgery and medical departments gath-
ered for an update from the infection control specialists. The event was
officially framed as a crisis. It was clearly communicated that the out-
break severely threatened the daily functioning of the hospital. At worst,
it would result in a ban on operations and shutdown of complete depart-
ments, which meant that no patients could be admitted. However, the
specialists’ understanding was questioned by some employees. In the ple-
nary session, no specific information was shared about how every hospital
department was to operationalise measures to cope with the situation.
The situation was particularly difficult for the surgery unit, where the
managerial group met to discuss the next steps. The managers decided on
immediate measures with respect to hygiene and strict infection control.
They worked out the technicalities that affected the daily operations of
the unit, such as washing the ventilation system, possibly closing surgery
rooms, building barracks for surgery, prohibiting the wearing of jewellery
and wearing new clothes with less particle release. These measures were
planned to diminish the danger of contamination. The outbreak threw
a department that worked in clockwork fashion into chaos, profoundly
changing a system where everything was planned in detail and performed
by specialists.
210 S. Sirris
Targeting
Following the joint hospital meeting that framed the situation as a crisis,
the managerial group of the surgery unit met. The group was headed
by the unit manager, Tor, and the assistant unit manager, Anne. This
meeting served as a debriefing and was aimed at outlining the next steps
and preparing for the staff meeting on the following day.
Tor: I have to consider quality, which means safety for patients. Quality is
paramount. Does anyone disagree?
Anne: Whatever we do, care for the patients must be the priority in this
crisis. Not inflicting any danger. Perform quality work, as always. Yet,
we also have to think about the employees.
The sequence of the conversation highlights the severity of the situa-
tion. The interpretation of the situation as a crisis was confirmed. This
unit was faced with the challenge of handling the disruption. The man-
agers displayed commitment to the core values and did not question
them. Central to the discussion was identifying the target of the values:
patients or clients. This was the starting point for deciding the measures
to be taken. The unit manager believed that the patients were the target
and that the employees should adjust. This, in turn, led to some con-
fronting.
Confronting
The discussion gave rise to some tensions between the managerial group
and the professionals. In the following session of the meeting, specific
measures were discussed like change of clothes, closing of doors and
ensuring less traffic. Some measures were prescribed as vital, while oth-
ers were optional and a matter of discretion, depending on the fram-
ing of the situation. It was evident that the core values were evoked
to strengthen the argument for strict measures. Quality and respect for
patients trumped other concerns. In the discussions following the out-
break, the issue of new clothes—switching from ordinary green cotton
clothing to blue surgical paper clothes—was of particular interest. Blue
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 211
clothes were more hygienic but warm and uncomfortable to wear. This
indicates a new practice. In their discussion, managers shared some more
relevant information: air quality measurements in the surgery rooms had
revealed high particulate matter, so measures had to be taken to improve
patient safety. Blue clothing was tighter and would reduce the transmis-
sion of particles but was highly unpopular among the nurses. The man-
agers decided on a strategy to approach the professionals, since they sus-
pected that this measure would not be appreciated.
The following transcript highlights the conflicts between the manage-
ment and the employees of the unit. The staff representative was called
Hans. Both Tor and Anne wore blue paper clothing. When I made a
note of this, Tor replied, ‘I do not have to participate in surgery today.
A bit symbolic… I want to statue a good example’. In the staff meeting,
a nurse asked whether it was acceptable to wear trousers under the blue
surgical clothing. The group then discussed different clothing issues.
Tor: We have a crystal clear recommendation, and we must follow it.
Clothing is of immediate importance. We must prioritise quality and
safety.
Hans: The surgeons, however, sit with open coats. Some anaesthetics even
wear jewellery. It is very unhygienic with maintenance work in the cor-
ridors.
Tor: We are the ones who must take the lead and set a good example.
Hans: Heat makes the blue surgical clothing melt. It burns easily.
Tor: We must prioritise fire safety. I too am extremely exhausted by the
maintenance work.
Hans: What about the nurses who are allergic to the blue clothing?
Tor: No other hospitals have reported any kind of allergic reactions. Now,
we are in crisis. We must use blue clothing.
Hans: Two of the nurses were dripping wet because of the blue clothing.
This is not justice or respect!
Tor: There is nothing to discuss! This is how we have to do it now!
This discussion between the manager and the staff representative is an
example of the use of values as motivation for actions. Tor emphasised
quality, arguing for safety and hygiene for the sake of the patients, while
Hans defended the rights of the employees. Hans based his argument on
the employees’ work conditions and challenged the process of how the
212 S. Sirris
decisions were made. Further, he noted that while surgery nurses had
to strictly follow the rules, the surgeons and anaesthetics seem to flout
them. Finally, he addressed the issue of respect: he noted that the staff
did not feel that the manager had approached the situation in a respectful
or understanding manner. The above excerpt shows that Tor considered
the patients the target of core values, which in turn meant confronting
the professionals.
Identifying
Hanne was the unit manager in the medical unit. She met with her assis-
tant, Atle, and a physician. Below is an excerpt of their conversation:
Hanne: I have to protect my staff from this interference. If nurses have to
use a disinfecting spray and wash the rooms, there will be no time left
for patient care and professional tasks. This is by definition not their
job.
Atle: Yes, this means a drop in quality. Such measures prevent us from pro-
viding good care. The central hospital management is not very respect-
ful. They don’t understand our unit’s situation and how the infection
affects our work.
Physician: The measures imposed on us are quite out of proportion.
These data challenge the framing of the event as a crisis. This may partly
be explained by the nature of the medical unit in which patients were
kept for supervision before and after surgery. In their conversation, the
core value of justice was evoked by ridiculing the strict demands for
washing the walls and floors but not the door. Hanne’s strategy was
explicitly to protect the professionals. Instead of confronting them, she
emphasised on identification with them.
Her position was also evident in the subsequent staff meeting. Hanne
wanted to safeguard her staff from ‘this interruption of [their] daily
business’. In meetings with the infection control team and physicians,
she negotiated strongly, and in staff meetings, she did so by under-
communicating the danger. At the staff meeting, Hanne provided very
little information, which signalled that the outbreak was not a crisis.
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 213
Hanne: Have you all seen the e-mail from the infection advisors? These
bacteria cannot fly or jump. They are transmitted physically. So, wash
your hands and be meticulous about hygiene—as always.
Atle: You also know about the measures. We are told to work based on val-
ues. This situation represents challenges for us. I believe that we should
be left in peace to realise and work based on the core values, as we see
fit.
Employee: We must respect the new guidelines, right?
Hanne: How do we show justice in a situation when we are full with
patients? Values keep up reflections. Yet we cannot abdicate from our
core work.
Negotiating
The above sequences reveal strategies for negotiating the fixedness and
fluidity of values. These strategies involve both defining the values on a
general basis and specifying what practising the value in a new situation
means for the actors. In the surgery unit, tensions arose between the two
groups of discussion participants: the managerial group and the profes-
sionals. Both groups agreed that patient security was of upmost impor-
tance, aligning with the core value of quality. The managers argued that
the professionals, instead of prioritising the patients, were emphasising
their own rights in the name of justice. Both parties agreed that respect
was shown to patients but not to employees or managers. The profes-
sionals believed that the unit management was loyal towards the hospi-
tal management but not towards the employees. In other words, they
were disregarding the professional value of collegiality. The target of the
core values was thus contested. The managers held differing views about
whether the employees or patients were the targets of the core values.
In the medical unit, the two parties were the unit manager and the
staff on the one hand and the central management of the hospital,
including infection control specialists, on the other. In this unit, the
manager identified more clearly with the professionals. She interpreted
the infection control measures as an interference to the work of the unit
and engaged at length to protect the daily functioning of the unit. Her
stance was against that of the hospital management, and she repeatedly
214 S. Sirris
Table 11.2 Managerial values work
Characteristic Surgery unit Medical unit
EVENT Bacteria outbreak in hospital
FRAMING Severe crisis to be
handled
Undue disruption to be
avoided
TARGETING Patients Professionals
Confronting Professionals Top management
Identifying Patients and top
managements
Professionals
NEGOTIATING
Quality Safety for patients Providing good
professional work
Justice Rights of patients Rights of employees
Respect Enforced measures Regular professional
work and routines
OUTCOME
Example of new
practice
New clothing Strengthen existing
hygienic procedures
highlighted the violation of the value discourse by the top management.
This indicates that core values were tools of loyalty. She frequently con-
fronted her top managers about practices that were not coherent with the
core values. She explained that if those values were to be realised, a higher
budget was needed. She also asked for the core values to be changed to
avoid ‘open hypocrisy’. Table 11.2 summarises the main findings and the
central efforts of the two managers. The data also indicate a process with
overlapping phases of managerial values work.
Discussion
The research question guiding this study is ‘How do managers negotiate
core values as fixed and fluid? ’ Situated within a values discourse of a
hospital, the case study illustrates how managers evoke, interpret and re-
construct core values at a time of sudden change. This case is highly rel-
evant to elucidate the phenomenon in question: managerial values work.
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 215
Capturing the Fixed and Fluid Nature of Values
One of the main contributions of this work is how the data display val-
ues as both fixed and fluid. This conceptualisation develops Eisenberg
(1984, p. 232) who points out that values promote ‘unified diversity’
because of their ambiguous nature. Core values appear to be a double-
edged sword: easy to recapitulate but also to alter. Studying the inter-
pretations of core values in situ showcases their dynamics as values, by
nature, extend beyond the particular yet are enacted in specific contexts
and situations. They are abstract and theoretical yet leave solid impres-
sions and serve as orienting devices for actions (Van Deth & Scarbrough,
1995). The study findings highlight how values are manifested in an
organisation’s structure and culture, yet they are also manipulated. Thus,
values are simultaneously fixed and fluid.
As expected, both nurse managers demonstrated value consciousness
and identified the value discourse as the central driver of their actions
in a critical situation. A key difference, however, was the issue of target-
ing. The middle managers were unsure if they had to be loyal to the top
management or the employees, and to the hospital or their own unit.
Both managers experienced a mismatch between the core values and the
observed practices. They engaged and risked conflicts to avoid this dis-
crepancy between values and practices. This involvement reflects their
commitment to the core values as they felt deeply responsible for shap-
ing the practices accordingly. Thus, the observations in this study reveal
how the boundaries between values blur.
The phases of framing, targeting, and negotiating show how values are
fundamentally imprecise and open to various interpretations in different
contexts. On the one hand, a fixed set of core values was recognised in
the research context; however, on the other hand, this set was fluid due to
its embeddedness in the flux of events. This was evident in the case where
the two middle managers channelled information differently. The surgery
unit manager was very direct and did not initiate talks; instead, he argued
for certain measures. The medical unit manager held back information
from her employees and downplayed the heated debates during the man-
agerial meetings. Through their rhetorical efforts—or lack thereof—they
216 S. Sirris
prioritised the infection event differently. In the surgery unit, the discus-
sions were dramatic, but in the medical unit, the measures were ridiculed
and not considered worth fussing over. This indicates that in the medical
unit, the core values were not employed to promote the infection control
measures. On the contrary, arguing from the perspective quality, the unit
was in favour of letting professionals do their work.
The Elasticity of Values
A second contribution of this work is the conceptualisation of value
elasticity. This notion is inspired by the notion of value ambiguity and
develops the conceptualisation of the fixed and fluid nature of values.
Values are observed to be ambiguous and transfer the responsibility of
the ‘right’ interpretation on to the participating actors (Eisenberg, 1984;
Gehman et al., 2013). Not only did I observe the presence of value clar-
ity and unclarity, but I also outlined the process of how actors strategi-
cally employ values in their work. The present study provides empirical
material and a broader conceptualisation on how elasticity is evident in
managerial work. Not only are values open for interpretation, they are
subject for negotiating and the interests of actors. This approach to val-
ues is more strategic and represents a deliberate way of employing values
as tools and means to an end. The focus is thus on achieving something.
This points towards the ‘hard’ aspects of values, suggestive of power and
even manipulation.
The benefit of studying a given set of values is that the conceptual
dimension of values remains stable. It also reveals conceptual stretching
and what actors believe falls within the boundaries of a value definition.
A helpful metaphor is the idea of contracting and expanding, suggested
by Edmonton and Cha (2006).
The data in this study point to mechanisms that trigger processes
with an observable outcome or new practices. Value elasticity refers to
the fixed and fluid dynamics of values, in the sense that a value cannot
be fully defined. Value elasticity is an inherent characteristic of values—
detectable when values are negotiated. It surfaces in conceptual stretch-
ing, which entails both expanding—widening the held notion of what
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 217
a value covers—and contracting, which is limiting its contents. Unlike
rules, values do not come with fixed meanings for any situation, even
if the situation is a crisis. The findings of the study serve to correct to
the misconception that values act as a unifying force in the midst of a
basic disruption. Thus, this study extends the research of Gehman et al.
(2013) and reveals new insights about values work in situations of change
and crisis. Values have been understood to create unity (Selznick, 1957),
but this study shows that this is not always the case. Crises and sudden
changes are opportunities for managers to perform strategic values work
that is guided by their interests. Rules are not enough; values need to be
re-negotiated when the situation demands it.
The Shortcomings of Core Values
A third contribution of this work concerns the shortcomings of
core values on a general level. Core values signal that the organ-
isation is coherent and united because the values guide activities
towards shared goals (Wæraas, 2018). Interestingly, all the actors
in the case study reiterated the key organisational discourse in the
hospital, namely its core values, which appear to hold a sacro-
sanct position. However, the case study points to the drawbacks of
research conducted on fixed sets of values (Cameron et al., 2014)
rather than lived values. Even if the ‘set-approaches’ offer analyti-
cal clarity, they may be too static and ideal typical. For example,
official statements from the hospital offer value clarity by express-
ing explicit intentions and standards for actions across situations.
These values are the outcome of processes that have been bottom-up,
yet they are still values for practice and not necessarily values in practice.
Values and practices are connected, but this work shows that it is naïve
to assume consistency between them. The present study questions this
assumption by facilitating in-depth insights into a neglected dimension
of values through the concept of value elasticity. Whereas fixed core val-
ues imply institutionalisation, I explore how their fluid nature emerges
in heated discussions. The case shows how interpretations are fluid and
are applied to push the interests of the actors. The findings illustrate
218 S. Sirris
how core values may be undermined and even manipulated. Thus, this
chapter provides a critical perspective on values that emphasises their
‘darker’ side instead of their positive effects (Schein, 2010).
A key objective for this chapter is to investigate if and how core values
are part of an ongoing negotiation. I argue that values are not necessarily
fixed, even if the core values are well formulated. Rather, actors employ
them in dynamic interplay and ongoing interpretations—and the same
values may have different meanings for different people. This study has
implications for the notions of core values in a theoretical sense, and it
provides empirical evidence on how values manifest in managerial prac-
tices. This study shows that managers use value elasticity to bring about
change. Through the processes of negotiating they explore meanings that
lead to new practices. By their efforts, they link organisational continuity
with contextual and adaptive change.
The case describes a process from event to outcome containing three
parallel micro-processes: framing, targeting and negotiating. On the basis
of the contextual findings displayed in Table 11.1, I visualise theoreti-
cal contributions in Fig. 11.1. Value elasticity is constituted and evident
throughout this process and not only as an outcome.
Fig. 11.1 Elasticity in managerial values work
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 219
Concluding Remarks
This study illustrates how values are devices of orientation that express
intentions and guide actions in managerial work. I have empirically
demonstrated how core values constitute both unity and diversity. The
‘unified diversity’ is due to the inherent ambiguity of values. I have devel-
oped this notion into a new conceptualisation by proposing values as
fixed and fluid; the phenomenon of value elasticity. My findings illus-
trate how managers perform values work, seeking to align or justify their
practices with the core values. In the managerial discussions, some values
were evoked and used explicitly to argue for a practice consonant with
the managerial strategy. These everyday evocations of the same values are
not abstract. Rather, values are used to implicate specific ends and par-
ticular actions to be taken.
The chapter shows how values may surface especially in controversies
and conflicts. I have provided data on how a value discourse is evoked,
presented and represented. Further, I have proposed the construct of
value elasticity and a model that visualises it. Values may be identified
as priorities, worth, centrality and drivers for actions. In dilemmas, they
are evoked and explicated more than in situations where the course of
action is clear. The ambiguity provides scope for negotiating values.
Values work is a space of contestation when it comes to the interpreta-
tions drawn and the concrete consequences that a given value may imply
in a particular case. Core values are open to dialectic claims and ongoing
tensions. Discursive practices support this characteristic by showing the
elastic properties in processual ways, in which values are negotiated and
lead to divergent configurations of practices.
References
Aadland, E., & Skjørshammer, M. (2012). From God to good? Faith-based
institutions in the secular society. Journal of Management, Spirituality &
Religion, 9(1), 1–19.
Albert, S., & Whetten, D. A. (1985). Organizational identity. In L. L.
Cummings & B. M. Staw (Eds.), Research in organizational behavior (Vol.
7, pp. 263–295). Greenwich, CT: JAI.
220 S. Sirris
Argyris, C., & Schon, D. (1978). Organizational learning: A theory of action
approach. Reading, MA: Addison Wesley.
Askeland, H., Espedal, G., & Sirris, S. (2019). Values as vessels of religion?
The role of values in everyday work at faith-based organizations. Diaconia.
Journal for the Study of Christian Social Practice, 10(1), 27–49.
Cameron, K. S., Quinn, R. E., DeGraff, J., & Thakor, A. V. (2014). Competing
values leadership. Cheltenham: Edward Elgar Publishing.
Cha, S. E., & Edmondson, A. C. (2006). When values backfire: Leadership,
attribution, and disenchantment in a values-driven organization. The
Leadership Quarterly, 17 (1), 57–78.
Denzin, N. K., & Lincoln, Y. S. (2005). The Sage handbook of qualitative
research. San Francisco: Sage.
Eisenberg, E. M. (1984). Ambiguity as strategy in organizational communica-
tion. Communication Monographs, 51(3), 227–242.
Gehman, J., Trevino, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Rokeach, M. (1973). The nature of human values. New York: Free Press.
Schein, E. H. (2010). Organizational culture and leadership (4th ed.). San
Francisco: Wiley.
Selznick, P. (1957). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpretation.
Evanston, IL: Row Peterson.
Sirris, S., & Byrkjeflot, H. (2019). Realising calling through managers’
identity work. Comparing themes of calling in faith-based and religious
organisations. Nordic Journal of Religion and Society, 32(2), 132–147.
Thelen, K. A., & Mahoney, J. (2010). Explaining institutional change:
Ambiguity, agency, and power. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Van Deth, J. W., & Scarbrough, E. (1995). The concept of values. In J.
W. van Deth & E. Scarbrough (Eds.), The impact of values (pp. 21–47).
Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Wæraas, A. (2018). Putting on the velvet glove: The paradox of “soft” core
values in “hard” organizations. Administration & Society, 50(1), 53–77.
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid … 221
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
12
Work on Values When Shaping Public
Institutions: “What’s Trust Got to Do
with It?”—Experiences from Scandinavia
Benedicte Tveter Kivle
Introduction
In this chapter, I elaborate on trust as a value in the public sector and how
it is worked upon while structuring Scandinavian public organisations.
Based on textual analysis of articles in three national popular scientific
journals in the Scandinavian countries during the last decade (2007–
2019), I propose patterns for values work in the shaping and reshaping
of public structures.
Good governance, that is finding the best structures for public organi-
sations, is constantly questioned and discussed by politicians, academics,
bureaucrats, ‘think tanks’, labour unions and others who have an interest
in this issue (Bozeman, 2007; Garofalo, 2011; Jørgensen & Sørensen,
2012). The understanding of values in this debate is important, because
values and structures are intimately connected. Institutional theorists
argue that (public) institutions are (public) organisations infused with
B. T. Kivle (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
e-mail: benedicte.kivle@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_12
223
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_12&domain=pdf
mailto:benedicte.kivle@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_12
224 B. T. Kivle
values (Garofalo, 2011; Selznick, 1957; Van Deth & Scarbrough, 1998).
But values are not only carried out or enacted by individual leaders or
collective actors, as Selznick proposed more than 60 years ago (Scott,
1981; Selznick, 1957). They are also carried out through the choices
done behind specific formal structures are materialised values, and the
choices of formal rules, goals, the division of labour and the hierarchy
of responsibility and power are (always) based on values (Kaarbø, 2017;
Scott, 1981). Some values may be treated as ‘God-given’. For example,
the value ‘efficiency’ or slogans like ‘more health for every penny’ might
give the impression that cost-efficient structures are neutral and rational,
when in fact, they are highly normative. Hence, values work is taking
place within the shaping of formal structures and should be possible to
detect. Values work in these shaping processes has to little degree been
studied before. This is exactly what I do in my text analysis.
The Value of Trust in Public Institutions
With initiatives for trust-based management (TBM) in public organisa-
tions, the value of trust is explicitly promoted and materialised in man-
agement and structures (Nyhan, 2000). In Scandinavia, starting around
2005 in Denmark, TBM was introduced as a public governance model,
with ‘trust’ as the first keyword, followed by ‘trust model’, ‘trust reform’
and ‘trust delegation’ (Bentzen, 2016; Kuvaas, 2017; Preisler, 2016).
TBM in the public sector is an operationalisation of steering paradigms
like new public governance and public values management (Garofalo,
2011; Ocasio, 2008), based on principles from these frameworks. After
decades of heavy reliance on private market-inspired New Public Man-
agement (NPM) models and reforms, these alternatives to organising the
public sector in Scandinavia have reached the arenas of political deci-
sion (Garofalo, 2011). In this way, trust-based initiatives both challenge
existing dominant values and priorities and propose specific practical
solutions.
Values are normative conceptions of the desirable, values are not
directly observable, but are evident in moral discourse (Van Deth & Scar-
brough, 1998). Values are materialised through practices, though they
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 225
are often perceived as values only after a practice has been instituted
(Aadland, 2010). Values are not constant entities. For example, love,
respect and efficiency are desirable but are interpreted and expressed dif-
ferently according to their contexts at any given time (Espedal, 2019). In
this book, we explore how values are worked on within institutional con-
texts, claiming that values are deliberately ambiguous and that they must
remain ambiguous to maintain their relevance across contextual settings.
Like any value, trust is ambiguous and complex (Khodyakov, 2007).
Trust is both reflexive and intuitive, conceptualised as strategic, symbolic,
relational and institutional (Aadland, 2010; Julsrud, 2018). It can gen-
erally be defined as ‘a psychological state comprising the intention to
accept vulnerability based upon positive expectations of the intentions
or behaviour of another’ (Rousseau, Sitkin, Burt, & Camerer, 1998).
This psychological state of positive expectations is most often desired and
valued. A general trust, also called horizontal trust, is a precondition to
acting socially (Giddens, 1984). In fact, theorists will argue that it is not
possible to act without relying on positive actions from the surroundings
(Julsrud, 2018). Distrust and scepticism, on the other hand, are seen as
an intention to accept no vulnerability, basing every action on negative
expectations of the intentions or behaviour of others; this is something
few would find desirable in its purest form. A balance between naïve
expectancy and suspicion is often viewed as the most realistic approach
to social settings (Giddens, 1984).
Trust in institutions is distinguished from interpersonal trust, although
the two are closely linked (Fukuyama, 1995). Trust in public organ-
isations involves holding positive expectations towards public systems
(Bozeman, 2007). Trust within public organisations is also associated
with positive interpersonal expectations of other actors within the struc-
tures. Hence, trust in the context of public organisations includes the
development of trustworthy extra- and intra-organisational relationships
(Khodyakov, 2007). This complexity is also found in the TBM models.
The public sector depends on trust to function optimally (Bozeman,
2007; Fukuyama, 1995). Values in public organisations are principles
which must be followed or standards which must be met by public
organisations while they regulate or produce services. The public ethos is
226 B. T. Kivle
a moral basis of values such as professional independence, accountabil-
ity, transparency and security under the law. All these values are based
on the assumptions that government is in pursuit of the public interest
(Bozeman, 2007; Byrkjeflot & Engelstad, 2018; Jørgensen & Sørensen,
2012). Hence, public trust is connected to the people’s positive expecta-
tions of intentions or behaviour by public systems and the people rep-
resenting these systems (Rousseau et al., 1998). However, which values
that dominate in public institutions at any given time are changeable.
This valuation is, rather, a dynamic movement among the architects, the
stakeholders and the decision-makers within the public sector, placing
more or less emphasis on values across time and space (Jørgensen &
Sørensen, 2012).
According to research and international ratings, Scandinavian soci-
eties are among the most trusting societies in the world, due to his-
torically stable rule (Andersen, 2018), well-functioning public institu-
tions (Rothstein, 2013), high social capital and strong civil societies
(Fukuyama, 1995; Putnam, 2001). When trust is reintroduced as a value
in shaping public management (Nyhan, 2000), this occurs in an already
trusting environment, though some stakeholders, as we shall see in the
examined material, fear that trust is decreasing in the Scandinavian soci-
eties.
The Context: Models and Reforms on Trust
in Scandinavia
The value of trust has been materialised through the implementation of
TBM in different forms in all three Scandinavian countries during the
last decade (Preisler, 2016; Trust-Delegation, 2018). Trust as a manage-
rial value in governmental institutions was reintroduced as part of the
solution for reshaping the public sector (Bentzen, 2016; Nyhan, 2000).
Although local contexts may provide a variety of facets, certain overall
characteristics characterise TBM.
TBM concerns both interpersonal trust among organisational actors
and formal structures which can enable, or at least not counteract, trust-
worthy relationships. TBM aims at giving space to employees to take on
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 227
the responsibility for and control over tasks in their own work situations
(Nyhan, 2000). Following the principles of transformational leadership,
rather than attempting to raise efficiency through control and incentives,
the focus is on performance based on agreements and a high level of
trust between the parties concerned (Bass, 1990; Jensen & Svendsen,
2014; Julsrud, 2018). Employees are assumed to be experts in their own
fields; they have special knowledge of all aspects of their working situ-
ations and processes and have a vested interest in optimising them. By
seeking the employees’ input and advice and by rewarding good ideas,
managers harvest this invaluable resource pool. The reasoning is that if
the employee has experienced to be a positive impact at her workplace,
it heightens her sense of pride and co-ownership and encourages her
to take on even greater responsibility (Jensen, 2014; Kuvaas, 2017). As
Jensen (2014) remarks, ‘When employees are encouraged to offer input
and suggestions, and it is safe for them to speak their minds and even
to make mistakes, a distrustful, heavy-control, “zero-defect” culture is
avoided’. TBM is made possible by administrative systems, such as incen-
tive systems and expedient control, systems that embody positive expec-
tations from (most) co-workers. Professional co-workers do not oppose
control as such; thus, they often request control systems which provide
predictability and stability in their work. But the control must enable the
professionals and not hinder them from doing their job.
Different models of TBM and trust-based managerial structures have
been introduced into the public sector in Scandinavia. For example, such
principles were put into practice in the municipalities of Helsingborg
(2007) and Copenhagen (2009), and through an agreement between the
Danish government and the biggest unions in the country (FTF, AC and
OAC), seven principles of good public management were signed in 2013
(Preisler, 2016). The seven principles were as follows (author’s transla-
tion):
(1) Management of the public sector shall focus on overall purposes,
goals and results;
(2) Dialogue, openness and clear goals shall be the basis of task solutions;
(3) Leadership and management shall manifest and consider trust and
responsibility;
228 B. T. Kivle
(4) Development and the professional freedom to act shall be based on
well-documented knowledge;
(5) Tasks shall be solved based on knowledge about what works;
(6) Leadership and engagement shall promote innovation; and
(7) Public services shall actively draw on citizens’ own resources.
In Sweden, the so-called Trust Delegation was appointed by the gov-
ernment in 2016 (Trust-Delegation, 2018). They conducted research
and projects for the purpose of collecting knowledge about trust in the
public sector. Their final report will be presented at the end of 2019. In
Norway, the trust model was politically introduced for the Oslo munici-
pality in 2017 through a social democratic political statement emphasis-
ing trust and openness and the reduction of detailed control mechanisms
(Johansen, 2017).
Overall, TBM structures seek to strengthen trustworthy extra- and
intra-organisational relationships: trust between the citizens and public
organisations, between managers and employees within public organisa-
tions, and among subgroups and departments within the organisations
(Bentzen, 2016; Khodyakov, 2007).
However, promoters of TBM meet resistance from external as well as
internal actors. The realism in basing management and administration
on trust is questioned. Bureaucrats and professionals working in public
sector may find it insulting when politicians insinuate that public sec-
tor needs more trust. Many insiders working in the sector experience
and practice trust every day, so why would they need a trust-reform? In
this context of dispute and confrontation about shaping the managerial
structures of public sector, the value of trust is worked upon.
Trust is discussed, promoted or denigrated by stakeholders, analysts
and decision-makers while they discuss the shape of structures in pub-
lic sector. The examined material gives insight into how stakeholders
work on trust in different and sometimes conflicting ways. I see trust
being dealt with through defined mechanisms of values work (Gehman,
Treviño, & Garud, 2013) and draw patterns of the competing processes
of values work (Jackall, 1988; Thornton, 2012). In this way, I highlight
values work in the shaping of structures, and not only in the culture,
within organisations.
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 229
Theoretical Perspectives: Values Work
and Institutional Logic
The work on values is operationalised into four mechanisms (Gehman
et al., 2013). The four mechanisms of values work are described as (1)
pockets of concern, (2) knotting of concerns into networks, (3) per-
forming value practice, and (4) circulating values (Gehman et al., 2013).
Inspired by practice theories, Gehman et al. based their model on empir-
ical data from a vast range of actions and decisions taking place over a
period of almost a decade. The researchers observed how actors changed
an unwanted dishonest business college culture into a culture based on
honesty and honour. The authors stated that values practices are observ-
able and processual and unfold within time and space (Gehman et al.,
2013). In a similar way, work on values is understood as ‘sayings and
doings in organizations that articulate and accomplish the desirable in
relevance to right and wrong action and behaviour’ (Espedal, 2019).
Values work starts with the unstructured and loosely linked identifica-
tion of concerns, the ‘pockets of concern’. These are constructed into pat-
terns, connecting the pockets together in wider networks of keypersons,
named by Gehman and colleagues as ‘knotting of concerns’. Generators
for knotting concerns could involve formal meetings or informal talks. I
presuppose that generators for knotting concerns could also involve dis-
cussions going on in newspapers and journals; arenas where keypersons
can present concerns of distrust and promote new trust practices. The
knotting enables the formulation of new value practices and eventually
‘ends’ in new patterns of value practices. When values are practised in
specific contexts, they are confronted by practical possibilities or practi-
cal obstacles, such as competing value practices (Gehman et al., 2013).
Underneath this movement from isolated concerns into new patterns
and practices, the semiotic tools for communicating values are present.
In the circulation of values, a value practice is addressed and legitimised
by metaphors, signs and symbols, implicitly representing frameworks
of institutional logics. Elements from logics are identified in practices
and texts through, among others, the use of root metaphors, symbols
and signs (Fairclough, 2007; Ocasio, 2008; Thornton, 2012). In values
230 B. T. Kivle
work, these semiotic elements merge the framework of institutional log-
ics and the circulation of values (Gehman et al., 2013). Metaphors, sym-
bols and signs are known to text analytics and are tools for values work,
and they aid value transfer across contexts (Fairclough, 2007; Vieira &
de Queiroz, 2017). Changes and stabilities within institutions may be
understood with respect to the dynamics among different institutional
logics (Lawrence & Suddaby, 2006; Sirris, 2019; Thornton, 2012). Con-
tradicting institutional logics pinpoints the fact that the same value can
be (and often is) interpreted and handled differently by different actors
(Ocasio, 2008). In my study, values work, and the mechanisms of con-
cern, values practice and value circulation are explored further.
Research Setting and Method
Research Setting
The empirical material for this qualitative textual analysis includes three
popular scientific journals on public governance, situated in Norway,
Sweden and Denmark. The contributors/text authors are academics, ana-
lysts, bureaucrats and journalists as well as stakeholders and decision-
makers in and around the public sector who present information, opin-
ions and meanings with respect to the management and administration
of the public sector. The journals have some definitional power to decide
what is relevant and what is irrelevant in the pursuit of achieving ‘good
governance’ and well-functioning public organisations (Bourdieu, 1994).
The journals in themselves are arenas for keypersons to knot clusters of
concerns (mechanism 2 in Gehman’s model). While forming the texts,
contributors also knot their concerns, making sense of the situation.
One popular scientific journal from each Scandinavian country was
strategically chosen. In Norway, the journal Stat og styring, or State and
Governance, was chosen, while in Denmark, the digital journal Denof-
fentlige.dk, or The Public, and in Sweden, the digital version of Dagens
samhälle, or Today’s Society, were chosen. All three journals were chosen
because of their relevance in the discussions on public administration.
The search terms ‘tillit/tillid’ and/or ‘kontroll’ (trust and/or control) on
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 231
the webpages of the journals returned a substantial number of popu-
lar scientific articles and comments about TBM, altogether 101 articles,
about 420 pages. The national contexts and the differences between the
journals notably influence the variety of perspectives on the topics. Dif-
ferent concerns are given more emphasis within the different journals.
For example, there is an overall emphasis on the managerial role in the
Swedish journal, while in the Danish and Norwegian journals, there is
more emphasis on the structures of performance management. The Dan-
ish contributions show, overall, a more direct scepticism towards NPM.
All three journals are popular scientific magazines, presenting a vari-
ety of texts in the feature genre and in the academic analytical genre.
All three are arenas for discussions on public management and leader-
ship. Danish contributions constitute twice those of the Norwegian and
Swedish. The Danish journal had 54 articles on trust, while the Nor-
wegian journal had 25 and the Swedish 22 relevant articles. This might
perhaps be because the Danish are in the forefront of these debates on
trust-based management. In Norway, there is a preponderance of edi-
torial articles, while in Denmark, there are mostly academic comments,
and in Sweden, there is a majority of political articles (Figs. 12.1, 12.2,
and 12.3). There may be national differences as to what milieus are
most dominant in the discussions on TBM. But the national differences
between the texts are overshadowed by similarities across the national
contexts. Many contributors refer to the other countries in their texts
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
Norway editorial/news Norway academic Norway political Norway Bureacrat
Fig. 12.1 Norway: Number of articles on trust devided in published year and
type of article
232 B. T. Kivle
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2011
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017
2018
2019
Sweden editorial/news Sweden academic Sweden political/union Sweden Bureacrat
Fig. 12.2 Sweden: Number of articles on trust devided in published year and
type of article
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
2011
2013
2015
2017
2019
Denmark editorial/news Denmark academic Denmark political Denmark Bureacrat
Denmark Professional
Fig. 12.3 Denmark: Number of articles on trust devided in published year and
type of article
and look to each other across borders. So the differences are not taken
into consideration to any great extent in the textual analysis.1
Textual Analysis
Textual analysis was conducted on the 101 articles, using the hermeneuti-
cal principles of circular movement between subjective and objective par-
ticulars and wholeness (Lockyer, 2008; Vieira & de Queiroz, 2017). Fol-
lowing a qualitative content analysis approach, coding and categorisation
1I have translated all quotes from the texts as scrupulously as possible, from Danish, Swedish
and Norwegian to English.
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 233
were applied, aided by the four mechanisms of values work. This inter-
pretative sense-making resulted in illustrative examples and a nuancing
of the four mechanisms (Gehman et al., 2013). To provide an overview
of the different contributions, I categorised and characterised the texts
according to country, occupation/position of contributor and year of
publishing (Figs. 12.1, 12.2, and 12.3). From this overview, I manually
performed an analysis on all the texts. This was time-consuming, but it
provided a good insight into the texts. I hermeneutically found patterns
and controversies from citations and categories, disputing and confirm-
ing theoretical mechanisms of values work and institutional logics.
Textual analysis does not attempt to identify the ‘correct’ interpreta-
tion of a text but is used to identify which interpretations are possible
and likely (Lockyer, 2008). Textual analysis of popular scientific jour-
nals provides information about central influencers’ deliberate attempts
to make their opinions and situational analysis heard. The clear, well-
formulated texts give us a peek into the authors’ thought-through world
view and identity and, I presuppose, a difference in underlining insti-
tutional logical rationales. The texts do, in this way, illuminate interest-
ing mechanisms of values work and competing institutional logics, even
though the material lack data on the informal day-to-day work.
Findings
The 101 articles were published within a range of eight years, from 2011
to 2019 (Figs. 12.1, 12.2, and 12.3). The peak in 2016 correlates with
political initiatives for TBM in Oslo and Sweden. In Denmark, the first
PhD on TBM was also published at this time (Bentzen, 2016). Contrib-
utors were either academics or bureaucrats either on a local or a central
level, many were journalists with an academic education, and some rep-
resented political think tanks, adding political colour to their arguments.
Most of the authors (95/101) promoted the idea of TBM in the public
sector. The six contributors who did question the models proposed were
therefore given extra attention, to elaborate on alternative perspectives
on trust.
234 B. T. Kivle
Values Work Mechanisms
The texts mirror the four mechanisms in Gehman’s model (Gehman
et al., 2013). The lack of trust is identified in malpractices and dys-
functional systems in public organisations (mechanism 1). The concerns
regarding distrust are ordered by stakeholder according to overreaching
descriptions of the root causes of malpractice. Some contributors turn
from describing the challenges to suggesting new practices within pub-
lic organisations, built on trust, preferably models of TBM. They point
to possible positive outcomes of these practices. Other articles deal with
possible obstacles associated with the TBM-models (mechanism 3). To
various degrees, the authors utilise semiotic tools to underline images of
trust in public organisations. The use of semiotic tools aids circulation of
the discourse on trust (mechanism 4). Hence, the mechanisms of values
work are evidently present, traceable through the texts.
There are also examples of texts which contradict a homogenous pro-
cess of values work. Even if one agrees with some of the concerns, there is
ambiguity among the stakeholders concerning what are seen as causes of
the observed dysfunctions and distrust. Concerns about distrust are dis-
puted and questioned. The contributors also differ with respect to what
practical implications the concerns on trust should have. Below, I present
how promoters of TBM and critics towards TBM, describe their attitude
towards (lack of) trust in public institutions, as well as their contradict-
ing views on possibilities lying in new and old value practices.
Pockets of Concern and Competing Understandings
of Root Causes
The texts show how descriptions of concerns substantially differ. The
differences continue when the stakeholders present the stated concerns
into wider understandings of the root causes of malpractice and distrust.
Many texts point to concerns about a lack of trust, reflecting the fact
that values work, besides seeking the ‘good’, also involves avoiding the
‘bad’ (Gehman et al., 2013). While Gehman et al. point to dishonest
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 235
practices in a business school, for example cheating on exams, my mate-
rial shows numerous examples of distrust in what is described as a dys-
functional public sector. One Danish editor-in-chief expresses his con-
cern this way; ‘It is hard to be employed in a system which has erased all
trust from the citizen and the abilities of the coworker. (…) It enforces
powerlessness, and powerlessness enforces rejection’. Many of the exam-
ples themselves refer to examples of systematic distrust and overexagger-
ated control.
Trust and distrust are explicitly mentioned or implicitly implied
through associated concepts, such as a lack of cooperation and commu-
nication or badly performed services. Professionals show concern about
how people are treated in public services, and some express how resi-
dents in an elderly home, for example, are treated as ‘milk that has gone
bad’. The professionals are concerned about the relation between profes-
sionals and the receivers of public services. The description of systematic
misconduct underlines the need to strengthen trust through the way in
which public organisations are organised.
But there are those who contradict the image of crisis and distrust
in the public sector. Pointing to surveys among citizens and managers,
researchers propose a more positive picture. One professor from Nor-
way sums up findings from a large international survey in 2013, stating:
‘we have no crisis in Norway, Top managers are satisfied, co-workers are
satisfied, and citizens seem to be quite satisfied’. So compared to other
countries in Europe, the citizens of Nordic countries still express a high
level of trust towards public sector. This point is promoted by some aca-
demics and politicians in the texts, stating that there is no need for more
trust in public sector.
Root causes of the observed malpractice and distrust are either
described as exaggerated bureaucratic control mechanisms, failures in the
capitalist system in the public sector or faults in the political decision-
making systems. Researchers express the importance of seeing miscon-
duct as systematic problems and not as individuals’ responsibilities: ‘The
reforms and documentation requirements produce distrust and are the
seed of the whole misery’ (Norwegian academic). Hence, the blame of
236 B. T. Kivle
distrust is given to the practice of overwhelming documentation require-
ments. Bureaucratic mechanisms are closely linked to political decision-
making, where the need to fight errors leads politicians to impose more
detailed control. The need for action results in ineffective cumbersome
procedures which ‘slow down the daily work without the work being
faultless for that reason’ (Norwegian left-wing think-tank).
Promoters of the TBM blame the NPM principles themselves for the
distrust, stating that quality contradicts the external reward-mechanisms
of the market-logic; ‘Quality, long-term durability takes time. (…) It
is freedom rather than reward that makes us creative at work’. Others,
however, see the malpractice as a perversion of NPM principles. Defend-
ing the market-logic of NPM, they see the malpractice as ‘a result of
goal management and performance measurement being implemented in
a bureaucratic context, where the only response to poor performance
is more rules and more metrics of compliance’ (Danish academic). The
bureaucracy is to blame and not the business principles of NPM.
Others, again, raise their voices to defend the existing bureaucratic sys-
tem, and state that bureaucratic control is necessary to secure trust. ‘Here
is a paradox; we are the public. We have a contract with citizens about
equality and predictable, continuous behaviour. (…) It is a contract that
secures trust and a civilized society – and at the same time makes inno-
vation difficult for us’ (Danish bureaucrat).
Practising Trust, Possibilities and Obstacles
TBM is promoted or disputed as value practices of trust. While Gehman
et al. describe resistance, enrolment and adjustment of the honour code,
the suggested practices of TBM are dealt with in similar manners in the
examined texts. Promoters of TBM emphasize different possibilities that
lie within the trust-based structures. The ‘added value of management by
trust’ is promoted to be ‘partly savings from eliminating the monitoring
of coworkers’ actions and partly the increase in the organization’s social
capital’ (Danish academic). The decrease in exaggerated control builds
social capital, understood as interpersonal trust. When local institutions
and co-workers are managed and controlled based on a basic confidence
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 237
in co-workers, ‘communication and cooperation in the organization will
improve, the costs of control will decrease and space will be given for
professionalism, eliminating the zero-defect culture that kills innovative
initiatives’ (Danish academic).
While some promoters emphasise the decrease in bureaucratic control
specifically, others emphasise the underlying paradigm shift the reshap-
ing of public structures include. ‘The trust reform is about creating a
greater connection in work close to the citizen and about solving tasks
in as decentralized a way as possible. It is a paradigm shift’ (Danish
think tank analyst). TBM promoters see a positive spiral, where trust
and results strengthen each other. Practitioners equate practising trust in
public organisations with making room for individual professional dis-
cretion. ‘Steering and managing more based on trust in employee compe-
tencies, professionalism and commitment will increase motivation while
providing the necessary frontline space to unleash innovative potential’
(Swedish professional). Trust is also associated with openness and free-
dom of speech: ‘The trust reform presupposes – unarticulated – a work
culture where management is open to criticism and where employees can
speak freely’ (Danish academic).
Some of the texts’ authors do, however, uphold resistance towards the
proposed new practices. Sceptics of the TBM models and defenders of
existing systems of goal management claim, for example, that replacing
control with trust is naïve and unrealistic. Rather, they defend the exist-
ing system as the best available option of public systems. They challenge
the critics to come up with a realistic alternative. ‘What (do) the crit-
ics of goal management really think are realistic alternatives for central
administration. The road through a legitimate structural administrative
context is demanding, but it exists’ (Norwegian bureaucrat). In this way,
the structural practice of trust is given resistance.
Circulating Trust
Trust seldom appears in an isolated way. Rather, it is given meaning
through a semantic context. Images of trust, the surrounding concepts,
give us mental constructions for sense-making to allow us to understand
238 B. T. Kivle
trust in public management and structures. I found metaphors and the
use of key concepts which aided different understandings of trust.
Metaphors illustrating public sector are primarily used by promoters
of TBM to demonstrate their concerns about existing systems. Trust is
by these stakeholders seen as a promoter for purposeful work, indicating
a community-logic: ‘Two people were asked about their similar work.
The one answered, “I carry rocks”, and the other answered “I build a
cathedral”’. Followed by the statement, ‘Without map and compass, you
easily get lost’. A Swedish analyst makes this point to oppose a bureau-
cratic control-motivated structure.
Traces of a marked logic can also be observed through phrases such as
‘protecting the consumer’ from ill-treatment through control and doc-
umentation (Swedish liberal think-tank). Critics of the market logic,
however, illustrate their concern through metaphors of a market: ‘Wel-
fare and services are placed on shelves in a supermarket where the cus-
tomer passes through with a shopping basket’ (Danish social democratic
think tank). The misfit combination of supermarket and welfare serves
to underline the need for a structural and paradigm shift.
The different actors’ identities, built over time, are linked to their
general perception of reality. For instance, for a promoter of the mar-
ket logic, attempts simplify public structures to reduce the number of
rules and process requirements is interpreted as ‘an attempt to bring the
NPM back to the original track of decentralized management’ (Danish
academic promoter of NPM).
Discussion
So, how do we know that these findings are traces of values work? The
concept of values work comes from a practice perspective, based on sub-
stantial empirical research. Can I claim to find something similar through
a simple textual analysis? The findings have their clear limits. However,
the journal texts clearly show traces of the mechanisms in values work.
I would even suggest that the arena for discussing public organisation in
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 239
journals like these are arenas for knotting concerns, strengthening net-
works of promoters of trust-based practices in public sector (Gehman
et al., 2013).
The discussions on trust may be viewed as mere examples of promo-
tion of and resistance to change, or they may (also) be viewed as traces of
competing underlying assumptions. Competing value systems, or insti-
tutional logics, place trust in different contexts, giving different meanings
to a value (Ocasio, 2008). Four logics were traceable in the texts: market-
, bureaucratic-, professional- and community-logic (Ife, 1997). Trust is
promoted in different ways by the different logics. As Gehman quotes:
‘It’s like apple pie. Who could be against it?’ (Gehman et al., 2013).
The disagreements are rather about whether there is a crisis of trust and
whether it is necessary to overturn the public structure to maintain and
increase trust. The situational concerns and the practical implications dif-
fer among the institutional logics. Contributors dispute whether trust is
under pressure in public organisations, whether trust is secured through
bureaucratic procedures which strengthen predictability, whether trust is
executed through more space to perform professional tasks, or whether
the best solution is to let free market-mechanisms from bureaucratic con-
trol. Hence, the work on trust happens on the arenas for discussing not
only public sector culture, but also public sector structure, and it seems
to happen within this landscape of competing institutional logics.
Conclusion
My empirical findings confirm the core argument in this book, which
is that values are flexible entities and that they must remain flexible and
ambiguous, so they can maintain their relevance across time and space
(Espedal, 2019; Sirris, 2019). When the sense-making of trust becomes
too specific, the value turns into a normative injunction and will be
instantly disputed. Actors framing their understanding within different
logics may agree that trust is a desirable value, but it is when trust is
given situational contents that differences appear.
Further empirical investigations could provide more insights into how
values work and how institutional logics influence each other. Further
240 B. T. Kivle
studies could also investigate the relative power dimensions between
these logics, along with theories on paradigm shifts. How is one dom-
inant logic position conquered by another? Gehman et al. do have great
strengths in their substantial descriptions of changes in value practices
(Gehman et al., 2013). My study contributes to the developed under-
standing of how trust as value heterogeneously is worked upon through
the mechanisms of values work; shaping, reshaping and discussing con-
cerns towards and changes within structures of public organisations.
References
Aadland, E. J. (2010). Values in professional practice: Towards a critical reflec-
tive methodology. Journal of Business Ethics, 97 (3), 461–472.
Andersen, R. F. (2018). Trust in Scandinavia: Findings from moving borders
between Denmark and Germany. Scandinavian Political Studies, 41(1), 22–
48.
Bass, B. M. (1990). From transactional to transformational leadership: Learn-
ing to share the vision. Organizational Dynamics, 18(3), 19–31.
Bentzen, T. Ø. (2016). Tillidsbaseret styring og ledelse i offentlige institusjoner
[Trustbased management in public institutions]. Copenhagen: Roskilde
University.
Bourdieu, P. (1994). Language and symbolic power. Oxford: Polity Press.
Bozeman, B. (2007). Public values and public interest: Counterbalancing eco-
nomic individualism. Washington, DC: Georgetown University Press.
Byrkjeflot, H., & Engelstad, F. (2018). Bureaucracy and society in transition:
Comparative perspectives. UK: Emerald Group Publishing.
Espedal, G. (2019). Values work as a performative practice. In H. Askeland,
G. Espedal, B. J. Løvaas, & S. Sirris (Eds.), Values work in organization and
leadership: Institutional perspectives. London, UK: Palgrave.
Fairclough, N. (2007). Critical discourse analysis. In M. Hartwig (Ed.), Dic-
tionary of Critical Realism. London: Routledge.
Fukuyama, F. (1995). Social capital and the global economy. Foreign Affairs,
74(5), 89–103.
Garofalo, C. (2011). Governance and values in contemporary public service. In
M. S. De vries & P. S. Kim (Eds.), Value and Virtue in Public Administration.
Hampshire: Palgrave Macmillan.
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 241
Gehman, J., Treviño, L. K., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process
study of the emergence and performance of organizational values practices.
Academy of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Giddens, A. (1984). The constitution of society. Berkeley and Los Angeles: Uni-
versity of California Press.
Ife, J. (1997). Rethinking social work: Towards critical practice. South Melbourne:
Longman.
Jackall, R. (1988). Moral mazes: The world of corporate managers. Interna-
tional Journal of Politics, Culture, and Society, 1(4), 598–614. https://doi.
org/10.1007/BF01390690.
Jensen, K. (2014). Trust or control? Trust-based management and the thriving
workplace. Forbes.
Jensen, K., & Svendsen, G. T. (2014). Control is good, but trust is cheaper.
Forbes.
Johansen, R. (2017). Tillitsbasert Styring og Ledelse i Oslo kommune [Trustbased
governance and management in Oslo municipality]. Byrådssak 1055/17.
Julsrud, T. E. (2018). Organisatorisk tillit. Grunnlaget for samarbeid i
nettverkenes tid [Organizational trust. The bases for cooperation in the time
of networks]. Bergen: Fagbokforlaget.
Jørgensen, T. B., & Sørensen, D.-L. (2012). Codes of good governance: Public
integrity, 15(1), 71–96.
Kaarbø, K. (2017). Kollisjoner mellom ulike normer og verdier i styring av
offentlig sektor? [Collisions between different norms and values in govern-
ing public sector] In E. A. Aadland, H. (Ed.), Verdibevisst ledelse [Value
conscious leadership]. Oslo: Cappelen Damm Akademisk.
Khodyakov, D. (2007). Trust as a process: A three-dimensional approach. Soci-
ology, 41(1), 115–132.
Kuvaas, B. (2017, February 28). Sverige kan, så hvorfor ikke Norge? [Sweden
can, why not Norway?]. Dagens Næringsliv.
Lawrence, T. B., & Suddaby, R. (2006). Institutions and institutional work. In
S. R. Clegg, C. Hardy, T. B. Lawrence, & W. R. Nord (Eds.), Handbook of
organization studies (pp. 215–254). London: Sage.
Lockyer, S. (2008). Textual analysis. In L. M. Given (Ed.), Sage encyclopedia of
qualitative research methods vol. 1 & 2. London: Sage.
Nyhan, R. C. (2000). Changing the paradigm: Trust and its role in public
sector organizations. The American Review of Public Administration, 30(1),
87–109. https://doi.org/10.1177/02750740022064560.
https://doi.org/10.1007/BF01390690
https://doi.org/10.1177/02750740022064560
242 B. T. Kivle
Ocasio, T. (2008). Institutional logics. In R. Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B.
Lawrence, & R. E. Meyer (Ed.), The Sage handbook of organizational insti-
tutionalism (pp. 99–129). London: Sage.
Preisler, M. (2016, September 2016). The City of Copenhagen: Work based
on trust, not control. Nordic Labour Journal.
Putnam, R. D. (2001). Bowling alone: The collapse and revival of American com-
munity. New York: Simon & Schuster.
Rothstein, B. (2013). Corruption and social trust: Why the fish rots from the
head down. Social Research, 80(4), 1009–1032.
Rousseau, D. M., Sitkin, S. B., Burt, R. S., & Camerer, C. (1998). Not so
different after all: A cross-discipline view of trust. Academy of Management
Review, 23(3), 393–404.
Scott, W. R. (1981). Organizations, rational, natural and open systems. Upper
Saddle River, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Selznick, P. (1957). Leadership in administration: A sociological interpretation.
New Orleans: Quid Pro Books.
Sirris, S. (2019) Institutional complexity challenging values and identities
in Scandinavian welfare organisations. In H. Askeland, G. Espedal, B. J.
Løvaas, & S. Sirris (Eds.), Values work in organization and leadership: Insti-
tutional perspectives. London, UK: Palgrave.
Thornton, P. H. (2012). The institutional logics perspective: A new approach to
culture, structure, and process. Oxford: Oxford University Press.
Trust-Delegation. (2018). Summary Swedish delegation for trust-based public
management. Retrieved from www.tillitsdelegationen.se.
Van Deth, J. W., & Scarbrough, E. (1998). The concept of values. In J. W.
van Deth & E. Scarbrough (Eds.), The impact of values. New York: Oxford
University Press.
Vieira, K. A. L., & de Queiroz, G. M. (2017). Hermeneutic Content Analysis:
A method of textual analysis. International Journal of Business Marketing and
Management (IJBMM), 2(8), 7.
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions … 243
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
13
The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering
Johan von Essen
Introduction
The chapters in this anthology explore different aspects of how values
work within organisations to structure individual behaviour in everyday
life. The present chapter will contribute to this endeavour by studying
how values related to the volunteer experience are used to construct iden-
tities of engaged citizens in contemporary Swedish society.
In research on volunteering, there is a vital interest in values since
persons engaged in volunteer work are expected to embrace pro-social
values. Thus, values are often studied as antecedents to volunteering
since they are supposed to cause action. This is of interest for schol-
ars and policy-makers since volunteering is expected to deliver desir-
able outcomes such as welfare services, trust, deliberative democracy and
empowerment.
J. von Essen (B)
Centre for Civil Society Research at Ersta Sköndal Bräcke University College,
Stockholm, Sweden
e-mail: johan.von-essen@esh.se
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_13
245
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_13&domain=pdf
mailto:johan.von-essen@esh.se
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_13
246 J. von Essen
To a lesser extent have scholars been interested in the volunteer expe-
rience, how volunteering is constructed, how it transforms people’s per-
ceptions of themselves and society, and what their engagement means
to them (Wilson, 2012). How the social construct of volunteering is
maintained by scholars and policy-makers to make it into a legitimate
and significant object of scholarly enquiry is previously studied (Sachar,
von Essen, & Hustinx, 2019). This chapter studies how values related
to the volunteer experience are used by individuals to construct and dis-
close their identities. Here, values are not discussed as causes of actions;
instead, how values are used to constitute the identity of the actor is
studied. By taking the relation between values and actions in this reverse
order, the aim is to contribute to the research on values by studying
how values may be used in constituting and disclosing the identity of an
individual.
Agents, Values and Identity
Values are often treated as normative opinions on desirable behaviours,
objectives and ideals that individuals or organisations have to guide prac-
tices (see introduction by Askeland, Espedal, Jelstad Løvaas and Sirris).
This perspective on values and actions and how values relate to institu-
tions is studied in several chapters in this volume. A reversed perspec-
tive on values work will be explored in the present chapter by using
some ideas on human agency suggested by Charles Taylor. At the heart
of Taylor’s philosophical anthropology is the notion that the values of an
agent are not only used in discrete evaluations of possible alternatives to
guide action, they also constitute the quality of the actor. By evaluating
a normative significant situation leading to the preference of one alterna-
tive over another, a human agent discloses the kind of person she wants
to be, so that identity is defined by the agent’s evaluations (see also Jel-
stad Løvaas and Bruland Vråle for the significance of values for identity
work).
In this respect, Taylor refers to ‘strong evaluation’, which is an evalu-
ation of a normative significant situation where possible alternatives are
logically related so that they get their meaning in relation to each other.
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 247
Strong evaluations are made within a language of evaluative distinctions
where alternatives are characterised contrastively so that competing alter-
natives can only be understood in relation to one other. For instance, the
decision to help someone is due to an evaluation of a situation where the
agent values altruism instead of egoism, and the meanings of altruism
and egoism are dependent on each other. To reflexively evaluate different
alternatives demands a vocabulary of worth that comprises contrasting
alternatives where the superiority of one alternative over another can be
expressed (Taylor, 1985, p. 24).
According to Taylor, this implies that when individuals talk about
their actions and prefer one alternative over another the alternatives are
parts of an evaluative horizon (Taylor, 1991) which situates them in a
social context so that acting in one way discloses the kind of person the
human agent wants to be. The notion of identity refers to essential eval-
uations because they are the indispensable horizon based on which indi-
viduals reflect and evaluate as persons (Taylor, 1985, p. 35).
Since values get their meaning in contrast to other values, individuals
may disclose their identities in contrast to other lifestyles, in particu-
lar when deviating from dominant or taken-for-granted norms, which
makes it necessary to defend the identity. This implies that values are
contextual as they may be reactions against a prevailing social order (see
also chapter by Askeland). By deviating from social norms or traditions,
one can appear as a person in society (cf. Hustinx, 2003; Wuthnow,
1991).
By the term “identity”, Tayler does not refer to decontextualised phys-
ical or psychological traits. Instead, identity is used in the same sense
as when “we talk about ‘finding one’s identity’, or going through an
‘identity crisis’” (Taylor, 1985, p. 34). Thus, identity is self-reflexive and
socially dependent; it is the sense one has of oneself (Grönlund, 2011).
Taylors’ argument is theoretical, but recent empirical research has also
shown that volunteering can provide volunteers with a sense of identity
(von Essen, 2016; Wuthnow, 1991) especially due to the change towards
reflexive volunteering (Hustinx, 2003), and that individuals may have
multiple social identities, depending on social interaction (Grönlund,
2011).
248 J. von Essen
One may understand the relation between values and factual state-
ments in the sense that facts precede values since values are based on fac-
tual prerequisites. By this understanding, facts are self-evident whereas
values are subjective and may be disputed. However, factual statements
are not independent of values since there are no “brute facts”. Instead
reality, not least human action (Ricoeur, 1971), is interpreted, and
ascribed meaning which implies that descriptions of reality may be artic-
ulated in more than one way. Hence, normative statements and reality
descriptions are not totally independent of each other. An articulation of
the significance of an object tends to make it different from what it was
before (Taylor, 1985, p. 38).
The volunteers were asked, “What is volunteering?” On the surface,
this request is about defining volunteering. But as will be evident, the
volunteers interpreted volunteering and ascribed their descriptions with
meaning and explanations which made volunteering normatively signif-
icant. It is impossible to judge if the values and motives referred to by
the volunteers have caused their actions, and this is not what is studied.
Instead, it is demonstrated how values work when constructing volun-
teering so that human agents may disclose their identities as engaged
citizens in society.
The Volunteers
The focus will be on the narratives of the interviewed volunteers. Pre-
vious research has demonstrated that volunteers are influenced by the
organisational context (Hooghe, 2003). However, here the organisations
they work in will merely function as a contextual backdrop to make sense
of the interviewee’s narratives. Only to a limited extent will context-
dependent differences among the volunteers be discussed. The material
is based on interviews conducted in 2013 and 2014 with 41 volunteers
active in four different hybridised organisational contexts.
The first context involved interviews with ten police volunteers at the
Stockholm Police Department. The volunteer organisation is built into the
regular police organisation, where the “volunteer coordinators” play a key
role.
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 249
The second context involved interviews with ten volunteers at
Stockholms Stadsmission (The Stockholm City Mission). This is a civil
society welfare organisation, founded in 1853, involved in social work
among youths and homeless persons, education and intercultural and
interreligious dialogue. This extensive activity demands a professional
management, paid staff and a solid organisation.
The third and fourth contexts involved interviews with two groups
of corporate volunteers (eleven and ten persons, respectively) in two dif-
ferent corporations (Skandia and Accenture) offering corporate volunteer
programmes. As part of their employment, the employees work as vol-
unteers one or two days per semester, often in or for a civil society organ-
isation.
The age distribution among the interviewees ranged from 21 to 89.
Seventeen of them were men and 24 were women. Age and gender were
unequally divided between the organisations. There were more women
than men active as volunteers in the corporations. In Accenture, the vol-
unteers were on average younger than in Skandia, but in both corpora-
tions they were typically middle class, well-educated and often held pres-
tigious posts. The majority of the corporate volunteers had no previous
experience of civic engagement. The volunteers in Stockholms Stadsmis-
sion were on average older compared to the other groups, and the dis-
tribution between men and women was fairly equal, and as among the
corporate volunteers, the volunteers were often middle class and well-
educated with, or retired from, a prestigious job. Among the police
volunteers, the age distribution was fairly even. The police volunteers
also were often persons with few resources, a problematic background, a
peripheral position in society or a dramatic personal history.
Not Paid
The most elaborated upon, and frequent theme found when the intervie-
wees were defining volunteering, was the notion that the term refers to
actions that are not paid for in monetary terms. That this theme was so
emphasised and elaborated on indicates that not getting paid is the most
urgent theme to explain and defend. A typical statement expressing this
250 J. von Essen
need comes from a middle-aged woman, active as a corporate volunteer
in Skandia.
I’d say that volunteering is unpaid work, at least not paid in cash. It’s
something you do for the sake of others. Not for your own gain but to
help another, and that other person or persons is usually needy.
It is crucial that this work is not paid for and she, like almost all the inter-
viewees, specified this aspect by adding that money cannot be involved.
Actions categorised as volunteering are not performed to yield profit or
gain, defined as payment in cash; instead, they are supposed to be for
the benefit of somebody else, preferably someone in need. The volun-
teers are aware of and thankful for the wide range of valuable experiences
and benefits their engagement gives them. Thus, the fact that money is
rejected does not make volunteering necessarily altruistic in any simple
interpretation of the concept; it is rather an exchange between actors
according to specific rules. The reason for the sharp restriction against
involving money does not come from a concern for the beneficiaries of
those actions; and the purpose of keeping unpaid work outside the mon-
etary system is to preserve the value and authentic character of those
actions.
Engagement
Volunteering as the outcome of an engagement is another important
theme. This is reflected in the answer of a middle-aged man engaged
in Stockholm’s City Mission who alleged that volunteering is:
… combination of two things. One is that you have an idea. That’s clear
from the words themselves. You want to promote something, lift forward
something, achieve something; and there’s also an element of commit-
ment. Some kind of burning idea that’s not found in any other kind of
work. That’s what it is; an idea plus commitment.
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 251
He mentions two aspects of engagement that recur as defining proper-
ties of volunteering: firstly, engagement as having an idea, which follows
from the Swedish term (ideellt arbete) that is etymologically related to
the word “idea”. However, it is not just any idea, it is specifically about
goodness. No one mentioned any ideology, political conviction or belief,
when they elaborated on engagement as a cause of volunteering; instead,
they emphasised the second aspect of engagement, its particular function
as an expression of themselves as persons.
By talking about volunteering as something they were engaged in,
were passionate about, believed in, etc., they were subjectivising these
actions (cf. Hultén & Wijkström, 2006). That is, they attached their
efforts to themselves as actors, which may be needed when there are sev-
eral possible competing motives that can make sense of a certain action
(Wuthnow, 1991). The crucial function of referring to engagement is to
make volunteering into actions that are intimately connected to them-
selves and to disclose who they are as persons.
When a middle-aged woman engaged as a police volunteer was asked
what volunteering is, she answered that it is non-paid work, but her
simultaneous ironical expression indicated the possible cynical interpre-
tation that the police organisation is taking advantage of her efforts as
free labour. She demonstrated that she was aware that volunteering is
open to both cynical and idealistic interpretations, and continued by
saying that according to her, volunteering is “… when you feel that you
want to engage in something you believe in, something you burn for …”.
The answer illustrates that engagement as an inner conviction ensures
that efforts cannot be contradicted or suspected to be due to cynical or
improper motives (cf. von Essen, 2016; Wuthnow, 1991); neither can
she be accused of naïvely being used by the organisation since her engage-
ment serves as a valid explanation of why she is deliberately making these
efforts without getting paid.
252 J. von Essen
Voluntary
A third recurrent theme is that volunteering is voluntary, which has sig-
nificance for the character of these actions as not monetarily compen-
sated. To work without being paid, of one’s own free will, is one precon-
dition for not being cynically perceived as being used. This was demon-
strated in the earlier quote by the female police volunteer. If perceived as
actions of free will, unpaid work is categorised as something different to
gainful employment.
A middle-aged woman, engaged as a corporate volunteer at Accenture,
explained the difference between volunteering and gainful employment:
“For me, voluntary work is such efforts as go beyond the work that is expected
of you in some way or another and which you are paid for.” According to
her and others, gainful employment is not a matter of free choice. But
beyond the demands of everyday life there is another and different social
realm where individuals can act out of free will. This does not necessarily
mean that volunteering really is entirely voluntary; it is of course embed-
ded in and dependent on social relations and organisational structures
where normative pressure and social contracts can have a distinct effect
(Hustinx & Meijs, 2011).
That volunteering is conceived of as voluntary is also significant for
its ability to be an expression of engagement. The interviewees claimed
to be genuine and sincere when engaged in volunteering, but coerced or
instrumental when acting as employees. These two dynamics are shown
when another middle-aged woman engaged as a corporate volunteer in
Accenture talked about unpaid work, “… there is no coercion. Instead it
is born out of one’s own motivation…”. As she was talking, she became
somewhat disturbed at being vague and not quite able to capture the
difference between being sincere and being coerced; instead, she found
herself lost in “philosophical discussions”. What she and other intervie-
wees were trying to capture is that in contrast to gainful employment,
their efforts are voluntary and to be voluntary engaged express them-
selves as autonomous subjects.
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 253
For the Benefit of the Other
The fourth theme providing the meaning of volunteering is its other-
directed dimension (Story, 1992), that is, intended for the benefit of a
person or cause. To be for the benefit of someone was a taken-for-granted
defining property, and unlike being non-paid, this aspect did not need
to be explained or defended, and there were no openings for possible
cynical interpretations. An elderly woman engaged as a police volunteer
answered as follows when asked about the nature of unpaid work:
Well it’s a good question. Most important, I think, is that it must be
beneficial to the society or the world, even…
Some of them explicitly said that volunteering means acting with the
intention to do something good, or for a good cause. But little was men-
tioned about the content of a good purpose and how it would be realised.
However, it was not about changing or influencing society or politics,
but rather to help with or amend particular shortcomings or needs. A
younger man, engaged as a corporate volunteer in Skandia, expressed
this apolitical understanding of volunteering by saying:
… doing something, whatever it’s possible to do, so it’s these two things
and you try to do as well as you can—donate money or offer your time
once a month or week to safety patrol the town or work with children
and young people or whatever the cause…
He mentioned these particular examples in order to contrast the volun-
tary character of volunteering with gainful employment, but also to con-
trast volunteers from persons who try to change the world because they
find it “imperfect”. The underlying premise seems to be that a political
conviction or belief is imperative, which threatens the idea of volunteer-
ing as actions of free choice.
Some of the interviewees added that volunteering has to be to the ben-
efit of someone or something outside their own private sphere; otherwise,
it is not entirely of free choice. A female corporate volunteer in Accen-
ture said that actions derived from predispositions or inherited behaviour
254 J. von Essen
are not volunteering. She concluded by saying, “I mean family, well you
have to care of your children, sort of ”. Thus, nursing or taking care of chil-
dren is not categorised as volunteering since these involve actions that are
either too natural or imperative to be deliberate or entirely of free choice.
So, Why Not Money?
It seems as if money has a meaning that is significant for how volun-
teering is perceived and how actions are categorised. Thus, to deepen
the understanding of the importance of keeping volunteering disassoci-
ated from monetary exchange the interviewees’ answers to the question
“Why not money?”, will be discussed here.
A frequent answer was that money can lead to opportunism and
threatens the fragile dynamic of volunteering. Basically, the recurring
idea was that if volunteering is rewarded, the inclination to act in a cal-
culating and egoistical manner would prevail over the genuine motive to
help or be benevolent. A typical statement revealing this view was given
by a middle-aged woman engaged as a corporate volunteer in Skandia:
For the simple reason that no one should be able to make an undue
profit from it, because that would attract persons and groups who do it
for themselves, for their own gain, …
According to her and others, the genuine dynamic of volunteering is eas-
ily overridden if money becomes involved, and the opportunistic motive
to earn money will get the upper hand. It is as if the dynamic of vol-
unteering is fragile and has to be protected against monetary incursions
(cf. Zelizer, 1996, p. 485). Egoism is taken to be the “default cause”
of human actions. To avoid people who are only interested in making
money and let the genuine motive to help prevail it is necessary to keep
money and volunteering apart.
The outlook on mankind that best fits the idea that monetary gain
will make individuals act in their own interest is the idea of the economic
man. The crucial presumption is that man by nature is calculus rational
and will act in his own interest. However, according to the interviewees,
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 255
if there is no money involved, this dynamic will not be triggered; instead,
altruistic motives can prevail. Hence, the volunteers will trust others and
themselves to be altruistic when there is no money at stake, but will
assume that people will act as rational egoists when money is involved. If
money is not involved, individuals can deliberately and of free choice act
altruistically. Volunteering is then framed so that being engaged in and
carrying out these efforts is to stand out as an individual in relation to
the norm of gainful employment and the natural inclination of man to
act in self-interest.
There were also other reasons to reject money. Some of the intervie-
wees said that if they got paid, it would make their engagement similar
to an occupation and thus become a way to earn their living. So, they
wanted to avoid money since the necessity of earning one’s living in real-
ity makes gainful employment somewhat coerced. An elderly woman and
corporate volunteer in Accenture described what would happen if they
were remunerated for their efforts.
You work not only because you want to, that is just a maybe; one is
dependent on work for getting by, for one’s own survival. When you
volunteer you’re not dependent on it; you’re not dependent on getting
something back in order to survive, that’s putting it bluntly ….
What she wanted to capture was that acting out of free will demands
independence, in this case from the necessity of earning one’s living in
order to survive.
Several interviewees also remarked that relations become contrac-
tual when money was involved, which restricted their freedom. To be
employed is a contractual, binding relationship and not a personal
engagement. Hence, money challenges the voluntary character of unpaid
work both because of the need to earn one’s daily bread and because of
the binding character of contractual relations.
There were persons in all four groups who declared that volunteering
entails a risk of becoming opportunistic and egoistic if money is involved.
However, this inclination to defend the altruistic character of volunteer-
ing was more frequently found and emphasised among the corporate vol-
unteers than among the interviewees in the other two groups. Some of
256 J. von Essen
the police volunteers on the other hand said that they felt the need to
explain and even defend their engagement since some people could not
understand why they made these efforts without getting paid. Thus, it
seems as if the corporate volunteers, who were often rather well-off, had
to defend the idea of volunteering against the inclination to act as the
rational egoist, whereas the police volunteers, who were more often liv-
ing in and confronted with a poorer environment, had to defend their
engagement against the suspicion of being used.
The interviewees also declared that money would be an immoral
motive for volunteering. One younger woman, who was engaged as a
corporate volunteer in Accenture, said that it would be a nightmare if
their efforts were paid since it would lead to people becoming engaged
only for the money. A younger man, who was engaged in corporate vol-
unteering in Skandia, declared that if money were accepted, the very def-
inition of goodness would be challenged since it would mean that money
and goodness were being confused. The underlying premise is that you
cannot be paid for being good because goodness demands that you are
sincere, and money makes relations instrumental (von Essen, 2015). It
is by the rejection of money that volunteering can be conceived to be a
morally significant action.
These are the reasons for excluding money from the precarious
dynamic of volunteering. When the interviewees tried to explain why
money was rejected, they talked about preserving volunteering as actions
of free will. In their answers, they oscillated between the practical need
for an income and an abstract idea of the nature of man as two threats
to the voluntary character of volunteering. But irrespective of their prac-
tical or abstract reasons, material needs and benefits had the character of
an “ultimate concern”, as an imperative necessity. To be able to act from
free will so that their actions were expressions of themselves as actors they
had to be autonomous and independent of their practical needs and of
human nature.1
1See Haers and von Essen (2015) for a discussion on free will and the Christian calling of
neighbourly love.
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 257
The Rewards of Unpaid Work
The fact that money was rejected does not mean that volunteering cannot
be rewarded at all. On the contrary, when the interviewees elaborated on
why money was rejected, they were anxious to mention all the other good
things they received from their volunteering.
When elaborating on their rewards they talked primarily about what
they experienced through helping. This was exemplified by many differ-
ent narratives, but on an abstract level they talked about the profound
meaning of helping someone without expecting anything in return.
The corporate volunteers talked more often than the others about the
satisfaction of using their professional skills to help others. Hence, they
often reflected a certain consultancy perspective on how to help and
empower the persons they met.
When asked about what they gained from their efforts the interviewees
also talked about the social aspects of their engagement and referred to
the people they came to meet while carrying out their efforts. Several
talked about how meeting a person in need or being able to help some-
one could create a certain intimacy. These encounters had changed some
of the interviewees’ lives and had made them more confident in asserting
the importance of love and solidarity among people.
Other interviewees also described the social context they were part of.
Some mentioned the fellowship and friendship with other volunteers as a
reward. One middle-aged man, engaged in the Stockholm City Mission,
mentioned the care the organisation showed its volunteers, saying:
… they often offer you cakes or buns, and coffee is free and things like
that, so it’s not money I get, but a cup of coffee and a nice bit of cake or
an ice cream ….
When they talked about the social aspects as rewards for their efforts
the absence of money was significant. They did not receive social rela-
tions, gratitude, care and trivial gifts as compensation for not being paid.
Instead, they could appreciate the social dimension of their engagement
because money was not involved. The gifts and the social relations were
not categorised as a second-best form of payment. Thus (the absence
258 J. von Essen
of) money was significant for the social relations enjoyed through their
engagement.
Their engagement led to relations with people that were quite dif-
ferent from those in their ordinary everyday life, and implied encoun-
ters with new lifestyles and different social conditions. Some intervie-
wees valued these encounters and said that because of their engagement
they had come to understand what it is like to live in poverty and need.
These experiences often perplexed them and sometimes changed them as
persons by widening their perspectives,2 even causing some of them to
reconsider their political standpoints.
A recurring notion among the interviewees was that they wanted to
find their efforts meaningful. To see themselves as good persons and to
be able to receive and enjoy the social dimension of their engagement,
their rewards had to be categorised as gifts. A younger man and corporate
volunteer in Accenture elaborated on what would happen if he were paid
for his efforts:
…then it’s a matter of someone buying your services rather than you
doing what you do simply because you want to do it and that would be
a hindrance in terms of motivation.
He said that he believed that for most people not being paid is posi-
tive because one can then get something else in return for one’s engage-
ment and he found this more valuable than ordinary payment. If peo-
ple were paid, their efforts would be transformed from being gifts into
exchanges and what they received would lose its meaning. A middle-aged
man, engaged in Stockholm’s City Mission, explained how money would
affect the categorisation of his actions:
… otherwise it’s more of an exchange. I exchange one unit for another
unit. But for me volunteering is about me giving something, in this mate-
rialistic physical world we live in.
2For the use of the term “perplex” see Eliasoph (2013).
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 259
If his efforts were categorised as exchanges, then what he received would
be an expected and calculated payment. He was fairly comfortably situ-
ated and used to business relations, but exchanges could not make him
into a good person since, as he said, goodness cannot be bought. What
was at stake for this man was his urge to give, in spite of and in con-
trast to the material world they all live in. So, acting as good persons by
helping someone and the good feeling and satisfaction they experienced
demanded that their rewards were categorised as gifts. The middle-aged
man engaged in Stockholm’s City Mission quoted above expressed this
idea as, “… volunteering means that you’re not expecting any payback, but
at the same time, that is what you do get”.3
Intention is obviously important. If they carried out their efforts with
the intention of getting paid, their actions would have been categorised
as exchanges. Hence, to be able to receive rewards from their engage-
ment, the reward had to be unexpected. Calculative motives for unpaid
work would preclude the unexpected rewards of their engagement. How-
ever, also the presence of money as such, and not only the intention to
get them, would determine how their actions were understood. Several
interviewees felt a need to defend the precarious dynamic of unpaid work
from a societal order where money is a central value and defines most
human relations.
Discussion
According to the interviewees, volunteering entails voluntary, unpaid
efforts and expressions of a personal engagement to act for the benefit
of someone else. This description resembles the common and prevalent
definitions of unpaid work that can be found in research on volunteer-
ing, with the exception that the organisational context is not included
and the personal engagement is emphasised (e.g. Handy et al., 2000;
3See von Essen (2015) for this paradoxical pattern and its structural similarity with the Lutheran
doctrine of the calling.
260 J. von Essen
Musick & Wilson, 2008). There are of course many possible explana-
tions for the exclusion of the organisational aspect. However, consider-
ing the hybridised character of the interviewees’ contexts this exclusion
is possibly due to a shift from a collective to an individualistic mode of
involvement (cf. Hustinx, 2003).
Charles Taylor’s ideas about strong evaluations and evaluative horizons
providing a vocabulary of worth will now be used to unfold how the
interviewees’ volunteer experience is used to construct and disclose their
identities.
It was important for the volunteers to reject money; by doing so, they
preserved volunteering as actions carried out of their own free will. To
ensure that their actions were expressing their identities they had to be
autonomous and independent of the need of earning their income. By
interpreting volunteering as actions performed by sincere agents their
identities could be disclosed by these actions, leaving no room for inter-
preting the actions as coerced or calculative, which would jeopardise the
authenticity of the agent.
However, this relation to money was context-sensitive. In another con-
text, when acting as employees for instance, they acted according to
other rules without violating their authenticity. How money is trans-
ferred in exchanges between people defines social relations and meaning
systems, and to use the incorrect transfer violates or challenges social rela-
tions (Zelizer, 1994). The empirical results indicate that values are used
according to Taylor’s argument, but with the proviso that values have
different meanings in different social contexts (see Grönlund, 2011 and
the chapter of Sirris). According to the interviewees, the involvement of
money would definitely determine whether their actions were categorised
as volunteering or not. This is not only because of how the concept of
volunteering is defined. If money were involved in volunteering, it would
have to be interpreted as a compensation and their efforts would have to
be understood as exchanges between parties. Hence, money is an arte-
fact that has social meaning in itself, regulated by social conventions and
defining social relations.
When referring to their engagement, the interviewees gave assurances
that their efforts were genuine and therefore categorised as other than
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 261
gainful employment. These two categories of action, structured by dif-
ferent dynamics—gainful employment based on the need for an income
and volunteering based on a personal engagement—were contrasted with
each other throughout in the interviews, often in juxtaposition in order
to acquire their meaning through the mirroring of each other. That vol-
unteering was evaluated in contrast to gainful employment was articu-
lated when they said that their engagement was voluntary, in contrast
to coerced employment which makes volunteering into a voluntary and
personal engagement.
When the volunteers elaborated on these themes, they recurrently
referred to values that stood in contrast to dominant norms in society
which made them appear as persons in society. The idea that volun-
teering constitutes a genuine and free realm deviant from and alterna-
tive to the materialistic society the interviewees were living in, was an
overarching theme. How volunteering was perceived and expressed was
dependent on this idea. Thus, the notion of volunteering as comprising
meaningful altruistic actions of free choice did not emerge in spite of the
individualistic and materialistic character of contemporary society. On
the contrary, volunteering was conceived to be altruistic because of the
materialistic society (see Wuthnow, 1991). This relation between mate-
rialistic society and altruistic volunteering is crucial; in order to under-
stand the functions volunteering serves for individuals, but also how it
is conceptually defined. This demonstrates that cognitive meaning, how
volunteering is conceptualised, and normative meaning, how it matters
to individuals, are dependent on each other.
Hence, according to the interviewees a society characterised by a com-
petitive, individualistic and self-interested culture does not make vol-
unteering more instrumental. On the contrary, such a society provides
motives for engagement. Furthermore, it constitutes the evaluative hori-
zon wherein an individual can deploy a language of evaluative distinc-
tions to make strong evaluations, and by preferring contrasting values
can disclose his or her identity as a reaction against the prevailing social
order.
The motives for volunteering are not only about finding solutions to
practical problems; there is more at stake. To be engaged makes it possi-
ble to refer to values by which one can disclose an identity as an authentic
262 J. von Essen
person free from the striving for material gain and acting for the sake of
goodness. This construction of volunteering involves an evaluative hori-
zon enabling a social realm of freedom and compassion in contrast to the
materialistic society where individuals can appear as engaged citizens by
referring to values that motivate their engagement.
References
Eliasoph, N. (2013). The politics of volunteering. Cambridge: Polity Press.
Grönlund, H. (2011). Identity and volunteering intertwined: Reflections on
the values of young adults. VOLUNTAS: International Journal of Voluntary
and Nonprofit Organizations, 22(4), 852–874.
Haers, J. & von Essen, J. (2015). Christian calling and volunteering. In L.
Hustinx, J. von Essen, J. Haers, & S. Mels (Eds.), Religion and volunteering:
Complex, contested and ambiguous relationships. New York: Springer.
Handy, F., Cnaan, R. A., Brudney, J. L., Ascoli, U., Meijs, L. C., & Ranade,
S. (2000). Public perception of “who is a volunteer”: An examination
of the net-cost approach from a cross-cultural perspective. VOLUNTAS:
International Journal of Voluntary and Nonprofit Organizations, 11(1), 45–65.
Hooghe, M. (2003). Participation in voluntary associations and value indica-
tors: The effect of current and previous participation experiences. Nonprofit
and Voluntary Sector Quarterly., 32(1), 47–69.
Hultén, P., & Wijkström, F. (2006). Särart och mervärde i den ideella sektorn.
En studie av ledares syn på de idéburna organisationernas betydelse. Stockholm:
Socialstyrelsen.
Hustinx, L. (2003). Reflexive modernity and styles of volunteering: The case of
the Flemish Red Cross volunteers (Diss.). Faculteit Sociale Wetenschappen,
Katholieke Universiteit Leuven, Leuven.
Hustinx, L., & Meijs, L. (2011). Re-embedding volunteering: In search of a
new collective ground. Voluntary Sector Review, 2(1), 5–21.
Musick, M., & Wilson, J. (2008). Volunteers: A social profile. Bloomington:
Indiana University Press.
Ricoeur, P. (1971). The model of the text: Meaningful action considered as a
text. Social Research, 38(3), 529–562.
Sachar, I., von Essen, J., & Hustinx, L. (2019). Opening up the ‘black box’
of ‘volunteering’: Tracing hybridization and purification mechanisms in
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering 263
volunteering research and promotion. Administrative Theory & Praxis.
Published Online.
Story, D. (1992). Volunteerism: The “self-regarding” and “other-regarding”
aspects of the human spirit. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 21(3),
3–18.
Taylor, C. (1985). Philosophical papers 1: Human agency and language.
Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Taylor, C. (1991). The ethics of authenticity. Cambridge, MA: Harvard
University Press.
von Essen, J. (2015). Lost and found in secularization: A religious perspective
on the meaning of volunteering. In L. Hustinx, J. von Essen, J. Haers, &
S. Mels, (Eds.), Religion and volunteering: Complex, contested and ambiguous
relationships. New York: Springer.
von Essen, J. (2016). On the meaning of volunteering: A study of worldviews
in everyday life. Foundations of Science, 21(2), 315–333.
Wilson, J. (2012). Volunteerism research: A review essay. Nonprofit and
Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 41(2), 176–212.
Wuthnow, R. (1991). Acts of compassion: Caring for others and helping ourselves.
Princeton: Princeton University Press.
Zelizer, V. A. (1994). The social meaning of money: Pin money, paychecks, poor
relief, & other currencies. New York: Basic Books.
Zelizer, V. A. (1996). Payments and social ties. Sociological Forum, 11(3),
481–495.
264 J. von Essen
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
14
The Value of Group Reflection
Beate Jelstad Løvaas and Gry Bruland Vråle
I would have continued to stay in water, doing my best until I got ill. I will
never dare to stand alone again – that is what this group has taught me!
—Participant in a managerial group reflection
Introduction
What happens when managers from different organisations reflect upon
their challenging work relationships and everyday relational work situa-
tions? Being a manager at work can be lonely and challenging. In daily
practice, many activities that managers perform are unconscious and
B. J. Løvaas · G. B. Vråle (B)
VID Specialized University, Oslo, Norway
B. J. Løvaas
e-mail: beate.jelstad.lovaas@vid.no
G. B. Vråle
e-mail: gry.bruland.vrale@vid.no
© The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_14
265
http://crossmark.crossref.org/dialog/?doi=10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_14&domain=pdf
mailto:beate.jelstad.lovaas@vid.no
mailto:gry.bruland.vrale@vid.no
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9_14
266 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
unspoken. Collective reflection presents an opportunity for the managers
to bring the unspoken and unconscious to the forefront, thus creating a
space for the identification of values. Group reflection can strengthen
values consciousness and reflexivity among individual actors. As val-
ues guide choices of actions, values consciousness may even change and
improve practice (Aadland & Askeland, 2017), which is also suggested
by the positive relationship between managers’ values consciousness and
innovation in organisations (Nygaard & Løvaas, 2019). Thus, working
with values such as having a space to reflect on activities and work sit-
uations may facilitate values consciousness and allow for changes and
improvements in practice. In this way, group reflection may serve to link
everyday practices with the overall purpose of the organisation.
Values work both presupposes and increases reflexivity. The concept
of values work, as described in Chapter 1, includes ‘reflection-creating
processes’ producing value-related actions in specific situations (Espedal,
2019, p. 30). This chapter situates the perspective of values work by
investigating the significance of middle managers’ reflection processes
in a group supervision programme. Hence, managerial group reflection
serves as an example of values work. We adopt a practice-based and
micro-level perspective on how to perform values work, as described
in Chapter 1. Since the chapter explores group reflection processes that
involve managers from different organisations, we look specifically at val-
ues work being performed by managers outside their daily institutional
environments that produce value-related actions inside their organisa-
tions.
In this research, we pay special attention to reflections on challeng-
ing work relationships and everyday relational work situations. Rela-
tionships at work can be a source of enrichment that allows individ-
ual actors and organisations to learn, grow and flourish, or they can be
toxic and dysfunctional. Relationships are fundamental to organisations
and have always been a part of organisational theory and management
theory (Heaphy et al., 2018). Management researchers have long recog-
nised that the ‘people make the place’ (Schneider, 1987). Further, posi-
tive organisational scholars have given attention to work relationships by
the substantial body of research on high-quality connections as a power-
ful source for organisations (Dutton & Heaphy, 2003; Stephens, Heaphy
14 The Value of Group Reflection 267
& Dutton, 2012). Thus, reflecting on work relationships and daily rela-
tional situations and practices is important to organisations, as the reflec-
tions may enable new actions and practices that could be more beneficial
than the routinised versions. This study aims to examine the significance
of managers performing values work via group reflections on challenging
work relationships and everyday relational work situations. Specifically, it
examines how middle managers in organisations can be relational agents
aiding individual actors and organisations with work relationships and
hopefully contribute to the betterment of workplaces.
Reflection groups are of different types, such as supervision groups
(Vråle, 2017), ethical reflection groups (Aadland, 2010; Eide & Aadland,
2017) and coaching groups (Brown & Grant, 2010). An aspect common
to all these types of group reflection is that they all belong to the ‘think-
ing slow’ category (Kahneman, 2011). In his book titled, Thinking Fast
and Slow, Kahneman draws attention to how the human mind works
to improve judgements and decision-making. This study is mainly con-
cerned with the process of thinking slow together with others—reflecting
together in groups. Group reflection, as opposed to individual reflection,
can offer additional information that may lie outside one’s own thoughts.
It may also allow for identification with others to foster mutual learning
and growth. This occurs through the mechanisms of recognition—where
individuals recognise aspects of their selves in others—and integration—
where individuals incorporate aspects of others into their own selves
(Humbred & Rouse, 2016).
In this chapter, we describe a qualitative empirical intervention involv-
ing group reflections with middle managers from different work sectors.
The intervention was a supervised group reflection implemented over a
six-month period. The aim was to examine the value of supervised group
reflection, and the research question guiding this chapter is: What is the
significance of middle managers’ participation in a group supervision that
focuses on their work relationships? We investigate both the processes of
group supervision and the practices/outcomes, with a specific focus on
value-related actions.
268 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
Theoretical Framework and Previous Research
Identity
Identity is essential to social life and is a central construct to meaning and
motivation, logics of action and decision-making among others. Identity
answers the question ‘Who am I?’ and covers roles, social relations and
group membership. Studies on identity are situated in different contexts
such as organisational, professional, social and individual. We focus on
the individual level and view identity as ‘the sense an individual has of
oneself’ (Grönlund, 2011, p. 855). This sense of self is viewed as a reflex-
ive and continuous project (Giddens, 1991). In other words, identity
changes and develops throughout an individual’s life. This ongoing pro-
cess of constructing identities is called identity work (Svenningsson &
Alvesson, 2003). As discussed by Askeland (Chapter 2 in this volume),
values are part of and inherently connected to identity and identity work.
Thus, we argue that working with values in group reflections is connected
to the ongoing process of participants’ identity work.
Self-Awareness in Identity Processes
The concept of self-awareness is rooted in the disciplines of both psychol-
ogy and sociology (Carver, 2012), and it relates to the salience of social
and personal values. Self-awareness in identity processes is related to the
concept of self-identity (Sirris, 2019). It implies having access to one’s
values, feelings and processes. Self-awareness also implies flexible access
to one’s own affects. The self has a unique capacity termed reflexivity,
which refers to ‘the ability to turn around and take itself as the object of
its own view’ (Carver, 2012, p. 50). In this chapter, we specifically focus
on self-awareness because participation in group reflection facilitates pro-
cesses of self-awareness and consciousness, which are related to questions
such as ‘Who am I’ and ‘Who do I want to be, should be and can be’
(Vråle, 2015). Identification with others also strengthens self-awareness.
Identification is linked to the question, ‘How do I come to know who I
am in relation to you?’ (Humbred & Rouse, 2016, p. 438). Identifying
14 The Value of Group Reflection 269
with one another, for instance in a group reflection, may foster mutual
learning and growth.
Supervision
Scholars (such as Tveiten, 2013; Vråle, 2015, 2017) have explained
supervision as conscious reflections and dialogues based on humanistic
values, related to experiences from practical leadership. It helps man-
agers focus on their own manners, understand themselves better and
possibly change their ways of thinking and practices as leaders (Vråle,
2017). Severinsson (2014) notes even though supervision is a relatively
new scientific method, its results confirm the importance of the oppor-
tunity to reflect on one’s practical work. Brunero and Stein-Parbury
(2008) reported that supervision may prevent burnout, and Løkvik
(2019) showed that the positive outcomes of group reflection include
increased self-consciousness and increased organisational commitment.
Jensen, Rossavik, and Husebø (2018) concluded that group supervision
for middle managers may create common room for understanding dif-
ferent problems and encourage leaning on others for support when new
challenges occur.
With regard to ethics reflection groups, Hem, Molewijk, Gjerberg,
Lillemoen, and Pederson (2018) showed that participants promote
improved professional competence and confidence. Vråle, Borge, and
Nedberg (2017) identified courage as an important dimension of ethics
reflection groups. While a number of studies have examined the influ-
ence of group reflection on nurses in health care, few have focused on
managers.
We aim to add to the knowledge on group reflection among organisa-
tional managers with the help of an action-based intervention. We also
seek to contribute to the sparse literature on values work (see Chapter 3
by Espedal for a review), proposed by Gehman, Trevino, and Garud
(2013), by studying how engaging in group reflection processes outside
their institutions allows managers to produce value-related actions inside
their organisations.
270 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
Method
We conducted a six-month group supervision programme, from Novem-
ber 2017 to May 2018, for middle managers from different work sectors.
As part of the intervention, the participants reflected on their challeng-
ing work relationships, everyday relational work situations and practices
in a group.
Six female middle managers from different work sectors were recruited
from a value-based leadership programme at VID Specialized Univer-
sity to attend 10 supervised group reflection meetings (Table 14.1). Four
of the participants were from the non-profit sector, one participant was
from the public health sector, and one participant represented the private
profit sector. Three of the four non-profit participants worked at differ-
ent faith-based institutions. The age range of the participants was from
30 to 60 years.
The study adopts an action-based approach that aims at both taking
action and creating knowledge (Coghlan & Shani, 2018; Greenwood &
Levin, 2007; McNiff, 2017), described in the following. Inspired by the
principles of research circles (Slettebø, 2013) where practitioners develop
research questions along with the researchers, we invited the participants
to a workshop (Meeting 1). Questions such as how to develop sustainable
relationships at work were introduced by the participants in the work-
shop, and they were addressed in the focus group interviews and during
the group supervisions.
The researchers were leading and taking part in all of the 10 meetings.
Information from the two group interviews (Meetings 2 and 10) was
recorded and transcribed, and translated direct quotations from these
Table 14.1 Outline of the group meetings
Meeting 1 Workshop in which the researchers (authors of the study)
and practitioners (six informants) jointly developed ideas
for the research question
Meeting 2 Focus group interview before the group supervisions about
relational work, practices and values
Meeting 3–9 Seven group supervisions on relational aspects of leadership
(intervention)
Meeting 10 Focus group interview after the group supervisions
14 The Value of Group Reflection 271
meetings have been included in the findings. During the seven group
supervisions (Meetings 3–9), log notes were maintained by us. Refer-
ences to these log notes in the findings are not always direct quotations,
but close interpretations of the participants’ views. The participants con-
firmed the interpretations and also commented on the preliminary drafts
of the chapter.
Description of the Intervention
We used team reflections (Andersen, 1994), ethical reflections (Aadland,
2010; Eide & Aadland, 2017), and ‘outsider witness responses’ (Lundby,
2005) in the supervision group meetings. Each meeting lasted for 90
minutes. The intention behind all the sessions was to create space for
recognition and identification. Each session began with the supervisor
reading some text based on topics from the previous meeting to intro-
duce continuity, such as a passage on self-consciousness. This was fol-
lowed by a group participant narrating an event from her daily work as
a middle manager. One of the supervisors interviewed her. While she
narrated her story, the other participants reflected as a team (Andersen,
1994), they first listened without speaking.
After the narration, the rest of the group shared their reflections in a
fixed format: what special detail in the narration made an impression on
them, what according to them was the intention of the narrator, what
related experience did they remember from their role as a leader, and
what did they want to tell the owner of experience (Lundby, 2005). The
reflections were instructive and were to be shared in an open and appre-
ciative way. They were also expected to be informative and valuable to the
rest of the participants. At the end of each session, the supervisor asked
the narrator to summarise her learning and her key takeaways from the
session for future reflections.
Data Analysis
First, data from the two group interviews were transcribed. We inde-
pendently noted interesting and important aspects in the transcripts and
272 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
developed initial coding categories. Next, we discussed and refined our
preliminary coding and categories and jointly developed the categories
through mutual consent. Treating coding as a starting point rather than
an end point (Locke, Feldman, & Golden-Biddle, 2016), we also iden-
tified three questions: (1) What kind of relational situations did the par-
ticipants bring into the supervision groups, (2) what types of relational
mechanisms occurred within the supervision group, and (3) what did the
participants gain out of the supervision group—where did they move?
These questions shaped our interpretation of the data. Thematic analyses
and systematic coding of the data were performed using NVivo. We also
relied on theories on self and identity for understanding the material. We
went back and forth between empirical data and theoretical frameworks
until we were satisfied with our justification of participant experiences.
Oscillating between data and existing theory signals the use of an abduc-
tive approach (Bryman, 2012).
Ethical Considerations and Limitations of the Study
This study was approved by the Norwegian Social Science Data Services
(NSD). The respondents were informed about the intended use of the
data, confidentiality of information, voluntary participation, etc.
A methodological limitation of this study is that intervention was
evaluated by the researchers who conducted it. The researchers/authors
of the study were also the supervisors of the group reflection interven-
tion. However, to ensure an objective evaluation, the evaluation process
was therefore conducted on paper, and participation information was
anonymised. Another limitation of this study is that the sample did not
include any male leaders.
Findings
With regard to the first question of what relational situations were
brought into the group, seven situations were narrated in the seven group
meetings. Four were pertained to cooperation problems with a (superior)
14 The Value of Group Reflection 273
leader, one was related to a subordinate, and two were related to private
decision-making—of which one concerned a family business. One situ-
ation was addressed twice, as a follow-up after some months.
The narrations examined values such as power versus powerlessness
and trust versus mistrust. Participants expressed their powerlessness and
mistrust in different ways. Juggling two parallel levels of hierarchy in the
organisations made the power structure unclear and unpredictable for
the middle managers. One of the managers complained of being tired,
‘I have tried to tell them in 5 years and six months’. Another expressed
feeling trapped by her superior: ‘I feel I am “bought and paid”, I am a
dependent upon my leader because I need a reference from her’. Pow-
erlessness was also expressed as lack of hope: ‘There is no way back, the
conflict has gone too far’. One participant described her leader’s evalua-
tion of her in the following words: ‘I was characterised as passive aggres-
sive by the leader in a group meeting at work. That is the worst thing I
have ever experienced’. These accounts test the value of trust, which is
fundamental to a healthy work relationship.
Negative evaluations by leaders (such as being passive aggressive) may
disturb an individual’s sense of peace and force them to lose control
over work, feel tired or report sick. Other values that were highlighted
in the narrated situations were honesty—‘I can’t answer honestly’—and
freedom—‘I do not wish to be bound by structures of power! I want to
choose my own way’! Powerlessness and feelings of helplessness may be
understood as an existential phenomenon. Analysing such situations in a
group reflection may help leaders decide on the next steps while fulfilling
their responsibility and duties (Severinsson, 2014).
The second question pertained to the relational mechanisms seen in
the group reflections. We found that participants developed and practised
values such as openness and courage in the supervision group. One par-
ticipant expressed it as follows: ‘Practicing openness, honesty and courage
in the group and experiencing identification from the others created
movements and growth for me individually and for us as a group’. The
openness practised in the group was evident when a participant described
herself as passive aggressive. By telling the group that it was ‘the worst
thing I have ever experienced’, she demonstrated a willingness to share
without fear. Similarly, the participants discussed and openly disagreed
274 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
on topics such as the merits and demerits of leadership alliances. The
participants seemed to feel safe among middle managers from different
organisations. One participant described the group as a space to ‘slap and
slam, but also to test out’, which was indicative of a safe environment in
the group.
Openness was also evident in the sense of inquiry that characterised
the group discussions: the supervisors and participants used open-ended
questions instead of defining and concluding statements. One partici-
pant summarised this experienced in the following words: ‘You ask ques-
tions, without having a direction, but rather being open. I think this is
important to for me to do as a leader as well’.
The value of openness was developed at an early stage in the supervi-
sions. In the first group meeting, time was spent on becoming familiar
with the group and laying down some rules, such as for confidential-
ity. This process could have enabled and facilitated openness. Further,
the structure of the group session was the same for all the seven sessions.
This predictable structure may also have contributed to the psychological
safety (Edmondson, 1999) and sense of creativity of the participants.
As the participants freely shared their stories, the supervision group
engaged in identification through the mechanism of recognition, where
individuals recognise aspects of themselves that they share with others,
and through the mechanism of integration, where individuals incorpo-
rate aspects of others into their own selves (Humbred & Rouse, 2016).
The findings related to the third and main question (what the partic-
ipants gained from the group reflections) can be divided into two cat-
egories: moving inward and moving forward. The first represents indi-
vidual growth and self-awareness in identity processes, while the latter
captures value-related actions.
Moving Inward
Some of the individual actors learned more about their own emotions
from the group reflection work. Statements like ‘I didn’t know I was
that angry’ highlighted increased awareness of one’s own emotions. During
a session, the supervisor asked a participant to rate her anger on a scale
14 The Value of Group Reflection 275
from 1 to 10, with 10 being the highest. The participant answered, ‘At
least 8. My anger is in my stomach and in my neck’. The scaling question
served to awaken and generate awareness of unrecognised feelings.
Listening to the others’ reflections on one’s own narration also stirred
suppressed emotions, as noted by a participant: ‘My feelings have been
very much stronger after this meeting. It is a note to self that I carry feel-
ings, I don’t want to overlook these feelings’. Thus, the group reflections
enabled the individual actors to be more aware of their own emotions.
Another approach to moving inward and developing self-identity is
the awareness of one’s boundaries (Schibbye, 2011; Vråle, 2015), which
has a dialectical relationship with self-awareness. To be well-defined as a
person, one should be self-reflexive and vice versa (Schibbye, 2011). One
of the participants noted that meeting in groups helped to ‘get to know
own limits and boundaries, to take care of oneself’. This points to the
development of self-awareness through the knowledge of self-boundaries.
Another participant said, ‘The group helped me to clarify what are my
limits’. One participant learned to correct her own mistakes with the help
of group reflections, and another participant called for more challenging
discussions to identify any blind spots that she may have.
The findings indicate that the development of self-identity is accel-
erated when individuals find their own feelings, thoughts and reactions
reciprocated in others’ experiences. A participant expressed this as fol-
lows: ‘One needs an echo-room, a soundboard room like this’. This
quote highlights the need to be identified and appreciated. Identifica-
tion through recognition is vital to growth and learning (Humbred &
Rouse, 2016), and consequently, for the development of self-identity.
Before the intervention, the participants were asked about their expec-
tations from the programme, and they all mentioned self-development
in one way or another. These expectations were collectively experienced
as ‘moving inward’. Findings indicate that spaces for group reflection
enable individual actors to move inward through increased self-awareness
of emotions and through increased awareness of own boundaries. This is
an approach to constructing self-identity and thus performing identity
work.
276 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
Moving Forward
The group reflections also enabled the participants to ‘move forward’
in different ways. One participant moved forward by quitting her job.
Another one commented that the supervision group helped with a diffi-
cult decision: ‘The group gave me strength to take an important decision.
It has been a catalyst for the decision I have had inside for some time’.
The courage to overcome difficult situations, including feelings of pow-
erlessness, can be explained by the encouragement received in the super-
vision group. Similar findings reported by Vråle et al. (2017), Rokke
(2017) and Jensen et al. (2018) suggest that the development of courage
is a result of group reflection. In the study, the reflections empowered the
participants to move away from feelings of loneliness and powerlessness
to courageous decisions. Some participants who were ‘stuck’ found a way
forward.
Some participants also moved forward by implementing new changes
in their actions. For instance, while having a difficult conversation with
her leader, one of the participants tried to be more humble and vul-
nerable. She actioned this new approach by informing and sharing her
emotions with the leader: ‘Now I have tried to add a new element in the
dialogue, I have included my emotions in a way. That was actually a suc-
cess’. The participant moved forward by trying out a new approach. She
found it to be successful as her leader responded to her by communicat-
ing in a ‘more human’ way. This is an example of values work: how group
reflection processes performed by leaders outside their daily institutional
environments produce value-related action inside the organisation.
In sum, this study indicates that the significance of group reflection
and slow thinking (Kahneman, 2011) enables individual actors to move
inward through increased self-awareness and to move forward by imple-
menting value-related action. These findings are illustrated in Fig. 14.1.
The ‘bringing in’ component in the figure represents the situations nar-
rated by the participants, and the space for group reflection in the figure
represents what happens when reflecting together. In addition to the
mechanism of recognition, experiences of openness and identification
describe what happened in the space for group reflection, enabling the
participants to move inward and forward.
14 The Value of Group Reflection 277
Mechanism:
Recogni on
MOVING INWARD
MOVING FORWARD
SPACE FOR
GROUP REFLECTIONBRINGING IN
Fig. 14.1 The process, mechanism and significance of group reflection
Discussion
Findings indicate that spaces for group reflection enable individual actors
to move inward via identity processes such as increased awareness of
own emotions as well as to move forward by implementing new actions
(Fig. 14.1). The arrow between moving inward and moving forward can
be explained as increased awareness of emotions that leads to forward
movements. For instance, one participant said, ‘Workers come to my
office and pour their rage. I have to follow the administrative line. I deal
with my rage by seeking three new jobs’! This is a practical example of
the link between moving inward and moving forward. There also exists
a link between the ‘moving forward’ box and the ‘bringing in’ box in
Fig. 14.1. While there is no empirical evidence to support this linkage,
it has been included to signify that moving forward, such as trying out
new steps of action, can introduce new challenges.
Findings from this study indicate that group reflection on daily work
situations narrated by leaders may help individual leaders to increase
their self-awareness. This self-awareness may stem from the process of
278 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
listening patiently to a narrator’s story in a group reflection, with an
open mind and in complete attention. The structured and predictable
format of group reflections and the guaranteed confidentiality of the
information shared possibly create a safe space for the members in the
group (Vråle, 2015). Articulating difficult situations and experiences in
a safe atmosphere, as well as identifying and naming the values at stake
along with other leaders, sensitises the participants to new meanings and
to their own feelings, values and thoughts. Further, self-identifying and
being identified, through mirroring and emotional support from other
group members, seem to facilitate increased self-awareness and integrity
in decision-making related to daily work.
A key finding of this study is that the participants experienced
increased awareness of their own emotions. One participant did not
realise the extent of her anger (moving inward), while another moved
forward by communicating her emotions to her leader. Emotions can
provide valuable information about the values at stake. They may func-
tion as safeguards or alarms, signalling that important values, such as
integrity and trust, are under threat. This may manifest in an aware-
ness of anger, as with the participant in the supervision group. Values
are made meaningful through emotions, that are the ‘glue binding peo-
ple together’ (Zietsma, Toubiana, Voronov, & Roberts, 2019). Although
emotions shape the lives, actions and experiences of institutional actors
(Zietsma & Toubiana, 2018), until very recently, they have been largely
ignored in the literature on organisational institutionalism (Lok, Creed,
DeJordy, & Voronov, 2017). Focusing on emotions in organisations is
relevant and important to organisational life and practices. This study
shows that group reflection enables individual actors to move inward by
developing self-identity. Identity is fluid and not static; as a result, actors
continuously construct their identity. Working with values in a group
reflection is one approach to constructing identity and hence perform-
ing identity work (Sirris, 2019).
The role of reflection is a central component of the agency perspec-
tive that involves awareness of possibilities in everyday work situations.
Based on the findings of this study, we argue that managerial group
reflection on relational work situations, as a way of performing values
work, may nurture relational agency. Relational agency can be defined
14 The Value of Group Reflection 279
as a ‘reflexive and purposive capacity to initiate and carry out actions
for improving relationships in the workplace’ (Sundet & Carlsen, 2019).
The agency perspective proposes a lasting capacity that goes beyond the
momentary meetings highlighted, for instance, in the substantial body of
research on high-quality connections (Dutton & Heaphy, 2003). Rela-
tional agency is an important concept and approach as it has the power to
influence what many people consider the most important aspect of life—
relationships, and moreover, the quality of relationships (Waldinger,
2015). Thus, at a practical level, investigating and finding ways to seed
relational agency in managers may play an important role in organisa-
tions and potentially contribute to the betterment of workplaces. Group
reflection on practices and everyday relational work situations can be seen
as an avenue to seed relational agency in managers through experiences
of openness, identification and recognition in the group, enabling indi-
vidual actors to move inward and forward. Thus, values work through
managerial group reflection can be an approach to cultivating relational
agency.
Concluding Remarks
This chapter highlights the significance of middle managers’ group reflec-
tion centred on their work relationships. In essence, group reflections are
valuable as they enable individual actors to move inward, by construct-
ing their self-identity, and move forward by executing new steps of action
at work. Values work effected by managerial group reflection can be an
approach to cultivating relational agency. Such engagement may con-
tribute to better practices and thus better quality of organisational life
and services. In this way, values work may serve to link everyday prac-
tices with the overall purpose of the organisation.
280 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
References
Aadland, E. (2010). Values in professional practice: Towards a critical reflective
methodology. Journal of Business Ethics, 98, 461–472.
Aadland, E., & Askeland, H. (2017). Verdibevisst ledelse [Value-conscious
leadership]. Oslo: Cappelen Damm Akademisk.
Andersen, T. (1994). Reflekterende processer. Samtaler om samtalerne [Reflect-
ing processes. Talks about the talkers]. København: Dansk Psykologisk
København.
Brown, S. W., & Grant, A. M. (2010). From GROW to GROUP: Theoretical
issues and a practical model for group coaching in organisations. Coaching:
An International Journal of Theory, Research and Practice, 3(1), 30–45.
Brunero, S., & Stein-Parbury, J. (2008). The effectiveness of clinical supervi-
sion in nursing: An evidenced-based literature review. Australian Journal of
Advanced Nursing, 25(39), 86–94.
Bryman, A. (2012). Social research methods (4th ed.). Oxford: Oxford
University Press.
Carver, C. S. (2012). Self-awareness. In M. R. Leary & J. P. Tangney (Eds.),
Handbook of self and identity (2nd ed., pp. 50–68). New York: Guilford
Press.
Coghlan, D., & Shani, A. B. (R). (2018). Conducting action research for
business and management studies. London: Sage.
Dutton, J., & Heaphy, E. (2003). The power of high-quality connections. In
K. S. Cameron, J. E. Dutton, & R. E. Quinn (Eds.), Positive organizational
scholarship: Foundations of a new discipline (pp. 263–278). San Francisco:
Berrett-Koehler.
Edmondson, A. (1999). Psychological safety and learning behavior in work
teams. Administrative Science Quarterly, 44, 350–383.
Eide, T., & Aadland, E. (2017). Etikkhåndboka for kommunenes helse- og
omsorgstjenester [Handbook of ethical reflection]. Oslo: Kommuneforlaget.
Espedal, G. (2019). Being compassionate. Institutionalizing through values work
in a faith-based organization (PhD). VID Specialized University, Oslo.
Gehman, J., Trevino, L., & Garud, R. (2013). Values work: A process study of
the emergence and performance of organizational values practices. Academy
of Management Journal, 56 (1), 84–112.
Giddens, A. (1991). Modernity and self-identity: Self and society in late modern
age. Cambridge: Polity Press.
14 The Value of Group Reflection 281
Greenwood, D. J., & Levin, M. (2007). Introduction to action research: Social
research for social change (2nd ed.). London: Sage.
Grönlund, H. (2011). Identity and volunteering intertwined: Reflections of
the values of young adults. VOLUNTAS: International Journal of Voluntary
and Nonprofit Organizations, 22, 852–874.
Heaphy, E., Byron, K., Ballinger, G. A., Gittell, J. H., Leana, C., & Sluss, D.
(2018). The changing nature of work relationships. Academy of Management
Review, 43(4), 558–569.
Hem, M. H., Molewijk, B., Gjerberg, E., Lillemoen, L., & Pederson, R.
(2018). The significance of ethics reflection groups in mental health care:
A focus group study among health care professionals. BMC Medical Ethics,
19, 54.
Humbred, B. K., & Rouse, E. D. (2016). Seeing you in me and me in you:
Personal identification in the phases of mentoring relationships. Academy of
Management Review, 41(3), 435–455.
Jensen, A. R., Rossavik, B., & Husebø, S. E. (2018). Avdelingssykepleiere blir
bedre ledere med gruppeveiledning [Head nurses become better leaders when
they take part in group supervision]. http://doi.org/10.4220/Sykepleiens.
2018.73043.
Kahneman, D. (2011). Thinking fast and slow. London: Penguin Books Ltd.
Locke, K., Feldman, M. S., & Golden-Biddle, K. (2016). Discovery, valida-
tion, and live coding. In K. D. Elsbach & R. M. Kramer (Eds.), Handbook
of qualitative organizational research: Innovative pathways and methods
(pp. 371–379). New York: Routledge.
Lok, J., Creed, W. E. D., DeJordy, R., & Voronov, M. (2017). Living
institutions: Bringing emotions into organizational institutionalism. In R.
Greenwood, C. Oliver, T. B. Lawrence, & R. E. Meyer (Eds.), The Sage
handbook of organizational institutionalism (2nd ed., pp. 591–620). Los
Angeles and London: Sage.
Løkvik, O. (2019). There’s a crack in everything, that’s how the light gets in
(Master’s thesis). VID Specialized University, Oslo.
Lundby, G. (2005). Reflekterende team som hedrende seremoni [Reflecting team
as definitional ceremony]. Fokus på Familien, 3, 143–161.
McNiff, J. (2017). Action research: All you need to know. London: Sage.
Nygaard, J., & Løvaas, B. J. (2019). Hva er verdien av verdibevissthet? [What
is the value of value consciousness?]. Magma, 2, 55–64.
Rokke, S. (2017). Gjør etisk refleksjon de ansatte mer innovative? En kvalitativ
studie av personlaets og ledernes erfaring med etisk refleksjon i praksis [Does
http://doi.org/10.4220/Sykepleiens.2018.73043
282 B. J. Løvaas and G. B. Vråle
ethical reflection make employees more innovative?] (Master’s thesis). VID
Specialized University, Oslo.
Schibbye, A. L. L. (2011). Læringsprosesser i veiledning belyst ved utvalgte
relasjonsbegreper. In M. H. Rønnestad & S. Reichelt (Eds.), Veiledning i
psykoterapeutisk arbeid (pp. 67–78). Oslo: Universitetsforlaget.
Schneider, B. (1987). The people make the place. Personell Psychology, 40(3),
437–453.
Severinsson, E. (2014). Berättelser från handledning – røsterom vanmakt. In
E. Lasseius & E. Severinsson (Eds.), Hermeneutik i vårdpraxis. [Hermeneu-
tics in nursing practice], Det nära, det flyktiga, det dolda (pp. 177–186).
Malmø: Gleerups.
Sirris, S. (2019). Managers negotiating identities: Hybridizing professionalism
and managerialism in faith-based health organizations and in religious
organizations (PhD dissertation), VID Specialized University, Oslo.
Slettebø, T. (2013). Forskningssirkler som fagutvikling [Research circles
as professional development]. In E. Døhlie & A. M. Støkken (Eds.),
Fagutvikling i velferdstjenester (pp. 219–232). Oslo: Universitetsforlaget.
Stephens, J. P., Heaphy, E., & Dutton, J. E. (2012). High-quality connections.
In G. M. Spreitzer & K. Camron (Eds.), The Oxford handbook of positive
organizational scholarship. New York: Oxford University Press.
Sundet, J., & Carlsen, A. (2019). Sweet dreams (are made of this): Cultivat-
ing relational agency through high-quality connecting. In R. Burke & A.
Richardson (Eds.), Creating psychologically healthy workplaces (pp. 251–269).
Cheltenham, UK: Edvard Elgar.
Svenningsson, S., & Alvesson, M. (2003). Managing managerial identities:
Organizational fragmentation, discourse and identity struggle. Human
Relations, 56 (19), 1163–1193.
Tveiten, S. (2013). Veiledning; mer enn ord [Supervision; more than words].
Bergen: Fagbokforlaget.
Vråle, G. B. (2015). Veiledning når det røyner på [Supervision, in difficult
times]. Oslo: Gyldendal Akademisk.
Vråle, G. B. (2017). Veiledning – en vei til lederes verdibevissthet? [Supervision
– a way to value consciousness?]. In E. Aadland & H. Askeland (Eds.),
Verdibevisst ledelse (pp. 303–322). Oslo: Cappelen Damm Akademisk.
Vråle; G. B., Borge, L., & Nedberg, K. (2017). Etisk refleksjon og bevisstgjøring
i veiledning [Ethical reflection and consciousness in supervision]. Sykepleien
forskning. https://doi.org/10.4220/sykepleienf.2017.61626.
Waldinger, R. (2015, November). What makes a good life? Lessons from the
longest study on happiness [TED Talk]. Retrieved from https://www.ted.
https://doi.org/10.4220/sykepleienf.2017.61626
14 The Value of Group Reflection 283
com/talks/robert_waldinger_what_makes_a_good_life_lessons_from_the_
longest_study_on_happiness?language=en.
Zietsma, C., & Toubiana, M. (2018). The valuable, the constitutive, and the
energetic: Exploring the impact and importance of studying emotions and
institutions. Organization Studies, 39(4), 427–443.
Zietsma, C., Toubiana, M., Voronov, M., & Roberts, A. (2019). Emotions in
organization theory. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Open Access This chapter is licensed under the terms of the Creative
Commons Attribution 4.0 International License (http://creativecommons.org/
licenses/by/4.0/), which permits use, sharing, adaptation, distribution and
reproduction in any medium or format, as long as you give appropriate credit
to the original author(s) and the source, provide a link to the Creative Com-
mons license and indicate if changes were made.
The images or other third party material in this chapter are included in
the chapter’s Creative Commons license, unless indicated otherwise in a credit
line to the material. If material is not included in the chapter’s Creative Com-
mons license and your intended use is not permitted by statutory regulation
or exceeds the permitted use, you will need to obtain permission directly from
the copyright holder.
http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
Index
A
Aadland, E. 5, 16–20, 25, 27, 37,
42, 44, 46, 47, 141, 142, 182,
185, 206, 225, 266, 267, 271
Action 1, 3, 4, 6–8, 15, 16, 18–21,
23, 25, 26, 37, 38, 42, 43,
45, 46, 49, 68, 71, 82, 86,
118, 120, 121, 123, 124,
126, 130–132, 135, 142–144,
152, 160, 166, 172, 182–186,
189, 191–194, 201, 205, 208,
211, 215, 217, 219, 225, 229,
236, 246–254, 256, 258–261,
266–270, 274, 276–279
Actor 2, 3, 5, 9, 16–19, 22, 23,
25–27, 40, 45, 57, 59–61,
100, 105, 113, 119, 132, 142,
143, 153, 160, 162, 163, 168,
174, 182, 183, 185, 187, 191,
202, 203, 205, 213, 216–218,
224–226, 228–230, 238, 239,
246, 250, 251, 256, 266, 267,
274–276, 278, 279
Adams, J. 160
Adaption 7, 22, 26, 27, 140
Administration 7, 22, 63, 65, 127,
130–132, 151, 228, 230, 237
Aembe, B. 162, 173
Africa 2, 102, 112, 160, 170, 171
Agamben, G. 83–85, 87–91
Agency 3, 6, 7, 17, 23, 24, 46, 49,
60, 73, 127, 129, 140, 141,
146, 150, 160, 168–172, 183,
184, 187–189, 192–194, 204,
246, 278, 279
Agentic 8, 23, 26, 27, 74, 140, 141,
184, 193
Albert, S. 16, 61, 202
Aldama, A.M. 87, 88
© The Editor(s) (if applicable) and The Author(s) 2020
H. Askeland et al. (eds.), Understanding Values Work,
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9
285
https://doi.org/10.1007/978-3-030-37748-9
286 Index
Alford, R.R. 16, 23, 26, 27, 48, 60,
188
Alvesson, M. 49, 82, 98, 126, 131,
268
Ambiguity/ambiguous 7, 16, 19, 26,
27, 90, 92, 118, 123, 152,
154, 203, 204, 215, 216, 219,
225, 234, 239
Ancona, D.G. 187
Ansell, C. 122, 135
Anteby, M. 86
Argyris, C. 202
Askeland, H. 3, 5–7, 16, 17, 19, 20,
23, 25, 27, 37, 42, 47, 70,
73, 101, 102, 119, 123, 135,
140–143, 147, 148, 151, 152,
182, 185, 206, 246, 247, 266,
268
Attitudes 1, 18, 25, 201, 234
Authentic leadership 5
B
Barley, S.R. 3, 26
Battilana, J. 26
Bednarek-Gilland, A. 16–19, 25, 27,
188
Bento da Silva, Jose 7
Besharov, M.L. 48, 83, 121, 123,
134
Bevir, M. 117
Billis, D. 3, 57, 58, 67, 68, 71, 72
Bode, I. 66, 72
Børve, H.E. 99, 100
Bourne, H. 25, 37, 39
Bozeman, B. 223, 225, 226
Brown, M.E. 19
Brown, S.W. 267
Brunero, S. 269
Bryman, A. 272
Busch, T. 64, 71
Byrkjeflot, H. 100, 205, 226
C
Carver, C.S. 268
Catholic Religious Order 83, 84, 92
Certeau, M. 86
Change 5–7, 15, 19, 23, 24, 27,
28, 37, 38, 41–45, 47, 60,
70–73, 82, 91, 118–120, 129,
130, 134, 140, 141, 150, 152,
153, 166, 167, 169, 183–185,
187–190, 192, 193, 202, 204,
210, 214, 217, 218, 239, 247,
253, 266, 269
Chanut, V. 18, 20, 47
Character 7, 15, 27, 49, 59, 71, 72,
91, 120, 121, 125, 139–142,
145, 146, 148, 149, 151, 153,
188, 250, 252, 255, 256, 260,
261
Charismatic 5, 20
Chomienne, H. 47
Christensen, T. 63–66
Christo-Baker, E.A. 159, 160
Citizen 8, 61, 63–65, 67, 69, 70,
124, 128, 130, 131, 133, 228,
235–237, 245, 248, 262
Civic 2, 58, 61, 64–70, 72, 130,
162, 249
Civic organisation 57, 67, 68,
70–72, 146
Coghlan, D. 270
Cognitive 2, 8, 20, 22, 35, 44, 65,
124, 126, 127, 135, 183, 261
Collective 16–22, 25, 26, 40, 44,
60, 68, 69, 100, 132, 142,
Index 287
161, 163, 164, 170, 172, 174,
201, 224, 260, 266
Community 64, 67, 68, 89–91, 123,
127–130, 132, 141, 146, 152,
160–162, 167, 169–174, 186,
204, 207
Comparative 98–100, 113
Complex context 6, 58, 59, 61, 74
Concept/conceptions 4, 6, 16–21,
24, 26, 27, 36, 42, 43, 45, 60,
67, 72, 81, 82, 90, 98, 100,
118–121, 123, 124, 140, 141,
145, 160, 181, 183, 186, 203,
217, 224, 235, 237, 238, 250,
260, 266, 268, 279
Configuration 9, 205, 219
Conflict 8, 25, 40, 46, 110, 120,
123, 124, 127, 129, 130, 152,
160, 161, 172–174, 211, 215,
219, 273
Confronting 171, 210, 212
Construct 6, 8, 16, 21, 49, 50, 73,
88, 219, 245, 246, 260, 268,
278
Context/contextual 2, 4, 5, 8, 15,
19, 25–27, 37, 39, 44, 49,
50, 57–59, 63, 65, 73, 90,
92, 97, 99–101, 103, 104,
107–110, 112, 113, 119, 140,
141, 143, 148, 149, 159, 160,
162, 168–174, 202–204, 206,
215, 218, 225, 226, 228–231,
236, 237, 239, 247–249, 257,
259, 260, 268
Core values 4, 9, 15, 49, 50, 64, 72,
148, 150, 152, 185, 186, 191,
202–206, 208, 210, 212–219
Creed, W.E.D. 278
Crevani, L. 82
Cross-cultural management 98, 99,
113
Cultural configuration 8, 99, 100,
109, 112
Cultural/culture 2, 4, 18, 20, 22, 35,
58, 59, 62, 64, 66, 97–101,
103, 107, 111–113, 160, 162,
169–171, 183, 202, 228, 229,
237, 239, 261
Cultural dimensions 98
Culturally endorsed implicit lead-
ership theory (CLT) 98,
100
Cultural universals 98, 99, 113
Czarniawska, B. 191
D
Daskalaki, M. 42, 47, 186
Democratic Republic of Congo
(DRC) 8, 160, 161, 173, 174
Denters, B. 122
Desai, P.B. 47
Desirable 1, 3, 15, 17, 18, 21, 25,
26, 43, 160, 163, 170, 172,
183, 187, 194, 201, 224, 225,
229, 239, 245, 246
Desmarais, C. 47
de Vries, M. 16
Dewey, J. 36, 43, 186
Diaconia 145, 149, 207
Dialogue 7, 9, 19, 45, 86, 90, 92,
113, 125, 130, 134, 135, 206,
227, 249, 269, 276
DiMaggio, P.J. 23, 59, 122, 125,
140
Discourse 4, 16, 18, 38, 50, 112,
143, 150, 183, 185, 186, 191,
288 Index
201, 202, 205–207, 209, 214,
215, 217, 219, 224, 234
Disrupt 6, 189
Distinguish 7, 17, 21, 59, 82, 225
Durkheim, E. 23
Dutton, J.E. 266, 267, 279
E
Eden, D. 98
Edmondson, A.C. 202, 205, 274
Eisenberg, E.M. 204, 215, 216
Elasticity 9, 203–205, 216–219
Eliasoph, N. 258
Embedded 5, 15, 22, 49, 57, 60, 68,
73, 74, 100, 119, 123, 124,
143, 187, 252
Embedded agency 124, 153, 186
Emirbayer, M. 187
Emotions 40, 46, 274–278
Espedal, G. 3, 4, 6, 8, 16, 73, 160,
183, 189, 192, 206, 225, 229,
239, 246, 266, 269
Ethics 5, 19, 21, 206, 269
Europe 2, 62, 70, 194, 235
Evers, A. 67
Executives 36, 122, 142, 151, 152,
165, 170
External pressure 7, 26, 120, 127
F
Facilitation 7, 139
Facts 67, 82, 84, 118, 161, 172,
173, 182, 202, 224, 225, 230,
234, 248, 250, 257
Fairclough, N. 229, 230
Faith-based organisation 42, 47, 73,
183, 189, 190, 206
Falkenberg, G. 4, 148, 185
Fang, T. 98, 99
Field 5, 8, 16, 20, 22, 25, 27, 39,
40, 44, 59, 66, 81–83, 100,
102, 104, 105, 108–113, 119,
123, 124, 126, 141, 184, 188,
227
Fligstein, N. 131, 132
Fluid 9, 203, 205, 209, 215–217,
219, 278
Foxes 118, 125, 130, 134, 135
Framework 5, 9, 39, 61, 74, 90, 98,
100, 105, 109, 112, 126, 169,
224, 229, 230, 272
Freire, P. 170
Friedland, R. 16, 23, 25–27, 48, 60,
188
Fukuyama, F. 225, 226
Functionalism 4, 23
Future oriented 7
G
Gawer, A. 121, 126
Gehman, J. 3, 5, 16, 19, 20, 23, 25,
27, 36, 37, 42–47, 142, 143,
181, 183, 186, 192, 202, 204,
216, 217, 228–230, 233, 234,
236, 239, 240, 269
Gender roles 166, 168–171
Giddens, A. 225, 268
Gilardi, F. 117
The Global South 160, 174
GLOBE 98, 100
Glynn, A. 7, 16, 20, 23, 139, 153
Golant, B.D. 23, 140
Good organisation 7, 142, 144
Index 289
Governance 42, 50, 58, 65, 66, 72,
87, 117, 122, 125, 127, 132,
133, 142, 223, 224, 230
Graeber, D. 25
Green, M.J. 98
Greenwood, R. 2, 3, 22, 45, 58, 60,
189
Grönlund, H. 247, 260, 268
Group reflection 9, 266–270,
272–279
H
Habitual agency 7, 119, 126, 134
Haers, J. 256
Hallet, T. 126
Haveman, H.A. 81
Heaphy, E. 266, 279
Hinings, C.R. 48, 58
Historical 39, 58, 61, 63, 83, 133,
146, 148, 162, 189, 191, 204
Hitlin, S. 16, 25
Hofstede, G. 98, 113, 182
Hooghe, M. 248
Hospital 87, 191, 192, 203,
205–210, 212–215, 217
House, R.J. 5, 20, 25, 98, 113
Hultén, P. 251
Humbred, B.K. 267, 268, 274, 275
Hustinx, L. 246, 247, 252, 260
I
Ideal 6, 8, 9, 19, 21, 26, 43, 68, 69,
123, 125, 160, 189, 201, 217,
246
Identifying 38, 39, 42, 98, 182, 185,
188, 191, 193, 194, 210, 212,
268, 278
Identity 6, 8, 15, 16, 22, 24, 27, 42,
44, 46, 47, 59–61, 68, 71
Identity processes 9, 268, 274, 277
Identity work 16, 126, 128, 134,
140, 246, 268, 275, 278
Immigrant 101, 103, 106–109
Implicit 8, 21, 26, 97–101, 103,
104, 106–110, 112, 113, 142,
160, 162, 168, 170
Implicit leadership theory 98, 100,
107
Individual 7–9, 16–18, 21, 22, 24,
26, 27, 37, 47, 48, 50, 68, 82,
85, 86, 88–92, 98, 100, 103,
104, 106, 112, 119–121, 124,
161, 163, 170, 189, 203, 204,
224, 237, 245, 246, 255, 261,
266–268, 273–279
Infusing values 140, 152
Inglehart, R. 18, 182
Innovation 44, 118, 125, 131, 184,
228, 236, 266
Institutionalisation process 92
Institutionalism 59, 60, 73, 81, 82,
188, 189
Institutional leadership 3, 5–7, 16,
20, 21, 24, 27, 28, 49, 81–83,
85, 91, 92, 118–122, 125,
126, 135, 139–141, 153, 162
Institutional logic 9, 16, 22–24,
26–28, 48–50, 58, 60, 61, 65,
70, 74, 121, 128, 188, 202,
205, 229, 230, 233, 239
Institutional pluralism 2, 24, 27,
117, 119, 121–123, 131, 134,
135, 141, 143, 153, 205
Institutional theory 15, 16, 19, 20,
22–26, 38, 59, 60, 140, 188
Institutional void 123
290 Index
Institutional work 6, 7, 16, 20, 23,
28, 40, 42, 46, 49, 82, 92,
118–120, 125, 126, 129–131,
133, 134, 140, 141, 152, 188,
192, 193, 204
Institutionalising 141, 147
Institution/institutional 2, 3, 5, 6,
8, 15, 16, 21–24, 27, 37, 41,
42, 44, 45, 47–49, 57–63,
65–67, 70–74, 82–84, 92,
100, 104, 105, 108, 112, 113,
118–127, 133, 134, 141–143,
145–151, 160, 162, 171–174,
183, 186–191, 193, 194, 202,
204, 223, 225, 226, 230, 234,
236, 246, 266, 269, 270, 276
Intention/intentionally 3, 7, 27, 118,
139–141, 143, 147, 182, 188,
189, 191, 208, 217, 219, 225,
226, 253, 259, 271
Interpretation 3, 16, 19, 26, 40, 61,
101, 118, 129, 135, 151, 153,
154, 185, 202, 204, 206, 208,
210, 215–219, 233, 250, 251,
253, 271, 272
Isomorphism/isomorphic pressures
8, 59, 65, 119, 122, 127
J
Jackall, R. 228
Jäger, U.P. 67, 68, 70, 71
Jarzabkowski, P. 60
Jeavons, T.M. 16, 140
Jenkins, M. 25, 37, 39
Jensen, A.R. 269, 276
Jensen, K. 227
Jesuit 7, 83–92
Jørgensen, T.B. 16, 20, 148, 223,
226
K
Kaarbø, K. 224
Kahneman, D. 267, 276
Kemmis, S. 17
Kessel, T.B. 8, 170, 171
Khodyakov, D. 225, 228
Kim, P.S. 16
Kivle, Benedicte Tveter 8
Kluckhohn, C. 17, 21, 25, 43, 162,
170
Knowles, D. 90
Kraatz, M.S. 2, 7, 16, 20, 23, 26,
27, 42, 81, 82, 119–121, 125,
126, 131, 133, 139–141, 143,
153
Kunda, G. 3, 26
L
Lægreid, P. 63–66
Langley, A. 45, 46, 181, 182, 184,
186, 187, 190, 191
Language 6, 16, 36, 37, 49, 60, 149,
247, 261
Lawrence, T.B. 3, 4, 16, 22, 23, 43,
46, 82, 118, 124–126, 141,
188, 193, 230
Leaders 3–5, 7, 8, 16, 18, 20, 22,
23, 26, 42, 49, 83, 91, 92,
103, 104, 107, 108, 110, 113,
118–130, 134, 139–142, 145,
147, 148, 150–153, 159, 160,
162–165, 167–170, 172–174,
182, 185, 186, 271, 273, 274,
276, 278
Index 291
Leadership 4, 5, 7–9, 16, 17, 19, 20,
22, 24, 25, 27, 92
Leadership philosophy 20, 151
Legitimacy 22, 24, 26, 42, 72, 110,
118, 120, 127, 130, 148–151
Lencioni, P.M. 5, 18
Lerner, G. 171
Leviatan, U. 98
Lieblich, A. 163
Lindheim, T. 8
Lions 118, 125, 131, 134, 135
Lok, J. 278
Løkvik, O. 269
Lounsbury, M. 2, 3, 48, 58, 60, 121
Løvaas, B.J. 9, 119, 246, 266
M
Macro-process 42, 99, 140
Madimbo, M. 160, 171
Mahoney, J. 126, 204
Maierhofer, N.I. 19, 142
Maintain 4, 6, 7, 15, 23, 40, 44, 63,
69, 120, 122, 144, 151, 185,
189, 192, 203, 204, 225, 239
Management 7, 19, 20, 37, 47, 63,
72, 73, 83, 109–111, 117,
123, 128, 133, 170, 190,
211–215, 224, 226, 228, 230,
237, 238, 249, 266
Managers 7–9, 16, 49, 50, 63, 73,
74, 86, 89, 97–103, 105–109,
111–113, 140, 142, 144,
147, 150, 151, 190, 201–206,
208–215, 217–219, 227, 228,
235, 265–267, 269–271, 273,
274, 279
Market 2, 6, 61–63, 65, 67, 68, 70,
127, 129, 132
Materiality 85
Meglino, B.M. 16, 17, 25, 35
Methodology 8
Meyer, J.W. 22, 44, 59, 140, 188,
189
Meyer, M. 70
Meyer, R. 16
Micelotta, E.R. 2, 3, 58, 60
Micro-process 2, 3, 38, 40, 44, 187,
192, 218
Mintzberg, H. 16
Mische, A. 187
Mission 7, 44, 62, 67, 68, 70, 71,
73, 120, 132, 139, 141, 142,
144–153, 185, 191, 203, 206,
250, 257, 259
Mobilise 21, 25, 26, 40, 46, 47
Moles 118, 134, 135
Monastic order 84, 88, 90
Monastic rules 87, 88
Moore, J.H. 7, 140
Moore, M.H. 16
Moral work 2, 3, 194
Multicultural 49, 97, 99–101, 103,
109, 112, 113
Musick, M. 260
Mustafa, G. 98
N
Narrative 42, 127, 130, 133, 134,
152, 153, 160, 169, 172–174,
189, 191, 206, 208, 248, 257
Narrative life stories 163
Negotiate 8, 9, 49, 50, 97, 99, 100,
103, 104, 109, 119, 131, 161,
168, 171, 172, 174, 202–206,
208, 212, 216, 219
Neo-institutionalism 82
292 Index
Networks 38, 42, 45, 64, 68, 70, 72,
120, 143, 145, 161, 169, 186,
229, 239
New Public Governance (NPG) 118,
123, 224
New Public Management (NPM)
63–65, 68, 117, 122, 123,
224, 231, 236, 238
Ngongo, K.F. 161, 173
Ngunjiri, F.W. 159, 160, 162, 170,
171
Nicolini, D. 99
Njoroge, N. 160
Non-profit management 16
Non-profit organization 70
Normative 4, 8, 16, 17, 19, 21–25,
41, 43, 44, 46–48, 59, 64, 65,
68, 69, 73, 124, 127, 135,
143, 224, 239, 246, 248, 252,
261
Norway 61, 62, 64, 66, 97, 99, 102,
106–110, 146, 194, 228, 230,
231, 235
Nyhan, R.C. 224, 226, 227
O
Ocasio, T. 224, 229, 230, 239
Ocasio, W. 23, 48, 58, 60, 121
Objectivist 18
Oduyoye, M.A. 171, 172
Oliver, C. 3, 45
O’Malley, J.W. 84, 88
Openness 65, 92, 188, 227, 228,
237, 273, 274, 276, 279
Organisational history 202
Organisational institutionalism 4, 6,
15–17, 278
Organisational integrity 133, 134
Organisation/organisational 1–9,
15–27, 35–50, 57–65, 67, 68,
70–74, 81–83, 85, 86, 90,
92, 99–101, 104, 105, 108,
112, 113, 118–125, 127, 128,
130–135, 139–149, 151–153,
160, 162–164, 173, 174,
181–194, 201–206, 208, 215,
217, 218, 245, 246, 248, 249,
251, 252, 257, 259, 265–269,
273, 274, 276, 278, 279
Ostriches 134
P
Palazzo, G. 3, 16, 20, 23, 37, 38,
43–45, 47, 142, 143, 181,
183, 187
Parsonian 23, 24, 27
Parsons, T. 21, 24, 43
Paths to leadership 8, 163, 170, 173,
174
Patton, M.Q. 192
Perception 18, 43, 107, 124, 128,
129, 238, 246
Performance 3, 4, 6, 35, 38, 43,
166, 182, 191, 192, 227, 236
Performance management 4, 231
Performative 2, 6, 8, 43, 47, 57,
181, 186
Perkmann, M. 37, 39, 44, 47
Petersen, V.C. 5, 20, 142
Pettigrew, A.M. 190
Phillips, N. 46, 121, 126, 141, 183,
188, 189
Piliavin, J.A. 16, 25
Poland 124
Poverty 7, 62, 83–92, 258
Powell, W.W. 59, 122, 140
Index 293
Practice 1–9, 15, 18–20, 22–24, 26,
28, 35, 36, 40, 42–45, 48,
49, 57, 58, 60, 61, 68, 71,
87, 98–101, 103, 106, 111,
112, 118, 121, 125–134, 140,
142–145, 147–149, 151–153,
160, 162, 163, 168, 170, 172,
181, 182, 184–187, 189–193,
202, 203, 205–209, 211,
214–219, 224, 227–229, 234,
235, 237–239, 246, 265–267,
269, 270, 278, 279
Practice work 126, 129, 131
Preisler, M. 224, 226, 227
Procedural logic 84
Process-based 8
Process perspective 8, 45, 49, 141,
183, 184, 189
Process theory 184
Processual 2, 23, 27, 57, 143, 153,
188, 219, 229
Profession/professional 25, 40, 44,
58, 60, 64, 72, 100, 101,
112, 128, 129, 131, 141–143,
146–153, 183, 186, 194, 201,
204, 205, 207, 210–214, 216,
226–228, 235, 237, 239, 249,
257, 268, 269
Projective 7, 119
Projective agency 125, 126, 134, 135
Public 2–4, 6, 16, 20, 40, 47, 50,
57, 58, 61, 62, 64, 66–68, 71,
122, 124, 127–129, 131, 133,
143, 145, 146, 149, 150, 153,
162, 163, 223, 226, 239, 270
Public administration (PA) 16, 117,
118, 121–124, 127, 130,
132–134, 230
Public disputes 124, 125, 127
Public organisation 64, 65, 72, 122,
148, 224, 225, 228, 230, 234,
235, 237, 239, 240
Public sector 63–68, 70, 72,
223–228, 230, 233, 235, 238,
239
Purpose 1, 2, 4, 15, 39, 49, 58, 67,
71, 121, 228, 250, 253, 266,
279
Putnam, R.D. 123, 226
Q
Quattrone, P. 84, 86, 90
Quinn, R.E. 16, 25, 36, 201
R
Raffaelli, R. 7, 16, 20, 23, 139, 153
Rantakari, A. 191
Rational 20, 59, 68, 140, 224,
254–256
Ravlin, E.C. 16, 17, 25, 35
Realign 41, 183, 193
Reay, T. 48, 58
Recognition 172, 267, 271,
274–276, 279
Recurring 7, 28, 139, 141, 146, 152,
153, 254, 258
Reflection 9, 37, 135, 150, 151,
185, 266, 267, 269
Reflexivity 50, 266, 268
Regulations 65, 131, 149
Relational agency 278, 279
Relational skills 160
Religious organisation 7, 83, 141,
160, 164, 165
Research 3, 4, 16–21, 26, 27, 35–37,
47, 49, 50, 59, 98, 124,
294 Index
140–142, 144, 163, 182–186,
189–191, 193, 203, 214, 215,
217, 226, 238, 245–248, 259,
266, 267, 270, 279
Ricoeur, P. 191, 248
Riessman, C.K. 191
Rokeach, M. 18, 25, 202
Role 3, 23, 27, 39, 46, 47, 49, 59,
83, 86, 89–91, 100, 105, 106,
118, 120, 122, 125, 127, 128,
130, 132, 141–143, 147, 152,
162–164, 166, 168, 173, 174,
186, 191, 206, 231, 248, 271,
278, 279
Rosnes, E.V. 161, 163
Røvik, K.A. 63–65, 71, 72
Rowan, B. 44, 59, 140, 188
S
Sachar, I. 246
Sahlin, K. 44, 45
Salient 59, 140
Scandinavia 2, 44, 61–64, 141, 224,
227
Schatzki, T.R. 36, 43, 186
Schein, E.H. 36, 202, 218
Schibbye, A.L.L. 275
Schneider, B. 266
Scholarly 18, 58, 160, 246
Schön, D. 202
Schultz, M. 187
Schwartz, S.H. 18, 25, 36, 43, 182,
187
Scott, W.R. 22, 24, 43, 44, 46, 100,
101, 224
Self-awareness 170, 268, 274–278
Selznick, P. 5–8, 20–22, 24, 25, 42,
59, 61, 71, 73, 83, 91, 92,
118–125, 134, 139–141, 149,
153, 189, 193, 203, 217, 224
Simon, H.A. 17, 18
Sirris, S. 3, 6, 9, 16, 23, 73, 119,
205, 206, 230, 239, 246, 260,
268, 278
Skaine, R. 159, 160, 170
Social corporate responsibility 5
Social system 44
Societal (culture) 18, 35, 49, 69,
97–100, 103, 107, 113, 120,
122, 149, 160, 162, 168, 182,
185, 204, 215, 229, 259
South Kivu 8, 160, 161, 163, 168,
172–174
Spates, J.L. 16, 17, 21, 24, 163, 170
Spicer, A. 37, 39, 44, 47, 82
Spiritual Exercises (SE) 85–87, 89
Stake, R.E. 101
Stephens, J.P. 266
Stinchcombe, A.L. 189
Story, D 253
Strategic 37, 73, 141, 146, 149, 174,
191, 204, 216, 217, 225
Strong-process theory 186
Struminska-Kutra, M. 7, 127, 140
Submission of women in patriarchal
contexts 172
Suddaby, R. 4, 22, 23, 45, 82, 118,
125, 140, 141, 144, 145, 188,
189, 193, 230
Sundet, J. 279
T
Taken for granted 4, 16, 19, 23, 57,
72, 162, 188, 247, 253
Targeting 209, 214, 215, 218
Taylor, C. 246–248, 260
Index 295
Technical system 21
Temporal mobilising 23
Textual analysis 9, 223, 230, 232,
233, 238
Thelen, K. 126, 204
Thornton, P.H. 23, 48, 58, 60, 61,
121, 228–230
Tolbert, P.S. 193
Tradition 5, 6, 17, 18, 20, 64, 70,
73, 84, 98, 99, 141, 145, 148,
150–152, 159, 168, 193, 206,
247
Trajectory 6, 16, 17, 35, 59, 60
Transform 7, 38, 183, 187, 246
Transformational leadership 5, 20,
227
Translating 5, 7, 119, 123, 149, 153
Trans-situational 26, 43, 160, 170,
187
Trans-subjective 19
Treviño, L.K. 19, 38, 228
Trust 8, 9, 62, 68, 170, 171,
223–228, 230, 233–240, 245,
273, 278
Trust-based management (TBM)
9, 224–228, 231, 233, 234,
236–238
Typology of leaders-innovators 118,
119
V
Vaccaro, A. 3, 16, 20, 23, 37, 43–45,
47, 142, 143, 181, 183, 187
Valuation 15, 17, 19, 21, 25, 26, 46,
48, 226
Value-rationality 20
Value-related 4, 142, 192, 266, 267,
269, 274, 276
Values 1, 4, 7, 9, 17, 18, 20–22, 25,
26, 37, 40, 42, 46, 48, 49,
59, 71, 83–85, 91, 92, 135,
140, 142, 146, 152, 161, 168,
169, 172, 174, 182, 183, 185,
188, 190–194, 201–207, 213,
216–219, 223–226, 228, 230,
239, 240, 259, 267, 273, 274
Values-based 70, 134
Values-based leadership 5, 20, 270
Values consciousness 5, 50, 153,
215, 266
Values-in-use 35, 37, 202
Value spheres 48
Values practice 18, 36–38, 42, 43,
45–47, 49, 142, 151, 183,
186, 187, 191, 206, 217, 229,
230, 234, 236, 240
Values work 1–9, 15–18, 20, 23, 25,
27, 28, 36–38, 42–47, 49, 50,
57–60, 71, 73, 74, 97, 112,
139–147, 151, 152, 160–164,
168–170, 172–174, 181–183,
185–194, 202, 203, 209, 214,
217, 219, 223, 224, 228–230,
233, 234, 238–240, 245, 246,
248, 266, 267, 269, 278, 279
Van Deth, J.W. 18, 25, 43, 224
Ventresca, M. 123, 126
Vieira, K.A.L. 230, 232
Violence against women 165
Volunteer 8, 68, 69, 245–258, 260,
261
Volunteering 50, 62, 245–257,
259–261
von Essen, J. 8, 246, 247, 251, 256,
259
Vråle, G.B. 9, 246, 267–269, 275,
276, 278
296 Index
Vrangbæk, K. 16, 148
W
Wæraas, A. 9, 72, 73, 148, 149,
153, 202, 217
Wakahiu, J. 160, 171
Washington, M. 20, 23, 27, 81, 82,
118, 120, 140
Weak-process theory 182
Weber, M. 20, 23, 48, 88
Weick, K.E. 184
Welfare organisations 2, 57, 58, 61,
64, 65, 71–74, 185, 249
Whetten, D.A. 16, 61, 202
Whitman, S. 161
Wilson, J. 246, 260
Women and entrepreneurial
leadership 162
Women leadership 162, 171, 172
Women’s rights 160, 163, 165,
172–174
Work 2–4, 9, 15, 24, 26, 27, 276,
279
Workplace 2, 36, 49, 97, 99–101,
103, 109, 112, 113, 227, 267,
279
Work relationships 265–267, 270,
273, 279
Wuthnow, R. 247, 251, 261
Z
Zelizer, V.A. 254, 260
Zietsma, C. 124–126, 278
Zilber, T.B. 42, 43, 49, 101, 163,
189
Acknowledgements
Contents
Notes on Contributors
List of Figures
List of Tables
1 Understanding Values Work in Organisations and Leadership
Purpose and Focus of the Book
Introducing Values and Values Work
Values in Organisations and Leadership
Overview of Chapters in the Book
The What of Understanding Values Work—A Theoretical Framework
Exploring Who Is Doing Values Work—The Actors
Understanding How to Do Values Work
References
I Understanding Values, Values Work and Complex Institutional Contexts
2 Values—Reviewing the Construct and Drawing Implications for Values Work in Organisation and Leadership
Introduction
Basic Distinctions and Trajectory of the Values’ Concept
Values in Streams of Institutional Theory
Rounding Out the Concept of Values
Implications for Values Work in Organisation and Leadership
References
3 What Is Values Work? A Review of Values Work in Organisations
Research on Values Work: An Introduction
A Literature Review of Values Work in Organisations
Defining Values Work
The Institutional Context of Studies on Values Work
Values Work in Investigating Institutional Processes
Values Work Enhancing Normative Dimensions of Work
Outcomes of Studies on Values Work
Future Research on Values Work
References
4 Institutional Complexity Challenging Values and Identities in Scandinavian Welfare Organisations
Introduction
Institutional Complexity
The Context of the Scandinavian Welfare State
Introducing a Market Logic
Changes Affecting Public Values
The Welfare Mix
Coexisting Logics in Welfare Organisations
The Sectors as Ideal Types
Hybrid Civic Organisations and Values
Overall Discussion
Concluding Remarks
References
II Who Performs Values Work?
5 Institutional Leadership—The Historical Case Study of a Religious Organisation
Institutional Leadership as Institutional Work
The Jesuits
Ordering Individual Values
Ordering the Corpus’ Values
Ordering a Poor Way of Life
Leading a ‘Poor’ Corpus
Conclusion
Published Sources
References
6 ‘Good Leaders Do the Dirty Work’: Implicit Leadership Theory at the Multicultural Workplace
Introduction
A Critical Review of the Comparative Paradigm of Cultural Universals
Exploring Implicit Ideas of Leadership at the Multicultural Workplace
Research Design and Methods
Implicit Ideas of Leadership at the Multicultural Workplace
Implicit Ideas of Good and Bad Leadership in the Nursing Homes
Contextual Factors and Individual Experiences as Sources of Implicit Ideas of Leadership
Negotiating Leadership in the Nursing Homes
Concluding Remarks
References
7 Foxes and Lions: How Institutional Leaders Keep Organisational Integrity and Introduce Change
Introduction
Institutional Leadership: Linking Field, Organisation and Actor Levels
Institutional Pluralism and Public Administration
The Institutional Embodiment of Purpose: Strategies for (Not) Building Integrity While (Not) Introducing Change
Habitual and Projective Agency
Empirical Illustrations
Conclusions
References
8 Institutional Leadership: Maintaining and Developing the ‘Good’ Organisation
Introduction
Relating Values Work and Institutional Leadership
Research Setting
Mission, Character and the Embodiment of Values
Conceiving of the Good Home: Continuity and Development in Institutionalising the Mission
Leaders’ Contribution to Institutionalising ‘the Common Good’: Value Processes as Conveying of Character and the Role of the Organisation
Conceiving of and Performing ‘Good Practice’: Embodying Values in Organisational Structure and Practice
Concluding Remarks
References
9 Women’s Path to Leadership Through Values Work in a Context of Conflict and Violence
Introduction
A Context of Conflict and Violence
Women Leadership, Values and Values Work
Discovering Paths to Leadership Through Narrative Life Stories
Basombana’s Story
Kusinza’s Story
Individual and Collective Values on Education of Girls
Values Work Within the Framework of Religious Civil Society Organisations
The Fight for Women’s Rights
Concluding Remarks
References
III How Is Values Work Performed?
10 Catching Values in Flight: A Process Perspective on Researching Values in Organisations
Introduction
Process Studies and Values Work
Process Studies’ Role in Enhancing the Temporal and Relational Aspects of Organisational Work
Values as Part of Institutionalising Processes
Investigating Values Informed by Process Studies—A Strong-Process Perspective
Concluding Remarks
References
11 Values as Fixed and Fluid: Negotiating the Elasticity of Core Values
Introduction
Theoretical Perspectives on Core Values as Fixed and Fluid
Research Context and Methods
Research Setting and the Values Discourse
Data Collection and Analysis
Case Description and Findings
Framing
Targeting
Confronting
Identifying
Negotiating
Discussion
Capturing the Fixed and Fluid Nature of Values
The Elasticity of Values
The Shortcomings of Core Values
Concluding Remarks
References
12 Work on Values When Shaping Public Institutions: “What’s Trust Got to Do with It?”—Experiences from Scandinavia
Introduction
The Value of Trust in Public Institutions
The Context: Models and Reforms on Trust in Scandinavia
Theoretical Perspectives: Values Work and Institutional Logic
Research Setting and Method
Research Setting
Textual Analysis
Findings
Values Work Mechanisms
Pockets of Concern and Competing Understandings of Root Causes
Practising Trust, Possibilities and Obstacles
Circulating Trust
Discussion
Conclusion
References
13 The Art of Making Sense of Volunteering
Introduction
Agents, Values and Identity
The Volunteers
Not Paid
Engagement
Voluntary
For the Benefit of the Other
So, Why Not Money?
The Rewards of Unpaid Work
Discussion
References
14 The Value of Group Reflection
Introduction
Theoretical Framework and Previous Research
Identity
Self-Awareness in Identity Processes
Supervision
Method
Description of the Intervention
Data Analysis
Ethical Considerations and Limitations of the Study
Findings
Moving Inward
Moving Forward
Discussion
Concluding Remarks
References
Index